mirror of
https://github.com/Luzifer/cloudkeys-go.git
synced 2024-11-14 08:52:44 +00:00
9c6e3c89a5
* fix js scoping issue * add external libraries (they were offline too often) * new compiled scripts and css * new fixes in the binary * vendor update * change js source * remove needless variable * removed more needless variables
17084 lines
560 KiB
Go
17084 lines
560 KiB
Go
// Code generated by private/model/cli/gen-api/main.go. DO NOT EDIT.
|
|
|
|
package medialive
|
|
|
|
import (
|
|
"fmt"
|
|
|
|
"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/aws"
|
|
"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/aws/awsutil"
|
|
"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/aws/request"
|
|
"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/private/protocol"
|
|
"github.com/aws/aws-sdk-go/private/protocol/restjson"
|
|
)
|
|
|
|
const opBatchUpdateSchedule = "BatchUpdateSchedule"
|
|
|
|
// BatchUpdateScheduleRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
|
|
// client's request for the BatchUpdateSchedule operation. The "output" return
|
|
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes
|
|
// successfully.
|
|
//
|
|
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
|
|
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See BatchUpdateSchedule for more information on using the BatchUpdateSchedule
|
|
// API call, and error handling.
|
|
//
|
|
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
|
|
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
|
|
//
|
|
//
|
|
// // Example sending a request using the BatchUpdateScheduleRequest method.
|
|
// req, resp := client.BatchUpdateScheduleRequest(params)
|
|
//
|
|
// err := req.Send()
|
|
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
|
|
// fmt.Println(resp)
|
|
// }
|
|
//
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/medialive-2017-10-14/BatchUpdateSchedule
|
|
func (c *MediaLive) BatchUpdateScheduleRequest(input *BatchUpdateScheduleInput) (req *request.Request, output *BatchUpdateScheduleOutput) {
|
|
op := &request.Operation{
|
|
Name: opBatchUpdateSchedule,
|
|
HTTPMethod: "PUT",
|
|
HTTPPath: "/prod/channels/{channelId}/schedule",
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if input == nil {
|
|
input = &BatchUpdateScheduleInput{}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
output = &BatchUpdateScheduleOutput{}
|
|
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
|
|
return
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// BatchUpdateSchedule API operation for AWS Elemental MediaLive.
|
|
//
|
|
// Update a channel schedule
|
|
//
|
|
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
|
|
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
|
|
// the error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See the AWS API reference guide for AWS Elemental MediaLive's
|
|
// API operation BatchUpdateSchedule for usage and error information.
|
|
//
|
|
// Returned Error Codes:
|
|
// * ErrCodeBadRequestException "BadRequestException"
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeUnprocessableEntityException "UnprocessableEntityException"
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeInternalServerErrorException "InternalServerErrorException"
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeForbiddenException "ForbiddenException"
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeBadGatewayException "BadGatewayException"
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeNotFoundException "NotFoundException"
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeGatewayTimeoutException "GatewayTimeoutException"
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeTooManyRequestsException "TooManyRequestsException"
|
|
//
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/medialive-2017-10-14/BatchUpdateSchedule
|
|
func (c *MediaLive) BatchUpdateSchedule(input *BatchUpdateScheduleInput) (*BatchUpdateScheduleOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.BatchUpdateScheduleRequest(input)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// BatchUpdateScheduleWithContext is the same as BatchUpdateSchedule with the addition of
|
|
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
|
|
//
|
|
// See BatchUpdateSchedule for details on how to use this API operation.
|
|
//
|
|
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
|
|
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
|
|
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
|
|
// for more information on using Contexts.
|
|
func (c *MediaLive) BatchUpdateScheduleWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *BatchUpdateScheduleInput, opts ...request.Option) (*BatchUpdateScheduleOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.BatchUpdateScheduleRequest(input)
|
|
req.SetContext(ctx)
|
|
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
const opCreateChannel = "CreateChannel"
|
|
|
|
// CreateChannelRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
|
|
// client's request for the CreateChannel operation. The "output" return
|
|
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes
|
|
// successfully.
|
|
//
|
|
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
|
|
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See CreateChannel for more information on using the CreateChannel
|
|
// API call, and error handling.
|
|
//
|
|
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
|
|
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
|
|
//
|
|
//
|
|
// // Example sending a request using the CreateChannelRequest method.
|
|
// req, resp := client.CreateChannelRequest(params)
|
|
//
|
|
// err := req.Send()
|
|
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
|
|
// fmt.Println(resp)
|
|
// }
|
|
//
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/medialive-2017-10-14/CreateChannel
|
|
func (c *MediaLive) CreateChannelRequest(input *CreateChannelInput) (req *request.Request, output *CreateChannelOutput) {
|
|
op := &request.Operation{
|
|
Name: opCreateChannel,
|
|
HTTPMethod: "POST",
|
|
HTTPPath: "/prod/channels",
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if input == nil {
|
|
input = &CreateChannelInput{}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
output = &CreateChannelOutput{}
|
|
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
|
|
return
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// CreateChannel API operation for AWS Elemental MediaLive.
|
|
//
|
|
// Creates a new channel
|
|
//
|
|
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
|
|
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
|
|
// the error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See the AWS API reference guide for AWS Elemental MediaLive's
|
|
// API operation CreateChannel for usage and error information.
|
|
//
|
|
// Returned Error Codes:
|
|
// * ErrCodeBadRequestException "BadRequestException"
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeUnprocessableEntityException "UnprocessableEntityException"
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeInternalServerErrorException "InternalServerErrorException"
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeForbiddenException "ForbiddenException"
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeBadGatewayException "BadGatewayException"
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeGatewayTimeoutException "GatewayTimeoutException"
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeTooManyRequestsException "TooManyRequestsException"
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeConflictException "ConflictException"
|
|
//
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/medialive-2017-10-14/CreateChannel
|
|
func (c *MediaLive) CreateChannel(input *CreateChannelInput) (*CreateChannelOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.CreateChannelRequest(input)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// CreateChannelWithContext is the same as CreateChannel with the addition of
|
|
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
|
|
//
|
|
// See CreateChannel for details on how to use this API operation.
|
|
//
|
|
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
|
|
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
|
|
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
|
|
// for more information on using Contexts.
|
|
func (c *MediaLive) CreateChannelWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *CreateChannelInput, opts ...request.Option) (*CreateChannelOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.CreateChannelRequest(input)
|
|
req.SetContext(ctx)
|
|
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
const opCreateInput = "CreateInput"
|
|
|
|
// CreateInputRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
|
|
// client's request for the CreateInput operation. The "output" return
|
|
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes
|
|
// successfully.
|
|
//
|
|
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
|
|
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See CreateInput for more information on using the CreateInput
|
|
// API call, and error handling.
|
|
//
|
|
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
|
|
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
|
|
//
|
|
//
|
|
// // Example sending a request using the CreateInputRequest method.
|
|
// req, resp := client.CreateInputRequest(params)
|
|
//
|
|
// err := req.Send()
|
|
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
|
|
// fmt.Println(resp)
|
|
// }
|
|
//
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/medialive-2017-10-14/CreateInput
|
|
func (c *MediaLive) CreateInputRequest(input *CreateInputInput) (req *request.Request, output *CreateInputOutput) {
|
|
op := &request.Operation{
|
|
Name: opCreateInput,
|
|
HTTPMethod: "POST",
|
|
HTTPPath: "/prod/inputs",
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if input == nil {
|
|
input = &CreateInputInput{}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
output = &CreateInputOutput{}
|
|
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
|
|
return
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// CreateInput API operation for AWS Elemental MediaLive.
|
|
//
|
|
// Create an input
|
|
//
|
|
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
|
|
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
|
|
// the error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See the AWS API reference guide for AWS Elemental MediaLive's
|
|
// API operation CreateInput for usage and error information.
|
|
//
|
|
// Returned Error Codes:
|
|
// * ErrCodeBadRequestException "BadRequestException"
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeInternalServerErrorException "InternalServerErrorException"
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeForbiddenException "ForbiddenException"
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeBadGatewayException "BadGatewayException"
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeGatewayTimeoutException "GatewayTimeoutException"
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeTooManyRequestsException "TooManyRequestsException"
|
|
//
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/medialive-2017-10-14/CreateInput
|
|
func (c *MediaLive) CreateInput(input *CreateInputInput) (*CreateInputOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.CreateInputRequest(input)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// CreateInputWithContext is the same as CreateInput with the addition of
|
|
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
|
|
//
|
|
// See CreateInput for details on how to use this API operation.
|
|
//
|
|
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
|
|
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
|
|
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
|
|
// for more information on using Contexts.
|
|
func (c *MediaLive) CreateInputWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *CreateInputInput, opts ...request.Option) (*CreateInputOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.CreateInputRequest(input)
|
|
req.SetContext(ctx)
|
|
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
const opCreateInputSecurityGroup = "CreateInputSecurityGroup"
|
|
|
|
// CreateInputSecurityGroupRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
|
|
// client's request for the CreateInputSecurityGroup operation. The "output" return
|
|
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes
|
|
// successfully.
|
|
//
|
|
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
|
|
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See CreateInputSecurityGroup for more information on using the CreateInputSecurityGroup
|
|
// API call, and error handling.
|
|
//
|
|
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
|
|
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
|
|
//
|
|
//
|
|
// // Example sending a request using the CreateInputSecurityGroupRequest method.
|
|
// req, resp := client.CreateInputSecurityGroupRequest(params)
|
|
//
|
|
// err := req.Send()
|
|
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
|
|
// fmt.Println(resp)
|
|
// }
|
|
//
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/medialive-2017-10-14/CreateInputSecurityGroup
|
|
func (c *MediaLive) CreateInputSecurityGroupRequest(input *CreateInputSecurityGroupInput) (req *request.Request, output *CreateInputSecurityGroupOutput) {
|
|
op := &request.Operation{
|
|
Name: opCreateInputSecurityGroup,
|
|
HTTPMethod: "POST",
|
|
HTTPPath: "/prod/inputSecurityGroups",
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if input == nil {
|
|
input = &CreateInputSecurityGroupInput{}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
output = &CreateInputSecurityGroupOutput{}
|
|
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
|
|
return
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// CreateInputSecurityGroup API operation for AWS Elemental MediaLive.
|
|
//
|
|
// Creates a Input Security Group
|
|
//
|
|
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
|
|
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
|
|
// the error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See the AWS API reference guide for AWS Elemental MediaLive's
|
|
// API operation CreateInputSecurityGroup for usage and error information.
|
|
//
|
|
// Returned Error Codes:
|
|
// * ErrCodeBadRequestException "BadRequestException"
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeInternalServerErrorException "InternalServerErrorException"
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeForbiddenException "ForbiddenException"
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeBadGatewayException "BadGatewayException"
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeGatewayTimeoutException "GatewayTimeoutException"
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeTooManyRequestsException "TooManyRequestsException"
|
|
//
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/medialive-2017-10-14/CreateInputSecurityGroup
|
|
func (c *MediaLive) CreateInputSecurityGroup(input *CreateInputSecurityGroupInput) (*CreateInputSecurityGroupOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.CreateInputSecurityGroupRequest(input)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// CreateInputSecurityGroupWithContext is the same as CreateInputSecurityGroup with the addition of
|
|
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
|
|
//
|
|
// See CreateInputSecurityGroup for details on how to use this API operation.
|
|
//
|
|
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
|
|
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
|
|
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
|
|
// for more information on using Contexts.
|
|
func (c *MediaLive) CreateInputSecurityGroupWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *CreateInputSecurityGroupInput, opts ...request.Option) (*CreateInputSecurityGroupOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.CreateInputSecurityGroupRequest(input)
|
|
req.SetContext(ctx)
|
|
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
const opDeleteChannel = "DeleteChannel"
|
|
|
|
// DeleteChannelRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
|
|
// client's request for the DeleteChannel operation. The "output" return
|
|
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes
|
|
// successfully.
|
|
//
|
|
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
|
|
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See DeleteChannel for more information on using the DeleteChannel
|
|
// API call, and error handling.
|
|
//
|
|
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
|
|
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
|
|
//
|
|
//
|
|
// // Example sending a request using the DeleteChannelRequest method.
|
|
// req, resp := client.DeleteChannelRequest(params)
|
|
//
|
|
// err := req.Send()
|
|
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
|
|
// fmt.Println(resp)
|
|
// }
|
|
//
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/medialive-2017-10-14/DeleteChannel
|
|
func (c *MediaLive) DeleteChannelRequest(input *DeleteChannelInput) (req *request.Request, output *DeleteChannelOutput) {
|
|
op := &request.Operation{
|
|
Name: opDeleteChannel,
|
|
HTTPMethod: "DELETE",
|
|
HTTPPath: "/prod/channels/{channelId}",
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if input == nil {
|
|
input = &DeleteChannelInput{}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
output = &DeleteChannelOutput{}
|
|
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
|
|
return
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// DeleteChannel API operation for AWS Elemental MediaLive.
|
|
//
|
|
// Starts deletion of channel. The associated outputs are also deleted.
|
|
//
|
|
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
|
|
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
|
|
// the error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See the AWS API reference guide for AWS Elemental MediaLive's
|
|
// API operation DeleteChannel for usage and error information.
|
|
//
|
|
// Returned Error Codes:
|
|
// * ErrCodeBadRequestException "BadRequestException"
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeInternalServerErrorException "InternalServerErrorException"
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeForbiddenException "ForbiddenException"
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeBadGatewayException "BadGatewayException"
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeNotFoundException "NotFoundException"
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeGatewayTimeoutException "GatewayTimeoutException"
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeTooManyRequestsException "TooManyRequestsException"
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeConflictException "ConflictException"
|
|
//
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/medialive-2017-10-14/DeleteChannel
|
|
func (c *MediaLive) DeleteChannel(input *DeleteChannelInput) (*DeleteChannelOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.DeleteChannelRequest(input)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// DeleteChannelWithContext is the same as DeleteChannel with the addition of
|
|
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
|
|
//
|
|
// See DeleteChannel for details on how to use this API operation.
|
|
//
|
|
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
|
|
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
|
|
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
|
|
// for more information on using Contexts.
|
|
func (c *MediaLive) DeleteChannelWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *DeleteChannelInput, opts ...request.Option) (*DeleteChannelOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.DeleteChannelRequest(input)
|
|
req.SetContext(ctx)
|
|
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
const opDeleteInput = "DeleteInput"
|
|
|
|
// DeleteInputRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
|
|
// client's request for the DeleteInput operation. The "output" return
|
|
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes
|
|
// successfully.
|
|
//
|
|
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
|
|
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See DeleteInput for more information on using the DeleteInput
|
|
// API call, and error handling.
|
|
//
|
|
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
|
|
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
|
|
//
|
|
//
|
|
// // Example sending a request using the DeleteInputRequest method.
|
|
// req, resp := client.DeleteInputRequest(params)
|
|
//
|
|
// err := req.Send()
|
|
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
|
|
// fmt.Println(resp)
|
|
// }
|
|
//
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/medialive-2017-10-14/DeleteInput
|
|
func (c *MediaLive) DeleteInputRequest(input *DeleteInputInput) (req *request.Request, output *DeleteInputOutput) {
|
|
op := &request.Operation{
|
|
Name: opDeleteInput,
|
|
HTTPMethod: "DELETE",
|
|
HTTPPath: "/prod/inputs/{inputId}",
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if input == nil {
|
|
input = &DeleteInputInput{}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
output = &DeleteInputOutput{}
|
|
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
|
|
req.Handlers.Unmarshal.Swap(restjson.UnmarshalHandler.Name, protocol.UnmarshalDiscardBodyHandler)
|
|
return
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// DeleteInput API operation for AWS Elemental MediaLive.
|
|
//
|
|
// Deletes the input end point
|
|
//
|
|
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
|
|
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
|
|
// the error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See the AWS API reference guide for AWS Elemental MediaLive's
|
|
// API operation DeleteInput for usage and error information.
|
|
//
|
|
// Returned Error Codes:
|
|
// * ErrCodeBadRequestException "BadRequestException"
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeInternalServerErrorException "InternalServerErrorException"
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeForbiddenException "ForbiddenException"
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeBadGatewayException "BadGatewayException"
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeNotFoundException "NotFoundException"
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeGatewayTimeoutException "GatewayTimeoutException"
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeTooManyRequestsException "TooManyRequestsException"
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeConflictException "ConflictException"
|
|
//
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/medialive-2017-10-14/DeleteInput
|
|
func (c *MediaLive) DeleteInput(input *DeleteInputInput) (*DeleteInputOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.DeleteInputRequest(input)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// DeleteInputWithContext is the same as DeleteInput with the addition of
|
|
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
|
|
//
|
|
// See DeleteInput for details on how to use this API operation.
|
|
//
|
|
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
|
|
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
|
|
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
|
|
// for more information on using Contexts.
|
|
func (c *MediaLive) DeleteInputWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *DeleteInputInput, opts ...request.Option) (*DeleteInputOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.DeleteInputRequest(input)
|
|
req.SetContext(ctx)
|
|
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
const opDeleteInputSecurityGroup = "DeleteInputSecurityGroup"
|
|
|
|
// DeleteInputSecurityGroupRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
|
|
// client's request for the DeleteInputSecurityGroup operation. The "output" return
|
|
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes
|
|
// successfully.
|
|
//
|
|
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
|
|
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See DeleteInputSecurityGroup for more information on using the DeleteInputSecurityGroup
|
|
// API call, and error handling.
|
|
//
|
|
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
|
|
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
|
|
//
|
|
//
|
|
// // Example sending a request using the DeleteInputSecurityGroupRequest method.
|
|
// req, resp := client.DeleteInputSecurityGroupRequest(params)
|
|
//
|
|
// err := req.Send()
|
|
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
|
|
// fmt.Println(resp)
|
|
// }
|
|
//
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/medialive-2017-10-14/DeleteInputSecurityGroup
|
|
func (c *MediaLive) DeleteInputSecurityGroupRequest(input *DeleteInputSecurityGroupInput) (req *request.Request, output *DeleteInputSecurityGroupOutput) {
|
|
op := &request.Operation{
|
|
Name: opDeleteInputSecurityGroup,
|
|
HTTPMethod: "DELETE",
|
|
HTTPPath: "/prod/inputSecurityGroups/{inputSecurityGroupId}",
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if input == nil {
|
|
input = &DeleteInputSecurityGroupInput{}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
output = &DeleteInputSecurityGroupOutput{}
|
|
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
|
|
req.Handlers.Unmarshal.Swap(restjson.UnmarshalHandler.Name, protocol.UnmarshalDiscardBodyHandler)
|
|
return
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// DeleteInputSecurityGroup API operation for AWS Elemental MediaLive.
|
|
//
|
|
// Deletes an Input Security Group
|
|
//
|
|
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
|
|
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
|
|
// the error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See the AWS API reference guide for AWS Elemental MediaLive's
|
|
// API operation DeleteInputSecurityGroup for usage and error information.
|
|
//
|
|
// Returned Error Codes:
|
|
// * ErrCodeBadRequestException "BadRequestException"
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeInternalServerErrorException "InternalServerErrorException"
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeForbiddenException "ForbiddenException"
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeBadGatewayException "BadGatewayException"
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeNotFoundException "NotFoundException"
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeGatewayTimeoutException "GatewayTimeoutException"
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeTooManyRequestsException "TooManyRequestsException"
|
|
//
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/medialive-2017-10-14/DeleteInputSecurityGroup
|
|
func (c *MediaLive) DeleteInputSecurityGroup(input *DeleteInputSecurityGroupInput) (*DeleteInputSecurityGroupOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.DeleteInputSecurityGroupRequest(input)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// DeleteInputSecurityGroupWithContext is the same as DeleteInputSecurityGroup with the addition of
|
|
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
|
|
//
|
|
// See DeleteInputSecurityGroup for details on how to use this API operation.
|
|
//
|
|
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
|
|
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
|
|
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
|
|
// for more information on using Contexts.
|
|
func (c *MediaLive) DeleteInputSecurityGroupWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *DeleteInputSecurityGroupInput, opts ...request.Option) (*DeleteInputSecurityGroupOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.DeleteInputSecurityGroupRequest(input)
|
|
req.SetContext(ctx)
|
|
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
const opDeleteReservation = "DeleteReservation"
|
|
|
|
// DeleteReservationRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
|
|
// client's request for the DeleteReservation operation. The "output" return
|
|
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes
|
|
// successfully.
|
|
//
|
|
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
|
|
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See DeleteReservation for more information on using the DeleteReservation
|
|
// API call, and error handling.
|
|
//
|
|
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
|
|
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
|
|
//
|
|
//
|
|
// // Example sending a request using the DeleteReservationRequest method.
|
|
// req, resp := client.DeleteReservationRequest(params)
|
|
//
|
|
// err := req.Send()
|
|
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
|
|
// fmt.Println(resp)
|
|
// }
|
|
//
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/medialive-2017-10-14/DeleteReservation
|
|
func (c *MediaLive) DeleteReservationRequest(input *DeleteReservationInput) (req *request.Request, output *DeleteReservationOutput) {
|
|
op := &request.Operation{
|
|
Name: opDeleteReservation,
|
|
HTTPMethod: "DELETE",
|
|
HTTPPath: "/prod/reservations/{reservationId}",
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if input == nil {
|
|
input = &DeleteReservationInput{}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
output = &DeleteReservationOutput{}
|
|
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
|
|
return
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// DeleteReservation API operation for AWS Elemental MediaLive.
|
|
//
|
|
// Delete an expired reservation.
|
|
//
|
|
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
|
|
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
|
|
// the error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See the AWS API reference guide for AWS Elemental MediaLive's
|
|
// API operation DeleteReservation for usage and error information.
|
|
//
|
|
// Returned Error Codes:
|
|
// * ErrCodeBadRequestException "BadRequestException"
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeInternalServerErrorException "InternalServerErrorException"
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeForbiddenException "ForbiddenException"
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeBadGatewayException "BadGatewayException"
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeNotFoundException "NotFoundException"
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeGatewayTimeoutException "GatewayTimeoutException"
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeTooManyRequestsException "TooManyRequestsException"
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeConflictException "ConflictException"
|
|
//
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/medialive-2017-10-14/DeleteReservation
|
|
func (c *MediaLive) DeleteReservation(input *DeleteReservationInput) (*DeleteReservationOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.DeleteReservationRequest(input)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// DeleteReservationWithContext is the same as DeleteReservation with the addition of
|
|
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
|
|
//
|
|
// See DeleteReservation for details on how to use this API operation.
|
|
//
|
|
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
|
|
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
|
|
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
|
|
// for more information on using Contexts.
|
|
func (c *MediaLive) DeleteReservationWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *DeleteReservationInput, opts ...request.Option) (*DeleteReservationOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.DeleteReservationRequest(input)
|
|
req.SetContext(ctx)
|
|
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
const opDescribeChannel = "DescribeChannel"
|
|
|
|
// DescribeChannelRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
|
|
// client's request for the DescribeChannel operation. The "output" return
|
|
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes
|
|
// successfully.
|
|
//
|
|
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
|
|
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See DescribeChannel for more information on using the DescribeChannel
|
|
// API call, and error handling.
|
|
//
|
|
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
|
|
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
|
|
//
|
|
//
|
|
// // Example sending a request using the DescribeChannelRequest method.
|
|
// req, resp := client.DescribeChannelRequest(params)
|
|
//
|
|
// err := req.Send()
|
|
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
|
|
// fmt.Println(resp)
|
|
// }
|
|
//
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/medialive-2017-10-14/DescribeChannel
|
|
func (c *MediaLive) DescribeChannelRequest(input *DescribeChannelInput) (req *request.Request, output *DescribeChannelOutput) {
|
|
op := &request.Operation{
|
|
Name: opDescribeChannel,
|
|
HTTPMethod: "GET",
|
|
HTTPPath: "/prod/channels/{channelId}",
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if input == nil {
|
|
input = &DescribeChannelInput{}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
output = &DescribeChannelOutput{}
|
|
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
|
|
return
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// DescribeChannel API operation for AWS Elemental MediaLive.
|
|
//
|
|
// Gets details about a channel
|
|
//
|
|
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
|
|
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
|
|
// the error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See the AWS API reference guide for AWS Elemental MediaLive's
|
|
// API operation DescribeChannel for usage and error information.
|
|
//
|
|
// Returned Error Codes:
|
|
// * ErrCodeBadRequestException "BadRequestException"
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeInternalServerErrorException "InternalServerErrorException"
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeForbiddenException "ForbiddenException"
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeBadGatewayException "BadGatewayException"
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeNotFoundException "NotFoundException"
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeGatewayTimeoutException "GatewayTimeoutException"
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeTooManyRequestsException "TooManyRequestsException"
|
|
//
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/medialive-2017-10-14/DescribeChannel
|
|
func (c *MediaLive) DescribeChannel(input *DescribeChannelInput) (*DescribeChannelOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.DescribeChannelRequest(input)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// DescribeChannelWithContext is the same as DescribeChannel with the addition of
|
|
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
|
|
//
|
|
// See DescribeChannel for details on how to use this API operation.
|
|
//
|
|
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
|
|
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
|
|
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
|
|
// for more information on using Contexts.
|
|
func (c *MediaLive) DescribeChannelWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *DescribeChannelInput, opts ...request.Option) (*DescribeChannelOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.DescribeChannelRequest(input)
|
|
req.SetContext(ctx)
|
|
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
const opDescribeInput = "DescribeInput"
|
|
|
|
// DescribeInputRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
|
|
// client's request for the DescribeInput operation. The "output" return
|
|
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes
|
|
// successfully.
|
|
//
|
|
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
|
|
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See DescribeInput for more information on using the DescribeInput
|
|
// API call, and error handling.
|
|
//
|
|
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
|
|
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
|
|
//
|
|
//
|
|
// // Example sending a request using the DescribeInputRequest method.
|
|
// req, resp := client.DescribeInputRequest(params)
|
|
//
|
|
// err := req.Send()
|
|
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
|
|
// fmt.Println(resp)
|
|
// }
|
|
//
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/medialive-2017-10-14/DescribeInput
|
|
func (c *MediaLive) DescribeInputRequest(input *DescribeInputInput) (req *request.Request, output *DescribeInputOutput) {
|
|
op := &request.Operation{
|
|
Name: opDescribeInput,
|
|
HTTPMethod: "GET",
|
|
HTTPPath: "/prod/inputs/{inputId}",
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if input == nil {
|
|
input = &DescribeInputInput{}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
output = &DescribeInputOutput{}
|
|
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
|
|
return
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// DescribeInput API operation for AWS Elemental MediaLive.
|
|
//
|
|
// Produces details about an input
|
|
//
|
|
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
|
|
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
|
|
// the error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See the AWS API reference guide for AWS Elemental MediaLive's
|
|
// API operation DescribeInput for usage and error information.
|
|
//
|
|
// Returned Error Codes:
|
|
// * ErrCodeBadRequestException "BadRequestException"
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeInternalServerErrorException "InternalServerErrorException"
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeForbiddenException "ForbiddenException"
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeBadGatewayException "BadGatewayException"
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeNotFoundException "NotFoundException"
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeGatewayTimeoutException "GatewayTimeoutException"
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeTooManyRequestsException "TooManyRequestsException"
|
|
//
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/medialive-2017-10-14/DescribeInput
|
|
func (c *MediaLive) DescribeInput(input *DescribeInputInput) (*DescribeInputOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.DescribeInputRequest(input)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// DescribeInputWithContext is the same as DescribeInput with the addition of
|
|
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
|
|
//
|
|
// See DescribeInput for details on how to use this API operation.
|
|
//
|
|
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
|
|
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
|
|
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
|
|
// for more information on using Contexts.
|
|
func (c *MediaLive) DescribeInputWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *DescribeInputInput, opts ...request.Option) (*DescribeInputOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.DescribeInputRequest(input)
|
|
req.SetContext(ctx)
|
|
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
const opDescribeInputSecurityGroup = "DescribeInputSecurityGroup"
|
|
|
|
// DescribeInputSecurityGroupRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
|
|
// client's request for the DescribeInputSecurityGroup operation. The "output" return
|
|
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes
|
|
// successfully.
|
|
//
|
|
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
|
|
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See DescribeInputSecurityGroup for more information on using the DescribeInputSecurityGroup
|
|
// API call, and error handling.
|
|
//
|
|
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
|
|
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
|
|
//
|
|
//
|
|
// // Example sending a request using the DescribeInputSecurityGroupRequest method.
|
|
// req, resp := client.DescribeInputSecurityGroupRequest(params)
|
|
//
|
|
// err := req.Send()
|
|
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
|
|
// fmt.Println(resp)
|
|
// }
|
|
//
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/medialive-2017-10-14/DescribeInputSecurityGroup
|
|
func (c *MediaLive) DescribeInputSecurityGroupRequest(input *DescribeInputSecurityGroupInput) (req *request.Request, output *DescribeInputSecurityGroupOutput) {
|
|
op := &request.Operation{
|
|
Name: opDescribeInputSecurityGroup,
|
|
HTTPMethod: "GET",
|
|
HTTPPath: "/prod/inputSecurityGroups/{inputSecurityGroupId}",
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if input == nil {
|
|
input = &DescribeInputSecurityGroupInput{}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
output = &DescribeInputSecurityGroupOutput{}
|
|
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
|
|
return
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// DescribeInputSecurityGroup API operation for AWS Elemental MediaLive.
|
|
//
|
|
// Produces a summary of an Input Security Group
|
|
//
|
|
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
|
|
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
|
|
// the error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See the AWS API reference guide for AWS Elemental MediaLive's
|
|
// API operation DescribeInputSecurityGroup for usage and error information.
|
|
//
|
|
// Returned Error Codes:
|
|
// * ErrCodeBadRequestException "BadRequestException"
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeInternalServerErrorException "InternalServerErrorException"
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeForbiddenException "ForbiddenException"
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeBadGatewayException "BadGatewayException"
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeNotFoundException "NotFoundException"
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeGatewayTimeoutException "GatewayTimeoutException"
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeTooManyRequestsException "TooManyRequestsException"
|
|
//
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/medialive-2017-10-14/DescribeInputSecurityGroup
|
|
func (c *MediaLive) DescribeInputSecurityGroup(input *DescribeInputSecurityGroupInput) (*DescribeInputSecurityGroupOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.DescribeInputSecurityGroupRequest(input)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// DescribeInputSecurityGroupWithContext is the same as DescribeInputSecurityGroup with the addition of
|
|
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
|
|
//
|
|
// See DescribeInputSecurityGroup for details on how to use this API operation.
|
|
//
|
|
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
|
|
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
|
|
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
|
|
// for more information on using Contexts.
|
|
func (c *MediaLive) DescribeInputSecurityGroupWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *DescribeInputSecurityGroupInput, opts ...request.Option) (*DescribeInputSecurityGroupOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.DescribeInputSecurityGroupRequest(input)
|
|
req.SetContext(ctx)
|
|
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
const opDescribeOffering = "DescribeOffering"
|
|
|
|
// DescribeOfferingRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
|
|
// client's request for the DescribeOffering operation. The "output" return
|
|
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes
|
|
// successfully.
|
|
//
|
|
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
|
|
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See DescribeOffering for more information on using the DescribeOffering
|
|
// API call, and error handling.
|
|
//
|
|
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
|
|
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
|
|
//
|
|
//
|
|
// // Example sending a request using the DescribeOfferingRequest method.
|
|
// req, resp := client.DescribeOfferingRequest(params)
|
|
//
|
|
// err := req.Send()
|
|
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
|
|
// fmt.Println(resp)
|
|
// }
|
|
//
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/medialive-2017-10-14/DescribeOffering
|
|
func (c *MediaLive) DescribeOfferingRequest(input *DescribeOfferingInput) (req *request.Request, output *DescribeOfferingOutput) {
|
|
op := &request.Operation{
|
|
Name: opDescribeOffering,
|
|
HTTPMethod: "GET",
|
|
HTTPPath: "/prod/offerings/{offeringId}",
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if input == nil {
|
|
input = &DescribeOfferingInput{}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
output = &DescribeOfferingOutput{}
|
|
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
|
|
return
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// DescribeOffering API operation for AWS Elemental MediaLive.
|
|
//
|
|
// Get details for an offering.
|
|
//
|
|
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
|
|
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
|
|
// the error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See the AWS API reference guide for AWS Elemental MediaLive's
|
|
// API operation DescribeOffering for usage and error information.
|
|
//
|
|
// Returned Error Codes:
|
|
// * ErrCodeBadRequestException "BadRequestException"
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeInternalServerErrorException "InternalServerErrorException"
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeForbiddenException "ForbiddenException"
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeBadGatewayException "BadGatewayException"
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeNotFoundException "NotFoundException"
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeGatewayTimeoutException "GatewayTimeoutException"
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeTooManyRequestsException "TooManyRequestsException"
|
|
//
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/medialive-2017-10-14/DescribeOffering
|
|
func (c *MediaLive) DescribeOffering(input *DescribeOfferingInput) (*DescribeOfferingOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.DescribeOfferingRequest(input)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// DescribeOfferingWithContext is the same as DescribeOffering with the addition of
|
|
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
|
|
//
|
|
// See DescribeOffering for details on how to use this API operation.
|
|
//
|
|
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
|
|
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
|
|
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
|
|
// for more information on using Contexts.
|
|
func (c *MediaLive) DescribeOfferingWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *DescribeOfferingInput, opts ...request.Option) (*DescribeOfferingOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.DescribeOfferingRequest(input)
|
|
req.SetContext(ctx)
|
|
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
const opDescribeReservation = "DescribeReservation"
|
|
|
|
// DescribeReservationRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
|
|
// client's request for the DescribeReservation operation. The "output" return
|
|
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes
|
|
// successfully.
|
|
//
|
|
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
|
|
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See DescribeReservation for more information on using the DescribeReservation
|
|
// API call, and error handling.
|
|
//
|
|
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
|
|
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
|
|
//
|
|
//
|
|
// // Example sending a request using the DescribeReservationRequest method.
|
|
// req, resp := client.DescribeReservationRequest(params)
|
|
//
|
|
// err := req.Send()
|
|
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
|
|
// fmt.Println(resp)
|
|
// }
|
|
//
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/medialive-2017-10-14/DescribeReservation
|
|
func (c *MediaLive) DescribeReservationRequest(input *DescribeReservationInput) (req *request.Request, output *DescribeReservationOutput) {
|
|
op := &request.Operation{
|
|
Name: opDescribeReservation,
|
|
HTTPMethod: "GET",
|
|
HTTPPath: "/prod/reservations/{reservationId}",
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if input == nil {
|
|
input = &DescribeReservationInput{}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
output = &DescribeReservationOutput{}
|
|
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
|
|
return
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// DescribeReservation API operation for AWS Elemental MediaLive.
|
|
//
|
|
// Get details for a reservation.
|
|
//
|
|
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
|
|
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
|
|
// the error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See the AWS API reference guide for AWS Elemental MediaLive's
|
|
// API operation DescribeReservation for usage and error information.
|
|
//
|
|
// Returned Error Codes:
|
|
// * ErrCodeBadRequestException "BadRequestException"
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeInternalServerErrorException "InternalServerErrorException"
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeForbiddenException "ForbiddenException"
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeBadGatewayException "BadGatewayException"
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeNotFoundException "NotFoundException"
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeGatewayTimeoutException "GatewayTimeoutException"
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeTooManyRequestsException "TooManyRequestsException"
|
|
//
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/medialive-2017-10-14/DescribeReservation
|
|
func (c *MediaLive) DescribeReservation(input *DescribeReservationInput) (*DescribeReservationOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.DescribeReservationRequest(input)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// DescribeReservationWithContext is the same as DescribeReservation with the addition of
|
|
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
|
|
//
|
|
// See DescribeReservation for details on how to use this API operation.
|
|
//
|
|
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
|
|
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
|
|
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
|
|
// for more information on using Contexts.
|
|
func (c *MediaLive) DescribeReservationWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *DescribeReservationInput, opts ...request.Option) (*DescribeReservationOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.DescribeReservationRequest(input)
|
|
req.SetContext(ctx)
|
|
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
const opDescribeSchedule = "DescribeSchedule"
|
|
|
|
// DescribeScheduleRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
|
|
// client's request for the DescribeSchedule operation. The "output" return
|
|
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes
|
|
// successfully.
|
|
//
|
|
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
|
|
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See DescribeSchedule for more information on using the DescribeSchedule
|
|
// API call, and error handling.
|
|
//
|
|
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
|
|
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
|
|
//
|
|
//
|
|
// // Example sending a request using the DescribeScheduleRequest method.
|
|
// req, resp := client.DescribeScheduleRequest(params)
|
|
//
|
|
// err := req.Send()
|
|
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
|
|
// fmt.Println(resp)
|
|
// }
|
|
//
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/medialive-2017-10-14/DescribeSchedule
|
|
func (c *MediaLive) DescribeScheduleRequest(input *DescribeScheduleInput) (req *request.Request, output *DescribeScheduleOutput) {
|
|
op := &request.Operation{
|
|
Name: opDescribeSchedule,
|
|
HTTPMethod: "GET",
|
|
HTTPPath: "/prod/channels/{channelId}/schedule",
|
|
Paginator: &request.Paginator{
|
|
InputTokens: []string{"NextToken"},
|
|
OutputTokens: []string{"NextToken"},
|
|
LimitToken: "MaxResults",
|
|
TruncationToken: "",
|
|
},
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if input == nil {
|
|
input = &DescribeScheduleInput{}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
output = &DescribeScheduleOutput{}
|
|
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
|
|
return
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// DescribeSchedule API operation for AWS Elemental MediaLive.
|
|
//
|
|
// Get a channel schedule
|
|
//
|
|
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
|
|
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
|
|
// the error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See the AWS API reference guide for AWS Elemental MediaLive's
|
|
// API operation DescribeSchedule for usage and error information.
|
|
//
|
|
// Returned Error Codes:
|
|
// * ErrCodeBadRequestException "BadRequestException"
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeInternalServerErrorException "InternalServerErrorException"
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeForbiddenException "ForbiddenException"
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeBadGatewayException "BadGatewayException"
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeNotFoundException "NotFoundException"
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeGatewayTimeoutException "GatewayTimeoutException"
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeTooManyRequestsException "TooManyRequestsException"
|
|
//
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/medialive-2017-10-14/DescribeSchedule
|
|
func (c *MediaLive) DescribeSchedule(input *DescribeScheduleInput) (*DescribeScheduleOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.DescribeScheduleRequest(input)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// DescribeScheduleWithContext is the same as DescribeSchedule with the addition of
|
|
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
|
|
//
|
|
// See DescribeSchedule for details on how to use this API operation.
|
|
//
|
|
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
|
|
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
|
|
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
|
|
// for more information on using Contexts.
|
|
func (c *MediaLive) DescribeScheduleWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *DescribeScheduleInput, opts ...request.Option) (*DescribeScheduleOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.DescribeScheduleRequest(input)
|
|
req.SetContext(ctx)
|
|
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// DescribeSchedulePages iterates over the pages of a DescribeSchedule operation,
|
|
// calling the "fn" function with the response data for each page. To stop
|
|
// iterating, return false from the fn function.
|
|
//
|
|
// See DescribeSchedule method for more information on how to use this operation.
|
|
//
|
|
// Note: This operation can generate multiple requests to a service.
|
|
//
|
|
// // Example iterating over at most 3 pages of a DescribeSchedule operation.
|
|
// pageNum := 0
|
|
// err := client.DescribeSchedulePages(params,
|
|
// func(page *DescribeScheduleOutput, lastPage bool) bool {
|
|
// pageNum++
|
|
// fmt.Println(page)
|
|
// return pageNum <= 3
|
|
// })
|
|
//
|
|
func (c *MediaLive) DescribeSchedulePages(input *DescribeScheduleInput, fn func(*DescribeScheduleOutput, bool) bool) error {
|
|
return c.DescribeSchedulePagesWithContext(aws.BackgroundContext(), input, fn)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// DescribeSchedulePagesWithContext same as DescribeSchedulePages except
|
|
// it takes a Context and allows setting request options on the pages.
|
|
//
|
|
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
|
|
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
|
|
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
|
|
// for more information on using Contexts.
|
|
func (c *MediaLive) DescribeSchedulePagesWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *DescribeScheduleInput, fn func(*DescribeScheduleOutput, bool) bool, opts ...request.Option) error {
|
|
p := request.Pagination{
|
|
NewRequest: func() (*request.Request, error) {
|
|
var inCpy *DescribeScheduleInput
|
|
if input != nil {
|
|
tmp := *input
|
|
inCpy = &tmp
|
|
}
|
|
req, _ := c.DescribeScheduleRequest(inCpy)
|
|
req.SetContext(ctx)
|
|
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
|
|
return req, nil
|
|
},
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
cont := true
|
|
for p.Next() && cont {
|
|
cont = fn(p.Page().(*DescribeScheduleOutput), !p.HasNextPage())
|
|
}
|
|
return p.Err()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
const opListChannels = "ListChannels"
|
|
|
|
// ListChannelsRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
|
|
// client's request for the ListChannels operation. The "output" return
|
|
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes
|
|
// successfully.
|
|
//
|
|
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
|
|
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See ListChannels for more information on using the ListChannels
|
|
// API call, and error handling.
|
|
//
|
|
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
|
|
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
|
|
//
|
|
//
|
|
// // Example sending a request using the ListChannelsRequest method.
|
|
// req, resp := client.ListChannelsRequest(params)
|
|
//
|
|
// err := req.Send()
|
|
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
|
|
// fmt.Println(resp)
|
|
// }
|
|
//
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/medialive-2017-10-14/ListChannels
|
|
func (c *MediaLive) ListChannelsRequest(input *ListChannelsInput) (req *request.Request, output *ListChannelsOutput) {
|
|
op := &request.Operation{
|
|
Name: opListChannels,
|
|
HTTPMethod: "GET",
|
|
HTTPPath: "/prod/channels",
|
|
Paginator: &request.Paginator{
|
|
InputTokens: []string{"NextToken"},
|
|
OutputTokens: []string{"NextToken"},
|
|
LimitToken: "MaxResults",
|
|
TruncationToken: "",
|
|
},
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if input == nil {
|
|
input = &ListChannelsInput{}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
output = &ListChannelsOutput{}
|
|
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
|
|
return
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// ListChannels API operation for AWS Elemental MediaLive.
|
|
//
|
|
// Produces list of channels that have been created
|
|
//
|
|
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
|
|
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
|
|
// the error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See the AWS API reference guide for AWS Elemental MediaLive's
|
|
// API operation ListChannels for usage and error information.
|
|
//
|
|
// Returned Error Codes:
|
|
// * ErrCodeBadRequestException "BadRequestException"
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeInternalServerErrorException "InternalServerErrorException"
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeForbiddenException "ForbiddenException"
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeBadGatewayException "BadGatewayException"
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeGatewayTimeoutException "GatewayTimeoutException"
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeTooManyRequestsException "TooManyRequestsException"
|
|
//
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/medialive-2017-10-14/ListChannels
|
|
func (c *MediaLive) ListChannels(input *ListChannelsInput) (*ListChannelsOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.ListChannelsRequest(input)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// ListChannelsWithContext is the same as ListChannels with the addition of
|
|
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
|
|
//
|
|
// See ListChannels for details on how to use this API operation.
|
|
//
|
|
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
|
|
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
|
|
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
|
|
// for more information on using Contexts.
|
|
func (c *MediaLive) ListChannelsWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *ListChannelsInput, opts ...request.Option) (*ListChannelsOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.ListChannelsRequest(input)
|
|
req.SetContext(ctx)
|
|
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// ListChannelsPages iterates over the pages of a ListChannels operation,
|
|
// calling the "fn" function with the response data for each page. To stop
|
|
// iterating, return false from the fn function.
|
|
//
|
|
// See ListChannels method for more information on how to use this operation.
|
|
//
|
|
// Note: This operation can generate multiple requests to a service.
|
|
//
|
|
// // Example iterating over at most 3 pages of a ListChannels operation.
|
|
// pageNum := 0
|
|
// err := client.ListChannelsPages(params,
|
|
// func(page *ListChannelsOutput, lastPage bool) bool {
|
|
// pageNum++
|
|
// fmt.Println(page)
|
|
// return pageNum <= 3
|
|
// })
|
|
//
|
|
func (c *MediaLive) ListChannelsPages(input *ListChannelsInput, fn func(*ListChannelsOutput, bool) bool) error {
|
|
return c.ListChannelsPagesWithContext(aws.BackgroundContext(), input, fn)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// ListChannelsPagesWithContext same as ListChannelsPages except
|
|
// it takes a Context and allows setting request options on the pages.
|
|
//
|
|
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
|
|
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
|
|
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
|
|
// for more information on using Contexts.
|
|
func (c *MediaLive) ListChannelsPagesWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *ListChannelsInput, fn func(*ListChannelsOutput, bool) bool, opts ...request.Option) error {
|
|
p := request.Pagination{
|
|
NewRequest: func() (*request.Request, error) {
|
|
var inCpy *ListChannelsInput
|
|
if input != nil {
|
|
tmp := *input
|
|
inCpy = &tmp
|
|
}
|
|
req, _ := c.ListChannelsRequest(inCpy)
|
|
req.SetContext(ctx)
|
|
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
|
|
return req, nil
|
|
},
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
cont := true
|
|
for p.Next() && cont {
|
|
cont = fn(p.Page().(*ListChannelsOutput), !p.HasNextPage())
|
|
}
|
|
return p.Err()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
const opListInputSecurityGroups = "ListInputSecurityGroups"
|
|
|
|
// ListInputSecurityGroupsRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
|
|
// client's request for the ListInputSecurityGroups operation. The "output" return
|
|
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes
|
|
// successfully.
|
|
//
|
|
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
|
|
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See ListInputSecurityGroups for more information on using the ListInputSecurityGroups
|
|
// API call, and error handling.
|
|
//
|
|
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
|
|
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
|
|
//
|
|
//
|
|
// // Example sending a request using the ListInputSecurityGroupsRequest method.
|
|
// req, resp := client.ListInputSecurityGroupsRequest(params)
|
|
//
|
|
// err := req.Send()
|
|
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
|
|
// fmt.Println(resp)
|
|
// }
|
|
//
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/medialive-2017-10-14/ListInputSecurityGroups
|
|
func (c *MediaLive) ListInputSecurityGroupsRequest(input *ListInputSecurityGroupsInput) (req *request.Request, output *ListInputSecurityGroupsOutput) {
|
|
op := &request.Operation{
|
|
Name: opListInputSecurityGroups,
|
|
HTTPMethod: "GET",
|
|
HTTPPath: "/prod/inputSecurityGroups",
|
|
Paginator: &request.Paginator{
|
|
InputTokens: []string{"NextToken"},
|
|
OutputTokens: []string{"NextToken"},
|
|
LimitToken: "MaxResults",
|
|
TruncationToken: "",
|
|
},
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if input == nil {
|
|
input = &ListInputSecurityGroupsInput{}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
output = &ListInputSecurityGroupsOutput{}
|
|
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
|
|
return
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// ListInputSecurityGroups API operation for AWS Elemental MediaLive.
|
|
//
|
|
// Produces a list of Input Security Groups for an account
|
|
//
|
|
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
|
|
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
|
|
// the error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See the AWS API reference guide for AWS Elemental MediaLive's
|
|
// API operation ListInputSecurityGroups for usage and error information.
|
|
//
|
|
// Returned Error Codes:
|
|
// * ErrCodeBadRequestException "BadRequestException"
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeInternalServerErrorException "InternalServerErrorException"
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeForbiddenException "ForbiddenException"
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeBadGatewayException "BadGatewayException"
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeGatewayTimeoutException "GatewayTimeoutException"
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeTooManyRequestsException "TooManyRequestsException"
|
|
//
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/medialive-2017-10-14/ListInputSecurityGroups
|
|
func (c *MediaLive) ListInputSecurityGroups(input *ListInputSecurityGroupsInput) (*ListInputSecurityGroupsOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.ListInputSecurityGroupsRequest(input)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// ListInputSecurityGroupsWithContext is the same as ListInputSecurityGroups with the addition of
|
|
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
|
|
//
|
|
// See ListInputSecurityGroups for details on how to use this API operation.
|
|
//
|
|
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
|
|
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
|
|
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
|
|
// for more information on using Contexts.
|
|
func (c *MediaLive) ListInputSecurityGroupsWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *ListInputSecurityGroupsInput, opts ...request.Option) (*ListInputSecurityGroupsOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.ListInputSecurityGroupsRequest(input)
|
|
req.SetContext(ctx)
|
|
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// ListInputSecurityGroupsPages iterates over the pages of a ListInputSecurityGroups operation,
|
|
// calling the "fn" function with the response data for each page. To stop
|
|
// iterating, return false from the fn function.
|
|
//
|
|
// See ListInputSecurityGroups method for more information on how to use this operation.
|
|
//
|
|
// Note: This operation can generate multiple requests to a service.
|
|
//
|
|
// // Example iterating over at most 3 pages of a ListInputSecurityGroups operation.
|
|
// pageNum := 0
|
|
// err := client.ListInputSecurityGroupsPages(params,
|
|
// func(page *ListInputSecurityGroupsOutput, lastPage bool) bool {
|
|
// pageNum++
|
|
// fmt.Println(page)
|
|
// return pageNum <= 3
|
|
// })
|
|
//
|
|
func (c *MediaLive) ListInputSecurityGroupsPages(input *ListInputSecurityGroupsInput, fn func(*ListInputSecurityGroupsOutput, bool) bool) error {
|
|
return c.ListInputSecurityGroupsPagesWithContext(aws.BackgroundContext(), input, fn)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// ListInputSecurityGroupsPagesWithContext same as ListInputSecurityGroupsPages except
|
|
// it takes a Context and allows setting request options on the pages.
|
|
//
|
|
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
|
|
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
|
|
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
|
|
// for more information on using Contexts.
|
|
func (c *MediaLive) ListInputSecurityGroupsPagesWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *ListInputSecurityGroupsInput, fn func(*ListInputSecurityGroupsOutput, bool) bool, opts ...request.Option) error {
|
|
p := request.Pagination{
|
|
NewRequest: func() (*request.Request, error) {
|
|
var inCpy *ListInputSecurityGroupsInput
|
|
if input != nil {
|
|
tmp := *input
|
|
inCpy = &tmp
|
|
}
|
|
req, _ := c.ListInputSecurityGroupsRequest(inCpy)
|
|
req.SetContext(ctx)
|
|
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
|
|
return req, nil
|
|
},
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
cont := true
|
|
for p.Next() && cont {
|
|
cont = fn(p.Page().(*ListInputSecurityGroupsOutput), !p.HasNextPage())
|
|
}
|
|
return p.Err()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
const opListInputs = "ListInputs"
|
|
|
|
// ListInputsRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
|
|
// client's request for the ListInputs operation. The "output" return
|
|
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes
|
|
// successfully.
|
|
//
|
|
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
|
|
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See ListInputs for more information on using the ListInputs
|
|
// API call, and error handling.
|
|
//
|
|
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
|
|
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
|
|
//
|
|
//
|
|
// // Example sending a request using the ListInputsRequest method.
|
|
// req, resp := client.ListInputsRequest(params)
|
|
//
|
|
// err := req.Send()
|
|
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
|
|
// fmt.Println(resp)
|
|
// }
|
|
//
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/medialive-2017-10-14/ListInputs
|
|
func (c *MediaLive) ListInputsRequest(input *ListInputsInput) (req *request.Request, output *ListInputsOutput) {
|
|
op := &request.Operation{
|
|
Name: opListInputs,
|
|
HTTPMethod: "GET",
|
|
HTTPPath: "/prod/inputs",
|
|
Paginator: &request.Paginator{
|
|
InputTokens: []string{"NextToken"},
|
|
OutputTokens: []string{"NextToken"},
|
|
LimitToken: "MaxResults",
|
|
TruncationToken: "",
|
|
},
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if input == nil {
|
|
input = &ListInputsInput{}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
output = &ListInputsOutput{}
|
|
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
|
|
return
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// ListInputs API operation for AWS Elemental MediaLive.
|
|
//
|
|
// Produces list of inputs that have been created
|
|
//
|
|
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
|
|
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
|
|
// the error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See the AWS API reference guide for AWS Elemental MediaLive's
|
|
// API operation ListInputs for usage and error information.
|
|
//
|
|
// Returned Error Codes:
|
|
// * ErrCodeBadRequestException "BadRequestException"
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeInternalServerErrorException "InternalServerErrorException"
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeForbiddenException "ForbiddenException"
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeBadGatewayException "BadGatewayException"
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeGatewayTimeoutException "GatewayTimeoutException"
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeTooManyRequestsException "TooManyRequestsException"
|
|
//
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/medialive-2017-10-14/ListInputs
|
|
func (c *MediaLive) ListInputs(input *ListInputsInput) (*ListInputsOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.ListInputsRequest(input)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// ListInputsWithContext is the same as ListInputs with the addition of
|
|
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
|
|
//
|
|
// See ListInputs for details on how to use this API operation.
|
|
//
|
|
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
|
|
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
|
|
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
|
|
// for more information on using Contexts.
|
|
func (c *MediaLive) ListInputsWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *ListInputsInput, opts ...request.Option) (*ListInputsOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.ListInputsRequest(input)
|
|
req.SetContext(ctx)
|
|
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// ListInputsPages iterates over the pages of a ListInputs operation,
|
|
// calling the "fn" function with the response data for each page. To stop
|
|
// iterating, return false from the fn function.
|
|
//
|
|
// See ListInputs method for more information on how to use this operation.
|
|
//
|
|
// Note: This operation can generate multiple requests to a service.
|
|
//
|
|
// // Example iterating over at most 3 pages of a ListInputs operation.
|
|
// pageNum := 0
|
|
// err := client.ListInputsPages(params,
|
|
// func(page *ListInputsOutput, lastPage bool) bool {
|
|
// pageNum++
|
|
// fmt.Println(page)
|
|
// return pageNum <= 3
|
|
// })
|
|
//
|
|
func (c *MediaLive) ListInputsPages(input *ListInputsInput, fn func(*ListInputsOutput, bool) bool) error {
|
|
return c.ListInputsPagesWithContext(aws.BackgroundContext(), input, fn)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// ListInputsPagesWithContext same as ListInputsPages except
|
|
// it takes a Context and allows setting request options on the pages.
|
|
//
|
|
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
|
|
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
|
|
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
|
|
// for more information on using Contexts.
|
|
func (c *MediaLive) ListInputsPagesWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *ListInputsInput, fn func(*ListInputsOutput, bool) bool, opts ...request.Option) error {
|
|
p := request.Pagination{
|
|
NewRequest: func() (*request.Request, error) {
|
|
var inCpy *ListInputsInput
|
|
if input != nil {
|
|
tmp := *input
|
|
inCpy = &tmp
|
|
}
|
|
req, _ := c.ListInputsRequest(inCpy)
|
|
req.SetContext(ctx)
|
|
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
|
|
return req, nil
|
|
},
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
cont := true
|
|
for p.Next() && cont {
|
|
cont = fn(p.Page().(*ListInputsOutput), !p.HasNextPage())
|
|
}
|
|
return p.Err()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
const opListOfferings = "ListOfferings"
|
|
|
|
// ListOfferingsRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
|
|
// client's request for the ListOfferings operation. The "output" return
|
|
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes
|
|
// successfully.
|
|
//
|
|
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
|
|
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See ListOfferings for more information on using the ListOfferings
|
|
// API call, and error handling.
|
|
//
|
|
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
|
|
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
|
|
//
|
|
//
|
|
// // Example sending a request using the ListOfferingsRequest method.
|
|
// req, resp := client.ListOfferingsRequest(params)
|
|
//
|
|
// err := req.Send()
|
|
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
|
|
// fmt.Println(resp)
|
|
// }
|
|
//
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/medialive-2017-10-14/ListOfferings
|
|
func (c *MediaLive) ListOfferingsRequest(input *ListOfferingsInput) (req *request.Request, output *ListOfferingsOutput) {
|
|
op := &request.Operation{
|
|
Name: opListOfferings,
|
|
HTTPMethod: "GET",
|
|
HTTPPath: "/prod/offerings",
|
|
Paginator: &request.Paginator{
|
|
InputTokens: []string{"NextToken"},
|
|
OutputTokens: []string{"NextToken"},
|
|
LimitToken: "MaxResults",
|
|
TruncationToken: "",
|
|
},
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if input == nil {
|
|
input = &ListOfferingsInput{}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
output = &ListOfferingsOutput{}
|
|
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
|
|
return
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// ListOfferings API operation for AWS Elemental MediaLive.
|
|
//
|
|
// List offerings available for purchase.
|
|
//
|
|
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
|
|
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
|
|
// the error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See the AWS API reference guide for AWS Elemental MediaLive's
|
|
// API operation ListOfferings for usage and error information.
|
|
//
|
|
// Returned Error Codes:
|
|
// * ErrCodeBadRequestException "BadRequestException"
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeInternalServerErrorException "InternalServerErrorException"
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeForbiddenException "ForbiddenException"
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeBadGatewayException "BadGatewayException"
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeGatewayTimeoutException "GatewayTimeoutException"
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeTooManyRequestsException "TooManyRequestsException"
|
|
//
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/medialive-2017-10-14/ListOfferings
|
|
func (c *MediaLive) ListOfferings(input *ListOfferingsInput) (*ListOfferingsOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.ListOfferingsRequest(input)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// ListOfferingsWithContext is the same as ListOfferings with the addition of
|
|
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
|
|
//
|
|
// See ListOfferings for details on how to use this API operation.
|
|
//
|
|
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
|
|
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
|
|
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
|
|
// for more information on using Contexts.
|
|
func (c *MediaLive) ListOfferingsWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *ListOfferingsInput, opts ...request.Option) (*ListOfferingsOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.ListOfferingsRequest(input)
|
|
req.SetContext(ctx)
|
|
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// ListOfferingsPages iterates over the pages of a ListOfferings operation,
|
|
// calling the "fn" function with the response data for each page. To stop
|
|
// iterating, return false from the fn function.
|
|
//
|
|
// See ListOfferings method for more information on how to use this operation.
|
|
//
|
|
// Note: This operation can generate multiple requests to a service.
|
|
//
|
|
// // Example iterating over at most 3 pages of a ListOfferings operation.
|
|
// pageNum := 0
|
|
// err := client.ListOfferingsPages(params,
|
|
// func(page *ListOfferingsOutput, lastPage bool) bool {
|
|
// pageNum++
|
|
// fmt.Println(page)
|
|
// return pageNum <= 3
|
|
// })
|
|
//
|
|
func (c *MediaLive) ListOfferingsPages(input *ListOfferingsInput, fn func(*ListOfferingsOutput, bool) bool) error {
|
|
return c.ListOfferingsPagesWithContext(aws.BackgroundContext(), input, fn)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// ListOfferingsPagesWithContext same as ListOfferingsPages except
|
|
// it takes a Context and allows setting request options on the pages.
|
|
//
|
|
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
|
|
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
|
|
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
|
|
// for more information on using Contexts.
|
|
func (c *MediaLive) ListOfferingsPagesWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *ListOfferingsInput, fn func(*ListOfferingsOutput, bool) bool, opts ...request.Option) error {
|
|
p := request.Pagination{
|
|
NewRequest: func() (*request.Request, error) {
|
|
var inCpy *ListOfferingsInput
|
|
if input != nil {
|
|
tmp := *input
|
|
inCpy = &tmp
|
|
}
|
|
req, _ := c.ListOfferingsRequest(inCpy)
|
|
req.SetContext(ctx)
|
|
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
|
|
return req, nil
|
|
},
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
cont := true
|
|
for p.Next() && cont {
|
|
cont = fn(p.Page().(*ListOfferingsOutput), !p.HasNextPage())
|
|
}
|
|
return p.Err()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
const opListReservations = "ListReservations"
|
|
|
|
// ListReservationsRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
|
|
// client's request for the ListReservations operation. The "output" return
|
|
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes
|
|
// successfully.
|
|
//
|
|
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
|
|
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See ListReservations for more information on using the ListReservations
|
|
// API call, and error handling.
|
|
//
|
|
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
|
|
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
|
|
//
|
|
//
|
|
// // Example sending a request using the ListReservationsRequest method.
|
|
// req, resp := client.ListReservationsRequest(params)
|
|
//
|
|
// err := req.Send()
|
|
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
|
|
// fmt.Println(resp)
|
|
// }
|
|
//
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/medialive-2017-10-14/ListReservations
|
|
func (c *MediaLive) ListReservationsRequest(input *ListReservationsInput) (req *request.Request, output *ListReservationsOutput) {
|
|
op := &request.Operation{
|
|
Name: opListReservations,
|
|
HTTPMethod: "GET",
|
|
HTTPPath: "/prod/reservations",
|
|
Paginator: &request.Paginator{
|
|
InputTokens: []string{"NextToken"},
|
|
OutputTokens: []string{"NextToken"},
|
|
LimitToken: "MaxResults",
|
|
TruncationToken: "",
|
|
},
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if input == nil {
|
|
input = &ListReservationsInput{}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
output = &ListReservationsOutput{}
|
|
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
|
|
return
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// ListReservations API operation for AWS Elemental MediaLive.
|
|
//
|
|
// List purchased reservations.
|
|
//
|
|
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
|
|
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
|
|
// the error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See the AWS API reference guide for AWS Elemental MediaLive's
|
|
// API operation ListReservations for usage and error information.
|
|
//
|
|
// Returned Error Codes:
|
|
// * ErrCodeBadRequestException "BadRequestException"
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeInternalServerErrorException "InternalServerErrorException"
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeForbiddenException "ForbiddenException"
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeBadGatewayException "BadGatewayException"
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeGatewayTimeoutException "GatewayTimeoutException"
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeTooManyRequestsException "TooManyRequestsException"
|
|
//
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/medialive-2017-10-14/ListReservations
|
|
func (c *MediaLive) ListReservations(input *ListReservationsInput) (*ListReservationsOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.ListReservationsRequest(input)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// ListReservationsWithContext is the same as ListReservations with the addition of
|
|
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
|
|
//
|
|
// See ListReservations for details on how to use this API operation.
|
|
//
|
|
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
|
|
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
|
|
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
|
|
// for more information on using Contexts.
|
|
func (c *MediaLive) ListReservationsWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *ListReservationsInput, opts ...request.Option) (*ListReservationsOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.ListReservationsRequest(input)
|
|
req.SetContext(ctx)
|
|
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// ListReservationsPages iterates over the pages of a ListReservations operation,
|
|
// calling the "fn" function with the response data for each page. To stop
|
|
// iterating, return false from the fn function.
|
|
//
|
|
// See ListReservations method for more information on how to use this operation.
|
|
//
|
|
// Note: This operation can generate multiple requests to a service.
|
|
//
|
|
// // Example iterating over at most 3 pages of a ListReservations operation.
|
|
// pageNum := 0
|
|
// err := client.ListReservationsPages(params,
|
|
// func(page *ListReservationsOutput, lastPage bool) bool {
|
|
// pageNum++
|
|
// fmt.Println(page)
|
|
// return pageNum <= 3
|
|
// })
|
|
//
|
|
func (c *MediaLive) ListReservationsPages(input *ListReservationsInput, fn func(*ListReservationsOutput, bool) bool) error {
|
|
return c.ListReservationsPagesWithContext(aws.BackgroundContext(), input, fn)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// ListReservationsPagesWithContext same as ListReservationsPages except
|
|
// it takes a Context and allows setting request options on the pages.
|
|
//
|
|
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
|
|
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
|
|
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
|
|
// for more information on using Contexts.
|
|
func (c *MediaLive) ListReservationsPagesWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *ListReservationsInput, fn func(*ListReservationsOutput, bool) bool, opts ...request.Option) error {
|
|
p := request.Pagination{
|
|
NewRequest: func() (*request.Request, error) {
|
|
var inCpy *ListReservationsInput
|
|
if input != nil {
|
|
tmp := *input
|
|
inCpy = &tmp
|
|
}
|
|
req, _ := c.ListReservationsRequest(inCpy)
|
|
req.SetContext(ctx)
|
|
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
|
|
return req, nil
|
|
},
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
cont := true
|
|
for p.Next() && cont {
|
|
cont = fn(p.Page().(*ListReservationsOutput), !p.HasNextPage())
|
|
}
|
|
return p.Err()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
const opPurchaseOffering = "PurchaseOffering"
|
|
|
|
// PurchaseOfferingRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
|
|
// client's request for the PurchaseOffering operation. The "output" return
|
|
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes
|
|
// successfully.
|
|
//
|
|
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
|
|
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See PurchaseOffering for more information on using the PurchaseOffering
|
|
// API call, and error handling.
|
|
//
|
|
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
|
|
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
|
|
//
|
|
//
|
|
// // Example sending a request using the PurchaseOfferingRequest method.
|
|
// req, resp := client.PurchaseOfferingRequest(params)
|
|
//
|
|
// err := req.Send()
|
|
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
|
|
// fmt.Println(resp)
|
|
// }
|
|
//
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/medialive-2017-10-14/PurchaseOffering
|
|
func (c *MediaLive) PurchaseOfferingRequest(input *PurchaseOfferingInput) (req *request.Request, output *PurchaseOfferingOutput) {
|
|
op := &request.Operation{
|
|
Name: opPurchaseOffering,
|
|
HTTPMethod: "POST",
|
|
HTTPPath: "/prod/offerings/{offeringId}/purchase",
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if input == nil {
|
|
input = &PurchaseOfferingInput{}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
output = &PurchaseOfferingOutput{}
|
|
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
|
|
return
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// PurchaseOffering API operation for AWS Elemental MediaLive.
|
|
//
|
|
// Purchase an offering and create a reservation.
|
|
//
|
|
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
|
|
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
|
|
// the error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See the AWS API reference guide for AWS Elemental MediaLive's
|
|
// API operation PurchaseOffering for usage and error information.
|
|
//
|
|
// Returned Error Codes:
|
|
// * ErrCodeBadRequestException "BadRequestException"
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeInternalServerErrorException "InternalServerErrorException"
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeForbiddenException "ForbiddenException"
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeBadGatewayException "BadGatewayException"
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeNotFoundException "NotFoundException"
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeGatewayTimeoutException "GatewayTimeoutException"
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeTooManyRequestsException "TooManyRequestsException"
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeConflictException "ConflictException"
|
|
//
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/medialive-2017-10-14/PurchaseOffering
|
|
func (c *MediaLive) PurchaseOffering(input *PurchaseOfferingInput) (*PurchaseOfferingOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.PurchaseOfferingRequest(input)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// PurchaseOfferingWithContext is the same as PurchaseOffering with the addition of
|
|
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
|
|
//
|
|
// See PurchaseOffering for details on how to use this API operation.
|
|
//
|
|
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
|
|
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
|
|
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
|
|
// for more information on using Contexts.
|
|
func (c *MediaLive) PurchaseOfferingWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *PurchaseOfferingInput, opts ...request.Option) (*PurchaseOfferingOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.PurchaseOfferingRequest(input)
|
|
req.SetContext(ctx)
|
|
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
const opStartChannel = "StartChannel"
|
|
|
|
// StartChannelRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
|
|
// client's request for the StartChannel operation. The "output" return
|
|
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes
|
|
// successfully.
|
|
//
|
|
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
|
|
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See StartChannel for more information on using the StartChannel
|
|
// API call, and error handling.
|
|
//
|
|
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
|
|
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
|
|
//
|
|
//
|
|
// // Example sending a request using the StartChannelRequest method.
|
|
// req, resp := client.StartChannelRequest(params)
|
|
//
|
|
// err := req.Send()
|
|
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
|
|
// fmt.Println(resp)
|
|
// }
|
|
//
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/medialive-2017-10-14/StartChannel
|
|
func (c *MediaLive) StartChannelRequest(input *StartChannelInput) (req *request.Request, output *StartChannelOutput) {
|
|
op := &request.Operation{
|
|
Name: opStartChannel,
|
|
HTTPMethod: "POST",
|
|
HTTPPath: "/prod/channels/{channelId}/start",
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if input == nil {
|
|
input = &StartChannelInput{}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
output = &StartChannelOutput{}
|
|
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
|
|
return
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// StartChannel API operation for AWS Elemental MediaLive.
|
|
//
|
|
// Starts an existing channel
|
|
//
|
|
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
|
|
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
|
|
// the error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See the AWS API reference guide for AWS Elemental MediaLive's
|
|
// API operation StartChannel for usage and error information.
|
|
//
|
|
// Returned Error Codes:
|
|
// * ErrCodeBadRequestException "BadRequestException"
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeInternalServerErrorException "InternalServerErrorException"
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeForbiddenException "ForbiddenException"
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeBadGatewayException "BadGatewayException"
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeNotFoundException "NotFoundException"
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeGatewayTimeoutException "GatewayTimeoutException"
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeTooManyRequestsException "TooManyRequestsException"
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeConflictException "ConflictException"
|
|
//
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/medialive-2017-10-14/StartChannel
|
|
func (c *MediaLive) StartChannel(input *StartChannelInput) (*StartChannelOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.StartChannelRequest(input)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// StartChannelWithContext is the same as StartChannel with the addition of
|
|
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
|
|
//
|
|
// See StartChannel for details on how to use this API operation.
|
|
//
|
|
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
|
|
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
|
|
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
|
|
// for more information on using Contexts.
|
|
func (c *MediaLive) StartChannelWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *StartChannelInput, opts ...request.Option) (*StartChannelOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.StartChannelRequest(input)
|
|
req.SetContext(ctx)
|
|
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
const opStopChannel = "StopChannel"
|
|
|
|
// StopChannelRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
|
|
// client's request for the StopChannel operation. The "output" return
|
|
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes
|
|
// successfully.
|
|
//
|
|
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
|
|
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See StopChannel for more information on using the StopChannel
|
|
// API call, and error handling.
|
|
//
|
|
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
|
|
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
|
|
//
|
|
//
|
|
// // Example sending a request using the StopChannelRequest method.
|
|
// req, resp := client.StopChannelRequest(params)
|
|
//
|
|
// err := req.Send()
|
|
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
|
|
// fmt.Println(resp)
|
|
// }
|
|
//
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/medialive-2017-10-14/StopChannel
|
|
func (c *MediaLive) StopChannelRequest(input *StopChannelInput) (req *request.Request, output *StopChannelOutput) {
|
|
op := &request.Operation{
|
|
Name: opStopChannel,
|
|
HTTPMethod: "POST",
|
|
HTTPPath: "/prod/channels/{channelId}/stop",
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if input == nil {
|
|
input = &StopChannelInput{}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
output = &StopChannelOutput{}
|
|
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
|
|
return
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// StopChannel API operation for AWS Elemental MediaLive.
|
|
//
|
|
// Stops a running channel
|
|
//
|
|
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
|
|
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
|
|
// the error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See the AWS API reference guide for AWS Elemental MediaLive's
|
|
// API operation StopChannel for usage and error information.
|
|
//
|
|
// Returned Error Codes:
|
|
// * ErrCodeBadRequestException "BadRequestException"
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeInternalServerErrorException "InternalServerErrorException"
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeForbiddenException "ForbiddenException"
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeBadGatewayException "BadGatewayException"
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeNotFoundException "NotFoundException"
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeGatewayTimeoutException "GatewayTimeoutException"
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeTooManyRequestsException "TooManyRequestsException"
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeConflictException "ConflictException"
|
|
//
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/medialive-2017-10-14/StopChannel
|
|
func (c *MediaLive) StopChannel(input *StopChannelInput) (*StopChannelOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.StopChannelRequest(input)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// StopChannelWithContext is the same as StopChannel with the addition of
|
|
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
|
|
//
|
|
// See StopChannel for details on how to use this API operation.
|
|
//
|
|
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
|
|
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
|
|
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
|
|
// for more information on using Contexts.
|
|
func (c *MediaLive) StopChannelWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *StopChannelInput, opts ...request.Option) (*StopChannelOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.StopChannelRequest(input)
|
|
req.SetContext(ctx)
|
|
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
const opUpdateChannel = "UpdateChannel"
|
|
|
|
// UpdateChannelRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
|
|
// client's request for the UpdateChannel operation. The "output" return
|
|
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes
|
|
// successfully.
|
|
//
|
|
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
|
|
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See UpdateChannel for more information on using the UpdateChannel
|
|
// API call, and error handling.
|
|
//
|
|
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
|
|
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
|
|
//
|
|
//
|
|
// // Example sending a request using the UpdateChannelRequest method.
|
|
// req, resp := client.UpdateChannelRequest(params)
|
|
//
|
|
// err := req.Send()
|
|
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
|
|
// fmt.Println(resp)
|
|
// }
|
|
//
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/medialive-2017-10-14/UpdateChannel
|
|
func (c *MediaLive) UpdateChannelRequest(input *UpdateChannelInput) (req *request.Request, output *UpdateChannelOutput) {
|
|
op := &request.Operation{
|
|
Name: opUpdateChannel,
|
|
HTTPMethod: "PUT",
|
|
HTTPPath: "/prod/channels/{channelId}",
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if input == nil {
|
|
input = &UpdateChannelInput{}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
output = &UpdateChannelOutput{}
|
|
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
|
|
return
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// UpdateChannel API operation for AWS Elemental MediaLive.
|
|
//
|
|
// Updates a channel.
|
|
//
|
|
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
|
|
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
|
|
// the error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See the AWS API reference guide for AWS Elemental MediaLive's
|
|
// API operation UpdateChannel for usage and error information.
|
|
//
|
|
// Returned Error Codes:
|
|
// * ErrCodeBadRequestException "BadRequestException"
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeUnprocessableEntityException "UnprocessableEntityException"
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeInternalServerErrorException "InternalServerErrorException"
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeForbiddenException "ForbiddenException"
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeBadGatewayException "BadGatewayException"
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeGatewayTimeoutException "GatewayTimeoutException"
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeConflictException "ConflictException"
|
|
//
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/medialive-2017-10-14/UpdateChannel
|
|
func (c *MediaLive) UpdateChannel(input *UpdateChannelInput) (*UpdateChannelOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.UpdateChannelRequest(input)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// UpdateChannelWithContext is the same as UpdateChannel with the addition of
|
|
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
|
|
//
|
|
// See UpdateChannel for details on how to use this API operation.
|
|
//
|
|
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
|
|
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
|
|
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
|
|
// for more information on using Contexts.
|
|
func (c *MediaLive) UpdateChannelWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *UpdateChannelInput, opts ...request.Option) (*UpdateChannelOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.UpdateChannelRequest(input)
|
|
req.SetContext(ctx)
|
|
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
const opUpdateInput = "UpdateInput"
|
|
|
|
// UpdateInputRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
|
|
// client's request for the UpdateInput operation. The "output" return
|
|
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes
|
|
// successfully.
|
|
//
|
|
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
|
|
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See UpdateInput for more information on using the UpdateInput
|
|
// API call, and error handling.
|
|
//
|
|
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
|
|
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
|
|
//
|
|
//
|
|
// // Example sending a request using the UpdateInputRequest method.
|
|
// req, resp := client.UpdateInputRequest(params)
|
|
//
|
|
// err := req.Send()
|
|
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
|
|
// fmt.Println(resp)
|
|
// }
|
|
//
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/medialive-2017-10-14/UpdateInput
|
|
func (c *MediaLive) UpdateInputRequest(input *UpdateInputInput) (req *request.Request, output *UpdateInputOutput) {
|
|
op := &request.Operation{
|
|
Name: opUpdateInput,
|
|
HTTPMethod: "PUT",
|
|
HTTPPath: "/prod/inputs/{inputId}",
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if input == nil {
|
|
input = &UpdateInputInput{}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
output = &UpdateInputOutput{}
|
|
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
|
|
return
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// UpdateInput API operation for AWS Elemental MediaLive.
|
|
//
|
|
// Updates an input.
|
|
//
|
|
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
|
|
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
|
|
// the error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See the AWS API reference guide for AWS Elemental MediaLive's
|
|
// API operation UpdateInput for usage and error information.
|
|
//
|
|
// Returned Error Codes:
|
|
// * ErrCodeBadRequestException "BadRequestException"
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeInternalServerErrorException "InternalServerErrorException"
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeForbiddenException "ForbiddenException"
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeBadGatewayException "BadGatewayException"
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeNotFoundException "NotFoundException"
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeGatewayTimeoutException "GatewayTimeoutException"
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeConflictException "ConflictException"
|
|
//
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/medialive-2017-10-14/UpdateInput
|
|
func (c *MediaLive) UpdateInput(input *UpdateInputInput) (*UpdateInputOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.UpdateInputRequest(input)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// UpdateInputWithContext is the same as UpdateInput with the addition of
|
|
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
|
|
//
|
|
// See UpdateInput for details on how to use this API operation.
|
|
//
|
|
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
|
|
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
|
|
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
|
|
// for more information on using Contexts.
|
|
func (c *MediaLive) UpdateInputWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *UpdateInputInput, opts ...request.Option) (*UpdateInputOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.UpdateInputRequest(input)
|
|
req.SetContext(ctx)
|
|
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
const opUpdateInputSecurityGroup = "UpdateInputSecurityGroup"
|
|
|
|
// UpdateInputSecurityGroupRequest generates a "aws/request.Request" representing the
|
|
// client's request for the UpdateInputSecurityGroup operation. The "output" return
|
|
// value will be populated with the request's response once the request completes
|
|
// successfully.
|
|
//
|
|
// Use "Send" method on the returned Request to send the API call to the service.
|
|
// the "output" return value is not valid until after Send returns without error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See UpdateInputSecurityGroup for more information on using the UpdateInputSecurityGroup
|
|
// API call, and error handling.
|
|
//
|
|
// This method is useful when you want to inject custom logic or configuration
|
|
// into the SDK's request lifecycle. Such as custom headers, or retry logic.
|
|
//
|
|
//
|
|
// // Example sending a request using the UpdateInputSecurityGroupRequest method.
|
|
// req, resp := client.UpdateInputSecurityGroupRequest(params)
|
|
//
|
|
// err := req.Send()
|
|
// if err == nil { // resp is now filled
|
|
// fmt.Println(resp)
|
|
// }
|
|
//
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/medialive-2017-10-14/UpdateInputSecurityGroup
|
|
func (c *MediaLive) UpdateInputSecurityGroupRequest(input *UpdateInputSecurityGroupInput) (req *request.Request, output *UpdateInputSecurityGroupOutput) {
|
|
op := &request.Operation{
|
|
Name: opUpdateInputSecurityGroup,
|
|
HTTPMethod: "PUT",
|
|
HTTPPath: "/prod/inputSecurityGroups/{inputSecurityGroupId}",
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if input == nil {
|
|
input = &UpdateInputSecurityGroupInput{}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
output = &UpdateInputSecurityGroupOutput{}
|
|
req = c.newRequest(op, input, output)
|
|
return
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// UpdateInputSecurityGroup API operation for AWS Elemental MediaLive.
|
|
//
|
|
// Update an Input Security Group's Whilelists.
|
|
//
|
|
// Returns awserr.Error for service API and SDK errors. Use runtime type assertions
|
|
// with awserr.Error's Code and Message methods to get detailed information about
|
|
// the error.
|
|
//
|
|
// See the AWS API reference guide for AWS Elemental MediaLive's
|
|
// API operation UpdateInputSecurityGroup for usage and error information.
|
|
//
|
|
// Returned Error Codes:
|
|
// * ErrCodeBadRequestException "BadRequestException"
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeInternalServerErrorException "InternalServerErrorException"
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeForbiddenException "ForbiddenException"
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeBadGatewayException "BadGatewayException"
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeNotFoundException "NotFoundException"
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeGatewayTimeoutException "GatewayTimeoutException"
|
|
//
|
|
// * ErrCodeConflictException "ConflictException"
|
|
//
|
|
// See also, https://docs.aws.amazon.com/goto/WebAPI/medialive-2017-10-14/UpdateInputSecurityGroup
|
|
func (c *MediaLive) UpdateInputSecurityGroup(input *UpdateInputSecurityGroupInput) (*UpdateInputSecurityGroupOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.UpdateInputSecurityGroupRequest(input)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// UpdateInputSecurityGroupWithContext is the same as UpdateInputSecurityGroup with the addition of
|
|
// the ability to pass a context and additional request options.
|
|
//
|
|
// See UpdateInputSecurityGroup for details on how to use this API operation.
|
|
//
|
|
// The context must be non-nil and will be used for request cancellation. If
|
|
// the context is nil a panic will occur. In the future the SDK may create
|
|
// sub-contexts for http.Requests. See https://golang.org/pkg/context/
|
|
// for more information on using Contexts.
|
|
func (c *MediaLive) UpdateInputSecurityGroupWithContext(ctx aws.Context, input *UpdateInputSecurityGroupInput, opts ...request.Option) (*UpdateInputSecurityGroupOutput, error) {
|
|
req, out := c.UpdateInputSecurityGroupRequest(input)
|
|
req.SetContext(ctx)
|
|
req.ApplyOptions(opts...)
|
|
return out, req.Send()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type AacSettings struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// Average bitrate in bits/second. Valid values depend on rate control mode
|
|
// and profile.
|
|
Bitrate *float64 `locationName:"bitrate" type:"double"`
|
|
|
|
// Mono, Stereo, or 5.1 channel layout. Valid values depend on rate control
|
|
// mode and profile. The adReceiverMix setting receives a stereo description
|
|
// plus control track and emits a mono AAC encode of the description track,
|
|
// with control data emitted in the PES header as per ETSI TS 101 154 Annex
|
|
// E.
|
|
CodingMode *string `locationName:"codingMode" type:"string" enum:"AacCodingMode"`
|
|
|
|
// Set to "broadcasterMixedAd" when input contains pre-mixed main audio + AD
|
|
// (narration) as a stereo pair. The Audio Type field (audioType) will be set
|
|
// to 3, which signals to downstream systems that this stream contains "broadcaster
|
|
// mixed AD". Note that the input received by the encoder must contain pre-mixed
|
|
// audio; the encoder does not perform the mixing. The values in audioTypeControl
|
|
// and audioType (in AudioDescription) are ignored when set to broadcasterMixedAd.Leave
|
|
// set to "normal" when input does not contain pre-mixed audio + AD.
|
|
InputType *string `locationName:"inputType" type:"string" enum:"AacInputType"`
|
|
|
|
// AAC Profile.
|
|
Profile *string `locationName:"profile" type:"string" enum:"AacProfile"`
|
|
|
|
// Rate Control Mode.
|
|
RateControlMode *string `locationName:"rateControlMode" type:"string" enum:"AacRateControlMode"`
|
|
|
|
// Sets LATM / LOAS AAC output for raw containers.
|
|
RawFormat *string `locationName:"rawFormat" type:"string" enum:"AacRawFormat"`
|
|
|
|
// Sample rate in Hz. Valid values depend on rate control mode and profile.
|
|
SampleRate *float64 `locationName:"sampleRate" type:"double"`
|
|
|
|
// Use MPEG-2 AAC audio instead of MPEG-4 AAC audio for raw or MPEG-2 Transport
|
|
// Stream containers.
|
|
Spec *string `locationName:"spec" type:"string" enum:"AacSpec"`
|
|
|
|
// VBR Quality Level - Only used if rateControlMode is VBR.
|
|
VbrQuality *string `locationName:"vbrQuality" type:"string" enum:"AacVbrQuality"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s AacSettings) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s AacSettings) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetBitrate sets the Bitrate field's value.
|
|
func (s *AacSettings) SetBitrate(v float64) *AacSettings {
|
|
s.Bitrate = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetCodingMode sets the CodingMode field's value.
|
|
func (s *AacSettings) SetCodingMode(v string) *AacSettings {
|
|
s.CodingMode = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetInputType sets the InputType field's value.
|
|
func (s *AacSettings) SetInputType(v string) *AacSettings {
|
|
s.InputType = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetProfile sets the Profile field's value.
|
|
func (s *AacSettings) SetProfile(v string) *AacSettings {
|
|
s.Profile = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetRateControlMode sets the RateControlMode field's value.
|
|
func (s *AacSettings) SetRateControlMode(v string) *AacSettings {
|
|
s.RateControlMode = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetRawFormat sets the RawFormat field's value.
|
|
func (s *AacSettings) SetRawFormat(v string) *AacSettings {
|
|
s.RawFormat = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetSampleRate sets the SampleRate field's value.
|
|
func (s *AacSettings) SetSampleRate(v float64) *AacSettings {
|
|
s.SampleRate = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetSpec sets the Spec field's value.
|
|
func (s *AacSettings) SetSpec(v string) *AacSettings {
|
|
s.Spec = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetVbrQuality sets the VbrQuality field's value.
|
|
func (s *AacSettings) SetVbrQuality(v string) *AacSettings {
|
|
s.VbrQuality = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type Ac3Settings struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// Average bitrate in bits/second. Valid bitrates depend on the coding mode.
|
|
Bitrate *float64 `locationName:"bitrate" type:"double"`
|
|
|
|
// Specifies the bitstream mode (bsmod) for the emitted AC-3 stream. See ATSC
|
|
// A/52-2012 for background on these values.
|
|
BitstreamMode *string `locationName:"bitstreamMode" type:"string" enum:"Ac3BitstreamMode"`
|
|
|
|
// Dolby Digital coding mode. Determines number of channels.
|
|
CodingMode *string `locationName:"codingMode" type:"string" enum:"Ac3CodingMode"`
|
|
|
|
// Sets the dialnorm for the output. If excluded and input audio is Dolby Digital,
|
|
// dialnorm will be passed through.
|
|
Dialnorm *int64 `locationName:"dialnorm" min:"1" type:"integer"`
|
|
|
|
// If set to filmStandard, adds dynamic range compression signaling to the output
|
|
// bitstream as defined in the Dolby Digital specification.
|
|
DrcProfile *string `locationName:"drcProfile" type:"string" enum:"Ac3DrcProfile"`
|
|
|
|
// When set to enabled, applies a 120Hz lowpass filter to the LFE channel prior
|
|
// to encoding. Only valid in codingMode32Lfe mode.
|
|
LfeFilter *string `locationName:"lfeFilter" type:"string" enum:"Ac3LfeFilter"`
|
|
|
|
// When set to "followInput", encoder metadata will be sourced from the DD,
|
|
// DD+, or DolbyE decoder that supplied this audio data. If audio was not supplied
|
|
// from one of these streams, then the static metadata settings will be used.
|
|
MetadataControl *string `locationName:"metadataControl" type:"string" enum:"Ac3MetadataControl"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s Ac3Settings) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s Ac3Settings) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *Ac3Settings) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "Ac3Settings"}
|
|
if s.Dialnorm != nil && *s.Dialnorm < 1 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinValue("Dialnorm", 1))
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetBitrate sets the Bitrate field's value.
|
|
func (s *Ac3Settings) SetBitrate(v float64) *Ac3Settings {
|
|
s.Bitrate = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetBitstreamMode sets the BitstreamMode field's value.
|
|
func (s *Ac3Settings) SetBitstreamMode(v string) *Ac3Settings {
|
|
s.BitstreamMode = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetCodingMode sets the CodingMode field's value.
|
|
func (s *Ac3Settings) SetCodingMode(v string) *Ac3Settings {
|
|
s.CodingMode = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetDialnorm sets the Dialnorm field's value.
|
|
func (s *Ac3Settings) SetDialnorm(v int64) *Ac3Settings {
|
|
s.Dialnorm = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetDrcProfile sets the DrcProfile field's value.
|
|
func (s *Ac3Settings) SetDrcProfile(v string) *Ac3Settings {
|
|
s.DrcProfile = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetLfeFilter sets the LfeFilter field's value.
|
|
func (s *Ac3Settings) SetLfeFilter(v string) *Ac3Settings {
|
|
s.LfeFilter = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetMetadataControl sets the MetadataControl field's value.
|
|
func (s *Ac3Settings) SetMetadataControl(v string) *Ac3Settings {
|
|
s.MetadataControl = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type ArchiveContainerSettings struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
M2tsSettings *M2tsSettings `locationName:"m2tsSettings" type:"structure"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s ArchiveContainerSettings) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s ArchiveContainerSettings) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *ArchiveContainerSettings) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "ArchiveContainerSettings"}
|
|
if s.M2tsSettings != nil {
|
|
if err := s.M2tsSettings.Validate(); err != nil {
|
|
invalidParams.AddNested("M2tsSettings", err.(request.ErrInvalidParams))
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetM2tsSettings sets the M2tsSettings field's value.
|
|
func (s *ArchiveContainerSettings) SetM2tsSettings(v *M2tsSettings) *ArchiveContainerSettings {
|
|
s.M2tsSettings = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type ArchiveGroupSettings struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// A directory and base filename where archive files should be written. If the
|
|
// base filename portion of the URI is left blank, the base filename of the
|
|
// first input will be automatically inserted.
|
|
//
|
|
// Destination is a required field
|
|
Destination *OutputLocationRef `locationName:"destination" type:"structure" required:"true"`
|
|
|
|
// Number of seconds to write to archive file before closing and starting a
|
|
// new one.
|
|
RolloverInterval *int64 `locationName:"rolloverInterval" min:"1" type:"integer"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s ArchiveGroupSettings) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s ArchiveGroupSettings) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *ArchiveGroupSettings) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "ArchiveGroupSettings"}
|
|
if s.Destination == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("Destination"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.RolloverInterval != nil && *s.RolloverInterval < 1 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinValue("RolloverInterval", 1))
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetDestination sets the Destination field's value.
|
|
func (s *ArchiveGroupSettings) SetDestination(v *OutputLocationRef) *ArchiveGroupSettings {
|
|
s.Destination = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetRolloverInterval sets the RolloverInterval field's value.
|
|
func (s *ArchiveGroupSettings) SetRolloverInterval(v int64) *ArchiveGroupSettings {
|
|
s.RolloverInterval = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type ArchiveOutputSettings struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// Settings specific to the container type of the file.
|
|
//
|
|
// ContainerSettings is a required field
|
|
ContainerSettings *ArchiveContainerSettings `locationName:"containerSettings" type:"structure" required:"true"`
|
|
|
|
// Output file extension. If excluded, this will be auto-selected from the container
|
|
// type.
|
|
Extension *string `locationName:"extension" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// String concatenated to the end of the destination filename. Required for
|
|
// multiple outputs of the same type.
|
|
NameModifier *string `locationName:"nameModifier" type:"string"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s ArchiveOutputSettings) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s ArchiveOutputSettings) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *ArchiveOutputSettings) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "ArchiveOutputSettings"}
|
|
if s.ContainerSettings == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("ContainerSettings"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.ContainerSettings != nil {
|
|
if err := s.ContainerSettings.Validate(); err != nil {
|
|
invalidParams.AddNested("ContainerSettings", err.(request.ErrInvalidParams))
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetContainerSettings sets the ContainerSettings field's value.
|
|
func (s *ArchiveOutputSettings) SetContainerSettings(v *ArchiveContainerSettings) *ArchiveOutputSettings {
|
|
s.ContainerSettings = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetExtension sets the Extension field's value.
|
|
func (s *ArchiveOutputSettings) SetExtension(v string) *ArchiveOutputSettings {
|
|
s.Extension = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetNameModifier sets the NameModifier field's value.
|
|
func (s *ArchiveOutputSettings) SetNameModifier(v string) *ArchiveOutputSettings {
|
|
s.NameModifier = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type AribDestinationSettings struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s AribDestinationSettings) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s AribDestinationSettings) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type AribSourceSettings struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s AribSourceSettings) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s AribSourceSettings) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type AudioChannelMapping struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// Indices and gain values for each input channel that should be remixed into
|
|
// this output channel.
|
|
//
|
|
// InputChannelLevels is a required field
|
|
InputChannelLevels []*InputChannelLevel `locationName:"inputChannelLevels" type:"list" required:"true"`
|
|
|
|
// The index of the output channel being produced.
|
|
//
|
|
// OutputChannel is a required field
|
|
OutputChannel *int64 `locationName:"outputChannel" type:"integer" required:"true"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s AudioChannelMapping) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s AudioChannelMapping) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *AudioChannelMapping) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "AudioChannelMapping"}
|
|
if s.InputChannelLevels == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("InputChannelLevels"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.OutputChannel == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("OutputChannel"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.InputChannelLevels != nil {
|
|
for i, v := range s.InputChannelLevels {
|
|
if v == nil {
|
|
continue
|
|
}
|
|
if err := v.Validate(); err != nil {
|
|
invalidParams.AddNested(fmt.Sprintf("%s[%v]", "InputChannelLevels", i), err.(request.ErrInvalidParams))
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetInputChannelLevels sets the InputChannelLevels field's value.
|
|
func (s *AudioChannelMapping) SetInputChannelLevels(v []*InputChannelLevel) *AudioChannelMapping {
|
|
s.InputChannelLevels = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetOutputChannel sets the OutputChannel field's value.
|
|
func (s *AudioChannelMapping) SetOutputChannel(v int64) *AudioChannelMapping {
|
|
s.OutputChannel = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type AudioCodecSettings struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
AacSettings *AacSettings `locationName:"aacSettings" type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
Ac3Settings *Ac3Settings `locationName:"ac3Settings" type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
Eac3Settings *Eac3Settings `locationName:"eac3Settings" type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
Mp2Settings *Mp2Settings `locationName:"mp2Settings" type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
PassThroughSettings *PassThroughSettings `locationName:"passThroughSettings" type:"structure"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s AudioCodecSettings) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s AudioCodecSettings) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *AudioCodecSettings) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "AudioCodecSettings"}
|
|
if s.Ac3Settings != nil {
|
|
if err := s.Ac3Settings.Validate(); err != nil {
|
|
invalidParams.AddNested("Ac3Settings", err.(request.ErrInvalidParams))
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
if s.Eac3Settings != nil {
|
|
if err := s.Eac3Settings.Validate(); err != nil {
|
|
invalidParams.AddNested("Eac3Settings", err.(request.ErrInvalidParams))
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetAacSettings sets the AacSettings field's value.
|
|
func (s *AudioCodecSettings) SetAacSettings(v *AacSettings) *AudioCodecSettings {
|
|
s.AacSettings = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetAc3Settings sets the Ac3Settings field's value.
|
|
func (s *AudioCodecSettings) SetAc3Settings(v *Ac3Settings) *AudioCodecSettings {
|
|
s.Ac3Settings = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetEac3Settings sets the Eac3Settings field's value.
|
|
func (s *AudioCodecSettings) SetEac3Settings(v *Eac3Settings) *AudioCodecSettings {
|
|
s.Eac3Settings = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetMp2Settings sets the Mp2Settings field's value.
|
|
func (s *AudioCodecSettings) SetMp2Settings(v *Mp2Settings) *AudioCodecSettings {
|
|
s.Mp2Settings = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetPassThroughSettings sets the PassThroughSettings field's value.
|
|
func (s *AudioCodecSettings) SetPassThroughSettings(v *PassThroughSettings) *AudioCodecSettings {
|
|
s.PassThroughSettings = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type AudioDescription struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// Advanced audio normalization settings.
|
|
AudioNormalizationSettings *AudioNormalizationSettings `locationName:"audioNormalizationSettings" type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// The name of the AudioSelector used as the source for this AudioDescription.
|
|
//
|
|
// AudioSelectorName is a required field
|
|
AudioSelectorName *string `locationName:"audioSelectorName" type:"string" required:"true"`
|
|
|
|
// Applies only if audioTypeControl is useConfigured. The values for audioType
|
|
// are defined in ISO-IEC 13818-1.
|
|
AudioType *string `locationName:"audioType" type:"string" enum:"AudioType"`
|
|
|
|
// Determines how audio type is determined. followInput: If the input contains
|
|
// an ISO 639 audioType, then that value is passed through to the output. If
|
|
// the input contains no ISO 639 audioType, the value in Audio Type is included
|
|
// in the output. useConfigured: The value in Audio Type is included in the
|
|
// output.Note that this field and audioType are both ignored if inputType is
|
|
// broadcasterMixedAd.
|
|
AudioTypeControl *string `locationName:"audioTypeControl" type:"string" enum:"AudioDescriptionAudioTypeControl"`
|
|
|
|
// Audio codec settings.
|
|
CodecSettings *AudioCodecSettings `locationName:"codecSettings" type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// Indicates the language of the audio output track. Only used if languageControlMode
|
|
// is useConfigured, or there is no ISO 639 language code specified in the input.
|
|
LanguageCode *string `locationName:"languageCode" min:"3" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// Choosing followInput will cause the ISO 639 language code of the output to
|
|
// follow the ISO 639 language code of the input. The languageCode will be used
|
|
// when useConfigured is set, or when followInput is selected but there is no
|
|
// ISO 639 language code specified by the input.
|
|
LanguageCodeControl *string `locationName:"languageCodeControl" type:"string" enum:"AudioDescriptionLanguageCodeControl"`
|
|
|
|
// The name of this AudioDescription. Outputs will use this name to uniquely
|
|
// identify this AudioDescription. Description names should be unique within
|
|
// this Live Event.
|
|
//
|
|
// Name is a required field
|
|
Name *string `locationName:"name" type:"string" required:"true"`
|
|
|
|
// Settings that control how input audio channels are remixed into the output
|
|
// audio channels.
|
|
RemixSettings *RemixSettings `locationName:"remixSettings" type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// Used for MS Smooth and Apple HLS outputs. Indicates the name displayed by
|
|
// the player (eg. English, or Director Commentary).
|
|
StreamName *string `locationName:"streamName" type:"string"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s AudioDescription) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s AudioDescription) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *AudioDescription) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "AudioDescription"}
|
|
if s.AudioSelectorName == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("AudioSelectorName"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.LanguageCode != nil && len(*s.LanguageCode) < 3 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("LanguageCode", 3))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.Name == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("Name"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.CodecSettings != nil {
|
|
if err := s.CodecSettings.Validate(); err != nil {
|
|
invalidParams.AddNested("CodecSettings", err.(request.ErrInvalidParams))
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
if s.RemixSettings != nil {
|
|
if err := s.RemixSettings.Validate(); err != nil {
|
|
invalidParams.AddNested("RemixSettings", err.(request.ErrInvalidParams))
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetAudioNormalizationSettings sets the AudioNormalizationSettings field's value.
|
|
func (s *AudioDescription) SetAudioNormalizationSettings(v *AudioNormalizationSettings) *AudioDescription {
|
|
s.AudioNormalizationSettings = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetAudioSelectorName sets the AudioSelectorName field's value.
|
|
func (s *AudioDescription) SetAudioSelectorName(v string) *AudioDescription {
|
|
s.AudioSelectorName = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetAudioType sets the AudioType field's value.
|
|
func (s *AudioDescription) SetAudioType(v string) *AudioDescription {
|
|
s.AudioType = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetAudioTypeControl sets the AudioTypeControl field's value.
|
|
func (s *AudioDescription) SetAudioTypeControl(v string) *AudioDescription {
|
|
s.AudioTypeControl = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetCodecSettings sets the CodecSettings field's value.
|
|
func (s *AudioDescription) SetCodecSettings(v *AudioCodecSettings) *AudioDescription {
|
|
s.CodecSettings = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetLanguageCode sets the LanguageCode field's value.
|
|
func (s *AudioDescription) SetLanguageCode(v string) *AudioDescription {
|
|
s.LanguageCode = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetLanguageCodeControl sets the LanguageCodeControl field's value.
|
|
func (s *AudioDescription) SetLanguageCodeControl(v string) *AudioDescription {
|
|
s.LanguageCodeControl = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetName sets the Name field's value.
|
|
func (s *AudioDescription) SetName(v string) *AudioDescription {
|
|
s.Name = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetRemixSettings sets the RemixSettings field's value.
|
|
func (s *AudioDescription) SetRemixSettings(v *RemixSettings) *AudioDescription {
|
|
s.RemixSettings = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetStreamName sets the StreamName field's value.
|
|
func (s *AudioDescription) SetStreamName(v string) *AudioDescription {
|
|
s.StreamName = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type AudioLanguageSelection struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// Selects a specific three-letter language code from within an audio source.
|
|
//
|
|
// LanguageCode is a required field
|
|
LanguageCode *string `locationName:"languageCode" type:"string" required:"true"`
|
|
|
|
// When set to "strict", the transport stream demux strictly identifies audio
|
|
// streams by their language descriptor. If a PMT update occurs such that an
|
|
// audio stream matching the initially selected language is no longer present
|
|
// then mute will be encoded until the language returns. If "loose", then on
|
|
// a PMT update the demux will choose another audio stream in the program with
|
|
// the same stream type if it can't find one with the same language.
|
|
LanguageSelectionPolicy *string `locationName:"languageSelectionPolicy" type:"string" enum:"AudioLanguageSelectionPolicy"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s AudioLanguageSelection) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s AudioLanguageSelection) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *AudioLanguageSelection) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "AudioLanguageSelection"}
|
|
if s.LanguageCode == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("LanguageCode"))
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetLanguageCode sets the LanguageCode field's value.
|
|
func (s *AudioLanguageSelection) SetLanguageCode(v string) *AudioLanguageSelection {
|
|
s.LanguageCode = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetLanguageSelectionPolicy sets the LanguageSelectionPolicy field's value.
|
|
func (s *AudioLanguageSelection) SetLanguageSelectionPolicy(v string) *AudioLanguageSelection {
|
|
s.LanguageSelectionPolicy = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type AudioNormalizationSettings struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// Audio normalization algorithm to use. itu17701 conforms to the CALM Act specification,
|
|
// itu17702 conforms to the EBU R-128 specification.
|
|
Algorithm *string `locationName:"algorithm" type:"string" enum:"AudioNormalizationAlgorithm"`
|
|
|
|
// When set to correctAudio the output audio is corrected using the chosen algorithm.
|
|
// If set to measureOnly, the audio will be measured but not adjusted.
|
|
AlgorithmControl *string `locationName:"algorithmControl" type:"string" enum:"AudioNormalizationAlgorithmControl"`
|
|
|
|
// Target LKFS(loudness) to adjust volume to. If no value is entered, a default
|
|
// value will be used according to the chosen algorithm. The CALM Act (1770-1)
|
|
// recommends a target of -24 LKFS. The EBU R-128 specification (1770-2) recommends
|
|
// a target of -23 LKFS.
|
|
TargetLkfs *float64 `locationName:"targetLkfs" type:"double"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s AudioNormalizationSettings) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s AudioNormalizationSettings) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetAlgorithm sets the Algorithm field's value.
|
|
func (s *AudioNormalizationSettings) SetAlgorithm(v string) *AudioNormalizationSettings {
|
|
s.Algorithm = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetAlgorithmControl sets the AlgorithmControl field's value.
|
|
func (s *AudioNormalizationSettings) SetAlgorithmControl(v string) *AudioNormalizationSettings {
|
|
s.AlgorithmControl = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetTargetLkfs sets the TargetLkfs field's value.
|
|
func (s *AudioNormalizationSettings) SetTargetLkfs(v float64) *AudioNormalizationSettings {
|
|
s.TargetLkfs = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type AudioOnlyHlsSettings struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// Specifies the group to which the audio Rendition belongs.
|
|
AudioGroupId *string `locationName:"audioGroupId" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// For use with an audio only Stream. Must be a .jpg or .png file. If given,
|
|
// this image will be used as the cover-art for the audio only output. Ideally,
|
|
// it should be formatted for an iPhone screen for two reasons. The iPhone does
|
|
// not resize the image, it crops a centered image on the top/bottom and left/right.
|
|
// Additionally, this image file gets saved bit-for-bit into every 10-second
|
|
// segment file, so will increase bandwidth by {image file size} * {segment
|
|
// count} * {user count.}.
|
|
AudioOnlyImage *InputLocation `locationName:"audioOnlyImage" type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// Four types of audio-only tracks are supported:Audio-Only Variant StreamThe
|
|
// client can play back this audio-only stream instead of video in low-bandwidth
|
|
// scenarios. Represented as an EXT-X-STREAM-INF in the HLS manifest.Alternate
|
|
// Audio, Auto Select, DefaultAlternate rendition that the client should try
|
|
// to play back by default. Represented as an EXT-X-MEDIA in the HLS manifest
|
|
// with DEFAULT=YES, AUTOSELECT=YESAlternate Audio, Auto Select, Not DefaultAlternate
|
|
// rendition that the client may try to play back by default. Represented as
|
|
// an EXT-X-MEDIA in the HLS manifest with DEFAULT=NO, AUTOSELECT=YESAlternate
|
|
// Audio, not Auto SelectAlternate rendition that the client will not try to
|
|
// play back by default. Represented as an EXT-X-MEDIA in the HLS manifest with
|
|
// DEFAULT=NO, AUTOSELECT=NO
|
|
AudioTrackType *string `locationName:"audioTrackType" type:"string" enum:"AudioOnlyHlsTrackType"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s AudioOnlyHlsSettings) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s AudioOnlyHlsSettings) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *AudioOnlyHlsSettings) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "AudioOnlyHlsSettings"}
|
|
if s.AudioOnlyImage != nil {
|
|
if err := s.AudioOnlyImage.Validate(); err != nil {
|
|
invalidParams.AddNested("AudioOnlyImage", err.(request.ErrInvalidParams))
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetAudioGroupId sets the AudioGroupId field's value.
|
|
func (s *AudioOnlyHlsSettings) SetAudioGroupId(v string) *AudioOnlyHlsSettings {
|
|
s.AudioGroupId = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetAudioOnlyImage sets the AudioOnlyImage field's value.
|
|
func (s *AudioOnlyHlsSettings) SetAudioOnlyImage(v *InputLocation) *AudioOnlyHlsSettings {
|
|
s.AudioOnlyImage = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetAudioTrackType sets the AudioTrackType field's value.
|
|
func (s *AudioOnlyHlsSettings) SetAudioTrackType(v string) *AudioOnlyHlsSettings {
|
|
s.AudioTrackType = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type AudioPidSelection struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// Selects a specific PID from within a source.
|
|
//
|
|
// Pid is a required field
|
|
Pid *int64 `locationName:"pid" type:"integer" required:"true"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s AudioPidSelection) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s AudioPidSelection) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *AudioPidSelection) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "AudioPidSelection"}
|
|
if s.Pid == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("Pid"))
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetPid sets the Pid field's value.
|
|
func (s *AudioPidSelection) SetPid(v int64) *AudioPidSelection {
|
|
s.Pid = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type AudioSelector struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// The name of this AudioSelector. AudioDescriptions will use this name to uniquely
|
|
// identify this Selector. Selector names should be unique per input.
|
|
//
|
|
// Name is a required field
|
|
Name *string `locationName:"name" min:"1" type:"string" required:"true"`
|
|
|
|
// The audio selector settings.
|
|
SelectorSettings *AudioSelectorSettings `locationName:"selectorSettings" type:"structure"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s AudioSelector) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s AudioSelector) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *AudioSelector) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "AudioSelector"}
|
|
if s.Name == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("Name"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.Name != nil && len(*s.Name) < 1 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("Name", 1))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.SelectorSettings != nil {
|
|
if err := s.SelectorSettings.Validate(); err != nil {
|
|
invalidParams.AddNested("SelectorSettings", err.(request.ErrInvalidParams))
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetName sets the Name field's value.
|
|
func (s *AudioSelector) SetName(v string) *AudioSelector {
|
|
s.Name = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetSelectorSettings sets the SelectorSettings field's value.
|
|
func (s *AudioSelector) SetSelectorSettings(v *AudioSelectorSettings) *AudioSelector {
|
|
s.SelectorSettings = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type AudioSelectorSettings struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
AudioLanguageSelection *AudioLanguageSelection `locationName:"audioLanguageSelection" type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
AudioPidSelection *AudioPidSelection `locationName:"audioPidSelection" type:"structure"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s AudioSelectorSettings) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s AudioSelectorSettings) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *AudioSelectorSettings) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "AudioSelectorSettings"}
|
|
if s.AudioLanguageSelection != nil {
|
|
if err := s.AudioLanguageSelection.Validate(); err != nil {
|
|
invalidParams.AddNested("AudioLanguageSelection", err.(request.ErrInvalidParams))
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
if s.AudioPidSelection != nil {
|
|
if err := s.AudioPidSelection.Validate(); err != nil {
|
|
invalidParams.AddNested("AudioPidSelection", err.(request.ErrInvalidParams))
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetAudioLanguageSelection sets the AudioLanguageSelection field's value.
|
|
func (s *AudioSelectorSettings) SetAudioLanguageSelection(v *AudioLanguageSelection) *AudioSelectorSettings {
|
|
s.AudioLanguageSelection = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetAudioPidSelection sets the AudioPidSelection field's value.
|
|
func (s *AudioSelectorSettings) SetAudioPidSelection(v *AudioPidSelection) *AudioSelectorSettings {
|
|
s.AudioPidSelection = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type AvailBlanking struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// Blanking image to be used. Leave empty for solid black. Only bmp and png
|
|
// images are supported.
|
|
AvailBlankingImage *InputLocation `locationName:"availBlankingImage" type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// When set to enabled, causes video, audio and captions to be blanked when
|
|
// insertion metadata is added.
|
|
State *string `locationName:"state" type:"string" enum:"AvailBlankingState"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s AvailBlanking) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s AvailBlanking) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *AvailBlanking) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "AvailBlanking"}
|
|
if s.AvailBlankingImage != nil {
|
|
if err := s.AvailBlankingImage.Validate(); err != nil {
|
|
invalidParams.AddNested("AvailBlankingImage", err.(request.ErrInvalidParams))
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetAvailBlankingImage sets the AvailBlankingImage field's value.
|
|
func (s *AvailBlanking) SetAvailBlankingImage(v *InputLocation) *AvailBlanking {
|
|
s.AvailBlankingImage = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetState sets the State field's value.
|
|
func (s *AvailBlanking) SetState(v string) *AvailBlanking {
|
|
s.State = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type AvailConfiguration struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// Ad avail settings.
|
|
AvailSettings *AvailSettings `locationName:"availSettings" type:"structure"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s AvailConfiguration) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s AvailConfiguration) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *AvailConfiguration) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "AvailConfiguration"}
|
|
if s.AvailSettings != nil {
|
|
if err := s.AvailSettings.Validate(); err != nil {
|
|
invalidParams.AddNested("AvailSettings", err.(request.ErrInvalidParams))
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetAvailSettings sets the AvailSettings field's value.
|
|
func (s *AvailConfiguration) SetAvailSettings(v *AvailSettings) *AvailConfiguration {
|
|
s.AvailSettings = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type AvailSettings struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
Scte35SpliceInsert *Scte35SpliceInsert `locationName:"scte35SpliceInsert" type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
Scte35TimeSignalApos *Scte35TimeSignalApos `locationName:"scte35TimeSignalApos" type:"structure"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s AvailSettings) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s AvailSettings) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *AvailSettings) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "AvailSettings"}
|
|
if s.Scte35SpliceInsert != nil {
|
|
if err := s.Scte35SpliceInsert.Validate(); err != nil {
|
|
invalidParams.AddNested("Scte35SpliceInsert", err.(request.ErrInvalidParams))
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
if s.Scte35TimeSignalApos != nil {
|
|
if err := s.Scte35TimeSignalApos.Validate(); err != nil {
|
|
invalidParams.AddNested("Scte35TimeSignalApos", err.(request.ErrInvalidParams))
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetScte35SpliceInsert sets the Scte35SpliceInsert field's value.
|
|
func (s *AvailSettings) SetScte35SpliceInsert(v *Scte35SpliceInsert) *AvailSettings {
|
|
s.Scte35SpliceInsert = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetScte35TimeSignalApos sets the Scte35TimeSignalApos field's value.
|
|
func (s *AvailSettings) SetScte35TimeSignalApos(v *Scte35TimeSignalApos) *AvailSettings {
|
|
s.Scte35TimeSignalApos = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// A list of schedule actions to create (in a request) or that have been created
|
|
// (in a response).
|
|
type BatchScheduleActionCreateRequest struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// A list of schedule actions to create.
|
|
//
|
|
// ScheduleActions is a required field
|
|
ScheduleActions []*ScheduleAction `locationName:"scheduleActions" type:"list" required:"true"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s BatchScheduleActionCreateRequest) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s BatchScheduleActionCreateRequest) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *BatchScheduleActionCreateRequest) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "BatchScheduleActionCreateRequest"}
|
|
if s.ScheduleActions == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("ScheduleActions"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.ScheduleActions != nil {
|
|
for i, v := range s.ScheduleActions {
|
|
if v == nil {
|
|
continue
|
|
}
|
|
if err := v.Validate(); err != nil {
|
|
invalidParams.AddNested(fmt.Sprintf("%s[%v]", "ScheduleActions", i), err.(request.ErrInvalidParams))
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetScheduleActions sets the ScheduleActions field's value.
|
|
func (s *BatchScheduleActionCreateRequest) SetScheduleActions(v []*ScheduleAction) *BatchScheduleActionCreateRequest {
|
|
s.ScheduleActions = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// List of actions that have been created in the schedule.
|
|
type BatchScheduleActionCreateResult struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// List of actions that have been created in the schedule.
|
|
//
|
|
// ScheduleActions is a required field
|
|
ScheduleActions []*ScheduleAction `locationName:"scheduleActions" type:"list" required:"true"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s BatchScheduleActionCreateResult) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s BatchScheduleActionCreateResult) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetScheduleActions sets the ScheduleActions field's value.
|
|
func (s *BatchScheduleActionCreateResult) SetScheduleActions(v []*ScheduleAction) *BatchScheduleActionCreateResult {
|
|
s.ScheduleActions = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// A list of schedule actions to delete.
|
|
type BatchScheduleActionDeleteRequest struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// A list of schedule actions to delete.
|
|
//
|
|
// ActionNames is a required field
|
|
ActionNames []*string `locationName:"actionNames" type:"list" required:"true"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s BatchScheduleActionDeleteRequest) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s BatchScheduleActionDeleteRequest) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *BatchScheduleActionDeleteRequest) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "BatchScheduleActionDeleteRequest"}
|
|
if s.ActionNames == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("ActionNames"))
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetActionNames sets the ActionNames field's value.
|
|
func (s *BatchScheduleActionDeleteRequest) SetActionNames(v []*string) *BatchScheduleActionDeleteRequest {
|
|
s.ActionNames = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// List of actions that have been deleted from the schedule.
|
|
type BatchScheduleActionDeleteResult struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// List of actions that have been deleted from the schedule.
|
|
//
|
|
// ScheduleActions is a required field
|
|
ScheduleActions []*ScheduleAction `locationName:"scheduleActions" type:"list" required:"true"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s BatchScheduleActionDeleteResult) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s BatchScheduleActionDeleteResult) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetScheduleActions sets the ScheduleActions field's value.
|
|
func (s *BatchScheduleActionDeleteResult) SetScheduleActions(v []*ScheduleAction) *BatchScheduleActionDeleteResult {
|
|
s.ScheduleActions = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// A request to create actions (add actions to the schedule), delete actions
|
|
// (remove actions from the schedule), or both create and delete actions.
|
|
type BatchUpdateScheduleInput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// ChannelId is a required field
|
|
ChannelId *string `location:"uri" locationName:"channelId" type:"string" required:"true"`
|
|
|
|
// Schedule actions to create in the schedule.
|
|
Creates *BatchScheduleActionCreateRequest `locationName:"creates" type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// Schedule actions to delete from the schedule.
|
|
Deletes *BatchScheduleActionDeleteRequest `locationName:"deletes" type:"structure"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s BatchUpdateScheduleInput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s BatchUpdateScheduleInput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *BatchUpdateScheduleInput) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "BatchUpdateScheduleInput"}
|
|
if s.ChannelId == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("ChannelId"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.ChannelId != nil && len(*s.ChannelId) < 1 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("ChannelId", 1))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.Creates != nil {
|
|
if err := s.Creates.Validate(); err != nil {
|
|
invalidParams.AddNested("Creates", err.(request.ErrInvalidParams))
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
if s.Deletes != nil {
|
|
if err := s.Deletes.Validate(); err != nil {
|
|
invalidParams.AddNested("Deletes", err.(request.ErrInvalidParams))
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetChannelId sets the ChannelId field's value.
|
|
func (s *BatchUpdateScheduleInput) SetChannelId(v string) *BatchUpdateScheduleInput {
|
|
s.ChannelId = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetCreates sets the Creates field's value.
|
|
func (s *BatchUpdateScheduleInput) SetCreates(v *BatchScheduleActionCreateRequest) *BatchUpdateScheduleInput {
|
|
s.Creates = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetDeletes sets the Deletes field's value.
|
|
func (s *BatchUpdateScheduleInput) SetDeletes(v *BatchScheduleActionDeleteRequest) *BatchUpdateScheduleInput {
|
|
s.Deletes = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type BatchUpdateScheduleOutput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// List of actions that have been created in the schedule.
|
|
Creates *BatchScheduleActionCreateResult `locationName:"creates" type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// List of actions that have been deleted from the schedule.
|
|
Deletes *BatchScheduleActionDeleteResult `locationName:"deletes" type:"structure"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s BatchUpdateScheduleOutput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s BatchUpdateScheduleOutput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetCreates sets the Creates field's value.
|
|
func (s *BatchUpdateScheduleOutput) SetCreates(v *BatchScheduleActionCreateResult) *BatchUpdateScheduleOutput {
|
|
s.Creates = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetDeletes sets the Deletes field's value.
|
|
func (s *BatchUpdateScheduleOutput) SetDeletes(v *BatchScheduleActionDeleteResult) *BatchUpdateScheduleOutput {
|
|
s.Deletes = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type BlackoutSlate struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// Blackout slate image to be used. Leave empty for solid black. Only bmp and
|
|
// png images are supported.
|
|
BlackoutSlateImage *InputLocation `locationName:"blackoutSlateImage" type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// Setting to enabled causes the encoder to blackout the video, audio, and captions,
|
|
// and raise the "Network Blackout Image" slate when an SCTE104/35 Network End
|
|
// Segmentation Descriptor is encountered. The blackout will be lifted when
|
|
// the Network Start Segmentation Descriptor is encountered. The Network End
|
|
// and Network Start descriptors must contain a network ID that matches the
|
|
// value entered in "Network ID".
|
|
NetworkEndBlackout *string `locationName:"networkEndBlackout" type:"string" enum:"BlackoutSlateNetworkEndBlackout"`
|
|
|
|
// Path to local file to use as Network End Blackout image. Image will be scaled
|
|
// to fill the entire output raster.
|
|
NetworkEndBlackoutImage *InputLocation `locationName:"networkEndBlackoutImage" type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// Provides Network ID that matches EIDR ID format (e.g., "10.XXXX/XXXX-XXXX-XXXX-XXXX-XXXX-C").
|
|
NetworkId *string `locationName:"networkId" min:"34" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// When set to enabled, causes video, audio and captions to be blanked when
|
|
// indicated by program metadata.
|
|
State *string `locationName:"state" type:"string" enum:"BlackoutSlateState"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s BlackoutSlate) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s BlackoutSlate) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *BlackoutSlate) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "BlackoutSlate"}
|
|
if s.NetworkId != nil && len(*s.NetworkId) < 34 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("NetworkId", 34))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.BlackoutSlateImage != nil {
|
|
if err := s.BlackoutSlateImage.Validate(); err != nil {
|
|
invalidParams.AddNested("BlackoutSlateImage", err.(request.ErrInvalidParams))
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
if s.NetworkEndBlackoutImage != nil {
|
|
if err := s.NetworkEndBlackoutImage.Validate(); err != nil {
|
|
invalidParams.AddNested("NetworkEndBlackoutImage", err.(request.ErrInvalidParams))
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetBlackoutSlateImage sets the BlackoutSlateImage field's value.
|
|
func (s *BlackoutSlate) SetBlackoutSlateImage(v *InputLocation) *BlackoutSlate {
|
|
s.BlackoutSlateImage = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetNetworkEndBlackout sets the NetworkEndBlackout field's value.
|
|
func (s *BlackoutSlate) SetNetworkEndBlackout(v string) *BlackoutSlate {
|
|
s.NetworkEndBlackout = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetNetworkEndBlackoutImage sets the NetworkEndBlackoutImage field's value.
|
|
func (s *BlackoutSlate) SetNetworkEndBlackoutImage(v *InputLocation) *BlackoutSlate {
|
|
s.NetworkEndBlackoutImage = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetNetworkId sets the NetworkId field's value.
|
|
func (s *BlackoutSlate) SetNetworkId(v string) *BlackoutSlate {
|
|
s.NetworkId = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetState sets the State field's value.
|
|
func (s *BlackoutSlate) SetState(v string) *BlackoutSlate {
|
|
s.State = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type BurnInDestinationSettings struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// If no explicit xPosition or yPosition is provided, setting alignment to centered
|
|
// will place the captions at the bottom center of the output. Similarly, setting
|
|
// a left alignment will align captions to the bottom left of the output. If
|
|
// x and y positions are given in conjunction with the alignment parameter,
|
|
// the font will be justified (either left or centered) relative to those coordinates.
|
|
// Selecting "smart" justification will left-justify live subtitles and center-justify
|
|
// pre-recorded subtitles. All burn-in and DVB-Sub font settings must match.
|
|
Alignment *string `locationName:"alignment" type:"string" enum:"BurnInAlignment"`
|
|
|
|
// Specifies the color of the rectangle behind the captions. All burn-in and
|
|
// DVB-Sub font settings must match.
|
|
BackgroundColor *string `locationName:"backgroundColor" type:"string" enum:"BurnInBackgroundColor"`
|
|
|
|
// Specifies the opacity of the background rectangle. 255 is opaque; 0 is transparent.
|
|
// Leaving this parameter out is equivalent to setting it to 0 (transparent).
|
|
// All burn-in and DVB-Sub font settings must match.
|
|
BackgroundOpacity *int64 `locationName:"backgroundOpacity" type:"integer"`
|
|
|
|
// External font file used for caption burn-in. File extension must be 'ttf'
|
|
// or 'tte'. Although the user can select output fonts for many different types
|
|
// of input captions, embedded, STL and teletext sources use a strict grid system.
|
|
// Using external fonts with these caption sources could cause unexpected display
|
|
// of proportional fonts. All burn-in and DVB-Sub font settings must match.
|
|
Font *InputLocation `locationName:"font" type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// Specifies the color of the burned-in captions. This option is not valid for
|
|
// source captions that are STL, 608/embedded or teletext. These source settings
|
|
// are already pre-defined by the caption stream. All burn-in and DVB-Sub font
|
|
// settings must match.
|
|
FontColor *string `locationName:"fontColor" type:"string" enum:"BurnInFontColor"`
|
|
|
|
// Specifies the opacity of the burned-in captions. 255 is opaque; 0 is transparent.
|
|
// All burn-in and DVB-Sub font settings must match.
|
|
FontOpacity *int64 `locationName:"fontOpacity" type:"integer"`
|
|
|
|
// Font resolution in DPI (dots per inch); default is 96 dpi. All burn-in and
|
|
// DVB-Sub font settings must match.
|
|
FontResolution *int64 `locationName:"fontResolution" min:"96" type:"integer"`
|
|
|
|
// When set to 'auto' fontSize will scale depending on the size of the output.
|
|
// Giving a positive integer will specify the exact font size in points. All
|
|
// burn-in and DVB-Sub font settings must match.
|
|
FontSize *string `locationName:"fontSize" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// Specifies font outline color. This option is not valid for source captions
|
|
// that are either 608/embedded or teletext. These source settings are already
|
|
// pre-defined by the caption stream. All burn-in and DVB-Sub font settings
|
|
// must match.
|
|
OutlineColor *string `locationName:"outlineColor" type:"string" enum:"BurnInOutlineColor"`
|
|
|
|
// Specifies font outline size in pixels. This option is not valid for source
|
|
// captions that are either 608/embedded or teletext. These source settings
|
|
// are already pre-defined by the caption stream. All burn-in and DVB-Sub font
|
|
// settings must match.
|
|
OutlineSize *int64 `locationName:"outlineSize" type:"integer"`
|
|
|
|
// Specifies the color of the shadow cast by the captions. All burn-in and DVB-Sub
|
|
// font settings must match.
|
|
ShadowColor *string `locationName:"shadowColor" type:"string" enum:"BurnInShadowColor"`
|
|
|
|
// Specifies the opacity of the shadow. 255 is opaque; 0 is transparent. Leaving
|
|
// this parameter out is equivalent to setting it to 0 (transparent). All burn-in
|
|
// and DVB-Sub font settings must match.
|
|
ShadowOpacity *int64 `locationName:"shadowOpacity" type:"integer"`
|
|
|
|
// Specifies the horizontal offset of the shadow relative to the captions in
|
|
// pixels. A value of -2 would result in a shadow offset 2 pixels to the left.
|
|
// All burn-in and DVB-Sub font settings must match.
|
|
ShadowXOffset *int64 `locationName:"shadowXOffset" type:"integer"`
|
|
|
|
// Specifies the vertical offset of the shadow relative to the captions in pixels.
|
|
// A value of -2 would result in a shadow offset 2 pixels above the text. All
|
|
// burn-in and DVB-Sub font settings must match.
|
|
ShadowYOffset *int64 `locationName:"shadowYOffset" type:"integer"`
|
|
|
|
// Controls whether a fixed grid size will be used to generate the output subtitles
|
|
// bitmap. Only applicable for Teletext inputs and DVB-Sub/Burn-in outputs.
|
|
TeletextGridControl *string `locationName:"teletextGridControl" type:"string" enum:"BurnInTeletextGridControl"`
|
|
|
|
// Specifies the horizontal position of the caption relative to the left side
|
|
// of the output in pixels. A value of 10 would result in the captions starting
|
|
// 10 pixels from the left of the output. If no explicit xPosition is provided,
|
|
// the horizontal caption position will be determined by the alignment parameter.
|
|
// All burn-in and DVB-Sub font settings must match.
|
|
XPosition *int64 `locationName:"xPosition" type:"integer"`
|
|
|
|
// Specifies the vertical position of the caption relative to the top of the
|
|
// output in pixels. A value of 10 would result in the captions starting 10
|
|
// pixels from the top of the output. If no explicit yPosition is provided,
|
|
// the caption will be positioned towards the bottom of the output. All burn-in
|
|
// and DVB-Sub font settings must match.
|
|
YPosition *int64 `locationName:"yPosition" type:"integer"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s BurnInDestinationSettings) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s BurnInDestinationSettings) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *BurnInDestinationSettings) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "BurnInDestinationSettings"}
|
|
if s.FontResolution != nil && *s.FontResolution < 96 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinValue("FontResolution", 96))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.Font != nil {
|
|
if err := s.Font.Validate(); err != nil {
|
|
invalidParams.AddNested("Font", err.(request.ErrInvalidParams))
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetAlignment sets the Alignment field's value.
|
|
func (s *BurnInDestinationSettings) SetAlignment(v string) *BurnInDestinationSettings {
|
|
s.Alignment = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetBackgroundColor sets the BackgroundColor field's value.
|
|
func (s *BurnInDestinationSettings) SetBackgroundColor(v string) *BurnInDestinationSettings {
|
|
s.BackgroundColor = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetBackgroundOpacity sets the BackgroundOpacity field's value.
|
|
func (s *BurnInDestinationSettings) SetBackgroundOpacity(v int64) *BurnInDestinationSettings {
|
|
s.BackgroundOpacity = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetFont sets the Font field's value.
|
|
func (s *BurnInDestinationSettings) SetFont(v *InputLocation) *BurnInDestinationSettings {
|
|
s.Font = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetFontColor sets the FontColor field's value.
|
|
func (s *BurnInDestinationSettings) SetFontColor(v string) *BurnInDestinationSettings {
|
|
s.FontColor = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetFontOpacity sets the FontOpacity field's value.
|
|
func (s *BurnInDestinationSettings) SetFontOpacity(v int64) *BurnInDestinationSettings {
|
|
s.FontOpacity = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetFontResolution sets the FontResolution field's value.
|
|
func (s *BurnInDestinationSettings) SetFontResolution(v int64) *BurnInDestinationSettings {
|
|
s.FontResolution = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetFontSize sets the FontSize field's value.
|
|
func (s *BurnInDestinationSettings) SetFontSize(v string) *BurnInDestinationSettings {
|
|
s.FontSize = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetOutlineColor sets the OutlineColor field's value.
|
|
func (s *BurnInDestinationSettings) SetOutlineColor(v string) *BurnInDestinationSettings {
|
|
s.OutlineColor = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetOutlineSize sets the OutlineSize field's value.
|
|
func (s *BurnInDestinationSettings) SetOutlineSize(v int64) *BurnInDestinationSettings {
|
|
s.OutlineSize = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetShadowColor sets the ShadowColor field's value.
|
|
func (s *BurnInDestinationSettings) SetShadowColor(v string) *BurnInDestinationSettings {
|
|
s.ShadowColor = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetShadowOpacity sets the ShadowOpacity field's value.
|
|
func (s *BurnInDestinationSettings) SetShadowOpacity(v int64) *BurnInDestinationSettings {
|
|
s.ShadowOpacity = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetShadowXOffset sets the ShadowXOffset field's value.
|
|
func (s *BurnInDestinationSettings) SetShadowXOffset(v int64) *BurnInDestinationSettings {
|
|
s.ShadowXOffset = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetShadowYOffset sets the ShadowYOffset field's value.
|
|
func (s *BurnInDestinationSettings) SetShadowYOffset(v int64) *BurnInDestinationSettings {
|
|
s.ShadowYOffset = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetTeletextGridControl sets the TeletextGridControl field's value.
|
|
func (s *BurnInDestinationSettings) SetTeletextGridControl(v string) *BurnInDestinationSettings {
|
|
s.TeletextGridControl = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetXPosition sets the XPosition field's value.
|
|
func (s *BurnInDestinationSettings) SetXPosition(v int64) *BurnInDestinationSettings {
|
|
s.XPosition = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetYPosition sets the YPosition field's value.
|
|
func (s *BurnInDestinationSettings) SetYPosition(v int64) *BurnInDestinationSettings {
|
|
s.YPosition = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Output groups for this Live Event. Output groups contain information about
|
|
// where streams should be distributed.
|
|
type CaptionDescription struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// Specifies which input caption selector to use as a caption source when generating
|
|
// output captions. This field should match a captionSelector name.
|
|
//
|
|
// CaptionSelectorName is a required field
|
|
CaptionSelectorName *string `locationName:"captionSelectorName" type:"string" required:"true"`
|
|
|
|
// Additional settings for captions destination that depend on the destination
|
|
// type.
|
|
DestinationSettings *CaptionDestinationSettings `locationName:"destinationSettings" type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// ISO 639-2 three-digit code: http://www.loc.gov/standards/iso639-2/
|
|
LanguageCode *string `locationName:"languageCode" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// Human readable information to indicate captions available for players (eg.
|
|
// English, or Spanish).
|
|
LanguageDescription *string `locationName:"languageDescription" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// Name of the caption description. Used to associate a caption description
|
|
// with an output. Names must be unique within an event.
|
|
//
|
|
// Name is a required field
|
|
Name *string `locationName:"name" type:"string" required:"true"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s CaptionDescription) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s CaptionDescription) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *CaptionDescription) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "CaptionDescription"}
|
|
if s.CaptionSelectorName == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("CaptionSelectorName"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.Name == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("Name"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.DestinationSettings != nil {
|
|
if err := s.DestinationSettings.Validate(); err != nil {
|
|
invalidParams.AddNested("DestinationSettings", err.(request.ErrInvalidParams))
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetCaptionSelectorName sets the CaptionSelectorName field's value.
|
|
func (s *CaptionDescription) SetCaptionSelectorName(v string) *CaptionDescription {
|
|
s.CaptionSelectorName = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetDestinationSettings sets the DestinationSettings field's value.
|
|
func (s *CaptionDescription) SetDestinationSettings(v *CaptionDestinationSettings) *CaptionDescription {
|
|
s.DestinationSettings = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetLanguageCode sets the LanguageCode field's value.
|
|
func (s *CaptionDescription) SetLanguageCode(v string) *CaptionDescription {
|
|
s.LanguageCode = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetLanguageDescription sets the LanguageDescription field's value.
|
|
func (s *CaptionDescription) SetLanguageDescription(v string) *CaptionDescription {
|
|
s.LanguageDescription = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetName sets the Name field's value.
|
|
func (s *CaptionDescription) SetName(v string) *CaptionDescription {
|
|
s.Name = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type CaptionDestinationSettings struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
AribDestinationSettings *AribDestinationSettings `locationName:"aribDestinationSettings" type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
BurnInDestinationSettings *BurnInDestinationSettings `locationName:"burnInDestinationSettings" type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
DvbSubDestinationSettings *DvbSubDestinationSettings `locationName:"dvbSubDestinationSettings" type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
EmbeddedDestinationSettings *EmbeddedDestinationSettings `locationName:"embeddedDestinationSettings" type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
EmbeddedPlusScte20DestinationSettings *EmbeddedPlusScte20DestinationSettings `locationName:"embeddedPlusScte20DestinationSettings" type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
RtmpCaptionInfoDestinationSettings *RtmpCaptionInfoDestinationSettings `locationName:"rtmpCaptionInfoDestinationSettings" type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
Scte20PlusEmbeddedDestinationSettings *Scte20PlusEmbeddedDestinationSettings `locationName:"scte20PlusEmbeddedDestinationSettings" type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
Scte27DestinationSettings *Scte27DestinationSettings `locationName:"scte27DestinationSettings" type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
SmpteTtDestinationSettings *SmpteTtDestinationSettings `locationName:"smpteTtDestinationSettings" type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
TeletextDestinationSettings *TeletextDestinationSettings `locationName:"teletextDestinationSettings" type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
TtmlDestinationSettings *TtmlDestinationSettings `locationName:"ttmlDestinationSettings" type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
WebvttDestinationSettings *WebvttDestinationSettings `locationName:"webvttDestinationSettings" type:"structure"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s CaptionDestinationSettings) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s CaptionDestinationSettings) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *CaptionDestinationSettings) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "CaptionDestinationSettings"}
|
|
if s.BurnInDestinationSettings != nil {
|
|
if err := s.BurnInDestinationSettings.Validate(); err != nil {
|
|
invalidParams.AddNested("BurnInDestinationSettings", err.(request.ErrInvalidParams))
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
if s.DvbSubDestinationSettings != nil {
|
|
if err := s.DvbSubDestinationSettings.Validate(); err != nil {
|
|
invalidParams.AddNested("DvbSubDestinationSettings", err.(request.ErrInvalidParams))
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetAribDestinationSettings sets the AribDestinationSettings field's value.
|
|
func (s *CaptionDestinationSettings) SetAribDestinationSettings(v *AribDestinationSettings) *CaptionDestinationSettings {
|
|
s.AribDestinationSettings = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetBurnInDestinationSettings sets the BurnInDestinationSettings field's value.
|
|
func (s *CaptionDestinationSettings) SetBurnInDestinationSettings(v *BurnInDestinationSettings) *CaptionDestinationSettings {
|
|
s.BurnInDestinationSettings = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetDvbSubDestinationSettings sets the DvbSubDestinationSettings field's value.
|
|
func (s *CaptionDestinationSettings) SetDvbSubDestinationSettings(v *DvbSubDestinationSettings) *CaptionDestinationSettings {
|
|
s.DvbSubDestinationSettings = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetEmbeddedDestinationSettings sets the EmbeddedDestinationSettings field's value.
|
|
func (s *CaptionDestinationSettings) SetEmbeddedDestinationSettings(v *EmbeddedDestinationSettings) *CaptionDestinationSettings {
|
|
s.EmbeddedDestinationSettings = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetEmbeddedPlusScte20DestinationSettings sets the EmbeddedPlusScte20DestinationSettings field's value.
|
|
func (s *CaptionDestinationSettings) SetEmbeddedPlusScte20DestinationSettings(v *EmbeddedPlusScte20DestinationSettings) *CaptionDestinationSettings {
|
|
s.EmbeddedPlusScte20DestinationSettings = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetRtmpCaptionInfoDestinationSettings sets the RtmpCaptionInfoDestinationSettings field's value.
|
|
func (s *CaptionDestinationSettings) SetRtmpCaptionInfoDestinationSettings(v *RtmpCaptionInfoDestinationSettings) *CaptionDestinationSettings {
|
|
s.RtmpCaptionInfoDestinationSettings = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetScte20PlusEmbeddedDestinationSettings sets the Scte20PlusEmbeddedDestinationSettings field's value.
|
|
func (s *CaptionDestinationSettings) SetScte20PlusEmbeddedDestinationSettings(v *Scte20PlusEmbeddedDestinationSettings) *CaptionDestinationSettings {
|
|
s.Scte20PlusEmbeddedDestinationSettings = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetScte27DestinationSettings sets the Scte27DestinationSettings field's value.
|
|
func (s *CaptionDestinationSettings) SetScte27DestinationSettings(v *Scte27DestinationSettings) *CaptionDestinationSettings {
|
|
s.Scte27DestinationSettings = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetSmpteTtDestinationSettings sets the SmpteTtDestinationSettings field's value.
|
|
func (s *CaptionDestinationSettings) SetSmpteTtDestinationSettings(v *SmpteTtDestinationSettings) *CaptionDestinationSettings {
|
|
s.SmpteTtDestinationSettings = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetTeletextDestinationSettings sets the TeletextDestinationSettings field's value.
|
|
func (s *CaptionDestinationSettings) SetTeletextDestinationSettings(v *TeletextDestinationSettings) *CaptionDestinationSettings {
|
|
s.TeletextDestinationSettings = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetTtmlDestinationSettings sets the TtmlDestinationSettings field's value.
|
|
func (s *CaptionDestinationSettings) SetTtmlDestinationSettings(v *TtmlDestinationSettings) *CaptionDestinationSettings {
|
|
s.TtmlDestinationSettings = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetWebvttDestinationSettings sets the WebvttDestinationSettings field's value.
|
|
func (s *CaptionDestinationSettings) SetWebvttDestinationSettings(v *WebvttDestinationSettings) *CaptionDestinationSettings {
|
|
s.WebvttDestinationSettings = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Maps a caption channel to an ISO 693-2 language code (http://www.loc.gov/standards/iso639-2),
|
|
// with an optional description.
|
|
type CaptionLanguageMapping struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// The closed caption channel being described by this CaptionLanguageMapping.
|
|
// Each channel mapping must have a unique channel number (maximum of 4)
|
|
//
|
|
// CaptionChannel is a required field
|
|
CaptionChannel *int64 `locationName:"captionChannel" min:"1" type:"integer" required:"true"`
|
|
|
|
// Three character ISO 639-2 language code (see http://www.loc.gov/standards/iso639-2)
|
|
//
|
|
// LanguageCode is a required field
|
|
LanguageCode *string `locationName:"languageCode" min:"3" type:"string" required:"true"`
|
|
|
|
// Textual description of language
|
|
//
|
|
// LanguageDescription is a required field
|
|
LanguageDescription *string `locationName:"languageDescription" min:"1" type:"string" required:"true"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s CaptionLanguageMapping) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s CaptionLanguageMapping) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *CaptionLanguageMapping) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "CaptionLanguageMapping"}
|
|
if s.CaptionChannel == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("CaptionChannel"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.CaptionChannel != nil && *s.CaptionChannel < 1 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinValue("CaptionChannel", 1))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.LanguageCode == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("LanguageCode"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.LanguageCode != nil && len(*s.LanguageCode) < 3 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("LanguageCode", 3))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.LanguageDescription == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("LanguageDescription"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.LanguageDescription != nil && len(*s.LanguageDescription) < 1 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("LanguageDescription", 1))
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetCaptionChannel sets the CaptionChannel field's value.
|
|
func (s *CaptionLanguageMapping) SetCaptionChannel(v int64) *CaptionLanguageMapping {
|
|
s.CaptionChannel = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetLanguageCode sets the LanguageCode field's value.
|
|
func (s *CaptionLanguageMapping) SetLanguageCode(v string) *CaptionLanguageMapping {
|
|
s.LanguageCode = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetLanguageDescription sets the LanguageDescription field's value.
|
|
func (s *CaptionLanguageMapping) SetLanguageDescription(v string) *CaptionLanguageMapping {
|
|
s.LanguageDescription = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Output groups for this Live Event. Output groups contain information about
|
|
// where streams should be distributed.
|
|
type CaptionSelector struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// When specified this field indicates the three letter language code of the
|
|
// caption track to extract from the source.
|
|
LanguageCode *string `locationName:"languageCode" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// Name identifier for a caption selector. This name is used to associate this
|
|
// caption selector with one or more caption descriptions. Names must be unique
|
|
// within an event.
|
|
//
|
|
// Name is a required field
|
|
Name *string `locationName:"name" min:"1" type:"string" required:"true"`
|
|
|
|
// Caption selector settings.
|
|
SelectorSettings *CaptionSelectorSettings `locationName:"selectorSettings" type:"structure"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s CaptionSelector) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s CaptionSelector) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *CaptionSelector) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "CaptionSelector"}
|
|
if s.Name == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("Name"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.Name != nil && len(*s.Name) < 1 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("Name", 1))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.SelectorSettings != nil {
|
|
if err := s.SelectorSettings.Validate(); err != nil {
|
|
invalidParams.AddNested("SelectorSettings", err.(request.ErrInvalidParams))
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetLanguageCode sets the LanguageCode field's value.
|
|
func (s *CaptionSelector) SetLanguageCode(v string) *CaptionSelector {
|
|
s.LanguageCode = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetName sets the Name field's value.
|
|
func (s *CaptionSelector) SetName(v string) *CaptionSelector {
|
|
s.Name = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetSelectorSettings sets the SelectorSettings field's value.
|
|
func (s *CaptionSelector) SetSelectorSettings(v *CaptionSelectorSettings) *CaptionSelector {
|
|
s.SelectorSettings = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type CaptionSelectorSettings struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
AribSourceSettings *AribSourceSettings `locationName:"aribSourceSettings" type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
DvbSubSourceSettings *DvbSubSourceSettings `locationName:"dvbSubSourceSettings" type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
EmbeddedSourceSettings *EmbeddedSourceSettings `locationName:"embeddedSourceSettings" type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
Scte20SourceSettings *Scte20SourceSettings `locationName:"scte20SourceSettings" type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
Scte27SourceSettings *Scte27SourceSettings `locationName:"scte27SourceSettings" type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
TeletextSourceSettings *TeletextSourceSettings `locationName:"teletextSourceSettings" type:"structure"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s CaptionSelectorSettings) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s CaptionSelectorSettings) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *CaptionSelectorSettings) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "CaptionSelectorSettings"}
|
|
if s.DvbSubSourceSettings != nil {
|
|
if err := s.DvbSubSourceSettings.Validate(); err != nil {
|
|
invalidParams.AddNested("DvbSubSourceSettings", err.(request.ErrInvalidParams))
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
if s.EmbeddedSourceSettings != nil {
|
|
if err := s.EmbeddedSourceSettings.Validate(); err != nil {
|
|
invalidParams.AddNested("EmbeddedSourceSettings", err.(request.ErrInvalidParams))
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
if s.Scte20SourceSettings != nil {
|
|
if err := s.Scte20SourceSettings.Validate(); err != nil {
|
|
invalidParams.AddNested("Scte20SourceSettings", err.(request.ErrInvalidParams))
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
if s.Scte27SourceSettings != nil {
|
|
if err := s.Scte27SourceSettings.Validate(); err != nil {
|
|
invalidParams.AddNested("Scte27SourceSettings", err.(request.ErrInvalidParams))
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetAribSourceSettings sets the AribSourceSettings field's value.
|
|
func (s *CaptionSelectorSettings) SetAribSourceSettings(v *AribSourceSettings) *CaptionSelectorSettings {
|
|
s.AribSourceSettings = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetDvbSubSourceSettings sets the DvbSubSourceSettings field's value.
|
|
func (s *CaptionSelectorSettings) SetDvbSubSourceSettings(v *DvbSubSourceSettings) *CaptionSelectorSettings {
|
|
s.DvbSubSourceSettings = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetEmbeddedSourceSettings sets the EmbeddedSourceSettings field's value.
|
|
func (s *CaptionSelectorSettings) SetEmbeddedSourceSettings(v *EmbeddedSourceSettings) *CaptionSelectorSettings {
|
|
s.EmbeddedSourceSettings = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetScte20SourceSettings sets the Scte20SourceSettings field's value.
|
|
func (s *CaptionSelectorSettings) SetScte20SourceSettings(v *Scte20SourceSettings) *CaptionSelectorSettings {
|
|
s.Scte20SourceSettings = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetScte27SourceSettings sets the Scte27SourceSettings field's value.
|
|
func (s *CaptionSelectorSettings) SetScte27SourceSettings(v *Scte27SourceSettings) *CaptionSelectorSettings {
|
|
s.Scte27SourceSettings = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetTeletextSourceSettings sets the TeletextSourceSettings field's value.
|
|
func (s *CaptionSelectorSettings) SetTeletextSourceSettings(v *TeletextSourceSettings) *CaptionSelectorSettings {
|
|
s.TeletextSourceSettings = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type Channel struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// The unique arn of the channel.
|
|
Arn *string `locationName:"arn" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// A list of destinations of the channel. For UDP outputs, there is onedestination
|
|
// per output. For other types (HLS, for example), there isone destination per
|
|
// packager.
|
|
Destinations []*OutputDestination `locationName:"destinations" type:"list"`
|
|
|
|
// The endpoints where outgoing connections initiate from
|
|
EgressEndpoints []*ChannelEgressEndpoint `locationName:"egressEndpoints" type:"list"`
|
|
|
|
EncoderSettings *EncoderSettings `locationName:"encoderSettings" type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// The unique id of the channel.
|
|
Id *string `locationName:"id" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// List of input attachments for channel.
|
|
InputAttachments []*InputAttachment `locationName:"inputAttachments" type:"list"`
|
|
|
|
InputSpecification *InputSpecification `locationName:"inputSpecification" type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// The log level being written to CloudWatch Logs.
|
|
LogLevel *string `locationName:"logLevel" type:"string" enum:"LogLevel"`
|
|
|
|
// The name of the channel. (user-mutable)
|
|
Name *string `locationName:"name" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// The number of currently healthy pipelines.
|
|
PipelinesRunningCount *int64 `locationName:"pipelinesRunningCount" type:"integer"`
|
|
|
|
// The Amazon Resource Name (ARN) of the role assumed when running the Channel.
|
|
RoleArn *string `locationName:"roleArn" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
State *string `locationName:"state" type:"string" enum:"ChannelState"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s Channel) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s Channel) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetArn sets the Arn field's value.
|
|
func (s *Channel) SetArn(v string) *Channel {
|
|
s.Arn = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetDestinations sets the Destinations field's value.
|
|
func (s *Channel) SetDestinations(v []*OutputDestination) *Channel {
|
|
s.Destinations = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetEgressEndpoints sets the EgressEndpoints field's value.
|
|
func (s *Channel) SetEgressEndpoints(v []*ChannelEgressEndpoint) *Channel {
|
|
s.EgressEndpoints = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetEncoderSettings sets the EncoderSettings field's value.
|
|
func (s *Channel) SetEncoderSettings(v *EncoderSettings) *Channel {
|
|
s.EncoderSettings = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetId sets the Id field's value.
|
|
func (s *Channel) SetId(v string) *Channel {
|
|
s.Id = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetInputAttachments sets the InputAttachments field's value.
|
|
func (s *Channel) SetInputAttachments(v []*InputAttachment) *Channel {
|
|
s.InputAttachments = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetInputSpecification sets the InputSpecification field's value.
|
|
func (s *Channel) SetInputSpecification(v *InputSpecification) *Channel {
|
|
s.InputSpecification = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetLogLevel sets the LogLevel field's value.
|
|
func (s *Channel) SetLogLevel(v string) *Channel {
|
|
s.LogLevel = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetName sets the Name field's value.
|
|
func (s *Channel) SetName(v string) *Channel {
|
|
s.Name = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetPipelinesRunningCount sets the PipelinesRunningCount field's value.
|
|
func (s *Channel) SetPipelinesRunningCount(v int64) *Channel {
|
|
s.PipelinesRunningCount = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetRoleArn sets the RoleArn field's value.
|
|
func (s *Channel) SetRoleArn(v string) *Channel {
|
|
s.RoleArn = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetState sets the State field's value.
|
|
func (s *Channel) SetState(v string) *Channel {
|
|
s.State = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type ChannelEgressEndpoint struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// Public IP of where a channel's output comes from
|
|
SourceIp *string `locationName:"sourceIp" type:"string"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s ChannelEgressEndpoint) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s ChannelEgressEndpoint) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetSourceIp sets the SourceIp field's value.
|
|
func (s *ChannelEgressEndpoint) SetSourceIp(v string) *ChannelEgressEndpoint {
|
|
s.SourceIp = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type ChannelSummary struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// The unique arn of the channel.
|
|
Arn *string `locationName:"arn" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// A list of destinations of the channel. For UDP outputs, there is onedestination
|
|
// per output. For other types (HLS, for example), there isone destination per
|
|
// packager.
|
|
Destinations []*OutputDestination `locationName:"destinations" type:"list"`
|
|
|
|
// The endpoints where outgoing connections initiate from
|
|
EgressEndpoints []*ChannelEgressEndpoint `locationName:"egressEndpoints" type:"list"`
|
|
|
|
// The unique id of the channel.
|
|
Id *string `locationName:"id" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// List of input attachments for channel.
|
|
InputAttachments []*InputAttachment `locationName:"inputAttachments" type:"list"`
|
|
|
|
InputSpecification *InputSpecification `locationName:"inputSpecification" type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// The log level being written to CloudWatch Logs.
|
|
LogLevel *string `locationName:"logLevel" type:"string" enum:"LogLevel"`
|
|
|
|
// The name of the channel. (user-mutable)
|
|
Name *string `locationName:"name" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// The number of currently healthy pipelines.
|
|
PipelinesRunningCount *int64 `locationName:"pipelinesRunningCount" type:"integer"`
|
|
|
|
// The Amazon Resource Name (ARN) of the role assumed when running the Channel.
|
|
RoleArn *string `locationName:"roleArn" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
State *string `locationName:"state" type:"string" enum:"ChannelState"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s ChannelSummary) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s ChannelSummary) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetArn sets the Arn field's value.
|
|
func (s *ChannelSummary) SetArn(v string) *ChannelSummary {
|
|
s.Arn = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetDestinations sets the Destinations field's value.
|
|
func (s *ChannelSummary) SetDestinations(v []*OutputDestination) *ChannelSummary {
|
|
s.Destinations = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetEgressEndpoints sets the EgressEndpoints field's value.
|
|
func (s *ChannelSummary) SetEgressEndpoints(v []*ChannelEgressEndpoint) *ChannelSummary {
|
|
s.EgressEndpoints = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetId sets the Id field's value.
|
|
func (s *ChannelSummary) SetId(v string) *ChannelSummary {
|
|
s.Id = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetInputAttachments sets the InputAttachments field's value.
|
|
func (s *ChannelSummary) SetInputAttachments(v []*InputAttachment) *ChannelSummary {
|
|
s.InputAttachments = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetInputSpecification sets the InputSpecification field's value.
|
|
func (s *ChannelSummary) SetInputSpecification(v *InputSpecification) *ChannelSummary {
|
|
s.InputSpecification = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetLogLevel sets the LogLevel field's value.
|
|
func (s *ChannelSummary) SetLogLevel(v string) *ChannelSummary {
|
|
s.LogLevel = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetName sets the Name field's value.
|
|
func (s *ChannelSummary) SetName(v string) *ChannelSummary {
|
|
s.Name = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetPipelinesRunningCount sets the PipelinesRunningCount field's value.
|
|
func (s *ChannelSummary) SetPipelinesRunningCount(v int64) *ChannelSummary {
|
|
s.PipelinesRunningCount = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetRoleArn sets the RoleArn field's value.
|
|
func (s *ChannelSummary) SetRoleArn(v string) *ChannelSummary {
|
|
s.RoleArn = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetState sets the State field's value.
|
|
func (s *ChannelSummary) SetState(v string) *ChannelSummary {
|
|
s.State = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type CreateChannelInput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
Destinations []*OutputDestination `locationName:"destinations" type:"list"`
|
|
|
|
EncoderSettings *EncoderSettings `locationName:"encoderSettings" type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
InputAttachments []*InputAttachment `locationName:"inputAttachments" type:"list"`
|
|
|
|
InputSpecification *InputSpecification `locationName:"inputSpecification" type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// The log level the user wants for their channel.
|
|
LogLevel *string `locationName:"logLevel" type:"string" enum:"LogLevel"`
|
|
|
|
Name *string `locationName:"name" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
RequestId *string `locationName:"requestId" type:"string" idempotencyToken:"true"`
|
|
|
|
Reserved *string `locationName:"reserved" deprecated:"true" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
RoleArn *string `locationName:"roleArn" type:"string"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s CreateChannelInput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s CreateChannelInput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *CreateChannelInput) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "CreateChannelInput"}
|
|
if s.EncoderSettings != nil {
|
|
if err := s.EncoderSettings.Validate(); err != nil {
|
|
invalidParams.AddNested("EncoderSettings", err.(request.ErrInvalidParams))
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
if s.InputAttachments != nil {
|
|
for i, v := range s.InputAttachments {
|
|
if v == nil {
|
|
continue
|
|
}
|
|
if err := v.Validate(); err != nil {
|
|
invalidParams.AddNested(fmt.Sprintf("%s[%v]", "InputAttachments", i), err.(request.ErrInvalidParams))
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetDestinations sets the Destinations field's value.
|
|
func (s *CreateChannelInput) SetDestinations(v []*OutputDestination) *CreateChannelInput {
|
|
s.Destinations = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetEncoderSettings sets the EncoderSettings field's value.
|
|
func (s *CreateChannelInput) SetEncoderSettings(v *EncoderSettings) *CreateChannelInput {
|
|
s.EncoderSettings = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetInputAttachments sets the InputAttachments field's value.
|
|
func (s *CreateChannelInput) SetInputAttachments(v []*InputAttachment) *CreateChannelInput {
|
|
s.InputAttachments = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetInputSpecification sets the InputSpecification field's value.
|
|
func (s *CreateChannelInput) SetInputSpecification(v *InputSpecification) *CreateChannelInput {
|
|
s.InputSpecification = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetLogLevel sets the LogLevel field's value.
|
|
func (s *CreateChannelInput) SetLogLevel(v string) *CreateChannelInput {
|
|
s.LogLevel = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetName sets the Name field's value.
|
|
func (s *CreateChannelInput) SetName(v string) *CreateChannelInput {
|
|
s.Name = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetRequestId sets the RequestId field's value.
|
|
func (s *CreateChannelInput) SetRequestId(v string) *CreateChannelInput {
|
|
s.RequestId = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetReserved sets the Reserved field's value.
|
|
func (s *CreateChannelInput) SetReserved(v string) *CreateChannelInput {
|
|
s.Reserved = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetRoleArn sets the RoleArn field's value.
|
|
func (s *CreateChannelInput) SetRoleArn(v string) *CreateChannelInput {
|
|
s.RoleArn = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type CreateChannelOutput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
Channel *Channel `locationName:"channel" type:"structure"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s CreateChannelOutput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s CreateChannelOutput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetChannel sets the Channel field's value.
|
|
func (s *CreateChannelOutput) SetChannel(v *Channel) *CreateChannelOutput {
|
|
s.Channel = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type CreateInputInput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
Destinations []*InputDestinationRequest `locationName:"destinations" type:"list"`
|
|
|
|
InputSecurityGroups []*string `locationName:"inputSecurityGroups" type:"list"`
|
|
|
|
MediaConnectFlows []*MediaConnectFlowRequest `locationName:"mediaConnectFlows" type:"list"`
|
|
|
|
Name *string `locationName:"name" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
RequestId *string `locationName:"requestId" type:"string" idempotencyToken:"true"`
|
|
|
|
RoleArn *string `locationName:"roleArn" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
Sources []*InputSourceRequest `locationName:"sources" type:"list"`
|
|
|
|
Type *string `locationName:"type" type:"string" enum:"InputType"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s CreateInputInput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s CreateInputInput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetDestinations sets the Destinations field's value.
|
|
func (s *CreateInputInput) SetDestinations(v []*InputDestinationRequest) *CreateInputInput {
|
|
s.Destinations = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetInputSecurityGroups sets the InputSecurityGroups field's value.
|
|
func (s *CreateInputInput) SetInputSecurityGroups(v []*string) *CreateInputInput {
|
|
s.InputSecurityGroups = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetMediaConnectFlows sets the MediaConnectFlows field's value.
|
|
func (s *CreateInputInput) SetMediaConnectFlows(v []*MediaConnectFlowRequest) *CreateInputInput {
|
|
s.MediaConnectFlows = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetName sets the Name field's value.
|
|
func (s *CreateInputInput) SetName(v string) *CreateInputInput {
|
|
s.Name = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetRequestId sets the RequestId field's value.
|
|
func (s *CreateInputInput) SetRequestId(v string) *CreateInputInput {
|
|
s.RequestId = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetRoleArn sets the RoleArn field's value.
|
|
func (s *CreateInputInput) SetRoleArn(v string) *CreateInputInput {
|
|
s.RoleArn = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetSources sets the Sources field's value.
|
|
func (s *CreateInputInput) SetSources(v []*InputSourceRequest) *CreateInputInput {
|
|
s.Sources = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetType sets the Type field's value.
|
|
func (s *CreateInputInput) SetType(v string) *CreateInputInput {
|
|
s.Type = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type CreateInputOutput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
Input *Input `locationName:"input" type:"structure"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s CreateInputOutput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s CreateInputOutput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetInput sets the Input field's value.
|
|
func (s *CreateInputOutput) SetInput(v *Input) *CreateInputOutput {
|
|
s.Input = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type CreateInputSecurityGroupInput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
WhitelistRules []*InputWhitelistRuleCidr `locationName:"whitelistRules" type:"list"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s CreateInputSecurityGroupInput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s CreateInputSecurityGroupInput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetWhitelistRules sets the WhitelistRules field's value.
|
|
func (s *CreateInputSecurityGroupInput) SetWhitelistRules(v []*InputWhitelistRuleCidr) *CreateInputSecurityGroupInput {
|
|
s.WhitelistRules = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type CreateInputSecurityGroupOutput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// An Input Security Group
|
|
SecurityGroup *InputSecurityGroup `locationName:"securityGroup" type:"structure"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s CreateInputSecurityGroupOutput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s CreateInputSecurityGroupOutput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetSecurityGroup sets the SecurityGroup field's value.
|
|
func (s *CreateInputSecurityGroupOutput) SetSecurityGroup(v *InputSecurityGroup) *CreateInputSecurityGroupOutput {
|
|
s.SecurityGroup = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type DeleteChannelInput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// ChannelId is a required field
|
|
ChannelId *string `location:"uri" locationName:"channelId" type:"string" required:"true"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s DeleteChannelInput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s DeleteChannelInput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *DeleteChannelInput) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "DeleteChannelInput"}
|
|
if s.ChannelId == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("ChannelId"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.ChannelId != nil && len(*s.ChannelId) < 1 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("ChannelId", 1))
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetChannelId sets the ChannelId field's value.
|
|
func (s *DeleteChannelInput) SetChannelId(v string) *DeleteChannelInput {
|
|
s.ChannelId = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type DeleteChannelOutput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
Arn *string `locationName:"arn" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
Destinations []*OutputDestination `locationName:"destinations" type:"list"`
|
|
|
|
EgressEndpoints []*ChannelEgressEndpoint `locationName:"egressEndpoints" type:"list"`
|
|
|
|
EncoderSettings *EncoderSettings `locationName:"encoderSettings" type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
Id *string `locationName:"id" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
InputAttachments []*InputAttachment `locationName:"inputAttachments" type:"list"`
|
|
|
|
InputSpecification *InputSpecification `locationName:"inputSpecification" type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// The log level the user wants for their channel.
|
|
LogLevel *string `locationName:"logLevel" type:"string" enum:"LogLevel"`
|
|
|
|
Name *string `locationName:"name" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
PipelinesRunningCount *int64 `locationName:"pipelinesRunningCount" type:"integer"`
|
|
|
|
RoleArn *string `locationName:"roleArn" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
State *string `locationName:"state" type:"string" enum:"ChannelState"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s DeleteChannelOutput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s DeleteChannelOutput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetArn sets the Arn field's value.
|
|
func (s *DeleteChannelOutput) SetArn(v string) *DeleteChannelOutput {
|
|
s.Arn = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetDestinations sets the Destinations field's value.
|
|
func (s *DeleteChannelOutput) SetDestinations(v []*OutputDestination) *DeleteChannelOutput {
|
|
s.Destinations = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetEgressEndpoints sets the EgressEndpoints field's value.
|
|
func (s *DeleteChannelOutput) SetEgressEndpoints(v []*ChannelEgressEndpoint) *DeleteChannelOutput {
|
|
s.EgressEndpoints = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetEncoderSettings sets the EncoderSettings field's value.
|
|
func (s *DeleteChannelOutput) SetEncoderSettings(v *EncoderSettings) *DeleteChannelOutput {
|
|
s.EncoderSettings = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetId sets the Id field's value.
|
|
func (s *DeleteChannelOutput) SetId(v string) *DeleteChannelOutput {
|
|
s.Id = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetInputAttachments sets the InputAttachments field's value.
|
|
func (s *DeleteChannelOutput) SetInputAttachments(v []*InputAttachment) *DeleteChannelOutput {
|
|
s.InputAttachments = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetInputSpecification sets the InputSpecification field's value.
|
|
func (s *DeleteChannelOutput) SetInputSpecification(v *InputSpecification) *DeleteChannelOutput {
|
|
s.InputSpecification = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetLogLevel sets the LogLevel field's value.
|
|
func (s *DeleteChannelOutput) SetLogLevel(v string) *DeleteChannelOutput {
|
|
s.LogLevel = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetName sets the Name field's value.
|
|
func (s *DeleteChannelOutput) SetName(v string) *DeleteChannelOutput {
|
|
s.Name = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetPipelinesRunningCount sets the PipelinesRunningCount field's value.
|
|
func (s *DeleteChannelOutput) SetPipelinesRunningCount(v int64) *DeleteChannelOutput {
|
|
s.PipelinesRunningCount = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetRoleArn sets the RoleArn field's value.
|
|
func (s *DeleteChannelOutput) SetRoleArn(v string) *DeleteChannelOutput {
|
|
s.RoleArn = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetState sets the State field's value.
|
|
func (s *DeleteChannelOutput) SetState(v string) *DeleteChannelOutput {
|
|
s.State = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type DeleteInputInput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// InputId is a required field
|
|
InputId *string `location:"uri" locationName:"inputId" type:"string" required:"true"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s DeleteInputInput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s DeleteInputInput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *DeleteInputInput) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "DeleteInputInput"}
|
|
if s.InputId == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("InputId"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.InputId != nil && len(*s.InputId) < 1 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("InputId", 1))
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetInputId sets the InputId field's value.
|
|
func (s *DeleteInputInput) SetInputId(v string) *DeleteInputInput {
|
|
s.InputId = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type DeleteInputOutput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s DeleteInputOutput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s DeleteInputOutput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type DeleteInputSecurityGroupInput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// InputSecurityGroupId is a required field
|
|
InputSecurityGroupId *string `location:"uri" locationName:"inputSecurityGroupId" type:"string" required:"true"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s DeleteInputSecurityGroupInput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s DeleteInputSecurityGroupInput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *DeleteInputSecurityGroupInput) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "DeleteInputSecurityGroupInput"}
|
|
if s.InputSecurityGroupId == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("InputSecurityGroupId"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.InputSecurityGroupId != nil && len(*s.InputSecurityGroupId) < 1 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("InputSecurityGroupId", 1))
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetInputSecurityGroupId sets the InputSecurityGroupId field's value.
|
|
func (s *DeleteInputSecurityGroupInput) SetInputSecurityGroupId(v string) *DeleteInputSecurityGroupInput {
|
|
s.InputSecurityGroupId = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type DeleteInputSecurityGroupOutput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s DeleteInputSecurityGroupOutput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s DeleteInputSecurityGroupOutput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type DeleteReservationInput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// ReservationId is a required field
|
|
ReservationId *string `location:"uri" locationName:"reservationId" type:"string" required:"true"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s DeleteReservationInput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s DeleteReservationInput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *DeleteReservationInput) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "DeleteReservationInput"}
|
|
if s.ReservationId == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("ReservationId"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.ReservationId != nil && len(*s.ReservationId) < 1 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("ReservationId", 1))
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetReservationId sets the ReservationId field's value.
|
|
func (s *DeleteReservationInput) SetReservationId(v string) *DeleteReservationInput {
|
|
s.ReservationId = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type DeleteReservationOutput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
Arn *string `locationName:"arn" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
Count *int64 `locationName:"count" type:"integer"`
|
|
|
|
CurrencyCode *string `locationName:"currencyCode" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
Duration *int64 `locationName:"duration" type:"integer"`
|
|
|
|
// Units for duration, e.g. 'MONTHS'
|
|
DurationUnits *string `locationName:"durationUnits" type:"string" enum:"OfferingDurationUnits"`
|
|
|
|
End *string `locationName:"end" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
FixedPrice *float64 `locationName:"fixedPrice" type:"double"`
|
|
|
|
Name *string `locationName:"name" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
OfferingDescription *string `locationName:"offeringDescription" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
OfferingId *string `locationName:"offeringId" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// Offering type, e.g. 'NO_UPFRONT'
|
|
OfferingType *string `locationName:"offeringType" type:"string" enum:"OfferingType"`
|
|
|
|
Region *string `locationName:"region" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
ReservationId *string `locationName:"reservationId" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// Resource configuration (codec, resolution, bitrate, ...)
|
|
ResourceSpecification *ReservationResourceSpecification `locationName:"resourceSpecification" type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
Start *string `locationName:"start" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// Current reservation state
|
|
State *string `locationName:"state" type:"string" enum:"ReservationState"`
|
|
|
|
UsagePrice *float64 `locationName:"usagePrice" type:"double"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s DeleteReservationOutput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s DeleteReservationOutput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetArn sets the Arn field's value.
|
|
func (s *DeleteReservationOutput) SetArn(v string) *DeleteReservationOutput {
|
|
s.Arn = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetCount sets the Count field's value.
|
|
func (s *DeleteReservationOutput) SetCount(v int64) *DeleteReservationOutput {
|
|
s.Count = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetCurrencyCode sets the CurrencyCode field's value.
|
|
func (s *DeleteReservationOutput) SetCurrencyCode(v string) *DeleteReservationOutput {
|
|
s.CurrencyCode = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetDuration sets the Duration field's value.
|
|
func (s *DeleteReservationOutput) SetDuration(v int64) *DeleteReservationOutput {
|
|
s.Duration = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetDurationUnits sets the DurationUnits field's value.
|
|
func (s *DeleteReservationOutput) SetDurationUnits(v string) *DeleteReservationOutput {
|
|
s.DurationUnits = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetEnd sets the End field's value.
|
|
func (s *DeleteReservationOutput) SetEnd(v string) *DeleteReservationOutput {
|
|
s.End = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetFixedPrice sets the FixedPrice field's value.
|
|
func (s *DeleteReservationOutput) SetFixedPrice(v float64) *DeleteReservationOutput {
|
|
s.FixedPrice = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetName sets the Name field's value.
|
|
func (s *DeleteReservationOutput) SetName(v string) *DeleteReservationOutput {
|
|
s.Name = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetOfferingDescription sets the OfferingDescription field's value.
|
|
func (s *DeleteReservationOutput) SetOfferingDescription(v string) *DeleteReservationOutput {
|
|
s.OfferingDescription = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetOfferingId sets the OfferingId field's value.
|
|
func (s *DeleteReservationOutput) SetOfferingId(v string) *DeleteReservationOutput {
|
|
s.OfferingId = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetOfferingType sets the OfferingType field's value.
|
|
func (s *DeleteReservationOutput) SetOfferingType(v string) *DeleteReservationOutput {
|
|
s.OfferingType = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetRegion sets the Region field's value.
|
|
func (s *DeleteReservationOutput) SetRegion(v string) *DeleteReservationOutput {
|
|
s.Region = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetReservationId sets the ReservationId field's value.
|
|
func (s *DeleteReservationOutput) SetReservationId(v string) *DeleteReservationOutput {
|
|
s.ReservationId = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetResourceSpecification sets the ResourceSpecification field's value.
|
|
func (s *DeleteReservationOutput) SetResourceSpecification(v *ReservationResourceSpecification) *DeleteReservationOutput {
|
|
s.ResourceSpecification = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetStart sets the Start field's value.
|
|
func (s *DeleteReservationOutput) SetStart(v string) *DeleteReservationOutput {
|
|
s.Start = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetState sets the State field's value.
|
|
func (s *DeleteReservationOutput) SetState(v string) *DeleteReservationOutput {
|
|
s.State = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetUsagePrice sets the UsagePrice field's value.
|
|
func (s *DeleteReservationOutput) SetUsagePrice(v float64) *DeleteReservationOutput {
|
|
s.UsagePrice = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type DescribeChannelInput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// ChannelId is a required field
|
|
ChannelId *string `location:"uri" locationName:"channelId" type:"string" required:"true"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s DescribeChannelInput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s DescribeChannelInput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *DescribeChannelInput) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "DescribeChannelInput"}
|
|
if s.ChannelId == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("ChannelId"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.ChannelId != nil && len(*s.ChannelId) < 1 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("ChannelId", 1))
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetChannelId sets the ChannelId field's value.
|
|
func (s *DescribeChannelInput) SetChannelId(v string) *DescribeChannelInput {
|
|
s.ChannelId = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type DescribeChannelOutput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
Arn *string `locationName:"arn" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
Destinations []*OutputDestination `locationName:"destinations" type:"list"`
|
|
|
|
EgressEndpoints []*ChannelEgressEndpoint `locationName:"egressEndpoints" type:"list"`
|
|
|
|
EncoderSettings *EncoderSettings `locationName:"encoderSettings" type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
Id *string `locationName:"id" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
InputAttachments []*InputAttachment `locationName:"inputAttachments" type:"list"`
|
|
|
|
InputSpecification *InputSpecification `locationName:"inputSpecification" type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// The log level the user wants for their channel.
|
|
LogLevel *string `locationName:"logLevel" type:"string" enum:"LogLevel"`
|
|
|
|
Name *string `locationName:"name" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
PipelinesRunningCount *int64 `locationName:"pipelinesRunningCount" type:"integer"`
|
|
|
|
RoleArn *string `locationName:"roleArn" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
State *string `locationName:"state" type:"string" enum:"ChannelState"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s DescribeChannelOutput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s DescribeChannelOutput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetArn sets the Arn field's value.
|
|
func (s *DescribeChannelOutput) SetArn(v string) *DescribeChannelOutput {
|
|
s.Arn = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetDestinations sets the Destinations field's value.
|
|
func (s *DescribeChannelOutput) SetDestinations(v []*OutputDestination) *DescribeChannelOutput {
|
|
s.Destinations = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetEgressEndpoints sets the EgressEndpoints field's value.
|
|
func (s *DescribeChannelOutput) SetEgressEndpoints(v []*ChannelEgressEndpoint) *DescribeChannelOutput {
|
|
s.EgressEndpoints = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetEncoderSettings sets the EncoderSettings field's value.
|
|
func (s *DescribeChannelOutput) SetEncoderSettings(v *EncoderSettings) *DescribeChannelOutput {
|
|
s.EncoderSettings = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetId sets the Id field's value.
|
|
func (s *DescribeChannelOutput) SetId(v string) *DescribeChannelOutput {
|
|
s.Id = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetInputAttachments sets the InputAttachments field's value.
|
|
func (s *DescribeChannelOutput) SetInputAttachments(v []*InputAttachment) *DescribeChannelOutput {
|
|
s.InputAttachments = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetInputSpecification sets the InputSpecification field's value.
|
|
func (s *DescribeChannelOutput) SetInputSpecification(v *InputSpecification) *DescribeChannelOutput {
|
|
s.InputSpecification = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetLogLevel sets the LogLevel field's value.
|
|
func (s *DescribeChannelOutput) SetLogLevel(v string) *DescribeChannelOutput {
|
|
s.LogLevel = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetName sets the Name field's value.
|
|
func (s *DescribeChannelOutput) SetName(v string) *DescribeChannelOutput {
|
|
s.Name = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetPipelinesRunningCount sets the PipelinesRunningCount field's value.
|
|
func (s *DescribeChannelOutput) SetPipelinesRunningCount(v int64) *DescribeChannelOutput {
|
|
s.PipelinesRunningCount = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetRoleArn sets the RoleArn field's value.
|
|
func (s *DescribeChannelOutput) SetRoleArn(v string) *DescribeChannelOutput {
|
|
s.RoleArn = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetState sets the State field's value.
|
|
func (s *DescribeChannelOutput) SetState(v string) *DescribeChannelOutput {
|
|
s.State = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type DescribeInputInput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// InputId is a required field
|
|
InputId *string `location:"uri" locationName:"inputId" type:"string" required:"true"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s DescribeInputInput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s DescribeInputInput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *DescribeInputInput) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "DescribeInputInput"}
|
|
if s.InputId == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("InputId"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.InputId != nil && len(*s.InputId) < 1 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("InputId", 1))
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetInputId sets the InputId field's value.
|
|
func (s *DescribeInputInput) SetInputId(v string) *DescribeInputInput {
|
|
s.InputId = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type DescribeInputOutput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
Arn *string `locationName:"arn" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
AttachedChannels []*string `locationName:"attachedChannels" type:"list"`
|
|
|
|
Destinations []*InputDestination `locationName:"destinations" type:"list"`
|
|
|
|
Id *string `locationName:"id" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
MediaConnectFlows []*MediaConnectFlow `locationName:"mediaConnectFlows" type:"list"`
|
|
|
|
Name *string `locationName:"name" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
RoleArn *string `locationName:"roleArn" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
SecurityGroups []*string `locationName:"securityGroups" type:"list"`
|
|
|
|
Sources []*InputSource `locationName:"sources" type:"list"`
|
|
|
|
State *string `locationName:"state" type:"string" enum:"InputState"`
|
|
|
|
Type *string `locationName:"type" type:"string" enum:"InputType"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s DescribeInputOutput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s DescribeInputOutput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetArn sets the Arn field's value.
|
|
func (s *DescribeInputOutput) SetArn(v string) *DescribeInputOutput {
|
|
s.Arn = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetAttachedChannels sets the AttachedChannels field's value.
|
|
func (s *DescribeInputOutput) SetAttachedChannels(v []*string) *DescribeInputOutput {
|
|
s.AttachedChannels = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetDestinations sets the Destinations field's value.
|
|
func (s *DescribeInputOutput) SetDestinations(v []*InputDestination) *DescribeInputOutput {
|
|
s.Destinations = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetId sets the Id field's value.
|
|
func (s *DescribeInputOutput) SetId(v string) *DescribeInputOutput {
|
|
s.Id = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetMediaConnectFlows sets the MediaConnectFlows field's value.
|
|
func (s *DescribeInputOutput) SetMediaConnectFlows(v []*MediaConnectFlow) *DescribeInputOutput {
|
|
s.MediaConnectFlows = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetName sets the Name field's value.
|
|
func (s *DescribeInputOutput) SetName(v string) *DescribeInputOutput {
|
|
s.Name = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetRoleArn sets the RoleArn field's value.
|
|
func (s *DescribeInputOutput) SetRoleArn(v string) *DescribeInputOutput {
|
|
s.RoleArn = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetSecurityGroups sets the SecurityGroups field's value.
|
|
func (s *DescribeInputOutput) SetSecurityGroups(v []*string) *DescribeInputOutput {
|
|
s.SecurityGroups = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetSources sets the Sources field's value.
|
|
func (s *DescribeInputOutput) SetSources(v []*InputSource) *DescribeInputOutput {
|
|
s.Sources = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetState sets the State field's value.
|
|
func (s *DescribeInputOutput) SetState(v string) *DescribeInputOutput {
|
|
s.State = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetType sets the Type field's value.
|
|
func (s *DescribeInputOutput) SetType(v string) *DescribeInputOutput {
|
|
s.Type = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type DescribeInputSecurityGroupInput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// InputSecurityGroupId is a required field
|
|
InputSecurityGroupId *string `location:"uri" locationName:"inputSecurityGroupId" type:"string" required:"true"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s DescribeInputSecurityGroupInput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s DescribeInputSecurityGroupInput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *DescribeInputSecurityGroupInput) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "DescribeInputSecurityGroupInput"}
|
|
if s.InputSecurityGroupId == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("InputSecurityGroupId"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.InputSecurityGroupId != nil && len(*s.InputSecurityGroupId) < 1 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("InputSecurityGroupId", 1))
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetInputSecurityGroupId sets the InputSecurityGroupId field's value.
|
|
func (s *DescribeInputSecurityGroupInput) SetInputSecurityGroupId(v string) *DescribeInputSecurityGroupInput {
|
|
s.InputSecurityGroupId = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type DescribeInputSecurityGroupOutput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
Arn *string `locationName:"arn" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
Id *string `locationName:"id" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
Inputs []*string `locationName:"inputs" type:"list"`
|
|
|
|
State *string `locationName:"state" type:"string" enum:"InputSecurityGroupState"`
|
|
|
|
WhitelistRules []*InputWhitelistRule `locationName:"whitelistRules" type:"list"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s DescribeInputSecurityGroupOutput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s DescribeInputSecurityGroupOutput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetArn sets the Arn field's value.
|
|
func (s *DescribeInputSecurityGroupOutput) SetArn(v string) *DescribeInputSecurityGroupOutput {
|
|
s.Arn = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetId sets the Id field's value.
|
|
func (s *DescribeInputSecurityGroupOutput) SetId(v string) *DescribeInputSecurityGroupOutput {
|
|
s.Id = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetInputs sets the Inputs field's value.
|
|
func (s *DescribeInputSecurityGroupOutput) SetInputs(v []*string) *DescribeInputSecurityGroupOutput {
|
|
s.Inputs = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetState sets the State field's value.
|
|
func (s *DescribeInputSecurityGroupOutput) SetState(v string) *DescribeInputSecurityGroupOutput {
|
|
s.State = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetWhitelistRules sets the WhitelistRules field's value.
|
|
func (s *DescribeInputSecurityGroupOutput) SetWhitelistRules(v []*InputWhitelistRule) *DescribeInputSecurityGroupOutput {
|
|
s.WhitelistRules = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type DescribeOfferingInput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// OfferingId is a required field
|
|
OfferingId *string `location:"uri" locationName:"offeringId" type:"string" required:"true"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s DescribeOfferingInput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s DescribeOfferingInput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *DescribeOfferingInput) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "DescribeOfferingInput"}
|
|
if s.OfferingId == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("OfferingId"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.OfferingId != nil && len(*s.OfferingId) < 1 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("OfferingId", 1))
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetOfferingId sets the OfferingId field's value.
|
|
func (s *DescribeOfferingInput) SetOfferingId(v string) *DescribeOfferingInput {
|
|
s.OfferingId = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type DescribeOfferingOutput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
Arn *string `locationName:"arn" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
CurrencyCode *string `locationName:"currencyCode" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
Duration *int64 `locationName:"duration" type:"integer"`
|
|
|
|
// Units for duration, e.g. 'MONTHS'
|
|
DurationUnits *string `locationName:"durationUnits" type:"string" enum:"OfferingDurationUnits"`
|
|
|
|
FixedPrice *float64 `locationName:"fixedPrice" type:"double"`
|
|
|
|
OfferingDescription *string `locationName:"offeringDescription" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
OfferingId *string `locationName:"offeringId" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// Offering type, e.g. 'NO_UPFRONT'
|
|
OfferingType *string `locationName:"offeringType" type:"string" enum:"OfferingType"`
|
|
|
|
Region *string `locationName:"region" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// Resource configuration (codec, resolution, bitrate, ...)
|
|
ResourceSpecification *ReservationResourceSpecification `locationName:"resourceSpecification" type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
UsagePrice *float64 `locationName:"usagePrice" type:"double"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s DescribeOfferingOutput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s DescribeOfferingOutput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetArn sets the Arn field's value.
|
|
func (s *DescribeOfferingOutput) SetArn(v string) *DescribeOfferingOutput {
|
|
s.Arn = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetCurrencyCode sets the CurrencyCode field's value.
|
|
func (s *DescribeOfferingOutput) SetCurrencyCode(v string) *DescribeOfferingOutput {
|
|
s.CurrencyCode = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetDuration sets the Duration field's value.
|
|
func (s *DescribeOfferingOutput) SetDuration(v int64) *DescribeOfferingOutput {
|
|
s.Duration = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetDurationUnits sets the DurationUnits field's value.
|
|
func (s *DescribeOfferingOutput) SetDurationUnits(v string) *DescribeOfferingOutput {
|
|
s.DurationUnits = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetFixedPrice sets the FixedPrice field's value.
|
|
func (s *DescribeOfferingOutput) SetFixedPrice(v float64) *DescribeOfferingOutput {
|
|
s.FixedPrice = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetOfferingDescription sets the OfferingDescription field's value.
|
|
func (s *DescribeOfferingOutput) SetOfferingDescription(v string) *DescribeOfferingOutput {
|
|
s.OfferingDescription = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetOfferingId sets the OfferingId field's value.
|
|
func (s *DescribeOfferingOutput) SetOfferingId(v string) *DescribeOfferingOutput {
|
|
s.OfferingId = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetOfferingType sets the OfferingType field's value.
|
|
func (s *DescribeOfferingOutput) SetOfferingType(v string) *DescribeOfferingOutput {
|
|
s.OfferingType = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetRegion sets the Region field's value.
|
|
func (s *DescribeOfferingOutput) SetRegion(v string) *DescribeOfferingOutput {
|
|
s.Region = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetResourceSpecification sets the ResourceSpecification field's value.
|
|
func (s *DescribeOfferingOutput) SetResourceSpecification(v *ReservationResourceSpecification) *DescribeOfferingOutput {
|
|
s.ResourceSpecification = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetUsagePrice sets the UsagePrice field's value.
|
|
func (s *DescribeOfferingOutput) SetUsagePrice(v float64) *DescribeOfferingOutput {
|
|
s.UsagePrice = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type DescribeReservationInput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// ReservationId is a required field
|
|
ReservationId *string `location:"uri" locationName:"reservationId" type:"string" required:"true"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s DescribeReservationInput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s DescribeReservationInput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *DescribeReservationInput) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "DescribeReservationInput"}
|
|
if s.ReservationId == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("ReservationId"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.ReservationId != nil && len(*s.ReservationId) < 1 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("ReservationId", 1))
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetReservationId sets the ReservationId field's value.
|
|
func (s *DescribeReservationInput) SetReservationId(v string) *DescribeReservationInput {
|
|
s.ReservationId = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type DescribeReservationOutput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
Arn *string `locationName:"arn" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
Count *int64 `locationName:"count" type:"integer"`
|
|
|
|
CurrencyCode *string `locationName:"currencyCode" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
Duration *int64 `locationName:"duration" type:"integer"`
|
|
|
|
// Units for duration, e.g. 'MONTHS'
|
|
DurationUnits *string `locationName:"durationUnits" type:"string" enum:"OfferingDurationUnits"`
|
|
|
|
End *string `locationName:"end" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
FixedPrice *float64 `locationName:"fixedPrice" type:"double"`
|
|
|
|
Name *string `locationName:"name" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
OfferingDescription *string `locationName:"offeringDescription" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
OfferingId *string `locationName:"offeringId" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// Offering type, e.g. 'NO_UPFRONT'
|
|
OfferingType *string `locationName:"offeringType" type:"string" enum:"OfferingType"`
|
|
|
|
Region *string `locationName:"region" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
ReservationId *string `locationName:"reservationId" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// Resource configuration (codec, resolution, bitrate, ...)
|
|
ResourceSpecification *ReservationResourceSpecification `locationName:"resourceSpecification" type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
Start *string `locationName:"start" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// Current reservation state
|
|
State *string `locationName:"state" type:"string" enum:"ReservationState"`
|
|
|
|
UsagePrice *float64 `locationName:"usagePrice" type:"double"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s DescribeReservationOutput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s DescribeReservationOutput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetArn sets the Arn field's value.
|
|
func (s *DescribeReservationOutput) SetArn(v string) *DescribeReservationOutput {
|
|
s.Arn = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetCount sets the Count field's value.
|
|
func (s *DescribeReservationOutput) SetCount(v int64) *DescribeReservationOutput {
|
|
s.Count = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetCurrencyCode sets the CurrencyCode field's value.
|
|
func (s *DescribeReservationOutput) SetCurrencyCode(v string) *DescribeReservationOutput {
|
|
s.CurrencyCode = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetDuration sets the Duration field's value.
|
|
func (s *DescribeReservationOutput) SetDuration(v int64) *DescribeReservationOutput {
|
|
s.Duration = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetDurationUnits sets the DurationUnits field's value.
|
|
func (s *DescribeReservationOutput) SetDurationUnits(v string) *DescribeReservationOutput {
|
|
s.DurationUnits = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetEnd sets the End field's value.
|
|
func (s *DescribeReservationOutput) SetEnd(v string) *DescribeReservationOutput {
|
|
s.End = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetFixedPrice sets the FixedPrice field's value.
|
|
func (s *DescribeReservationOutput) SetFixedPrice(v float64) *DescribeReservationOutput {
|
|
s.FixedPrice = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetName sets the Name field's value.
|
|
func (s *DescribeReservationOutput) SetName(v string) *DescribeReservationOutput {
|
|
s.Name = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetOfferingDescription sets the OfferingDescription field's value.
|
|
func (s *DescribeReservationOutput) SetOfferingDescription(v string) *DescribeReservationOutput {
|
|
s.OfferingDescription = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetOfferingId sets the OfferingId field's value.
|
|
func (s *DescribeReservationOutput) SetOfferingId(v string) *DescribeReservationOutput {
|
|
s.OfferingId = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetOfferingType sets the OfferingType field's value.
|
|
func (s *DescribeReservationOutput) SetOfferingType(v string) *DescribeReservationOutput {
|
|
s.OfferingType = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetRegion sets the Region field's value.
|
|
func (s *DescribeReservationOutput) SetRegion(v string) *DescribeReservationOutput {
|
|
s.Region = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetReservationId sets the ReservationId field's value.
|
|
func (s *DescribeReservationOutput) SetReservationId(v string) *DescribeReservationOutput {
|
|
s.ReservationId = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetResourceSpecification sets the ResourceSpecification field's value.
|
|
func (s *DescribeReservationOutput) SetResourceSpecification(v *ReservationResourceSpecification) *DescribeReservationOutput {
|
|
s.ResourceSpecification = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetStart sets the Start field's value.
|
|
func (s *DescribeReservationOutput) SetStart(v string) *DescribeReservationOutput {
|
|
s.Start = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetState sets the State field's value.
|
|
func (s *DescribeReservationOutput) SetState(v string) *DescribeReservationOutput {
|
|
s.State = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetUsagePrice sets the UsagePrice field's value.
|
|
func (s *DescribeReservationOutput) SetUsagePrice(v float64) *DescribeReservationOutput {
|
|
s.UsagePrice = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type DescribeScheduleInput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// ChannelId is a required field
|
|
ChannelId *string `location:"uri" locationName:"channelId" type:"string" required:"true"`
|
|
|
|
MaxResults *int64 `location:"querystring" locationName:"maxResults" min:"1" type:"integer"`
|
|
|
|
NextToken *string `location:"querystring" locationName:"nextToken" type:"string"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s DescribeScheduleInput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s DescribeScheduleInput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *DescribeScheduleInput) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "DescribeScheduleInput"}
|
|
if s.ChannelId == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("ChannelId"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.ChannelId != nil && len(*s.ChannelId) < 1 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("ChannelId", 1))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.MaxResults != nil && *s.MaxResults < 1 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinValue("MaxResults", 1))
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetChannelId sets the ChannelId field's value.
|
|
func (s *DescribeScheduleInput) SetChannelId(v string) *DescribeScheduleInput {
|
|
s.ChannelId = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetMaxResults sets the MaxResults field's value.
|
|
func (s *DescribeScheduleInput) SetMaxResults(v int64) *DescribeScheduleInput {
|
|
s.MaxResults = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetNextToken sets the NextToken field's value.
|
|
func (s *DescribeScheduleInput) SetNextToken(v string) *DescribeScheduleInput {
|
|
s.NextToken = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type DescribeScheduleOutput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
NextToken *string `locationName:"nextToken" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
ScheduleActions []*ScheduleAction `locationName:"scheduleActions" type:"list"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s DescribeScheduleOutput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s DescribeScheduleOutput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetNextToken sets the NextToken field's value.
|
|
func (s *DescribeScheduleOutput) SetNextToken(v string) *DescribeScheduleOutput {
|
|
s.NextToken = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetScheduleActions sets the ScheduleActions field's value.
|
|
func (s *DescribeScheduleOutput) SetScheduleActions(v []*ScheduleAction) *DescribeScheduleOutput {
|
|
s.ScheduleActions = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// DVB Network Information Table (NIT)
|
|
type DvbNitSettings struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// The numeric value placed in the Network Information Table (NIT).
|
|
//
|
|
// NetworkId is a required field
|
|
NetworkId *int64 `locationName:"networkId" type:"integer" required:"true"`
|
|
|
|
// The network name text placed in the networkNameDescriptor inside the Network
|
|
// Information Table. Maximum length is 256 characters.
|
|
//
|
|
// NetworkName is a required field
|
|
NetworkName *string `locationName:"networkName" min:"1" type:"string" required:"true"`
|
|
|
|
// The number of milliseconds between instances of this table in the output
|
|
// transport stream.
|
|
RepInterval *int64 `locationName:"repInterval" min:"25" type:"integer"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s DvbNitSettings) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s DvbNitSettings) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *DvbNitSettings) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "DvbNitSettings"}
|
|
if s.NetworkId == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("NetworkId"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.NetworkName == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("NetworkName"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.NetworkName != nil && len(*s.NetworkName) < 1 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("NetworkName", 1))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.RepInterval != nil && *s.RepInterval < 25 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinValue("RepInterval", 25))
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetNetworkId sets the NetworkId field's value.
|
|
func (s *DvbNitSettings) SetNetworkId(v int64) *DvbNitSettings {
|
|
s.NetworkId = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetNetworkName sets the NetworkName field's value.
|
|
func (s *DvbNitSettings) SetNetworkName(v string) *DvbNitSettings {
|
|
s.NetworkName = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetRepInterval sets the RepInterval field's value.
|
|
func (s *DvbNitSettings) SetRepInterval(v int64) *DvbNitSettings {
|
|
s.RepInterval = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// DVB Service Description Table (SDT)
|
|
type DvbSdtSettings struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// Selects method of inserting SDT information into output stream. The sdtFollow
|
|
// setting copies SDT information from input stream to output stream. The sdtFollowIfPresent
|
|
// setting copies SDT information from input stream to output stream if SDT
|
|
// information is present in the input, otherwise it will fall back on the user-defined
|
|
// values. The sdtManual setting means user will enter the SDT information.
|
|
// The sdtNone setting means output stream will not contain SDT information.
|
|
OutputSdt *string `locationName:"outputSdt" type:"string" enum:"DvbSdtOutputSdt"`
|
|
|
|
// The number of milliseconds between instances of this table in the output
|
|
// transport stream.
|
|
RepInterval *int64 `locationName:"repInterval" min:"25" type:"integer"`
|
|
|
|
// The service name placed in the serviceDescriptor in the Service Description
|
|
// Table. Maximum length is 256 characters.
|
|
ServiceName *string `locationName:"serviceName" min:"1" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// The service provider name placed in the serviceDescriptor in the Service
|
|
// Description Table. Maximum length is 256 characters.
|
|
ServiceProviderName *string `locationName:"serviceProviderName" min:"1" type:"string"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s DvbSdtSettings) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s DvbSdtSettings) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *DvbSdtSettings) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "DvbSdtSettings"}
|
|
if s.RepInterval != nil && *s.RepInterval < 25 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinValue("RepInterval", 25))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.ServiceName != nil && len(*s.ServiceName) < 1 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("ServiceName", 1))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.ServiceProviderName != nil && len(*s.ServiceProviderName) < 1 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("ServiceProviderName", 1))
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetOutputSdt sets the OutputSdt field's value.
|
|
func (s *DvbSdtSettings) SetOutputSdt(v string) *DvbSdtSettings {
|
|
s.OutputSdt = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetRepInterval sets the RepInterval field's value.
|
|
func (s *DvbSdtSettings) SetRepInterval(v int64) *DvbSdtSettings {
|
|
s.RepInterval = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetServiceName sets the ServiceName field's value.
|
|
func (s *DvbSdtSettings) SetServiceName(v string) *DvbSdtSettings {
|
|
s.ServiceName = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetServiceProviderName sets the ServiceProviderName field's value.
|
|
func (s *DvbSdtSettings) SetServiceProviderName(v string) *DvbSdtSettings {
|
|
s.ServiceProviderName = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type DvbSubDestinationSettings struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// If no explicit xPosition or yPosition is provided, setting alignment to centered
|
|
// will place the captions at the bottom center of the output. Similarly, setting
|
|
// a left alignment will align captions to the bottom left of the output. If
|
|
// x and y positions are given in conjunction with the alignment parameter,
|
|
// the font will be justified (either left or centered) relative to those coordinates.
|
|
// Selecting "smart" justification will left-justify live subtitles and center-justify
|
|
// pre-recorded subtitles. This option is not valid for source captions that
|
|
// are STL or 608/embedded. These source settings are already pre-defined by
|
|
// the caption stream. All burn-in and DVB-Sub font settings must match.
|
|
Alignment *string `locationName:"alignment" type:"string" enum:"DvbSubDestinationAlignment"`
|
|
|
|
// Specifies the color of the rectangle behind the captions. All burn-in and
|
|
// DVB-Sub font settings must match.
|
|
BackgroundColor *string `locationName:"backgroundColor" type:"string" enum:"DvbSubDestinationBackgroundColor"`
|
|
|
|
// Specifies the opacity of the background rectangle. 255 is opaque; 0 is transparent.
|
|
// Leaving this parameter blank is equivalent to setting it to 0 (transparent).
|
|
// All burn-in and DVB-Sub font settings must match.
|
|
BackgroundOpacity *int64 `locationName:"backgroundOpacity" type:"integer"`
|
|
|
|
// External font file used for caption burn-in. File extension must be 'ttf'
|
|
// or 'tte'. Although the user can select output fonts for many different types
|
|
// of input captions, embedded, STL and teletext sources use a strict grid system.
|
|
// Using external fonts with these caption sources could cause unexpected display
|
|
// of proportional fonts. All burn-in and DVB-Sub font settings must match.
|
|
Font *InputLocation `locationName:"font" type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// Specifies the color of the burned-in captions. This option is not valid for
|
|
// source captions that are STL, 608/embedded or teletext. These source settings
|
|
// are already pre-defined by the caption stream. All burn-in and DVB-Sub font
|
|
// settings must match.
|
|
FontColor *string `locationName:"fontColor" type:"string" enum:"DvbSubDestinationFontColor"`
|
|
|
|
// Specifies the opacity of the burned-in captions. 255 is opaque; 0 is transparent.
|
|
// All burn-in and DVB-Sub font settings must match.
|
|
FontOpacity *int64 `locationName:"fontOpacity" type:"integer"`
|
|
|
|
// Font resolution in DPI (dots per inch); default is 96 dpi. All burn-in and
|
|
// DVB-Sub font settings must match.
|
|
FontResolution *int64 `locationName:"fontResolution" min:"96" type:"integer"`
|
|
|
|
// When set to auto fontSize will scale depending on the size of the output.
|
|
// Giving a positive integer will specify the exact font size in points. All
|
|
// burn-in and DVB-Sub font settings must match.
|
|
FontSize *string `locationName:"fontSize" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// Specifies font outline color. This option is not valid for source captions
|
|
// that are either 608/embedded or teletext. These source settings are already
|
|
// pre-defined by the caption stream. All burn-in and DVB-Sub font settings
|
|
// must match.
|
|
OutlineColor *string `locationName:"outlineColor" type:"string" enum:"DvbSubDestinationOutlineColor"`
|
|
|
|
// Specifies font outline size in pixels. This option is not valid for source
|
|
// captions that are either 608/embedded or teletext. These source settings
|
|
// are already pre-defined by the caption stream. All burn-in and DVB-Sub font
|
|
// settings must match.
|
|
OutlineSize *int64 `locationName:"outlineSize" type:"integer"`
|
|
|
|
// Specifies the color of the shadow cast by the captions. All burn-in and DVB-Sub
|
|
// font settings must match.
|
|
ShadowColor *string `locationName:"shadowColor" type:"string" enum:"DvbSubDestinationShadowColor"`
|
|
|
|
// Specifies the opacity of the shadow. 255 is opaque; 0 is transparent. Leaving
|
|
// this parameter blank is equivalent to setting it to 0 (transparent). All
|
|
// burn-in and DVB-Sub font settings must match.
|
|
ShadowOpacity *int64 `locationName:"shadowOpacity" type:"integer"`
|
|
|
|
// Specifies the horizontal offset of the shadow relative to the captions in
|
|
// pixels. A value of -2 would result in a shadow offset 2 pixels to the left.
|
|
// All burn-in and DVB-Sub font settings must match.
|
|
ShadowXOffset *int64 `locationName:"shadowXOffset" type:"integer"`
|
|
|
|
// Specifies the vertical offset of the shadow relative to the captions in pixels.
|
|
// A value of -2 would result in a shadow offset 2 pixels above the text. All
|
|
// burn-in and DVB-Sub font settings must match.
|
|
ShadowYOffset *int64 `locationName:"shadowYOffset" type:"integer"`
|
|
|
|
// Controls whether a fixed grid size will be used to generate the output subtitles
|
|
// bitmap. Only applicable for Teletext inputs and DVB-Sub/Burn-in outputs.
|
|
TeletextGridControl *string `locationName:"teletextGridControl" type:"string" enum:"DvbSubDestinationTeletextGridControl"`
|
|
|
|
// Specifies the horizontal position of the caption relative to the left side
|
|
// of the output in pixels. A value of 10 would result in the captions starting
|
|
// 10 pixels from the left of the output. If no explicit xPosition is provided,
|
|
// the horizontal caption position will be determined by the alignment parameter.
|
|
// This option is not valid for source captions that are STL, 608/embedded or
|
|
// teletext. These source settings are already pre-defined by the caption stream.
|
|
// All burn-in and DVB-Sub font settings must match.
|
|
XPosition *int64 `locationName:"xPosition" type:"integer"`
|
|
|
|
// Specifies the vertical position of the caption relative to the top of the
|
|
// output in pixels. A value of 10 would result in the captions starting 10
|
|
// pixels from the top of the output. If no explicit yPosition is provided,
|
|
// the caption will be positioned towards the bottom of the output. This option
|
|
// is not valid for source captions that are STL, 608/embedded or teletext.
|
|
// These source settings are already pre-defined by the caption stream. All
|
|
// burn-in and DVB-Sub font settings must match.
|
|
YPosition *int64 `locationName:"yPosition" type:"integer"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s DvbSubDestinationSettings) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s DvbSubDestinationSettings) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *DvbSubDestinationSettings) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "DvbSubDestinationSettings"}
|
|
if s.FontResolution != nil && *s.FontResolution < 96 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinValue("FontResolution", 96))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.Font != nil {
|
|
if err := s.Font.Validate(); err != nil {
|
|
invalidParams.AddNested("Font", err.(request.ErrInvalidParams))
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetAlignment sets the Alignment field's value.
|
|
func (s *DvbSubDestinationSettings) SetAlignment(v string) *DvbSubDestinationSettings {
|
|
s.Alignment = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetBackgroundColor sets the BackgroundColor field's value.
|
|
func (s *DvbSubDestinationSettings) SetBackgroundColor(v string) *DvbSubDestinationSettings {
|
|
s.BackgroundColor = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetBackgroundOpacity sets the BackgroundOpacity field's value.
|
|
func (s *DvbSubDestinationSettings) SetBackgroundOpacity(v int64) *DvbSubDestinationSettings {
|
|
s.BackgroundOpacity = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetFont sets the Font field's value.
|
|
func (s *DvbSubDestinationSettings) SetFont(v *InputLocation) *DvbSubDestinationSettings {
|
|
s.Font = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetFontColor sets the FontColor field's value.
|
|
func (s *DvbSubDestinationSettings) SetFontColor(v string) *DvbSubDestinationSettings {
|
|
s.FontColor = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetFontOpacity sets the FontOpacity field's value.
|
|
func (s *DvbSubDestinationSettings) SetFontOpacity(v int64) *DvbSubDestinationSettings {
|
|
s.FontOpacity = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetFontResolution sets the FontResolution field's value.
|
|
func (s *DvbSubDestinationSettings) SetFontResolution(v int64) *DvbSubDestinationSettings {
|
|
s.FontResolution = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetFontSize sets the FontSize field's value.
|
|
func (s *DvbSubDestinationSettings) SetFontSize(v string) *DvbSubDestinationSettings {
|
|
s.FontSize = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetOutlineColor sets the OutlineColor field's value.
|
|
func (s *DvbSubDestinationSettings) SetOutlineColor(v string) *DvbSubDestinationSettings {
|
|
s.OutlineColor = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetOutlineSize sets the OutlineSize field's value.
|
|
func (s *DvbSubDestinationSettings) SetOutlineSize(v int64) *DvbSubDestinationSettings {
|
|
s.OutlineSize = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetShadowColor sets the ShadowColor field's value.
|
|
func (s *DvbSubDestinationSettings) SetShadowColor(v string) *DvbSubDestinationSettings {
|
|
s.ShadowColor = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetShadowOpacity sets the ShadowOpacity field's value.
|
|
func (s *DvbSubDestinationSettings) SetShadowOpacity(v int64) *DvbSubDestinationSettings {
|
|
s.ShadowOpacity = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetShadowXOffset sets the ShadowXOffset field's value.
|
|
func (s *DvbSubDestinationSettings) SetShadowXOffset(v int64) *DvbSubDestinationSettings {
|
|
s.ShadowXOffset = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetShadowYOffset sets the ShadowYOffset field's value.
|
|
func (s *DvbSubDestinationSettings) SetShadowYOffset(v int64) *DvbSubDestinationSettings {
|
|
s.ShadowYOffset = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetTeletextGridControl sets the TeletextGridControl field's value.
|
|
func (s *DvbSubDestinationSettings) SetTeletextGridControl(v string) *DvbSubDestinationSettings {
|
|
s.TeletextGridControl = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetXPosition sets the XPosition field's value.
|
|
func (s *DvbSubDestinationSettings) SetXPosition(v int64) *DvbSubDestinationSettings {
|
|
s.XPosition = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetYPosition sets the YPosition field's value.
|
|
func (s *DvbSubDestinationSettings) SetYPosition(v int64) *DvbSubDestinationSettings {
|
|
s.YPosition = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type DvbSubSourceSettings struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// When using DVB-Sub with Burn-In or SMPTE-TT, use this PID for the source
|
|
// content. Unused for DVB-Sub passthrough. All DVB-Sub content is passed through,
|
|
// regardless of selectors.
|
|
Pid *int64 `locationName:"pid" min:"1" type:"integer"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s DvbSubSourceSettings) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s DvbSubSourceSettings) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *DvbSubSourceSettings) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "DvbSubSourceSettings"}
|
|
if s.Pid != nil && *s.Pid < 1 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinValue("Pid", 1))
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetPid sets the Pid field's value.
|
|
func (s *DvbSubSourceSettings) SetPid(v int64) *DvbSubSourceSettings {
|
|
s.Pid = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// DVB Time and Date Table (SDT)
|
|
type DvbTdtSettings struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// The number of milliseconds between instances of this table in the output
|
|
// transport stream.
|
|
RepInterval *int64 `locationName:"repInterval" min:"1000" type:"integer"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s DvbTdtSettings) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s DvbTdtSettings) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *DvbTdtSettings) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "DvbTdtSettings"}
|
|
if s.RepInterval != nil && *s.RepInterval < 1000 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinValue("RepInterval", 1000))
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetRepInterval sets the RepInterval field's value.
|
|
func (s *DvbTdtSettings) SetRepInterval(v int64) *DvbTdtSettings {
|
|
s.RepInterval = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type Eac3Settings struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// When set to attenuate3Db, applies a 3 dB attenuation to the surround channels.
|
|
// Only used for 3/2 coding mode.
|
|
AttenuationControl *string `locationName:"attenuationControl" type:"string" enum:"Eac3AttenuationControl"`
|
|
|
|
// Average bitrate in bits/second. Valid bitrates depend on the coding mode.
|
|
Bitrate *float64 `locationName:"bitrate" type:"double"`
|
|
|
|
// Specifies the bitstream mode (bsmod) for the emitted E-AC-3 stream. See ATSC
|
|
// A/52-2012 (Annex E) for background on these values.
|
|
BitstreamMode *string `locationName:"bitstreamMode" type:"string" enum:"Eac3BitstreamMode"`
|
|
|
|
// Dolby Digital Plus coding mode. Determines number of channels.
|
|
CodingMode *string `locationName:"codingMode" type:"string" enum:"Eac3CodingMode"`
|
|
|
|
// When set to enabled, activates a DC highpass filter for all input channels.
|
|
DcFilter *string `locationName:"dcFilter" type:"string" enum:"Eac3DcFilter"`
|
|
|
|
// Sets the dialnorm for the output. If blank and input audio is Dolby Digital
|
|
// Plus, dialnorm will be passed through.
|
|
Dialnorm *int64 `locationName:"dialnorm" min:"1" type:"integer"`
|
|
|
|
// Sets the Dolby dynamic range compression profile.
|
|
DrcLine *string `locationName:"drcLine" type:"string" enum:"Eac3DrcLine"`
|
|
|
|
// Sets the profile for heavy Dolby dynamic range compression, ensures that
|
|
// the instantaneous signal peaks do not exceed specified levels.
|
|
DrcRf *string `locationName:"drcRf" type:"string" enum:"Eac3DrcRf"`
|
|
|
|
// When encoding 3/2 audio, setting to lfe enables the LFE channel
|
|
LfeControl *string `locationName:"lfeControl" type:"string" enum:"Eac3LfeControl"`
|
|
|
|
// When set to enabled, applies a 120Hz lowpass filter to the LFE channel prior
|
|
// to encoding. Only valid with codingMode32 coding mode.
|
|
LfeFilter *string `locationName:"lfeFilter" type:"string" enum:"Eac3LfeFilter"`
|
|
|
|
// Left only/Right only center mix level. Only used for 3/2 coding mode.
|
|
LoRoCenterMixLevel *float64 `locationName:"loRoCenterMixLevel" type:"double"`
|
|
|
|
// Left only/Right only surround mix level. Only used for 3/2 coding mode.
|
|
LoRoSurroundMixLevel *float64 `locationName:"loRoSurroundMixLevel" type:"double"`
|
|
|
|
// Left total/Right total center mix level. Only used for 3/2 coding mode.
|
|
LtRtCenterMixLevel *float64 `locationName:"ltRtCenterMixLevel" type:"double"`
|
|
|
|
// Left total/Right total surround mix level. Only used for 3/2 coding mode.
|
|
LtRtSurroundMixLevel *float64 `locationName:"ltRtSurroundMixLevel" type:"double"`
|
|
|
|
// When set to followInput, encoder metadata will be sourced from the DD, DD+,
|
|
// or DolbyE decoder that supplied this audio data. If audio was not supplied
|
|
// from one of these streams, then the static metadata settings will be used.
|
|
MetadataControl *string `locationName:"metadataControl" type:"string" enum:"Eac3MetadataControl"`
|
|
|
|
// When set to whenPossible, input DD+ audio will be passed through if it is
|
|
// present on the input. This detection is dynamic over the life of the transcode.
|
|
// Inputs that alternate between DD+ and non-DD+ content will have a consistent
|
|
// DD+ output as the system alternates between passthrough and encoding.
|
|
PassthroughControl *string `locationName:"passthroughControl" type:"string" enum:"Eac3PassthroughControl"`
|
|
|
|
// When set to shift90Degrees, applies a 90-degree phase shift to the surround
|
|
// channels. Only used for 3/2 coding mode.
|
|
PhaseControl *string `locationName:"phaseControl" type:"string" enum:"Eac3PhaseControl"`
|
|
|
|
// Stereo downmix preference. Only used for 3/2 coding mode.
|
|
StereoDownmix *string `locationName:"stereoDownmix" type:"string" enum:"Eac3StereoDownmix"`
|
|
|
|
// When encoding 3/2 audio, sets whether an extra center back surround channel
|
|
// is matrix encoded into the left and right surround channels.
|
|
SurroundExMode *string `locationName:"surroundExMode" type:"string" enum:"Eac3SurroundExMode"`
|
|
|
|
// When encoding 2/0 audio, sets whether Dolby Surround is matrix encoded into
|
|
// the two channels.
|
|
SurroundMode *string `locationName:"surroundMode" type:"string" enum:"Eac3SurroundMode"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s Eac3Settings) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s Eac3Settings) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *Eac3Settings) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "Eac3Settings"}
|
|
if s.Dialnorm != nil && *s.Dialnorm < 1 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinValue("Dialnorm", 1))
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetAttenuationControl sets the AttenuationControl field's value.
|
|
func (s *Eac3Settings) SetAttenuationControl(v string) *Eac3Settings {
|
|
s.AttenuationControl = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetBitrate sets the Bitrate field's value.
|
|
func (s *Eac3Settings) SetBitrate(v float64) *Eac3Settings {
|
|
s.Bitrate = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetBitstreamMode sets the BitstreamMode field's value.
|
|
func (s *Eac3Settings) SetBitstreamMode(v string) *Eac3Settings {
|
|
s.BitstreamMode = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetCodingMode sets the CodingMode field's value.
|
|
func (s *Eac3Settings) SetCodingMode(v string) *Eac3Settings {
|
|
s.CodingMode = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetDcFilter sets the DcFilter field's value.
|
|
func (s *Eac3Settings) SetDcFilter(v string) *Eac3Settings {
|
|
s.DcFilter = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetDialnorm sets the Dialnorm field's value.
|
|
func (s *Eac3Settings) SetDialnorm(v int64) *Eac3Settings {
|
|
s.Dialnorm = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetDrcLine sets the DrcLine field's value.
|
|
func (s *Eac3Settings) SetDrcLine(v string) *Eac3Settings {
|
|
s.DrcLine = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetDrcRf sets the DrcRf field's value.
|
|
func (s *Eac3Settings) SetDrcRf(v string) *Eac3Settings {
|
|
s.DrcRf = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetLfeControl sets the LfeControl field's value.
|
|
func (s *Eac3Settings) SetLfeControl(v string) *Eac3Settings {
|
|
s.LfeControl = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetLfeFilter sets the LfeFilter field's value.
|
|
func (s *Eac3Settings) SetLfeFilter(v string) *Eac3Settings {
|
|
s.LfeFilter = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetLoRoCenterMixLevel sets the LoRoCenterMixLevel field's value.
|
|
func (s *Eac3Settings) SetLoRoCenterMixLevel(v float64) *Eac3Settings {
|
|
s.LoRoCenterMixLevel = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetLoRoSurroundMixLevel sets the LoRoSurroundMixLevel field's value.
|
|
func (s *Eac3Settings) SetLoRoSurroundMixLevel(v float64) *Eac3Settings {
|
|
s.LoRoSurroundMixLevel = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetLtRtCenterMixLevel sets the LtRtCenterMixLevel field's value.
|
|
func (s *Eac3Settings) SetLtRtCenterMixLevel(v float64) *Eac3Settings {
|
|
s.LtRtCenterMixLevel = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetLtRtSurroundMixLevel sets the LtRtSurroundMixLevel field's value.
|
|
func (s *Eac3Settings) SetLtRtSurroundMixLevel(v float64) *Eac3Settings {
|
|
s.LtRtSurroundMixLevel = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetMetadataControl sets the MetadataControl field's value.
|
|
func (s *Eac3Settings) SetMetadataControl(v string) *Eac3Settings {
|
|
s.MetadataControl = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetPassthroughControl sets the PassthroughControl field's value.
|
|
func (s *Eac3Settings) SetPassthroughControl(v string) *Eac3Settings {
|
|
s.PassthroughControl = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetPhaseControl sets the PhaseControl field's value.
|
|
func (s *Eac3Settings) SetPhaseControl(v string) *Eac3Settings {
|
|
s.PhaseControl = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetStereoDownmix sets the StereoDownmix field's value.
|
|
func (s *Eac3Settings) SetStereoDownmix(v string) *Eac3Settings {
|
|
s.StereoDownmix = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetSurroundExMode sets the SurroundExMode field's value.
|
|
func (s *Eac3Settings) SetSurroundExMode(v string) *Eac3Settings {
|
|
s.SurroundExMode = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetSurroundMode sets the SurroundMode field's value.
|
|
func (s *Eac3Settings) SetSurroundMode(v string) *Eac3Settings {
|
|
s.SurroundMode = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type EmbeddedDestinationSettings struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s EmbeddedDestinationSettings) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s EmbeddedDestinationSettings) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type EmbeddedPlusScte20DestinationSettings struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s EmbeddedPlusScte20DestinationSettings) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s EmbeddedPlusScte20DestinationSettings) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type EmbeddedSourceSettings struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// If upconvert, 608 data is both passed through via the "608 compatibility
|
|
// bytes" fields of the 708 wrapper as well as translated into 708. 708 data
|
|
// present in the source content will be discarded.
|
|
Convert608To708 *string `locationName:"convert608To708" type:"string" enum:"EmbeddedConvert608To708"`
|
|
|
|
// Set to "auto" to handle streams with intermittent and/or non-aligned SCTE-20
|
|
// and Embedded captions.
|
|
Scte20Detection *string `locationName:"scte20Detection" type:"string" enum:"EmbeddedScte20Detection"`
|
|
|
|
// Specifies the 608/708 channel number within the video track from which to
|
|
// extract captions. Unused for passthrough.
|
|
Source608ChannelNumber *int64 `locationName:"source608ChannelNumber" min:"1" type:"integer"`
|
|
|
|
// This field is unused and deprecated.
|
|
Source608TrackNumber *int64 `locationName:"source608TrackNumber" min:"1" type:"integer"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s EmbeddedSourceSettings) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s EmbeddedSourceSettings) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *EmbeddedSourceSettings) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "EmbeddedSourceSettings"}
|
|
if s.Source608ChannelNumber != nil && *s.Source608ChannelNumber < 1 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinValue("Source608ChannelNumber", 1))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.Source608TrackNumber != nil && *s.Source608TrackNumber < 1 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinValue("Source608TrackNumber", 1))
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetConvert608To708 sets the Convert608To708 field's value.
|
|
func (s *EmbeddedSourceSettings) SetConvert608To708(v string) *EmbeddedSourceSettings {
|
|
s.Convert608To708 = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetScte20Detection sets the Scte20Detection field's value.
|
|
func (s *EmbeddedSourceSettings) SetScte20Detection(v string) *EmbeddedSourceSettings {
|
|
s.Scte20Detection = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetSource608ChannelNumber sets the Source608ChannelNumber field's value.
|
|
func (s *EmbeddedSourceSettings) SetSource608ChannelNumber(v int64) *EmbeddedSourceSettings {
|
|
s.Source608ChannelNumber = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetSource608TrackNumber sets the Source608TrackNumber field's value.
|
|
func (s *EmbeddedSourceSettings) SetSource608TrackNumber(v int64) *EmbeddedSourceSettings {
|
|
s.Source608TrackNumber = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type EncoderSettings struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// AudioDescriptions is a required field
|
|
AudioDescriptions []*AudioDescription `locationName:"audioDescriptions" type:"list" required:"true"`
|
|
|
|
// Settings for ad avail blanking.
|
|
AvailBlanking *AvailBlanking `locationName:"availBlanking" type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// Event-wide configuration settings for ad avail insertion.
|
|
AvailConfiguration *AvailConfiguration `locationName:"availConfiguration" type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// Settings for blackout slate.
|
|
BlackoutSlate *BlackoutSlate `locationName:"blackoutSlate" type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// Settings for caption decriptions
|
|
CaptionDescriptions []*CaptionDescription `locationName:"captionDescriptions" type:"list"`
|
|
|
|
// Configuration settings that apply to the event as a whole.
|
|
GlobalConfiguration *GlobalConfiguration `locationName:"globalConfiguration" type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// OutputGroups is a required field
|
|
OutputGroups []*OutputGroup `locationName:"outputGroups" type:"list" required:"true"`
|
|
|
|
// Contains settings used to acquire and adjust timecode information from inputs.
|
|
//
|
|
// TimecodeConfig is a required field
|
|
TimecodeConfig *TimecodeConfig `locationName:"timecodeConfig" type:"structure" required:"true"`
|
|
|
|
// VideoDescriptions is a required field
|
|
VideoDescriptions []*VideoDescription `locationName:"videoDescriptions" type:"list" required:"true"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s EncoderSettings) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s EncoderSettings) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *EncoderSettings) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "EncoderSettings"}
|
|
if s.AudioDescriptions == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("AudioDescriptions"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.OutputGroups == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("OutputGroups"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.TimecodeConfig == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("TimecodeConfig"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.VideoDescriptions == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("VideoDescriptions"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.AudioDescriptions != nil {
|
|
for i, v := range s.AudioDescriptions {
|
|
if v == nil {
|
|
continue
|
|
}
|
|
if err := v.Validate(); err != nil {
|
|
invalidParams.AddNested(fmt.Sprintf("%s[%v]", "AudioDescriptions", i), err.(request.ErrInvalidParams))
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
if s.AvailBlanking != nil {
|
|
if err := s.AvailBlanking.Validate(); err != nil {
|
|
invalidParams.AddNested("AvailBlanking", err.(request.ErrInvalidParams))
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
if s.AvailConfiguration != nil {
|
|
if err := s.AvailConfiguration.Validate(); err != nil {
|
|
invalidParams.AddNested("AvailConfiguration", err.(request.ErrInvalidParams))
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
if s.BlackoutSlate != nil {
|
|
if err := s.BlackoutSlate.Validate(); err != nil {
|
|
invalidParams.AddNested("BlackoutSlate", err.(request.ErrInvalidParams))
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
if s.CaptionDescriptions != nil {
|
|
for i, v := range s.CaptionDescriptions {
|
|
if v == nil {
|
|
continue
|
|
}
|
|
if err := v.Validate(); err != nil {
|
|
invalidParams.AddNested(fmt.Sprintf("%s[%v]", "CaptionDescriptions", i), err.(request.ErrInvalidParams))
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
if s.GlobalConfiguration != nil {
|
|
if err := s.GlobalConfiguration.Validate(); err != nil {
|
|
invalidParams.AddNested("GlobalConfiguration", err.(request.ErrInvalidParams))
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
if s.OutputGroups != nil {
|
|
for i, v := range s.OutputGroups {
|
|
if v == nil {
|
|
continue
|
|
}
|
|
if err := v.Validate(); err != nil {
|
|
invalidParams.AddNested(fmt.Sprintf("%s[%v]", "OutputGroups", i), err.(request.ErrInvalidParams))
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
if s.TimecodeConfig != nil {
|
|
if err := s.TimecodeConfig.Validate(); err != nil {
|
|
invalidParams.AddNested("TimecodeConfig", err.(request.ErrInvalidParams))
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
if s.VideoDescriptions != nil {
|
|
for i, v := range s.VideoDescriptions {
|
|
if v == nil {
|
|
continue
|
|
}
|
|
if err := v.Validate(); err != nil {
|
|
invalidParams.AddNested(fmt.Sprintf("%s[%v]", "VideoDescriptions", i), err.(request.ErrInvalidParams))
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetAudioDescriptions sets the AudioDescriptions field's value.
|
|
func (s *EncoderSettings) SetAudioDescriptions(v []*AudioDescription) *EncoderSettings {
|
|
s.AudioDescriptions = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetAvailBlanking sets the AvailBlanking field's value.
|
|
func (s *EncoderSettings) SetAvailBlanking(v *AvailBlanking) *EncoderSettings {
|
|
s.AvailBlanking = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetAvailConfiguration sets the AvailConfiguration field's value.
|
|
func (s *EncoderSettings) SetAvailConfiguration(v *AvailConfiguration) *EncoderSettings {
|
|
s.AvailConfiguration = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetBlackoutSlate sets the BlackoutSlate field's value.
|
|
func (s *EncoderSettings) SetBlackoutSlate(v *BlackoutSlate) *EncoderSettings {
|
|
s.BlackoutSlate = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetCaptionDescriptions sets the CaptionDescriptions field's value.
|
|
func (s *EncoderSettings) SetCaptionDescriptions(v []*CaptionDescription) *EncoderSettings {
|
|
s.CaptionDescriptions = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetGlobalConfiguration sets the GlobalConfiguration field's value.
|
|
func (s *EncoderSettings) SetGlobalConfiguration(v *GlobalConfiguration) *EncoderSettings {
|
|
s.GlobalConfiguration = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetOutputGroups sets the OutputGroups field's value.
|
|
func (s *EncoderSettings) SetOutputGroups(v []*OutputGroup) *EncoderSettings {
|
|
s.OutputGroups = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetTimecodeConfig sets the TimecodeConfig field's value.
|
|
func (s *EncoderSettings) SetTimecodeConfig(v *TimecodeConfig) *EncoderSettings {
|
|
s.TimecodeConfig = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetVideoDescriptions sets the VideoDescriptions field's value.
|
|
func (s *EncoderSettings) SetVideoDescriptions(v []*VideoDescription) *EncoderSettings {
|
|
s.VideoDescriptions = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type FecOutputSettings struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// Parameter D from SMPTE 2022-1. The height of the FEC protection matrix. The
|
|
// number of transport stream packets per column error correction packet. Must
|
|
// be between 4 and 20, inclusive.
|
|
ColumnDepth *int64 `locationName:"columnDepth" min:"4" type:"integer"`
|
|
|
|
// Enables column only or column and row based FEC
|
|
IncludeFec *string `locationName:"includeFec" type:"string" enum:"FecOutputIncludeFec"`
|
|
|
|
// Parameter L from SMPTE 2022-1. The width of the FEC protection matrix. Must
|
|
// be between 1 and 20, inclusive. If only Column FEC is used, then larger values
|
|
// increase robustness. If Row FEC is used, then this is the number of transport
|
|
// stream packets per row error correction packet, and the value must be between
|
|
// 4 and 20, inclusive, if includeFec is columnAndRow. If includeFec is column,
|
|
// this value must be 1 to 20, inclusive.
|
|
RowLength *int64 `locationName:"rowLength" min:"1" type:"integer"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s FecOutputSettings) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s FecOutputSettings) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *FecOutputSettings) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "FecOutputSettings"}
|
|
if s.ColumnDepth != nil && *s.ColumnDepth < 4 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinValue("ColumnDepth", 4))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.RowLength != nil && *s.RowLength < 1 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinValue("RowLength", 1))
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetColumnDepth sets the ColumnDepth field's value.
|
|
func (s *FecOutputSettings) SetColumnDepth(v int64) *FecOutputSettings {
|
|
s.ColumnDepth = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetIncludeFec sets the IncludeFec field's value.
|
|
func (s *FecOutputSettings) SetIncludeFec(v string) *FecOutputSettings {
|
|
s.IncludeFec = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetRowLength sets the RowLength field's value.
|
|
func (s *FecOutputSettings) SetRowLength(v int64) *FecOutputSettings {
|
|
s.RowLength = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Start time for the action.
|
|
type FixedModeScheduleActionStartSettings struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// Start time for the action to start in the channel. (Not the time for the
|
|
// action to be added to the schedule: actions are always added to the schedule
|
|
// immediately.) UTC format: yyyy-mm-ddThh:mm:ss.nnnZ. All the letters are digits
|
|
// (for example, mm might be 01) except for the two constants "T" for time and
|
|
// "Z" for "UTC format".
|
|
//
|
|
// Time is a required field
|
|
Time *string `locationName:"time" type:"string" required:"true"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s FixedModeScheduleActionStartSettings) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s FixedModeScheduleActionStartSettings) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *FixedModeScheduleActionStartSettings) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "FixedModeScheduleActionStartSettings"}
|
|
if s.Time == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("Time"))
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetTime sets the Time field's value.
|
|
func (s *FixedModeScheduleActionStartSettings) SetTime(v string) *FixedModeScheduleActionStartSettings {
|
|
s.Time = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Settings to specify if an action follows another.
|
|
type FollowModeScheduleActionStartSettings struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// Identifies whether this action starts relative to the start or relative to
|
|
// the end of the reference action.
|
|
//
|
|
// FollowPoint is a required field
|
|
FollowPoint *string `locationName:"followPoint" type:"string" required:"true" enum:"FollowPoint"`
|
|
|
|
// The action name of another action that this one refers to.
|
|
//
|
|
// ReferenceActionName is a required field
|
|
ReferenceActionName *string `locationName:"referenceActionName" type:"string" required:"true"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s FollowModeScheduleActionStartSettings) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s FollowModeScheduleActionStartSettings) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *FollowModeScheduleActionStartSettings) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "FollowModeScheduleActionStartSettings"}
|
|
if s.FollowPoint == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("FollowPoint"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.ReferenceActionName == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("ReferenceActionName"))
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetFollowPoint sets the FollowPoint field's value.
|
|
func (s *FollowModeScheduleActionStartSettings) SetFollowPoint(v string) *FollowModeScheduleActionStartSettings {
|
|
s.FollowPoint = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetReferenceActionName sets the ReferenceActionName field's value.
|
|
func (s *FollowModeScheduleActionStartSettings) SetReferenceActionName(v string) *FollowModeScheduleActionStartSettings {
|
|
s.ReferenceActionName = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type GlobalConfiguration struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// Value to set the initial audio gain for the Live Event.
|
|
InitialAudioGain *int64 `locationName:"initialAudioGain" type:"integer"`
|
|
|
|
// Indicates the action to take when the current input completes (e.g. end-of-file).
|
|
// When switchAndLoopInputs is configured the encoder will restart at the beginning
|
|
// of the first input. When "none" is configured the encoder will transcode
|
|
// either black, a solid color, or a user specified slate images per the "Input
|
|
// Loss Behavior" configuration until the next input switch occurs (which is
|
|
// controlled through the Channel Schedule API).
|
|
InputEndAction *string `locationName:"inputEndAction" type:"string" enum:"GlobalConfigurationInputEndAction"`
|
|
|
|
// Settings for system actions when input is lost.
|
|
InputLossBehavior *InputLossBehavior `locationName:"inputLossBehavior" type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// Indicates whether the rate of frames emitted by the Live encoder should be
|
|
// paced by its system clock (which optionally may be locked to another source
|
|
// via NTP) or should be locked to the clock of the source that is providing
|
|
// the input stream.
|
|
OutputTimingSource *string `locationName:"outputTimingSource" type:"string" enum:"GlobalConfigurationOutputTimingSource"`
|
|
|
|
// Adjusts video input buffer for streams with very low video framerates. This
|
|
// is commonly set to enabled for music channels with less than one video frame
|
|
// per second.
|
|
SupportLowFramerateInputs *string `locationName:"supportLowFramerateInputs" type:"string" enum:"GlobalConfigurationLowFramerateInputs"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s GlobalConfiguration) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s GlobalConfiguration) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *GlobalConfiguration) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "GlobalConfiguration"}
|
|
if s.InitialAudioGain != nil && *s.InitialAudioGain < -60 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinValue("InitialAudioGain", -60))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.InputLossBehavior != nil {
|
|
if err := s.InputLossBehavior.Validate(); err != nil {
|
|
invalidParams.AddNested("InputLossBehavior", err.(request.ErrInvalidParams))
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetInitialAudioGain sets the InitialAudioGain field's value.
|
|
func (s *GlobalConfiguration) SetInitialAudioGain(v int64) *GlobalConfiguration {
|
|
s.InitialAudioGain = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetInputEndAction sets the InputEndAction field's value.
|
|
func (s *GlobalConfiguration) SetInputEndAction(v string) *GlobalConfiguration {
|
|
s.InputEndAction = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetInputLossBehavior sets the InputLossBehavior field's value.
|
|
func (s *GlobalConfiguration) SetInputLossBehavior(v *InputLossBehavior) *GlobalConfiguration {
|
|
s.InputLossBehavior = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetOutputTimingSource sets the OutputTimingSource field's value.
|
|
func (s *GlobalConfiguration) SetOutputTimingSource(v string) *GlobalConfiguration {
|
|
s.OutputTimingSource = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetSupportLowFramerateInputs sets the SupportLowFramerateInputs field's value.
|
|
func (s *GlobalConfiguration) SetSupportLowFramerateInputs(v string) *GlobalConfiguration {
|
|
s.SupportLowFramerateInputs = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type H264Settings struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// Adaptive quantization. Allows intra-frame quantizers to vary to improve visual
|
|
// quality.
|
|
AdaptiveQuantization *string `locationName:"adaptiveQuantization" type:"string" enum:"H264AdaptiveQuantization"`
|
|
|
|
// Indicates that AFD values will be written into the output stream. If afdSignaling
|
|
// is "auto", the system will try to preserve the input AFD value (in cases
|
|
// where multiple AFD values are valid). If set to "fixed", the AFD value will
|
|
// be the value configured in the fixedAfd parameter.
|
|
AfdSignaling *string `locationName:"afdSignaling" type:"string" enum:"AfdSignaling"`
|
|
|
|
// Average bitrate in bits/second. Required when the rate control mode is VBR
|
|
// or CBR. Not used for QVBR. In an MS Smooth output group, each output must
|
|
// have a unique value when its bitrate is rounded down to the nearest multiple
|
|
// of 1000.
|
|
Bitrate *int64 `locationName:"bitrate" min:"1000" type:"integer"`
|
|
|
|
// Percentage of the buffer that should initially be filled (HRD buffer model).
|
|
BufFillPct *int64 `locationName:"bufFillPct" type:"integer"`
|
|
|
|
// Size of buffer (HRD buffer model) in bits/second.
|
|
BufSize *int64 `locationName:"bufSize" type:"integer"`
|
|
|
|
// Includes colorspace metadata in the output.
|
|
ColorMetadata *string `locationName:"colorMetadata" type:"string" enum:"H264ColorMetadata"`
|
|
|
|
// Entropy encoding mode. Use cabac (must be in Main or High profile) or cavlc.
|
|
EntropyEncoding *string `locationName:"entropyEncoding" type:"string" enum:"H264EntropyEncoding"`
|
|
|
|
// Four bit AFD value to write on all frames of video in the output stream.
|
|
// Only valid when afdSignaling is set to 'Fixed'.
|
|
FixedAfd *string `locationName:"fixedAfd" type:"string" enum:"FixedAfd"`
|
|
|
|
// If set to enabled, adjust quantization within each frame to reduce flicker
|
|
// or 'pop' on I-frames.
|
|
FlickerAq *string `locationName:"flickerAq" type:"string" enum:"H264FlickerAq"`
|
|
|
|
// This field indicates how the output video frame rate is specified. If "specified"
|
|
// is selected then the output video frame rate is determined by framerateNumerator
|
|
// and framerateDenominator, else if "initializeFromSource" is selected then
|
|
// the output video frame rate will be set equal to the input video frame rate
|
|
// of the first input.
|
|
FramerateControl *string `locationName:"framerateControl" type:"string" enum:"H264FramerateControl"`
|
|
|
|
// Framerate denominator.
|
|
FramerateDenominator *int64 `locationName:"framerateDenominator" type:"integer"`
|
|
|
|
// Framerate numerator - framerate is a fraction, e.g. 24000 / 1001 = 23.976
|
|
// fps.
|
|
FramerateNumerator *int64 `locationName:"framerateNumerator" type:"integer"`
|
|
|
|
// If enabled, use reference B frames for GOP structures that have B frames
|
|
// > 1.
|
|
GopBReference *string `locationName:"gopBReference" type:"string" enum:"H264GopBReference"`
|
|
|
|
// Frequency of closed GOPs. In streaming applications, it is recommended that
|
|
// this be set to 1 so a decoder joining mid-stream will receive an IDR frame
|
|
// as quickly as possible. Setting this value to 0 will break output segmenting.
|
|
GopClosedCadence *int64 `locationName:"gopClosedCadence" type:"integer"`
|
|
|
|
// Number of B-frames between reference frames.
|
|
GopNumBFrames *int64 `locationName:"gopNumBFrames" type:"integer"`
|
|
|
|
// GOP size (keyframe interval) in units of either frames or seconds per gopSizeUnits.
|
|
// Must be greater than zero.
|
|
GopSize *float64 `locationName:"gopSize" type:"double"`
|
|
|
|
// Indicates if the gopSize is specified in frames or seconds. If seconds the
|
|
// system will convert the gopSize into a frame count at run time.
|
|
GopSizeUnits *string `locationName:"gopSizeUnits" type:"string" enum:"H264GopSizeUnits"`
|
|
|
|
// H.264 Level.
|
|
Level *string `locationName:"level" type:"string" enum:"H264Level"`
|
|
|
|
// Amount of lookahead. A value of low can decrease latency and memory usage,
|
|
// while high can produce better quality for certain content.
|
|
LookAheadRateControl *string `locationName:"lookAheadRateControl" type:"string" enum:"H264LookAheadRateControl"`
|
|
|
|
// For QVBR: See the tooltip for Quality level For VBR: Set the maximum bitrate
|
|
// in order to accommodate expected spikes in the complexity of the video.
|
|
MaxBitrate *int64 `locationName:"maxBitrate" min:"1000" type:"integer"`
|
|
|
|
// Only meaningful if sceneChangeDetect is set to enabled. Enforces separation
|
|
// between repeated (cadence) I-frames and I-frames inserted by Scene Change
|
|
// Detection. If a scene change I-frame is within I-interval frames of a cadence
|
|
// I-frame, the GOP is shrunk and/or stretched to the scene change I-frame.
|
|
// GOP stretch requires enabling lookahead as well as setting I-interval. The
|
|
// normal cadence resumes for the next GOP. Note: Maximum GOP stretch = GOP
|
|
// size + Min-I-interval - 1
|
|
MinIInterval *int64 `locationName:"minIInterval" type:"integer"`
|
|
|
|
// Number of reference frames to use. The encoder may use more than requested
|
|
// if using B-frames and/or interlaced encoding.
|
|
NumRefFrames *int64 `locationName:"numRefFrames" min:"1" type:"integer"`
|
|
|
|
// This field indicates how the output pixel aspect ratio is specified. If "specified"
|
|
// is selected then the output video pixel aspect ratio is determined by parNumerator
|
|
// and parDenominator, else if "initializeFromSource" is selected then the output
|
|
// pixsel aspect ratio will be set equal to the input video pixel aspect ratio
|
|
// of the first input.
|
|
ParControl *string `locationName:"parControl" type:"string" enum:"H264ParControl"`
|
|
|
|
// Pixel Aspect Ratio denominator.
|
|
ParDenominator *int64 `locationName:"parDenominator" min:"1" type:"integer"`
|
|
|
|
// Pixel Aspect Ratio numerator.
|
|
ParNumerator *int64 `locationName:"parNumerator" type:"integer"`
|
|
|
|
// H.264 Profile.
|
|
Profile *string `locationName:"profile" type:"string" enum:"H264Profile"`
|
|
|
|
// Controls the target quality for the video encode. Applies only when the rate
|
|
// control mode is QVBR. Set values for the QVBR quality level field and Max
|
|
// bitrate field that suit your most important viewing devices. Recommended
|
|
// values are:- Primary screen: Quality level: 8 to 10. Max bitrate: 4M- PC
|
|
// or tablet: Quality level: 7. Max bitrate: 1.5M to 3M- Smartphone: Quality
|
|
// level: 6. Max bitrate: 1M to 1.5M
|
|
QvbrQualityLevel *int64 `locationName:"qvbrQualityLevel" min:"1" type:"integer"`
|
|
|
|
// Rate control mode. QVBR: Quality will match the specified quality level except
|
|
// when it is constrained by themaximum bitrate. Recommended if you or your
|
|
// viewers pay for bandwidth.VBR: Quality and bitrate vary, depending on the
|
|
// video complexity. Recommended instead of QVBRif you want to maintain a specific
|
|
// average bitrate over the duration of the channel.CBR: Quality varies, depending
|
|
// on the video complexity. Recommended only if you distributeyour assets to
|
|
// devices that cannot handle variable bitrates.
|
|
RateControlMode *string `locationName:"rateControlMode" type:"string" enum:"H264RateControlMode"`
|
|
|
|
// Sets the scan type of the output to progressive or top-field-first interlaced.
|
|
ScanType *string `locationName:"scanType" type:"string" enum:"H264ScanType"`
|
|
|
|
// Scene change detection.- On: inserts I-frames when scene change is detected.-
|
|
// Off: does not force an I-frame when scene change is detected.
|
|
SceneChangeDetect *string `locationName:"sceneChangeDetect" type:"string" enum:"H264SceneChangeDetect"`
|
|
|
|
// Number of slices per picture. Must be less than or equal to the number of
|
|
// macroblock rows for progressive pictures, and less than or equal to half
|
|
// the number of macroblock rows for interlaced pictures.This field is optional;
|
|
// when no value is specified the encoder will choose the number of slices based
|
|
// on encode resolution.
|
|
Slices *int64 `locationName:"slices" min:"1" type:"integer"`
|
|
|
|
// Softness. Selects quantizer matrix, larger values reduce high-frequency content
|
|
// in the encoded image.
|
|
Softness *int64 `locationName:"softness" type:"integer"`
|
|
|
|
// If set to enabled, adjust quantization within each frame based on spatial
|
|
// variation of content complexity.
|
|
SpatialAq *string `locationName:"spatialAq" type:"string" enum:"H264SpatialAq"`
|
|
|
|
// If set to fixed, use gopNumBFrames B-frames per sub-GOP. If set to dynamic,
|
|
// optimize the number of B-frames used for each sub-GOP to improve visual quality.
|
|
SubgopLength *string `locationName:"subgopLength" type:"string" enum:"H264SubGopLength"`
|
|
|
|
// Produces a bitstream compliant with SMPTE RP-2027.
|
|
Syntax *string `locationName:"syntax" type:"string" enum:"H264Syntax"`
|
|
|
|
// If set to enabled, adjust quantization within each frame based on temporal
|
|
// variation of content complexity.
|
|
TemporalAq *string `locationName:"temporalAq" type:"string" enum:"H264TemporalAq"`
|
|
|
|
// Determines how timecodes should be inserted into the video elementary stream.-
|
|
// 'disabled': Do not include timecodes- 'picTimingSei': Pass through picture
|
|
// timing SEI messages from the source specified in Timecode Config
|
|
TimecodeInsertion *string `locationName:"timecodeInsertion" type:"string" enum:"H264TimecodeInsertionBehavior"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s H264Settings) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s H264Settings) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *H264Settings) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "H264Settings"}
|
|
if s.Bitrate != nil && *s.Bitrate < 1000 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinValue("Bitrate", 1000))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.MaxBitrate != nil && *s.MaxBitrate < 1000 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinValue("MaxBitrate", 1000))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.NumRefFrames != nil && *s.NumRefFrames < 1 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinValue("NumRefFrames", 1))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.ParDenominator != nil && *s.ParDenominator < 1 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinValue("ParDenominator", 1))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.QvbrQualityLevel != nil && *s.QvbrQualityLevel < 1 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinValue("QvbrQualityLevel", 1))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.Slices != nil && *s.Slices < 1 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinValue("Slices", 1))
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetAdaptiveQuantization sets the AdaptiveQuantization field's value.
|
|
func (s *H264Settings) SetAdaptiveQuantization(v string) *H264Settings {
|
|
s.AdaptiveQuantization = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetAfdSignaling sets the AfdSignaling field's value.
|
|
func (s *H264Settings) SetAfdSignaling(v string) *H264Settings {
|
|
s.AfdSignaling = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetBitrate sets the Bitrate field's value.
|
|
func (s *H264Settings) SetBitrate(v int64) *H264Settings {
|
|
s.Bitrate = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetBufFillPct sets the BufFillPct field's value.
|
|
func (s *H264Settings) SetBufFillPct(v int64) *H264Settings {
|
|
s.BufFillPct = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetBufSize sets the BufSize field's value.
|
|
func (s *H264Settings) SetBufSize(v int64) *H264Settings {
|
|
s.BufSize = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetColorMetadata sets the ColorMetadata field's value.
|
|
func (s *H264Settings) SetColorMetadata(v string) *H264Settings {
|
|
s.ColorMetadata = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetEntropyEncoding sets the EntropyEncoding field's value.
|
|
func (s *H264Settings) SetEntropyEncoding(v string) *H264Settings {
|
|
s.EntropyEncoding = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetFixedAfd sets the FixedAfd field's value.
|
|
func (s *H264Settings) SetFixedAfd(v string) *H264Settings {
|
|
s.FixedAfd = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetFlickerAq sets the FlickerAq field's value.
|
|
func (s *H264Settings) SetFlickerAq(v string) *H264Settings {
|
|
s.FlickerAq = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetFramerateControl sets the FramerateControl field's value.
|
|
func (s *H264Settings) SetFramerateControl(v string) *H264Settings {
|
|
s.FramerateControl = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetFramerateDenominator sets the FramerateDenominator field's value.
|
|
func (s *H264Settings) SetFramerateDenominator(v int64) *H264Settings {
|
|
s.FramerateDenominator = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetFramerateNumerator sets the FramerateNumerator field's value.
|
|
func (s *H264Settings) SetFramerateNumerator(v int64) *H264Settings {
|
|
s.FramerateNumerator = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetGopBReference sets the GopBReference field's value.
|
|
func (s *H264Settings) SetGopBReference(v string) *H264Settings {
|
|
s.GopBReference = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetGopClosedCadence sets the GopClosedCadence field's value.
|
|
func (s *H264Settings) SetGopClosedCadence(v int64) *H264Settings {
|
|
s.GopClosedCadence = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetGopNumBFrames sets the GopNumBFrames field's value.
|
|
func (s *H264Settings) SetGopNumBFrames(v int64) *H264Settings {
|
|
s.GopNumBFrames = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetGopSize sets the GopSize field's value.
|
|
func (s *H264Settings) SetGopSize(v float64) *H264Settings {
|
|
s.GopSize = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetGopSizeUnits sets the GopSizeUnits field's value.
|
|
func (s *H264Settings) SetGopSizeUnits(v string) *H264Settings {
|
|
s.GopSizeUnits = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetLevel sets the Level field's value.
|
|
func (s *H264Settings) SetLevel(v string) *H264Settings {
|
|
s.Level = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetLookAheadRateControl sets the LookAheadRateControl field's value.
|
|
func (s *H264Settings) SetLookAheadRateControl(v string) *H264Settings {
|
|
s.LookAheadRateControl = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetMaxBitrate sets the MaxBitrate field's value.
|
|
func (s *H264Settings) SetMaxBitrate(v int64) *H264Settings {
|
|
s.MaxBitrate = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetMinIInterval sets the MinIInterval field's value.
|
|
func (s *H264Settings) SetMinIInterval(v int64) *H264Settings {
|
|
s.MinIInterval = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetNumRefFrames sets the NumRefFrames field's value.
|
|
func (s *H264Settings) SetNumRefFrames(v int64) *H264Settings {
|
|
s.NumRefFrames = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetParControl sets the ParControl field's value.
|
|
func (s *H264Settings) SetParControl(v string) *H264Settings {
|
|
s.ParControl = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetParDenominator sets the ParDenominator field's value.
|
|
func (s *H264Settings) SetParDenominator(v int64) *H264Settings {
|
|
s.ParDenominator = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetParNumerator sets the ParNumerator field's value.
|
|
func (s *H264Settings) SetParNumerator(v int64) *H264Settings {
|
|
s.ParNumerator = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetProfile sets the Profile field's value.
|
|
func (s *H264Settings) SetProfile(v string) *H264Settings {
|
|
s.Profile = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetQvbrQualityLevel sets the QvbrQualityLevel field's value.
|
|
func (s *H264Settings) SetQvbrQualityLevel(v int64) *H264Settings {
|
|
s.QvbrQualityLevel = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetRateControlMode sets the RateControlMode field's value.
|
|
func (s *H264Settings) SetRateControlMode(v string) *H264Settings {
|
|
s.RateControlMode = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetScanType sets the ScanType field's value.
|
|
func (s *H264Settings) SetScanType(v string) *H264Settings {
|
|
s.ScanType = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetSceneChangeDetect sets the SceneChangeDetect field's value.
|
|
func (s *H264Settings) SetSceneChangeDetect(v string) *H264Settings {
|
|
s.SceneChangeDetect = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetSlices sets the Slices field's value.
|
|
func (s *H264Settings) SetSlices(v int64) *H264Settings {
|
|
s.Slices = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetSoftness sets the Softness field's value.
|
|
func (s *H264Settings) SetSoftness(v int64) *H264Settings {
|
|
s.Softness = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetSpatialAq sets the SpatialAq field's value.
|
|
func (s *H264Settings) SetSpatialAq(v string) *H264Settings {
|
|
s.SpatialAq = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetSubgopLength sets the SubgopLength field's value.
|
|
func (s *H264Settings) SetSubgopLength(v string) *H264Settings {
|
|
s.SubgopLength = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetSyntax sets the Syntax field's value.
|
|
func (s *H264Settings) SetSyntax(v string) *H264Settings {
|
|
s.Syntax = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetTemporalAq sets the TemporalAq field's value.
|
|
func (s *H264Settings) SetTemporalAq(v string) *H264Settings {
|
|
s.TemporalAq = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetTimecodeInsertion sets the TimecodeInsertion field's value.
|
|
func (s *H264Settings) SetTimecodeInsertion(v string) *H264Settings {
|
|
s.TimecodeInsertion = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type HlsAkamaiSettings struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// Number of seconds to wait before retrying connection to the CDN if the connection
|
|
// is lost.
|
|
ConnectionRetryInterval *int64 `locationName:"connectionRetryInterval" type:"integer"`
|
|
|
|
// Size in seconds of file cache for streaming outputs.
|
|
FilecacheDuration *int64 `locationName:"filecacheDuration" type:"integer"`
|
|
|
|
// Specify whether or not to use chunked transfer encoding to Akamai. User should
|
|
// contact Akamai to enable this feature.
|
|
HttpTransferMode *string `locationName:"httpTransferMode" type:"string" enum:"HlsAkamaiHttpTransferMode"`
|
|
|
|
// Number of retry attempts that will be made before the Live Event is put into
|
|
// an error state.
|
|
NumRetries *int64 `locationName:"numRetries" type:"integer"`
|
|
|
|
// If a streaming output fails, number of seconds to wait until a restart is
|
|
// initiated. A value of 0 means never restart.
|
|
RestartDelay *int64 `locationName:"restartDelay" type:"integer"`
|
|
|
|
// Salt for authenticated Akamai.
|
|
Salt *string `locationName:"salt" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// Token parameter for authenticated akamai. If not specified, _gda_ is used.
|
|
Token *string `locationName:"token" type:"string"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s HlsAkamaiSettings) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s HlsAkamaiSettings) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetConnectionRetryInterval sets the ConnectionRetryInterval field's value.
|
|
func (s *HlsAkamaiSettings) SetConnectionRetryInterval(v int64) *HlsAkamaiSettings {
|
|
s.ConnectionRetryInterval = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetFilecacheDuration sets the FilecacheDuration field's value.
|
|
func (s *HlsAkamaiSettings) SetFilecacheDuration(v int64) *HlsAkamaiSettings {
|
|
s.FilecacheDuration = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetHttpTransferMode sets the HttpTransferMode field's value.
|
|
func (s *HlsAkamaiSettings) SetHttpTransferMode(v string) *HlsAkamaiSettings {
|
|
s.HttpTransferMode = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetNumRetries sets the NumRetries field's value.
|
|
func (s *HlsAkamaiSettings) SetNumRetries(v int64) *HlsAkamaiSettings {
|
|
s.NumRetries = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetRestartDelay sets the RestartDelay field's value.
|
|
func (s *HlsAkamaiSettings) SetRestartDelay(v int64) *HlsAkamaiSettings {
|
|
s.RestartDelay = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetSalt sets the Salt field's value.
|
|
func (s *HlsAkamaiSettings) SetSalt(v string) *HlsAkamaiSettings {
|
|
s.Salt = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetToken sets the Token field's value.
|
|
func (s *HlsAkamaiSettings) SetToken(v string) *HlsAkamaiSettings {
|
|
s.Token = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type HlsBasicPutSettings struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// Number of seconds to wait before retrying connection to the CDN if the connection
|
|
// is lost.
|
|
ConnectionRetryInterval *int64 `locationName:"connectionRetryInterval" type:"integer"`
|
|
|
|
// Size in seconds of file cache for streaming outputs.
|
|
FilecacheDuration *int64 `locationName:"filecacheDuration" type:"integer"`
|
|
|
|
// Number of retry attempts that will be made before the Live Event is put into
|
|
// an error state.
|
|
NumRetries *int64 `locationName:"numRetries" type:"integer"`
|
|
|
|
// If a streaming output fails, number of seconds to wait until a restart is
|
|
// initiated. A value of 0 means never restart.
|
|
RestartDelay *int64 `locationName:"restartDelay" type:"integer"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s HlsBasicPutSettings) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s HlsBasicPutSettings) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetConnectionRetryInterval sets the ConnectionRetryInterval field's value.
|
|
func (s *HlsBasicPutSettings) SetConnectionRetryInterval(v int64) *HlsBasicPutSettings {
|
|
s.ConnectionRetryInterval = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetFilecacheDuration sets the FilecacheDuration field's value.
|
|
func (s *HlsBasicPutSettings) SetFilecacheDuration(v int64) *HlsBasicPutSettings {
|
|
s.FilecacheDuration = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetNumRetries sets the NumRetries field's value.
|
|
func (s *HlsBasicPutSettings) SetNumRetries(v int64) *HlsBasicPutSettings {
|
|
s.NumRetries = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetRestartDelay sets the RestartDelay field's value.
|
|
func (s *HlsBasicPutSettings) SetRestartDelay(v int64) *HlsBasicPutSettings {
|
|
s.RestartDelay = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type HlsCdnSettings struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
HlsAkamaiSettings *HlsAkamaiSettings `locationName:"hlsAkamaiSettings" type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
HlsBasicPutSettings *HlsBasicPutSettings `locationName:"hlsBasicPutSettings" type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
HlsMediaStoreSettings *HlsMediaStoreSettings `locationName:"hlsMediaStoreSettings" type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
HlsWebdavSettings *HlsWebdavSettings `locationName:"hlsWebdavSettings" type:"structure"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s HlsCdnSettings) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s HlsCdnSettings) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetHlsAkamaiSettings sets the HlsAkamaiSettings field's value.
|
|
func (s *HlsCdnSettings) SetHlsAkamaiSettings(v *HlsAkamaiSettings) *HlsCdnSettings {
|
|
s.HlsAkamaiSettings = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetHlsBasicPutSettings sets the HlsBasicPutSettings field's value.
|
|
func (s *HlsCdnSettings) SetHlsBasicPutSettings(v *HlsBasicPutSettings) *HlsCdnSettings {
|
|
s.HlsBasicPutSettings = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetHlsMediaStoreSettings sets the HlsMediaStoreSettings field's value.
|
|
func (s *HlsCdnSettings) SetHlsMediaStoreSettings(v *HlsMediaStoreSettings) *HlsCdnSettings {
|
|
s.HlsMediaStoreSettings = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetHlsWebdavSettings sets the HlsWebdavSettings field's value.
|
|
func (s *HlsCdnSettings) SetHlsWebdavSettings(v *HlsWebdavSettings) *HlsCdnSettings {
|
|
s.HlsWebdavSettings = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type HlsGroupSettings struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// Choose one or more ad marker types to pass SCTE35 signals through to this
|
|
// group of Apple HLS outputs.
|
|
AdMarkers []*string `locationName:"adMarkers" type:"list"`
|
|
|
|
// A partial URI prefix that will be prepended to each output in the media .m3u8
|
|
// file. Can be used if base manifest is delivered from a different URL than
|
|
// the main .m3u8 file.
|
|
BaseUrlContent *string `locationName:"baseUrlContent" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// A partial URI prefix that will be prepended to each output in the media .m3u8
|
|
// file. Can be used if base manifest is delivered from a different URL than
|
|
// the main .m3u8 file.
|
|
BaseUrlManifest *string `locationName:"baseUrlManifest" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// Mapping of up to 4 caption channels to caption languages. Is only meaningful
|
|
// if captionLanguageSetting is set to "insert".
|
|
CaptionLanguageMappings []*CaptionLanguageMapping `locationName:"captionLanguageMappings" type:"list"`
|
|
|
|
// Applies only to 608 Embedded output captions.insert: Include CLOSED-CAPTIONS
|
|
// lines in the manifest. Specify at least one language in the CC1 Language
|
|
// Code field. One CLOSED-CAPTION line is added for each Language Code you specify.
|
|
// Make sure to specify the languages in the order in which they appear in the
|
|
// original source (if the source is embedded format) or the order of the caption
|
|
// selectors (if the source is other than embedded). Otherwise, languages in
|
|
// the manifest will not match up properly with the output captions.none: Include
|
|
// CLOSED-CAPTIONS=NONE line in the manifest.omit: Omit any CLOSED-CAPTIONS
|
|
// line from the manifest.
|
|
CaptionLanguageSetting *string `locationName:"captionLanguageSetting" type:"string" enum:"HlsCaptionLanguageSetting"`
|
|
|
|
// When set to "disabled", sets the #EXT-X-ALLOW-CACHE:no tag in the manifest,
|
|
// which prevents clients from saving media segments for later replay.
|
|
ClientCache *string `locationName:"clientCache" type:"string" enum:"HlsClientCache"`
|
|
|
|
// Specification to use (RFC-6381 or the default RFC-4281) during m3u8 playlist
|
|
// generation.
|
|
CodecSpecification *string `locationName:"codecSpecification" type:"string" enum:"HlsCodecSpecification"`
|
|
|
|
// For use with encryptionType. This is a 128-bit, 16-byte hex value represented
|
|
// by a 32-character text string. If ivSource is set to "explicit" then this
|
|
// parameter is required and is used as the IV for encryption.
|
|
ConstantIv *string `locationName:"constantIv" min:"32" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// A directory or HTTP destination for the HLS segments, manifest files, and
|
|
// encryption keys (if enabled).
|
|
//
|
|
// Destination is a required field
|
|
Destination *OutputLocationRef `locationName:"destination" type:"structure" required:"true"`
|
|
|
|
// Place segments in subdirectories.
|
|
DirectoryStructure *string `locationName:"directoryStructure" type:"string" enum:"HlsDirectoryStructure"`
|
|
|
|
// Encrypts the segments with the given encryption scheme. Exclude this parameter
|
|
// if no encryption is desired.
|
|
EncryptionType *string `locationName:"encryptionType" type:"string" enum:"HlsEncryptionType"`
|
|
|
|
// Parameters that control interactions with the CDN.
|
|
HlsCdnSettings *HlsCdnSettings `locationName:"hlsCdnSettings" type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// If mode is "live", the number of segments to retain in the manifest (.m3u8)
|
|
// file. This number must be less than or equal to keepSegments. If mode is
|
|
// "vod", this parameter has no effect.
|
|
IndexNSegments *int64 `locationName:"indexNSegments" min:"3" type:"integer"`
|
|
|
|
// Parameter that control output group behavior on input loss.
|
|
InputLossAction *string `locationName:"inputLossAction" type:"string" enum:"InputLossActionForHlsOut"`
|
|
|
|
// For use with encryptionType. The IV (Initialization Vector) is a 128-bit
|
|
// number used in conjunction with the key for encrypting blocks. If set to
|
|
// "include", IV is listed in the manifest, otherwise the IV is not in the manifest.
|
|
IvInManifest *string `locationName:"ivInManifest" type:"string" enum:"HlsIvInManifest"`
|
|
|
|
// For use with encryptionType. The IV (Initialization Vector) is a 128-bit
|
|
// number used in conjunction with the key for encrypting blocks. If this setting
|
|
// is "followsSegmentNumber", it will cause the IV to change every segment (to
|
|
// match the segment number). If this is set to "explicit", you must enter a
|
|
// constantIv value.
|
|
IvSource *string `locationName:"ivSource" type:"string" enum:"HlsIvSource"`
|
|
|
|
// If mode is "live", the number of TS segments to retain in the destination
|
|
// directory. If mode is "vod", this parameter has no effect.
|
|
KeepSegments *int64 `locationName:"keepSegments" min:"1" type:"integer"`
|
|
|
|
// The value specifies how the key is represented in the resource identified
|
|
// by the URI. If parameter is absent, an implicit value of "identity" is used.
|
|
// A reverse DNS string can also be given.
|
|
KeyFormat *string `locationName:"keyFormat" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// Either a single positive integer version value or a slash delimited list
|
|
// of version values (1/2/3).
|
|
KeyFormatVersions *string `locationName:"keyFormatVersions" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// The key provider settings.
|
|
KeyProviderSettings *KeyProviderSettings `locationName:"keyProviderSettings" type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// When set to gzip, compresses HLS playlist.
|
|
ManifestCompression *string `locationName:"manifestCompression" type:"string" enum:"HlsManifestCompression"`
|
|
|
|
// Indicates whether the output manifest should use floating point or integer
|
|
// values for segment duration.
|
|
ManifestDurationFormat *string `locationName:"manifestDurationFormat" type:"string" enum:"HlsManifestDurationFormat"`
|
|
|
|
// When set, minimumSegmentLength is enforced by looking ahead and back within
|
|
// the specified range for a nearby avail and extending the segment size if
|
|
// needed.
|
|
MinSegmentLength *int64 `locationName:"minSegmentLength" type:"integer"`
|
|
|
|
// If "vod", all segments are indexed and kept permanently in the destination
|
|
// and manifest. If "live", only the number segments specified in keepSegments
|
|
// and indexNSegments are kept; newer segments replace older segments, which
|
|
// may prevent players from rewinding all the way to the beginning of the event.VOD
|
|
// mode uses HLS EXT-X-PLAYLIST-TYPE of EVENT while the channel is running,
|
|
// converting it to a "VOD" type manifest on completion of the stream.
|
|
Mode *string `locationName:"mode" type:"string" enum:"HlsMode"`
|
|
|
|
// Generates the .m3u8 playlist file for this HLS output group. The segmentsOnly
|
|
// option will output segments without the .m3u8 file.
|
|
OutputSelection *string `locationName:"outputSelection" type:"string" enum:"HlsOutputSelection"`
|
|
|
|
// Includes or excludes EXT-X-PROGRAM-DATE-TIME tag in .m3u8 manifest files.
|
|
// The value is calculated as follows: either the program date and time are
|
|
// initialized using the input timecode source, or the time is initialized using
|
|
// the input timecode source and the date is initialized using the timestampOffset.
|
|
ProgramDateTime *string `locationName:"programDateTime" type:"string" enum:"HlsProgramDateTime"`
|
|
|
|
// Period of insertion of EXT-X-PROGRAM-DATE-TIME entry, in seconds.
|
|
ProgramDateTimePeriod *int64 `locationName:"programDateTimePeriod" type:"integer"`
|
|
|
|
// When set to "enabled", includes the media playlists from both pipelines in
|
|
// the master manifest (.m3u8) file.
|
|
RedundantManifest *string `locationName:"redundantManifest" type:"string" enum:"HlsRedundantManifest"`
|
|
|
|
// Length of MPEG-2 Transport Stream segments to create (in seconds). Note that
|
|
// segments will end on the next keyframe after this number of seconds, so actual
|
|
// segment length may be longer.
|
|
SegmentLength *int64 `locationName:"segmentLength" min:"1" type:"integer"`
|
|
|
|
// useInputSegmentation has been deprecated. The configured segment size is
|
|
// always used.
|
|
SegmentationMode *string `locationName:"segmentationMode" type:"string" enum:"HlsSegmentationMode"`
|
|
|
|
// Number of segments to write to a subdirectory before starting a new one.
|
|
// directoryStructure must be subdirectoryPerStream for this setting to have
|
|
// an effect.
|
|
SegmentsPerSubdirectory *int64 `locationName:"segmentsPerSubdirectory" min:"1" type:"integer"`
|
|
|
|
// Include or exclude RESOLUTION attribute for video in EXT-X-STREAM-INF tag
|
|
// of variant manifest.
|
|
StreamInfResolution *string `locationName:"streamInfResolution" type:"string" enum:"HlsStreamInfResolution"`
|
|
|
|
// Indicates ID3 frame that has the timecode.
|
|
TimedMetadataId3Frame *string `locationName:"timedMetadataId3Frame" type:"string" enum:"HlsTimedMetadataId3Frame"`
|
|
|
|
// Timed Metadata interval in seconds.
|
|
TimedMetadataId3Period *int64 `locationName:"timedMetadataId3Period" type:"integer"`
|
|
|
|
// Provides an extra millisecond delta offset to fine tune the timestamps.
|
|
TimestampDeltaMilliseconds *int64 `locationName:"timestampDeltaMilliseconds" type:"integer"`
|
|
|
|
// When set to "singleFile", emits the program as a single media resource (.ts)
|
|
// file, and uses #EXT-X-BYTERANGE tags to index segment for playback. Playback
|
|
// of VOD mode content during event is not guaranteed due to HTTP server caching.
|
|
TsFileMode *string `locationName:"tsFileMode" type:"string" enum:"HlsTsFileMode"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s HlsGroupSettings) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s HlsGroupSettings) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *HlsGroupSettings) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "HlsGroupSettings"}
|
|
if s.ConstantIv != nil && len(*s.ConstantIv) < 32 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("ConstantIv", 32))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.Destination == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("Destination"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.IndexNSegments != nil && *s.IndexNSegments < 3 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinValue("IndexNSegments", 3))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.KeepSegments != nil && *s.KeepSegments < 1 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinValue("KeepSegments", 1))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.SegmentLength != nil && *s.SegmentLength < 1 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinValue("SegmentLength", 1))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.SegmentsPerSubdirectory != nil && *s.SegmentsPerSubdirectory < 1 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinValue("SegmentsPerSubdirectory", 1))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.CaptionLanguageMappings != nil {
|
|
for i, v := range s.CaptionLanguageMappings {
|
|
if v == nil {
|
|
continue
|
|
}
|
|
if err := v.Validate(); err != nil {
|
|
invalidParams.AddNested(fmt.Sprintf("%s[%v]", "CaptionLanguageMappings", i), err.(request.ErrInvalidParams))
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
if s.KeyProviderSettings != nil {
|
|
if err := s.KeyProviderSettings.Validate(); err != nil {
|
|
invalidParams.AddNested("KeyProviderSettings", err.(request.ErrInvalidParams))
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetAdMarkers sets the AdMarkers field's value.
|
|
func (s *HlsGroupSettings) SetAdMarkers(v []*string) *HlsGroupSettings {
|
|
s.AdMarkers = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetBaseUrlContent sets the BaseUrlContent field's value.
|
|
func (s *HlsGroupSettings) SetBaseUrlContent(v string) *HlsGroupSettings {
|
|
s.BaseUrlContent = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetBaseUrlManifest sets the BaseUrlManifest field's value.
|
|
func (s *HlsGroupSettings) SetBaseUrlManifest(v string) *HlsGroupSettings {
|
|
s.BaseUrlManifest = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetCaptionLanguageMappings sets the CaptionLanguageMappings field's value.
|
|
func (s *HlsGroupSettings) SetCaptionLanguageMappings(v []*CaptionLanguageMapping) *HlsGroupSettings {
|
|
s.CaptionLanguageMappings = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetCaptionLanguageSetting sets the CaptionLanguageSetting field's value.
|
|
func (s *HlsGroupSettings) SetCaptionLanguageSetting(v string) *HlsGroupSettings {
|
|
s.CaptionLanguageSetting = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetClientCache sets the ClientCache field's value.
|
|
func (s *HlsGroupSettings) SetClientCache(v string) *HlsGroupSettings {
|
|
s.ClientCache = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetCodecSpecification sets the CodecSpecification field's value.
|
|
func (s *HlsGroupSettings) SetCodecSpecification(v string) *HlsGroupSettings {
|
|
s.CodecSpecification = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetConstantIv sets the ConstantIv field's value.
|
|
func (s *HlsGroupSettings) SetConstantIv(v string) *HlsGroupSettings {
|
|
s.ConstantIv = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetDestination sets the Destination field's value.
|
|
func (s *HlsGroupSettings) SetDestination(v *OutputLocationRef) *HlsGroupSettings {
|
|
s.Destination = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetDirectoryStructure sets the DirectoryStructure field's value.
|
|
func (s *HlsGroupSettings) SetDirectoryStructure(v string) *HlsGroupSettings {
|
|
s.DirectoryStructure = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetEncryptionType sets the EncryptionType field's value.
|
|
func (s *HlsGroupSettings) SetEncryptionType(v string) *HlsGroupSettings {
|
|
s.EncryptionType = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetHlsCdnSettings sets the HlsCdnSettings field's value.
|
|
func (s *HlsGroupSettings) SetHlsCdnSettings(v *HlsCdnSettings) *HlsGroupSettings {
|
|
s.HlsCdnSettings = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetIndexNSegments sets the IndexNSegments field's value.
|
|
func (s *HlsGroupSettings) SetIndexNSegments(v int64) *HlsGroupSettings {
|
|
s.IndexNSegments = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetInputLossAction sets the InputLossAction field's value.
|
|
func (s *HlsGroupSettings) SetInputLossAction(v string) *HlsGroupSettings {
|
|
s.InputLossAction = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetIvInManifest sets the IvInManifest field's value.
|
|
func (s *HlsGroupSettings) SetIvInManifest(v string) *HlsGroupSettings {
|
|
s.IvInManifest = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetIvSource sets the IvSource field's value.
|
|
func (s *HlsGroupSettings) SetIvSource(v string) *HlsGroupSettings {
|
|
s.IvSource = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetKeepSegments sets the KeepSegments field's value.
|
|
func (s *HlsGroupSettings) SetKeepSegments(v int64) *HlsGroupSettings {
|
|
s.KeepSegments = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetKeyFormat sets the KeyFormat field's value.
|
|
func (s *HlsGroupSettings) SetKeyFormat(v string) *HlsGroupSettings {
|
|
s.KeyFormat = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetKeyFormatVersions sets the KeyFormatVersions field's value.
|
|
func (s *HlsGroupSettings) SetKeyFormatVersions(v string) *HlsGroupSettings {
|
|
s.KeyFormatVersions = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetKeyProviderSettings sets the KeyProviderSettings field's value.
|
|
func (s *HlsGroupSettings) SetKeyProviderSettings(v *KeyProviderSettings) *HlsGroupSettings {
|
|
s.KeyProviderSettings = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetManifestCompression sets the ManifestCompression field's value.
|
|
func (s *HlsGroupSettings) SetManifestCompression(v string) *HlsGroupSettings {
|
|
s.ManifestCompression = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetManifestDurationFormat sets the ManifestDurationFormat field's value.
|
|
func (s *HlsGroupSettings) SetManifestDurationFormat(v string) *HlsGroupSettings {
|
|
s.ManifestDurationFormat = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetMinSegmentLength sets the MinSegmentLength field's value.
|
|
func (s *HlsGroupSettings) SetMinSegmentLength(v int64) *HlsGroupSettings {
|
|
s.MinSegmentLength = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetMode sets the Mode field's value.
|
|
func (s *HlsGroupSettings) SetMode(v string) *HlsGroupSettings {
|
|
s.Mode = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetOutputSelection sets the OutputSelection field's value.
|
|
func (s *HlsGroupSettings) SetOutputSelection(v string) *HlsGroupSettings {
|
|
s.OutputSelection = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetProgramDateTime sets the ProgramDateTime field's value.
|
|
func (s *HlsGroupSettings) SetProgramDateTime(v string) *HlsGroupSettings {
|
|
s.ProgramDateTime = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetProgramDateTimePeriod sets the ProgramDateTimePeriod field's value.
|
|
func (s *HlsGroupSettings) SetProgramDateTimePeriod(v int64) *HlsGroupSettings {
|
|
s.ProgramDateTimePeriod = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetRedundantManifest sets the RedundantManifest field's value.
|
|
func (s *HlsGroupSettings) SetRedundantManifest(v string) *HlsGroupSettings {
|
|
s.RedundantManifest = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetSegmentLength sets the SegmentLength field's value.
|
|
func (s *HlsGroupSettings) SetSegmentLength(v int64) *HlsGroupSettings {
|
|
s.SegmentLength = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetSegmentationMode sets the SegmentationMode field's value.
|
|
func (s *HlsGroupSettings) SetSegmentationMode(v string) *HlsGroupSettings {
|
|
s.SegmentationMode = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetSegmentsPerSubdirectory sets the SegmentsPerSubdirectory field's value.
|
|
func (s *HlsGroupSettings) SetSegmentsPerSubdirectory(v int64) *HlsGroupSettings {
|
|
s.SegmentsPerSubdirectory = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetStreamInfResolution sets the StreamInfResolution field's value.
|
|
func (s *HlsGroupSettings) SetStreamInfResolution(v string) *HlsGroupSettings {
|
|
s.StreamInfResolution = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetTimedMetadataId3Frame sets the TimedMetadataId3Frame field's value.
|
|
func (s *HlsGroupSettings) SetTimedMetadataId3Frame(v string) *HlsGroupSettings {
|
|
s.TimedMetadataId3Frame = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetTimedMetadataId3Period sets the TimedMetadataId3Period field's value.
|
|
func (s *HlsGroupSettings) SetTimedMetadataId3Period(v int64) *HlsGroupSettings {
|
|
s.TimedMetadataId3Period = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetTimestampDeltaMilliseconds sets the TimestampDeltaMilliseconds field's value.
|
|
func (s *HlsGroupSettings) SetTimestampDeltaMilliseconds(v int64) *HlsGroupSettings {
|
|
s.TimestampDeltaMilliseconds = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetTsFileMode sets the TsFileMode field's value.
|
|
func (s *HlsGroupSettings) SetTsFileMode(v string) *HlsGroupSettings {
|
|
s.TsFileMode = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type HlsInputSettings struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// When specified the HLS stream with the m3u8 BANDWIDTH that most closely matches
|
|
// this value will be chosen, otherwise the highest bandwidth stream in the
|
|
// m3u8 will be chosen. The bitrate is specified in bits per second, as in an
|
|
// HLS manifest.
|
|
Bandwidth *int64 `locationName:"bandwidth" type:"integer"`
|
|
|
|
// When specified, reading of the HLS input will begin this many buffer segments
|
|
// from the end (most recently written segment). When not specified, the HLS
|
|
// input will begin with the first segment specified in the m3u8.
|
|
BufferSegments *int64 `locationName:"bufferSegments" type:"integer"`
|
|
|
|
// The number of consecutive times that attempts to read a manifest or segment
|
|
// must fail before the input is considered unavailable.
|
|
Retries *int64 `locationName:"retries" type:"integer"`
|
|
|
|
// The number of seconds between retries when an attempt to read a manifest
|
|
// or segment fails.
|
|
RetryInterval *int64 `locationName:"retryInterval" type:"integer"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s HlsInputSettings) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s HlsInputSettings) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetBandwidth sets the Bandwidth field's value.
|
|
func (s *HlsInputSettings) SetBandwidth(v int64) *HlsInputSettings {
|
|
s.Bandwidth = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetBufferSegments sets the BufferSegments field's value.
|
|
func (s *HlsInputSettings) SetBufferSegments(v int64) *HlsInputSettings {
|
|
s.BufferSegments = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetRetries sets the Retries field's value.
|
|
func (s *HlsInputSettings) SetRetries(v int64) *HlsInputSettings {
|
|
s.Retries = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetRetryInterval sets the RetryInterval field's value.
|
|
func (s *HlsInputSettings) SetRetryInterval(v int64) *HlsInputSettings {
|
|
s.RetryInterval = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type HlsMediaStoreSettings struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// Number of seconds to wait before retrying connection to the CDN if the connection
|
|
// is lost.
|
|
ConnectionRetryInterval *int64 `locationName:"connectionRetryInterval" type:"integer"`
|
|
|
|
// Size in seconds of file cache for streaming outputs.
|
|
FilecacheDuration *int64 `locationName:"filecacheDuration" type:"integer"`
|
|
|
|
// When set to temporal, output files are stored in non-persistent memory for
|
|
// faster reading and writing.
|
|
MediaStoreStorageClass *string `locationName:"mediaStoreStorageClass" type:"string" enum:"HlsMediaStoreStorageClass"`
|
|
|
|
// Number of retry attempts that will be made before the Live Event is put into
|
|
// an error state.
|
|
NumRetries *int64 `locationName:"numRetries" type:"integer"`
|
|
|
|
// If a streaming output fails, number of seconds to wait until a restart is
|
|
// initiated. A value of 0 means never restart.
|
|
RestartDelay *int64 `locationName:"restartDelay" type:"integer"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s HlsMediaStoreSettings) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s HlsMediaStoreSettings) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetConnectionRetryInterval sets the ConnectionRetryInterval field's value.
|
|
func (s *HlsMediaStoreSettings) SetConnectionRetryInterval(v int64) *HlsMediaStoreSettings {
|
|
s.ConnectionRetryInterval = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetFilecacheDuration sets the FilecacheDuration field's value.
|
|
func (s *HlsMediaStoreSettings) SetFilecacheDuration(v int64) *HlsMediaStoreSettings {
|
|
s.FilecacheDuration = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetMediaStoreStorageClass sets the MediaStoreStorageClass field's value.
|
|
func (s *HlsMediaStoreSettings) SetMediaStoreStorageClass(v string) *HlsMediaStoreSettings {
|
|
s.MediaStoreStorageClass = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetNumRetries sets the NumRetries field's value.
|
|
func (s *HlsMediaStoreSettings) SetNumRetries(v int64) *HlsMediaStoreSettings {
|
|
s.NumRetries = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetRestartDelay sets the RestartDelay field's value.
|
|
func (s *HlsMediaStoreSettings) SetRestartDelay(v int64) *HlsMediaStoreSettings {
|
|
s.RestartDelay = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type HlsOutputSettings struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// Settings regarding the underlying stream. These settings are different for
|
|
// audio-only outputs.
|
|
//
|
|
// HlsSettings is a required field
|
|
HlsSettings *HlsSettings `locationName:"hlsSettings" type:"structure" required:"true"`
|
|
|
|
// String concatenated to the end of the destination filename. Accepts \"Format
|
|
// Identifiers\":#formatIdentifierParameters.
|
|
NameModifier *string `locationName:"nameModifier" min:"1" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// String concatenated to end of segment filenames.
|
|
SegmentModifier *string `locationName:"segmentModifier" type:"string"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s HlsOutputSettings) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s HlsOutputSettings) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *HlsOutputSettings) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "HlsOutputSettings"}
|
|
if s.HlsSettings == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("HlsSettings"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.NameModifier != nil && len(*s.NameModifier) < 1 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("NameModifier", 1))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.HlsSettings != nil {
|
|
if err := s.HlsSettings.Validate(); err != nil {
|
|
invalidParams.AddNested("HlsSettings", err.(request.ErrInvalidParams))
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetHlsSettings sets the HlsSettings field's value.
|
|
func (s *HlsOutputSettings) SetHlsSettings(v *HlsSettings) *HlsOutputSettings {
|
|
s.HlsSettings = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetNameModifier sets the NameModifier field's value.
|
|
func (s *HlsOutputSettings) SetNameModifier(v string) *HlsOutputSettings {
|
|
s.NameModifier = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetSegmentModifier sets the SegmentModifier field's value.
|
|
func (s *HlsOutputSettings) SetSegmentModifier(v string) *HlsOutputSettings {
|
|
s.SegmentModifier = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type HlsSettings struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
AudioOnlyHlsSettings *AudioOnlyHlsSettings `locationName:"audioOnlyHlsSettings" type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
StandardHlsSettings *StandardHlsSettings `locationName:"standardHlsSettings" type:"structure"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s HlsSettings) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s HlsSettings) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *HlsSettings) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "HlsSettings"}
|
|
if s.AudioOnlyHlsSettings != nil {
|
|
if err := s.AudioOnlyHlsSettings.Validate(); err != nil {
|
|
invalidParams.AddNested("AudioOnlyHlsSettings", err.(request.ErrInvalidParams))
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
if s.StandardHlsSettings != nil {
|
|
if err := s.StandardHlsSettings.Validate(); err != nil {
|
|
invalidParams.AddNested("StandardHlsSettings", err.(request.ErrInvalidParams))
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetAudioOnlyHlsSettings sets the AudioOnlyHlsSettings field's value.
|
|
func (s *HlsSettings) SetAudioOnlyHlsSettings(v *AudioOnlyHlsSettings) *HlsSettings {
|
|
s.AudioOnlyHlsSettings = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetStandardHlsSettings sets the StandardHlsSettings field's value.
|
|
func (s *HlsSettings) SetStandardHlsSettings(v *StandardHlsSettings) *HlsSettings {
|
|
s.StandardHlsSettings = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Settings for the action to emit HLS metadata
|
|
type HlsTimedMetadataScheduleActionSettings struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// Base64 string formatted according to the ID3 specification: http://id3.org/id3v2.4.0-structure
|
|
//
|
|
// Id3 is a required field
|
|
Id3 *string `locationName:"id3" type:"string" required:"true"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s HlsTimedMetadataScheduleActionSettings) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s HlsTimedMetadataScheduleActionSettings) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *HlsTimedMetadataScheduleActionSettings) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "HlsTimedMetadataScheduleActionSettings"}
|
|
if s.Id3 == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("Id3"))
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetId3 sets the Id3 field's value.
|
|
func (s *HlsTimedMetadataScheduleActionSettings) SetId3(v string) *HlsTimedMetadataScheduleActionSettings {
|
|
s.Id3 = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type HlsWebdavSettings struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// Number of seconds to wait before retrying connection to the CDN if the connection
|
|
// is lost.
|
|
ConnectionRetryInterval *int64 `locationName:"connectionRetryInterval" type:"integer"`
|
|
|
|
// Size in seconds of file cache for streaming outputs.
|
|
FilecacheDuration *int64 `locationName:"filecacheDuration" type:"integer"`
|
|
|
|
// Specify whether or not to use chunked transfer encoding to WebDAV.
|
|
HttpTransferMode *string `locationName:"httpTransferMode" type:"string" enum:"HlsWebdavHttpTransferMode"`
|
|
|
|
// Number of retry attempts that will be made before the Live Event is put into
|
|
// an error state.
|
|
NumRetries *int64 `locationName:"numRetries" type:"integer"`
|
|
|
|
// If a streaming output fails, number of seconds to wait until a restart is
|
|
// initiated. A value of 0 means never restart.
|
|
RestartDelay *int64 `locationName:"restartDelay" type:"integer"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s HlsWebdavSettings) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s HlsWebdavSettings) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetConnectionRetryInterval sets the ConnectionRetryInterval field's value.
|
|
func (s *HlsWebdavSettings) SetConnectionRetryInterval(v int64) *HlsWebdavSettings {
|
|
s.ConnectionRetryInterval = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetFilecacheDuration sets the FilecacheDuration field's value.
|
|
func (s *HlsWebdavSettings) SetFilecacheDuration(v int64) *HlsWebdavSettings {
|
|
s.FilecacheDuration = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetHttpTransferMode sets the HttpTransferMode field's value.
|
|
func (s *HlsWebdavSettings) SetHttpTransferMode(v string) *HlsWebdavSettings {
|
|
s.HttpTransferMode = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetNumRetries sets the NumRetries field's value.
|
|
func (s *HlsWebdavSettings) SetNumRetries(v int64) *HlsWebdavSettings {
|
|
s.NumRetries = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetRestartDelay sets the RestartDelay field's value.
|
|
func (s *HlsWebdavSettings) SetRestartDelay(v int64) *HlsWebdavSettings {
|
|
s.RestartDelay = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type Input struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// The Unique ARN of the input (generated, immutable).
|
|
Arn *string `locationName:"arn" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// A list of channel IDs that that input is attached to (currently an input
|
|
// can only be attached to one channel).
|
|
AttachedChannels []*string `locationName:"attachedChannels" type:"list"`
|
|
|
|
// A list of the destinations of the input (PUSH-type).
|
|
Destinations []*InputDestination `locationName:"destinations" type:"list"`
|
|
|
|
// The generated ID of the input (unique for user account, immutable).
|
|
Id *string `locationName:"id" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// A list of MediaConnect Flows for this input.
|
|
MediaConnectFlows []*MediaConnectFlow `locationName:"mediaConnectFlows" type:"list"`
|
|
|
|
// The user-assigned name (This is a mutable value).
|
|
Name *string `locationName:"name" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// The Amazon Resource Name (ARN) of the role this input assumes during and
|
|
// after creation.
|
|
RoleArn *string `locationName:"roleArn" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// A list of IDs for all the security groups attached to the input.
|
|
SecurityGroups []*string `locationName:"securityGroups" type:"list"`
|
|
|
|
// A list of the sources of the input (PULL-type).
|
|
Sources []*InputSource `locationName:"sources" type:"list"`
|
|
|
|
State *string `locationName:"state" type:"string" enum:"InputState"`
|
|
|
|
Type *string `locationName:"type" type:"string" enum:"InputType"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s Input) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s Input) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetArn sets the Arn field's value.
|
|
func (s *Input) SetArn(v string) *Input {
|
|
s.Arn = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetAttachedChannels sets the AttachedChannels field's value.
|
|
func (s *Input) SetAttachedChannels(v []*string) *Input {
|
|
s.AttachedChannels = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetDestinations sets the Destinations field's value.
|
|
func (s *Input) SetDestinations(v []*InputDestination) *Input {
|
|
s.Destinations = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetId sets the Id field's value.
|
|
func (s *Input) SetId(v string) *Input {
|
|
s.Id = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetMediaConnectFlows sets the MediaConnectFlows field's value.
|
|
func (s *Input) SetMediaConnectFlows(v []*MediaConnectFlow) *Input {
|
|
s.MediaConnectFlows = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetName sets the Name field's value.
|
|
func (s *Input) SetName(v string) *Input {
|
|
s.Name = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetRoleArn sets the RoleArn field's value.
|
|
func (s *Input) SetRoleArn(v string) *Input {
|
|
s.RoleArn = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetSecurityGroups sets the SecurityGroups field's value.
|
|
func (s *Input) SetSecurityGroups(v []*string) *Input {
|
|
s.SecurityGroups = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetSources sets the Sources field's value.
|
|
func (s *Input) SetSources(v []*InputSource) *Input {
|
|
s.Sources = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetState sets the State field's value.
|
|
func (s *Input) SetState(v string) *Input {
|
|
s.State = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetType sets the Type field's value.
|
|
func (s *Input) SetType(v string) *Input {
|
|
s.Type = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type InputAttachment struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// User-specified name for the attachment. This is required if the user wants
|
|
// to use this input in an input switch action.
|
|
InputAttachmentName *string `locationName:"inputAttachmentName" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// The ID of the input
|
|
InputId *string `locationName:"inputId" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// Settings of an input (caption selector, etc.)
|
|
InputSettings *InputSettings `locationName:"inputSettings" type:"structure"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s InputAttachment) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s InputAttachment) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *InputAttachment) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "InputAttachment"}
|
|
if s.InputSettings != nil {
|
|
if err := s.InputSettings.Validate(); err != nil {
|
|
invalidParams.AddNested("InputSettings", err.(request.ErrInvalidParams))
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetInputAttachmentName sets the InputAttachmentName field's value.
|
|
func (s *InputAttachment) SetInputAttachmentName(v string) *InputAttachment {
|
|
s.InputAttachmentName = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetInputId sets the InputId field's value.
|
|
func (s *InputAttachment) SetInputId(v string) *InputAttachment {
|
|
s.InputId = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetInputSettings sets the InputSettings field's value.
|
|
func (s *InputAttachment) SetInputSettings(v *InputSettings) *InputAttachment {
|
|
s.InputSettings = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type InputChannelLevel struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// Remixing value. Units are in dB and acceptable values are within the range
|
|
// from -60 (mute) and 6 dB.
|
|
//
|
|
// Gain is a required field
|
|
Gain *int64 `locationName:"gain" type:"integer" required:"true"`
|
|
|
|
// The index of the input channel used as a source.
|
|
//
|
|
// InputChannel is a required field
|
|
InputChannel *int64 `locationName:"inputChannel" type:"integer" required:"true"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s InputChannelLevel) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s InputChannelLevel) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *InputChannelLevel) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "InputChannelLevel"}
|
|
if s.Gain == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("Gain"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.Gain != nil && *s.Gain < -60 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinValue("Gain", -60))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.InputChannel == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("InputChannel"))
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetGain sets the Gain field's value.
|
|
func (s *InputChannelLevel) SetGain(v int64) *InputChannelLevel {
|
|
s.Gain = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetInputChannel sets the InputChannel field's value.
|
|
func (s *InputChannelLevel) SetInputChannel(v int64) *InputChannelLevel {
|
|
s.InputChannel = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// The settings for a PUSH type input.
|
|
type InputDestination struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// The system-generated static IP address of endpoint.It remains fixed for the
|
|
// lifetime of the input.
|
|
Ip *string `locationName:"ip" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// The port number for the input.
|
|
Port *string `locationName:"port" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// This represents the endpoint that the customer stream will bepushed to.
|
|
Url *string `locationName:"url" type:"string"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s InputDestination) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s InputDestination) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetIp sets the Ip field's value.
|
|
func (s *InputDestination) SetIp(v string) *InputDestination {
|
|
s.Ip = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetPort sets the Port field's value.
|
|
func (s *InputDestination) SetPort(v string) *InputDestination {
|
|
s.Port = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetUrl sets the Url field's value.
|
|
func (s *InputDestination) SetUrl(v string) *InputDestination {
|
|
s.Url = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Endpoint settings for a PUSH type input.
|
|
type InputDestinationRequest struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// A unique name for the location the RTMP stream is being pushedto.
|
|
StreamName *string `locationName:"streamName" type:"string"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s InputDestinationRequest) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s InputDestinationRequest) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetStreamName sets the StreamName field's value.
|
|
func (s *InputDestinationRequest) SetStreamName(v string) *InputDestinationRequest {
|
|
s.StreamName = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type InputLocation struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// key used to extract the password from EC2 Parameter store
|
|
PasswordParam *string `locationName:"passwordParam" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// Uniform Resource Identifier - This should be a path to a file accessible
|
|
// to the Live system (eg. a http:// URI) depending on the output type. For
|
|
// example, a RTMP destination should have a uri simliar to: "rtmp://fmsserver/live".
|
|
//
|
|
// Uri is a required field
|
|
Uri *string `locationName:"uri" type:"string" required:"true"`
|
|
|
|
// Username if credentials are required to access a file or publishing point.
|
|
// This can be either a plaintext username, or a reference to an AWS parameter
|
|
// store name from which the username can be retrieved. AWS Parameter store
|
|
// format: "ssm://"
|
|
Username *string `locationName:"username" type:"string"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s InputLocation) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s InputLocation) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *InputLocation) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "InputLocation"}
|
|
if s.Uri == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("Uri"))
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetPasswordParam sets the PasswordParam field's value.
|
|
func (s *InputLocation) SetPasswordParam(v string) *InputLocation {
|
|
s.PasswordParam = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetUri sets the Uri field's value.
|
|
func (s *InputLocation) SetUri(v string) *InputLocation {
|
|
s.Uri = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetUsername sets the Username field's value.
|
|
func (s *InputLocation) SetUsername(v string) *InputLocation {
|
|
s.Username = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type InputLossBehavior struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// On input loss, the number of milliseconds to substitute black into the output
|
|
// before switching to the frame specified by inputLossImageType. A value x,
|
|
// where 0 <= x <= 1,000,000 and a value of 1,000,000 will be interpreted as
|
|
// infinite.
|
|
BlackFrameMsec *int64 `locationName:"blackFrameMsec" type:"integer"`
|
|
|
|
// When input loss image type is "color" this field specifies the color to use.
|
|
// Value: 6 hex characters representing the values of RGB.
|
|
InputLossImageColor *string `locationName:"inputLossImageColor" min:"6" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// When input loss image type is "slate" these fields specify the parameters
|
|
// for accessing the slate.
|
|
InputLossImageSlate *InputLocation `locationName:"inputLossImageSlate" type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// Indicates whether to substitute a solid color or a slate into the output
|
|
// after input loss exceeds blackFrameMsec.
|
|
InputLossImageType *string `locationName:"inputLossImageType" type:"string" enum:"InputLossImageType"`
|
|
|
|
// On input loss, the number of milliseconds to repeat the previous picture
|
|
// before substituting black into the output. A value x, where 0 <= x <= 1,000,000
|
|
// and a value of 1,000,000 will be interpreted as infinite.
|
|
RepeatFrameMsec *int64 `locationName:"repeatFrameMsec" type:"integer"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s InputLossBehavior) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s InputLossBehavior) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *InputLossBehavior) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "InputLossBehavior"}
|
|
if s.InputLossImageColor != nil && len(*s.InputLossImageColor) < 6 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("InputLossImageColor", 6))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.InputLossImageSlate != nil {
|
|
if err := s.InputLossImageSlate.Validate(); err != nil {
|
|
invalidParams.AddNested("InputLossImageSlate", err.(request.ErrInvalidParams))
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetBlackFrameMsec sets the BlackFrameMsec field's value.
|
|
func (s *InputLossBehavior) SetBlackFrameMsec(v int64) *InputLossBehavior {
|
|
s.BlackFrameMsec = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetInputLossImageColor sets the InputLossImageColor field's value.
|
|
func (s *InputLossBehavior) SetInputLossImageColor(v string) *InputLossBehavior {
|
|
s.InputLossImageColor = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetInputLossImageSlate sets the InputLossImageSlate field's value.
|
|
func (s *InputLossBehavior) SetInputLossImageSlate(v *InputLocation) *InputLossBehavior {
|
|
s.InputLossImageSlate = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetInputLossImageType sets the InputLossImageType field's value.
|
|
func (s *InputLossBehavior) SetInputLossImageType(v string) *InputLossBehavior {
|
|
s.InputLossImageType = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetRepeatFrameMsec sets the RepeatFrameMsec field's value.
|
|
func (s *InputLossBehavior) SetRepeatFrameMsec(v int64) *InputLossBehavior {
|
|
s.RepeatFrameMsec = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// An Input Security Group
|
|
type InputSecurityGroup struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// Unique ARN of Input Security Group
|
|
Arn *string `locationName:"arn" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// The Id of the Input Security Group
|
|
Id *string `locationName:"id" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// The list of inputs currently using this Input Security Group.
|
|
Inputs []*string `locationName:"inputs" type:"list"`
|
|
|
|
// The current state of the Input Security Group.
|
|
State *string `locationName:"state" type:"string" enum:"InputSecurityGroupState"`
|
|
|
|
// Whitelist rules and their sync status
|
|
WhitelistRules []*InputWhitelistRule `locationName:"whitelistRules" type:"list"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s InputSecurityGroup) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s InputSecurityGroup) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetArn sets the Arn field's value.
|
|
func (s *InputSecurityGroup) SetArn(v string) *InputSecurityGroup {
|
|
s.Arn = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetId sets the Id field's value.
|
|
func (s *InputSecurityGroup) SetId(v string) *InputSecurityGroup {
|
|
s.Id = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetInputs sets the Inputs field's value.
|
|
func (s *InputSecurityGroup) SetInputs(v []*string) *InputSecurityGroup {
|
|
s.Inputs = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetState sets the State field's value.
|
|
func (s *InputSecurityGroup) SetState(v string) *InputSecurityGroup {
|
|
s.State = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetWhitelistRules sets the WhitelistRules field's value.
|
|
func (s *InputSecurityGroup) SetWhitelistRules(v []*InputWhitelistRule) *InputSecurityGroup {
|
|
s.WhitelistRules = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Live Event input parameters. There can be multiple inputs in a single Live
|
|
// Event.
|
|
type InputSettings struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// Used to select the audio stream to decode for inputs that have multiple available.
|
|
AudioSelectors []*AudioSelector `locationName:"audioSelectors" type:"list"`
|
|
|
|
// Used to select the caption input to use for inputs that have multiple available.
|
|
CaptionSelectors []*CaptionSelector `locationName:"captionSelectors" type:"list"`
|
|
|
|
// Enable or disable the deblock filter when filtering.
|
|
DeblockFilter *string `locationName:"deblockFilter" type:"string" enum:"InputDeblockFilter"`
|
|
|
|
// Enable or disable the denoise filter when filtering.
|
|
DenoiseFilter *string `locationName:"denoiseFilter" type:"string" enum:"InputDenoiseFilter"`
|
|
|
|
// Adjusts the magnitude of filtering from 1 (minimal) to 5 (strongest).
|
|
FilterStrength *int64 `locationName:"filterStrength" min:"1" type:"integer"`
|
|
|
|
// Turns on the filter for this input. MPEG-2 inputs have the deblocking filter
|
|
// enabled by default.1) auto - filtering will be applied depending on input
|
|
// type/quality2) disabled - no filtering will be applied to the input3) forced
|
|
// - filtering will be applied regardless of input type
|
|
InputFilter *string `locationName:"inputFilter" type:"string" enum:"InputFilter"`
|
|
|
|
// Input settings.
|
|
NetworkInputSettings *NetworkInputSettings `locationName:"networkInputSettings" type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// Loop input if it is a file. This allows a file input to be streamed indefinitely.
|
|
SourceEndBehavior *string `locationName:"sourceEndBehavior" type:"string" enum:"InputSourceEndBehavior"`
|
|
|
|
// Informs which video elementary stream to decode for input types that have
|
|
// multiple available.
|
|
VideoSelector *VideoSelector `locationName:"videoSelector" type:"structure"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s InputSettings) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s InputSettings) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *InputSettings) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "InputSettings"}
|
|
if s.FilterStrength != nil && *s.FilterStrength < 1 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinValue("FilterStrength", 1))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.AudioSelectors != nil {
|
|
for i, v := range s.AudioSelectors {
|
|
if v == nil {
|
|
continue
|
|
}
|
|
if err := v.Validate(); err != nil {
|
|
invalidParams.AddNested(fmt.Sprintf("%s[%v]", "AudioSelectors", i), err.(request.ErrInvalidParams))
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
if s.CaptionSelectors != nil {
|
|
for i, v := range s.CaptionSelectors {
|
|
if v == nil {
|
|
continue
|
|
}
|
|
if err := v.Validate(); err != nil {
|
|
invalidParams.AddNested(fmt.Sprintf("%s[%v]", "CaptionSelectors", i), err.(request.ErrInvalidParams))
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetAudioSelectors sets the AudioSelectors field's value.
|
|
func (s *InputSettings) SetAudioSelectors(v []*AudioSelector) *InputSettings {
|
|
s.AudioSelectors = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetCaptionSelectors sets the CaptionSelectors field's value.
|
|
func (s *InputSettings) SetCaptionSelectors(v []*CaptionSelector) *InputSettings {
|
|
s.CaptionSelectors = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetDeblockFilter sets the DeblockFilter field's value.
|
|
func (s *InputSettings) SetDeblockFilter(v string) *InputSettings {
|
|
s.DeblockFilter = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetDenoiseFilter sets the DenoiseFilter field's value.
|
|
func (s *InputSettings) SetDenoiseFilter(v string) *InputSettings {
|
|
s.DenoiseFilter = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetFilterStrength sets the FilterStrength field's value.
|
|
func (s *InputSettings) SetFilterStrength(v int64) *InputSettings {
|
|
s.FilterStrength = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetInputFilter sets the InputFilter field's value.
|
|
func (s *InputSettings) SetInputFilter(v string) *InputSettings {
|
|
s.InputFilter = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetNetworkInputSettings sets the NetworkInputSettings field's value.
|
|
func (s *InputSettings) SetNetworkInputSettings(v *NetworkInputSettings) *InputSettings {
|
|
s.NetworkInputSettings = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetSourceEndBehavior sets the SourceEndBehavior field's value.
|
|
func (s *InputSettings) SetSourceEndBehavior(v string) *InputSettings {
|
|
s.SourceEndBehavior = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetVideoSelector sets the VideoSelector field's value.
|
|
func (s *InputSettings) SetVideoSelector(v *VideoSelector) *InputSettings {
|
|
s.VideoSelector = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// The settings for a PULL type input.
|
|
type InputSource struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// The key used to extract the password from EC2 Parameter store.
|
|
PasswordParam *string `locationName:"passwordParam" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// This represents the customer's source URL where stream ispulled from.
|
|
Url *string `locationName:"url" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// The username for the input source.
|
|
Username *string `locationName:"username" type:"string"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s InputSource) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s InputSource) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetPasswordParam sets the PasswordParam field's value.
|
|
func (s *InputSource) SetPasswordParam(v string) *InputSource {
|
|
s.PasswordParam = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetUrl sets the Url field's value.
|
|
func (s *InputSource) SetUrl(v string) *InputSource {
|
|
s.Url = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetUsername sets the Username field's value.
|
|
func (s *InputSource) SetUsername(v string) *InputSource {
|
|
s.Username = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Settings for for a PULL type input.
|
|
type InputSourceRequest struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// The key used to extract the password from EC2 Parameter store.
|
|
PasswordParam *string `locationName:"passwordParam" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// This represents the customer's source URL where stream ispulled from.
|
|
Url *string `locationName:"url" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// The username for the input source.
|
|
Username *string `locationName:"username" type:"string"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s InputSourceRequest) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s InputSourceRequest) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetPasswordParam sets the PasswordParam field's value.
|
|
func (s *InputSourceRequest) SetPasswordParam(v string) *InputSourceRequest {
|
|
s.PasswordParam = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetUrl sets the Url field's value.
|
|
func (s *InputSourceRequest) SetUrl(v string) *InputSourceRequest {
|
|
s.Url = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetUsername sets the Username field's value.
|
|
func (s *InputSourceRequest) SetUsername(v string) *InputSourceRequest {
|
|
s.Username = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type InputSpecification struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// Input codec
|
|
Codec *string `locationName:"codec" type:"string" enum:"InputCodec"`
|
|
|
|
// Maximum input bitrate, categorized coarsely
|
|
MaximumBitrate *string `locationName:"maximumBitrate" type:"string" enum:"InputMaximumBitrate"`
|
|
|
|
// Input resolution, categorized coarsely
|
|
Resolution *string `locationName:"resolution" type:"string" enum:"InputResolution"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s InputSpecification) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s InputSpecification) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetCodec sets the Codec field's value.
|
|
func (s *InputSpecification) SetCodec(v string) *InputSpecification {
|
|
s.Codec = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetMaximumBitrate sets the MaximumBitrate field's value.
|
|
func (s *InputSpecification) SetMaximumBitrate(v string) *InputSpecification {
|
|
s.MaximumBitrate = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetResolution sets the Resolution field's value.
|
|
func (s *InputSpecification) SetResolution(v string) *InputSpecification {
|
|
s.Resolution = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Settings for the action to switch an input.
|
|
type InputSwitchScheduleActionSettings struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// The name of the input attachment that should be switched to by this action.
|
|
//
|
|
// InputAttachmentNameReference is a required field
|
|
InputAttachmentNameReference *string `locationName:"inputAttachmentNameReference" type:"string" required:"true"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s InputSwitchScheduleActionSettings) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s InputSwitchScheduleActionSettings) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *InputSwitchScheduleActionSettings) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "InputSwitchScheduleActionSettings"}
|
|
if s.InputAttachmentNameReference == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("InputAttachmentNameReference"))
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetInputAttachmentNameReference sets the InputAttachmentNameReference field's value.
|
|
func (s *InputSwitchScheduleActionSettings) SetInputAttachmentNameReference(v string) *InputSwitchScheduleActionSettings {
|
|
s.InputAttachmentNameReference = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Whitelist rule
|
|
type InputWhitelistRule struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// The IPv4 CIDR that's whitelisted.
|
|
Cidr *string `locationName:"cidr" type:"string"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s InputWhitelistRule) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s InputWhitelistRule) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetCidr sets the Cidr field's value.
|
|
func (s *InputWhitelistRule) SetCidr(v string) *InputWhitelistRule {
|
|
s.Cidr = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// An IPv4 CIDR to whitelist.
|
|
type InputWhitelistRuleCidr struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// The IPv4 CIDR to whitelist.
|
|
Cidr *string `locationName:"cidr" type:"string"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s InputWhitelistRuleCidr) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s InputWhitelistRuleCidr) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetCidr sets the Cidr field's value.
|
|
func (s *InputWhitelistRuleCidr) SetCidr(v string) *InputWhitelistRuleCidr {
|
|
s.Cidr = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type KeyProviderSettings struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
StaticKeySettings *StaticKeySettings `locationName:"staticKeySettings" type:"structure"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s KeyProviderSettings) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s KeyProviderSettings) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *KeyProviderSettings) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "KeyProviderSettings"}
|
|
if s.StaticKeySettings != nil {
|
|
if err := s.StaticKeySettings.Validate(); err != nil {
|
|
invalidParams.AddNested("StaticKeySettings", err.(request.ErrInvalidParams))
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetStaticKeySettings sets the StaticKeySettings field's value.
|
|
func (s *KeyProviderSettings) SetStaticKeySettings(v *StaticKeySettings) *KeyProviderSettings {
|
|
s.StaticKeySettings = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type ListChannelsInput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
MaxResults *int64 `location:"querystring" locationName:"maxResults" min:"1" type:"integer"`
|
|
|
|
NextToken *string `location:"querystring" locationName:"nextToken" type:"string"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s ListChannelsInput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s ListChannelsInput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *ListChannelsInput) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "ListChannelsInput"}
|
|
if s.MaxResults != nil && *s.MaxResults < 1 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinValue("MaxResults", 1))
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetMaxResults sets the MaxResults field's value.
|
|
func (s *ListChannelsInput) SetMaxResults(v int64) *ListChannelsInput {
|
|
s.MaxResults = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetNextToken sets the NextToken field's value.
|
|
func (s *ListChannelsInput) SetNextToken(v string) *ListChannelsInput {
|
|
s.NextToken = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type ListChannelsOutput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
Channels []*ChannelSummary `locationName:"channels" type:"list"`
|
|
|
|
NextToken *string `locationName:"nextToken" type:"string"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s ListChannelsOutput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s ListChannelsOutput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetChannels sets the Channels field's value.
|
|
func (s *ListChannelsOutput) SetChannels(v []*ChannelSummary) *ListChannelsOutput {
|
|
s.Channels = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetNextToken sets the NextToken field's value.
|
|
func (s *ListChannelsOutput) SetNextToken(v string) *ListChannelsOutput {
|
|
s.NextToken = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type ListInputSecurityGroupsInput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
MaxResults *int64 `location:"querystring" locationName:"maxResults" min:"1" type:"integer"`
|
|
|
|
NextToken *string `location:"querystring" locationName:"nextToken" type:"string"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s ListInputSecurityGroupsInput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s ListInputSecurityGroupsInput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *ListInputSecurityGroupsInput) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "ListInputSecurityGroupsInput"}
|
|
if s.MaxResults != nil && *s.MaxResults < 1 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinValue("MaxResults", 1))
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetMaxResults sets the MaxResults field's value.
|
|
func (s *ListInputSecurityGroupsInput) SetMaxResults(v int64) *ListInputSecurityGroupsInput {
|
|
s.MaxResults = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetNextToken sets the NextToken field's value.
|
|
func (s *ListInputSecurityGroupsInput) SetNextToken(v string) *ListInputSecurityGroupsInput {
|
|
s.NextToken = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type ListInputSecurityGroupsOutput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
InputSecurityGroups []*InputSecurityGroup `locationName:"inputSecurityGroups" type:"list"`
|
|
|
|
NextToken *string `locationName:"nextToken" type:"string"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s ListInputSecurityGroupsOutput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s ListInputSecurityGroupsOutput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetInputSecurityGroups sets the InputSecurityGroups field's value.
|
|
func (s *ListInputSecurityGroupsOutput) SetInputSecurityGroups(v []*InputSecurityGroup) *ListInputSecurityGroupsOutput {
|
|
s.InputSecurityGroups = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetNextToken sets the NextToken field's value.
|
|
func (s *ListInputSecurityGroupsOutput) SetNextToken(v string) *ListInputSecurityGroupsOutput {
|
|
s.NextToken = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type ListInputsInput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
MaxResults *int64 `location:"querystring" locationName:"maxResults" min:"1" type:"integer"`
|
|
|
|
NextToken *string `location:"querystring" locationName:"nextToken" type:"string"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s ListInputsInput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s ListInputsInput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *ListInputsInput) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "ListInputsInput"}
|
|
if s.MaxResults != nil && *s.MaxResults < 1 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinValue("MaxResults", 1))
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetMaxResults sets the MaxResults field's value.
|
|
func (s *ListInputsInput) SetMaxResults(v int64) *ListInputsInput {
|
|
s.MaxResults = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetNextToken sets the NextToken field's value.
|
|
func (s *ListInputsInput) SetNextToken(v string) *ListInputsInput {
|
|
s.NextToken = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type ListInputsOutput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
Inputs []*Input `locationName:"inputs" type:"list"`
|
|
|
|
NextToken *string `locationName:"nextToken" type:"string"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s ListInputsOutput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s ListInputsOutput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetInputs sets the Inputs field's value.
|
|
func (s *ListInputsOutput) SetInputs(v []*Input) *ListInputsOutput {
|
|
s.Inputs = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetNextToken sets the NextToken field's value.
|
|
func (s *ListInputsOutput) SetNextToken(v string) *ListInputsOutput {
|
|
s.NextToken = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type ListOfferingsInput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
ChannelConfiguration *string `location:"querystring" locationName:"channelConfiguration" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
Codec *string `location:"querystring" locationName:"codec" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
MaxResults *int64 `location:"querystring" locationName:"maxResults" min:"1" type:"integer"`
|
|
|
|
MaximumBitrate *string `location:"querystring" locationName:"maximumBitrate" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
MaximumFramerate *string `location:"querystring" locationName:"maximumFramerate" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
NextToken *string `location:"querystring" locationName:"nextToken" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
Resolution *string `location:"querystring" locationName:"resolution" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
ResourceType *string `location:"querystring" locationName:"resourceType" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
SpecialFeature *string `location:"querystring" locationName:"specialFeature" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
VideoQuality *string `location:"querystring" locationName:"videoQuality" type:"string"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s ListOfferingsInput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s ListOfferingsInput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *ListOfferingsInput) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "ListOfferingsInput"}
|
|
if s.MaxResults != nil && *s.MaxResults < 1 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinValue("MaxResults", 1))
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetChannelConfiguration sets the ChannelConfiguration field's value.
|
|
func (s *ListOfferingsInput) SetChannelConfiguration(v string) *ListOfferingsInput {
|
|
s.ChannelConfiguration = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetCodec sets the Codec field's value.
|
|
func (s *ListOfferingsInput) SetCodec(v string) *ListOfferingsInput {
|
|
s.Codec = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetMaxResults sets the MaxResults field's value.
|
|
func (s *ListOfferingsInput) SetMaxResults(v int64) *ListOfferingsInput {
|
|
s.MaxResults = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetMaximumBitrate sets the MaximumBitrate field's value.
|
|
func (s *ListOfferingsInput) SetMaximumBitrate(v string) *ListOfferingsInput {
|
|
s.MaximumBitrate = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetMaximumFramerate sets the MaximumFramerate field's value.
|
|
func (s *ListOfferingsInput) SetMaximumFramerate(v string) *ListOfferingsInput {
|
|
s.MaximumFramerate = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetNextToken sets the NextToken field's value.
|
|
func (s *ListOfferingsInput) SetNextToken(v string) *ListOfferingsInput {
|
|
s.NextToken = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetResolution sets the Resolution field's value.
|
|
func (s *ListOfferingsInput) SetResolution(v string) *ListOfferingsInput {
|
|
s.Resolution = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetResourceType sets the ResourceType field's value.
|
|
func (s *ListOfferingsInput) SetResourceType(v string) *ListOfferingsInput {
|
|
s.ResourceType = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetSpecialFeature sets the SpecialFeature field's value.
|
|
func (s *ListOfferingsInput) SetSpecialFeature(v string) *ListOfferingsInput {
|
|
s.SpecialFeature = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetVideoQuality sets the VideoQuality field's value.
|
|
func (s *ListOfferingsInput) SetVideoQuality(v string) *ListOfferingsInput {
|
|
s.VideoQuality = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type ListOfferingsOutput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
NextToken *string `locationName:"nextToken" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
Offerings []*Offering `locationName:"offerings" type:"list"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s ListOfferingsOutput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s ListOfferingsOutput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetNextToken sets the NextToken field's value.
|
|
func (s *ListOfferingsOutput) SetNextToken(v string) *ListOfferingsOutput {
|
|
s.NextToken = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetOfferings sets the Offerings field's value.
|
|
func (s *ListOfferingsOutput) SetOfferings(v []*Offering) *ListOfferingsOutput {
|
|
s.Offerings = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type ListReservationsInput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
Codec *string `location:"querystring" locationName:"codec" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
MaxResults *int64 `location:"querystring" locationName:"maxResults" min:"1" type:"integer"`
|
|
|
|
MaximumBitrate *string `location:"querystring" locationName:"maximumBitrate" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
MaximumFramerate *string `location:"querystring" locationName:"maximumFramerate" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
NextToken *string `location:"querystring" locationName:"nextToken" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
Resolution *string `location:"querystring" locationName:"resolution" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
ResourceType *string `location:"querystring" locationName:"resourceType" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
SpecialFeature *string `location:"querystring" locationName:"specialFeature" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
VideoQuality *string `location:"querystring" locationName:"videoQuality" type:"string"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s ListReservationsInput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s ListReservationsInput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *ListReservationsInput) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "ListReservationsInput"}
|
|
if s.MaxResults != nil && *s.MaxResults < 1 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinValue("MaxResults", 1))
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetCodec sets the Codec field's value.
|
|
func (s *ListReservationsInput) SetCodec(v string) *ListReservationsInput {
|
|
s.Codec = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetMaxResults sets the MaxResults field's value.
|
|
func (s *ListReservationsInput) SetMaxResults(v int64) *ListReservationsInput {
|
|
s.MaxResults = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetMaximumBitrate sets the MaximumBitrate field's value.
|
|
func (s *ListReservationsInput) SetMaximumBitrate(v string) *ListReservationsInput {
|
|
s.MaximumBitrate = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetMaximumFramerate sets the MaximumFramerate field's value.
|
|
func (s *ListReservationsInput) SetMaximumFramerate(v string) *ListReservationsInput {
|
|
s.MaximumFramerate = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetNextToken sets the NextToken field's value.
|
|
func (s *ListReservationsInput) SetNextToken(v string) *ListReservationsInput {
|
|
s.NextToken = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetResolution sets the Resolution field's value.
|
|
func (s *ListReservationsInput) SetResolution(v string) *ListReservationsInput {
|
|
s.Resolution = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetResourceType sets the ResourceType field's value.
|
|
func (s *ListReservationsInput) SetResourceType(v string) *ListReservationsInput {
|
|
s.ResourceType = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetSpecialFeature sets the SpecialFeature field's value.
|
|
func (s *ListReservationsInput) SetSpecialFeature(v string) *ListReservationsInput {
|
|
s.SpecialFeature = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetVideoQuality sets the VideoQuality field's value.
|
|
func (s *ListReservationsInput) SetVideoQuality(v string) *ListReservationsInput {
|
|
s.VideoQuality = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type ListReservationsOutput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
NextToken *string `locationName:"nextToken" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
Reservations []*Reservation `locationName:"reservations" type:"list"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s ListReservationsOutput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s ListReservationsOutput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetNextToken sets the NextToken field's value.
|
|
func (s *ListReservationsOutput) SetNextToken(v string) *ListReservationsOutput {
|
|
s.NextToken = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetReservations sets the Reservations field's value.
|
|
func (s *ListReservationsOutput) SetReservations(v []*Reservation) *ListReservationsOutput {
|
|
s.Reservations = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type M2tsSettings struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// When set to drop, output audio streams will be removed from the program if
|
|
// the selected input audio stream is removed from the input. This allows the
|
|
// output audio configuration to dynamically change based on input configuration.
|
|
// If this is set to encodeSilence, all output audio streams will output encoded
|
|
// silence when not connected to an active input stream.
|
|
AbsentInputAudioBehavior *string `locationName:"absentInputAudioBehavior" type:"string" enum:"M2tsAbsentInputAudioBehavior"`
|
|
|
|
// When set to enabled, uses ARIB-compliant field muxing and removes video descriptor.
|
|
Arib *string `locationName:"arib" type:"string" enum:"M2tsArib"`
|
|
|
|
// Packet Identifier (PID) for ARIB Captions in the transport stream. Can be
|
|
// entered as a decimal or hexadecimal value. Valid values are 32 (or 0x20)..8182
|
|
// (or 0x1ff6).
|
|
AribCaptionsPid *string `locationName:"aribCaptionsPid" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// If set to auto, pid number used for ARIB Captions will be auto-selected from
|
|
// unused pids. If set to useConfigured, ARIB Captions will be on the configured
|
|
// pid number.
|
|
AribCaptionsPidControl *string `locationName:"aribCaptionsPidControl" type:"string" enum:"M2tsAribCaptionsPidControl"`
|
|
|
|
// When set to dvb, uses DVB buffer model for Dolby Digital audio. When set
|
|
// to atsc, the ATSC model is used.
|
|
AudioBufferModel *string `locationName:"audioBufferModel" type:"string" enum:"M2tsAudioBufferModel"`
|
|
|
|
// The number of audio frames to insert for each PES packet.
|
|
AudioFramesPerPes *int64 `locationName:"audioFramesPerPes" type:"integer"`
|
|
|
|
// Packet Identifier (PID) of the elementary audio stream(s) in the transport
|
|
// stream. Multiple values are accepted, and can be entered in ranges and/or
|
|
// by comma separation. Can be entered as decimal or hexadecimal values. Each
|
|
// PID specified must be in the range of 32 (or 0x20)..8182 (or 0x1ff6).
|
|
AudioPids *string `locationName:"audioPids" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// When set to atsc, uses stream type = 0x81 for AC3 and stream type = 0x87
|
|
// for EAC3. When set to dvb, uses stream type = 0x06.
|
|
AudioStreamType *string `locationName:"audioStreamType" type:"string" enum:"M2tsAudioStreamType"`
|
|
|
|
// The output bitrate of the transport stream in bits per second. Setting to
|
|
// 0 lets the muxer automatically determine the appropriate bitrate.
|
|
Bitrate *int64 `locationName:"bitrate" type:"integer"`
|
|
|
|
// If set to multiplex, use multiplex buffer model for accurate interleaving.
|
|
// Setting to bufferModel to none can lead to lower latency, but low-memory
|
|
// devices may not be able to play back the stream without interruptions.
|
|
BufferModel *string `locationName:"bufferModel" type:"string" enum:"M2tsBufferModel"`
|
|
|
|
// When set to enabled, generates captionServiceDescriptor in PMT.
|
|
CcDescriptor *string `locationName:"ccDescriptor" type:"string" enum:"M2tsCcDescriptor"`
|
|
|
|
// Inserts DVB Network Information Table (NIT) at the specified table repetition
|
|
// interval.
|
|
DvbNitSettings *DvbNitSettings `locationName:"dvbNitSettings" type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// Inserts DVB Service Description Table (SDT) at the specified table repetition
|
|
// interval.
|
|
DvbSdtSettings *DvbSdtSettings `locationName:"dvbSdtSettings" type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// Packet Identifier (PID) for input source DVB Subtitle data to this output.
|
|
// Multiple values are accepted, and can be entered in ranges and/or by comma
|
|
// separation. Can be entered as decimal or hexadecimal values. Each PID specified
|
|
// must be in the range of 32 (or 0x20)..8182 (or 0x1ff6).
|
|
DvbSubPids *string `locationName:"dvbSubPids" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// Inserts DVB Time and Date Table (TDT) at the specified table repetition interval.
|
|
DvbTdtSettings *DvbTdtSettings `locationName:"dvbTdtSettings" type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// Packet Identifier (PID) for input source DVB Teletext data to this output.
|
|
// Can be entered as a decimal or hexadecimal value. Valid values are 32 (or
|
|
// 0x20)..8182 (or 0x1ff6).
|
|
DvbTeletextPid *string `locationName:"dvbTeletextPid" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// If set to passthrough, passes any EBIF data from the input source to this
|
|
// output.
|
|
Ebif *string `locationName:"ebif" type:"string" enum:"M2tsEbifControl"`
|
|
|
|
// When videoAndFixedIntervals is selected, audio EBP markers will be added
|
|
// to partitions 3 and 4. The interval between these additional markers will
|
|
// be fixed, and will be slightly shorter than the video EBP marker interval.
|
|
// Only available when EBP Cablelabs segmentation markers are selected. Partitions
|
|
// 1 and 2 will always follow the video interval.
|
|
EbpAudioInterval *string `locationName:"ebpAudioInterval" type:"string" enum:"M2tsAudioInterval"`
|
|
|
|
// When set, enforces that Encoder Boundary Points do not come within the specified
|
|
// time interval of each other by looking ahead at input video. If another EBP
|
|
// is going to come in within the specified time interval, the current EBP is
|
|
// not emitted, and the segment is "stretched" to the next marker. The lookahead
|
|
// value does not add latency to the system. The Live Event must be configured
|
|
// elsewhere to create sufficient latency to make the lookahead accurate.
|
|
EbpLookaheadMs *int64 `locationName:"ebpLookaheadMs" type:"integer"`
|
|
|
|
// Controls placement of EBP on Audio PIDs. If set to videoAndAudioPids, EBP
|
|
// markers will be placed on the video PID and all audio PIDs. If set to videoPid,
|
|
// EBP markers will be placed on only the video PID.
|
|
EbpPlacement *string `locationName:"ebpPlacement" type:"string" enum:"M2tsEbpPlacement"`
|
|
|
|
// This field is unused and deprecated.
|
|
EcmPid *string `locationName:"ecmPid" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// Include or exclude the ES Rate field in the PES header.
|
|
EsRateInPes *string `locationName:"esRateInPes" type:"string" enum:"M2tsEsRateInPes"`
|
|
|
|
// Packet Identifier (PID) for input source ETV Platform data to this output.
|
|
// Can be entered as a decimal or hexadecimal value. Valid values are 32 (or
|
|
// 0x20)..8182 (or 0x1ff6).
|
|
EtvPlatformPid *string `locationName:"etvPlatformPid" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// Packet Identifier (PID) for input source ETV Signal data to this output.
|
|
// Can be entered as a decimal or hexadecimal value. Valid values are 32 (or
|
|
// 0x20)..8182 (or 0x1ff6).
|
|
EtvSignalPid *string `locationName:"etvSignalPid" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// The length in seconds of each fragment. Only used with EBP markers.
|
|
FragmentTime *float64 `locationName:"fragmentTime" type:"double"`
|
|
|
|
// If set to passthrough, passes any KLV data from the input source to this
|
|
// output.
|
|
Klv *string `locationName:"klv" type:"string" enum:"M2tsKlv"`
|
|
|
|
// Packet Identifier (PID) for input source KLV data to this output. Multiple
|
|
// values are accepted, and can be entered in ranges and/or by comma separation.
|
|
// Can be entered as decimal or hexadecimal values. Each PID specified must
|
|
// be in the range of 32 (or 0x20)..8182 (or 0x1ff6).
|
|
KlvDataPids *string `locationName:"klvDataPids" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// Value in bits per second of extra null packets to insert into the transport
|
|
// stream. This can be used if a downstream encryption system requires periodic
|
|
// null packets.
|
|
NullPacketBitrate *float64 `locationName:"nullPacketBitrate" type:"double"`
|
|
|
|
// The number of milliseconds between instances of this table in the output
|
|
// transport stream. Valid values are 0, 10..1000.
|
|
PatInterval *int64 `locationName:"patInterval" type:"integer"`
|
|
|
|
// When set to pcrEveryPesPacket, a Program Clock Reference value is inserted
|
|
// for every Packetized Elementary Stream (PES) header. This parameter is effective
|
|
// only when the PCR PID is the same as the video or audio elementary stream.
|
|
PcrControl *string `locationName:"pcrControl" type:"string" enum:"M2tsPcrControl"`
|
|
|
|
// Maximum time in milliseconds between Program Clock Reference (PCRs) inserted
|
|
// into the transport stream.
|
|
PcrPeriod *int64 `locationName:"pcrPeriod" type:"integer"`
|
|
|
|
// Packet Identifier (PID) of the Program Clock Reference (PCR) in the transport
|
|
// stream. When no value is given, the encoder will assign the same value as
|
|
// the Video PID. Can be entered as a decimal or hexadecimal value. Valid values
|
|
// are 32 (or 0x20)..8182 (or 0x1ff6).
|
|
PcrPid *string `locationName:"pcrPid" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// The number of milliseconds between instances of this table in the output
|
|
// transport stream. Valid values are 0, 10..1000.
|
|
PmtInterval *int64 `locationName:"pmtInterval" type:"integer"`
|
|
|
|
// Packet Identifier (PID) for the Program Map Table (PMT) in the transport
|
|
// stream. Can be entered as a decimal or hexadecimal value. Valid values are
|
|
// 32 (or 0x20)..8182 (or 0x1ff6).
|
|
PmtPid *string `locationName:"pmtPid" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// The value of the program number field in the Program Map Table.
|
|
ProgramNum *int64 `locationName:"programNum" type:"integer"`
|
|
|
|
// When vbr, does not insert null packets into transport stream to fill specified
|
|
// bitrate. The bitrate setting acts as the maximum bitrate when vbr is set.
|
|
RateMode *string `locationName:"rateMode" type:"string" enum:"M2tsRateMode"`
|
|
|
|
// Packet Identifier (PID) for input source SCTE-27 data to this output. Multiple
|
|
// values are accepted, and can be entered in ranges and/or by comma separation.
|
|
// Can be entered as decimal or hexadecimal values. Each PID specified must
|
|
// be in the range of 32 (or 0x20)..8182 (or 0x1ff6).
|
|
Scte27Pids *string `locationName:"scte27Pids" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// Optionally pass SCTE-35 signals from the input source to this output.
|
|
Scte35Control *string `locationName:"scte35Control" type:"string" enum:"M2tsScte35Control"`
|
|
|
|
// Packet Identifier (PID) of the SCTE-35 stream in the transport stream. Can
|
|
// be entered as a decimal or hexadecimal value. Valid values are 32 (or 0x20)..8182
|
|
// (or 0x1ff6).
|
|
Scte35Pid *string `locationName:"scte35Pid" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// Inserts segmentation markers at each segmentationTime period. raiSegstart
|
|
// sets the Random Access Indicator bit in the adaptation field. raiAdapt sets
|
|
// the RAI bit and adds the current timecode in the private data bytes. psiSegstart
|
|
// inserts PAT and PMT tables at the start of segments. ebp adds Encoder Boundary
|
|
// Point information to the adaptation field as per OpenCable specification
|
|
// OC-SP-EBP-I01-130118. ebpLegacy adds Encoder Boundary Point information to
|
|
// the adaptation field using a legacy proprietary format.
|
|
SegmentationMarkers *string `locationName:"segmentationMarkers" type:"string" enum:"M2tsSegmentationMarkers"`
|
|
|
|
// The segmentation style parameter controls how segmentation markers are inserted
|
|
// into the transport stream. With avails, it is possible that segments may
|
|
// be truncated, which can influence where future segmentation markers are inserted.When
|
|
// a segmentation style of "resetCadence" is selected and a segment is truncated
|
|
// due to an avail, we will reset the segmentation cadence. This means the subsequent
|
|
// segment will have a duration of $segmentationTime seconds.When a segmentation
|
|
// style of "maintainCadence" is selected and a segment is truncated due to
|
|
// an avail, we will not reset the segmentation cadence. This means the subsequent
|
|
// segment will likely be truncated as well. However, all segments after that
|
|
// will have a duration of $segmentationTime seconds. Note that EBP lookahead
|
|
// is a slight exception to this rule.
|
|
SegmentationStyle *string `locationName:"segmentationStyle" type:"string" enum:"M2tsSegmentationStyle"`
|
|
|
|
// The length in seconds of each segment. Required unless markers is set to
|
|
// None_.
|
|
SegmentationTime *float64 `locationName:"segmentationTime" type:"double"`
|
|
|
|
// When set to passthrough, timed metadata will be passed through from input
|
|
// to output.
|
|
TimedMetadataBehavior *string `locationName:"timedMetadataBehavior" type:"string" enum:"M2tsTimedMetadataBehavior"`
|
|
|
|
// Packet Identifier (PID) of the timed metadata stream in the transport stream.
|
|
// Can be entered as a decimal or hexadecimal value. Valid values are 32 (or
|
|
// 0x20)..8182 (or 0x1ff6).
|
|
TimedMetadataPid *string `locationName:"timedMetadataPid" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// The value of the transport stream ID field in the Program Map Table.
|
|
TransportStreamId *int64 `locationName:"transportStreamId" type:"integer"`
|
|
|
|
// Packet Identifier (PID) of the elementary video stream in the transport stream.
|
|
// Can be entered as a decimal or hexadecimal value. Valid values are 32 (or
|
|
// 0x20)..8182 (or 0x1ff6).
|
|
VideoPid *string `locationName:"videoPid" type:"string"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s M2tsSettings) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s M2tsSettings) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *M2tsSettings) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "M2tsSettings"}
|
|
if s.DvbNitSettings != nil {
|
|
if err := s.DvbNitSettings.Validate(); err != nil {
|
|
invalidParams.AddNested("DvbNitSettings", err.(request.ErrInvalidParams))
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
if s.DvbSdtSettings != nil {
|
|
if err := s.DvbSdtSettings.Validate(); err != nil {
|
|
invalidParams.AddNested("DvbSdtSettings", err.(request.ErrInvalidParams))
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
if s.DvbTdtSettings != nil {
|
|
if err := s.DvbTdtSettings.Validate(); err != nil {
|
|
invalidParams.AddNested("DvbTdtSettings", err.(request.ErrInvalidParams))
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetAbsentInputAudioBehavior sets the AbsentInputAudioBehavior field's value.
|
|
func (s *M2tsSettings) SetAbsentInputAudioBehavior(v string) *M2tsSettings {
|
|
s.AbsentInputAudioBehavior = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetArib sets the Arib field's value.
|
|
func (s *M2tsSettings) SetArib(v string) *M2tsSettings {
|
|
s.Arib = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetAribCaptionsPid sets the AribCaptionsPid field's value.
|
|
func (s *M2tsSettings) SetAribCaptionsPid(v string) *M2tsSettings {
|
|
s.AribCaptionsPid = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetAribCaptionsPidControl sets the AribCaptionsPidControl field's value.
|
|
func (s *M2tsSettings) SetAribCaptionsPidControl(v string) *M2tsSettings {
|
|
s.AribCaptionsPidControl = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetAudioBufferModel sets the AudioBufferModel field's value.
|
|
func (s *M2tsSettings) SetAudioBufferModel(v string) *M2tsSettings {
|
|
s.AudioBufferModel = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetAudioFramesPerPes sets the AudioFramesPerPes field's value.
|
|
func (s *M2tsSettings) SetAudioFramesPerPes(v int64) *M2tsSettings {
|
|
s.AudioFramesPerPes = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetAudioPids sets the AudioPids field's value.
|
|
func (s *M2tsSettings) SetAudioPids(v string) *M2tsSettings {
|
|
s.AudioPids = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetAudioStreamType sets the AudioStreamType field's value.
|
|
func (s *M2tsSettings) SetAudioStreamType(v string) *M2tsSettings {
|
|
s.AudioStreamType = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetBitrate sets the Bitrate field's value.
|
|
func (s *M2tsSettings) SetBitrate(v int64) *M2tsSettings {
|
|
s.Bitrate = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetBufferModel sets the BufferModel field's value.
|
|
func (s *M2tsSettings) SetBufferModel(v string) *M2tsSettings {
|
|
s.BufferModel = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetCcDescriptor sets the CcDescriptor field's value.
|
|
func (s *M2tsSettings) SetCcDescriptor(v string) *M2tsSettings {
|
|
s.CcDescriptor = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetDvbNitSettings sets the DvbNitSettings field's value.
|
|
func (s *M2tsSettings) SetDvbNitSettings(v *DvbNitSettings) *M2tsSettings {
|
|
s.DvbNitSettings = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetDvbSdtSettings sets the DvbSdtSettings field's value.
|
|
func (s *M2tsSettings) SetDvbSdtSettings(v *DvbSdtSettings) *M2tsSettings {
|
|
s.DvbSdtSettings = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetDvbSubPids sets the DvbSubPids field's value.
|
|
func (s *M2tsSettings) SetDvbSubPids(v string) *M2tsSettings {
|
|
s.DvbSubPids = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetDvbTdtSettings sets the DvbTdtSettings field's value.
|
|
func (s *M2tsSettings) SetDvbTdtSettings(v *DvbTdtSettings) *M2tsSettings {
|
|
s.DvbTdtSettings = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetDvbTeletextPid sets the DvbTeletextPid field's value.
|
|
func (s *M2tsSettings) SetDvbTeletextPid(v string) *M2tsSettings {
|
|
s.DvbTeletextPid = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetEbif sets the Ebif field's value.
|
|
func (s *M2tsSettings) SetEbif(v string) *M2tsSettings {
|
|
s.Ebif = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetEbpAudioInterval sets the EbpAudioInterval field's value.
|
|
func (s *M2tsSettings) SetEbpAudioInterval(v string) *M2tsSettings {
|
|
s.EbpAudioInterval = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetEbpLookaheadMs sets the EbpLookaheadMs field's value.
|
|
func (s *M2tsSettings) SetEbpLookaheadMs(v int64) *M2tsSettings {
|
|
s.EbpLookaheadMs = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetEbpPlacement sets the EbpPlacement field's value.
|
|
func (s *M2tsSettings) SetEbpPlacement(v string) *M2tsSettings {
|
|
s.EbpPlacement = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetEcmPid sets the EcmPid field's value.
|
|
func (s *M2tsSettings) SetEcmPid(v string) *M2tsSettings {
|
|
s.EcmPid = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetEsRateInPes sets the EsRateInPes field's value.
|
|
func (s *M2tsSettings) SetEsRateInPes(v string) *M2tsSettings {
|
|
s.EsRateInPes = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetEtvPlatformPid sets the EtvPlatformPid field's value.
|
|
func (s *M2tsSettings) SetEtvPlatformPid(v string) *M2tsSettings {
|
|
s.EtvPlatformPid = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetEtvSignalPid sets the EtvSignalPid field's value.
|
|
func (s *M2tsSettings) SetEtvSignalPid(v string) *M2tsSettings {
|
|
s.EtvSignalPid = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetFragmentTime sets the FragmentTime field's value.
|
|
func (s *M2tsSettings) SetFragmentTime(v float64) *M2tsSettings {
|
|
s.FragmentTime = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetKlv sets the Klv field's value.
|
|
func (s *M2tsSettings) SetKlv(v string) *M2tsSettings {
|
|
s.Klv = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetKlvDataPids sets the KlvDataPids field's value.
|
|
func (s *M2tsSettings) SetKlvDataPids(v string) *M2tsSettings {
|
|
s.KlvDataPids = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetNullPacketBitrate sets the NullPacketBitrate field's value.
|
|
func (s *M2tsSettings) SetNullPacketBitrate(v float64) *M2tsSettings {
|
|
s.NullPacketBitrate = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetPatInterval sets the PatInterval field's value.
|
|
func (s *M2tsSettings) SetPatInterval(v int64) *M2tsSettings {
|
|
s.PatInterval = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetPcrControl sets the PcrControl field's value.
|
|
func (s *M2tsSettings) SetPcrControl(v string) *M2tsSettings {
|
|
s.PcrControl = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetPcrPeriod sets the PcrPeriod field's value.
|
|
func (s *M2tsSettings) SetPcrPeriod(v int64) *M2tsSettings {
|
|
s.PcrPeriod = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetPcrPid sets the PcrPid field's value.
|
|
func (s *M2tsSettings) SetPcrPid(v string) *M2tsSettings {
|
|
s.PcrPid = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetPmtInterval sets the PmtInterval field's value.
|
|
func (s *M2tsSettings) SetPmtInterval(v int64) *M2tsSettings {
|
|
s.PmtInterval = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetPmtPid sets the PmtPid field's value.
|
|
func (s *M2tsSettings) SetPmtPid(v string) *M2tsSettings {
|
|
s.PmtPid = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetProgramNum sets the ProgramNum field's value.
|
|
func (s *M2tsSettings) SetProgramNum(v int64) *M2tsSettings {
|
|
s.ProgramNum = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetRateMode sets the RateMode field's value.
|
|
func (s *M2tsSettings) SetRateMode(v string) *M2tsSettings {
|
|
s.RateMode = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetScte27Pids sets the Scte27Pids field's value.
|
|
func (s *M2tsSettings) SetScte27Pids(v string) *M2tsSettings {
|
|
s.Scte27Pids = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetScte35Control sets the Scte35Control field's value.
|
|
func (s *M2tsSettings) SetScte35Control(v string) *M2tsSettings {
|
|
s.Scte35Control = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetScte35Pid sets the Scte35Pid field's value.
|
|
func (s *M2tsSettings) SetScte35Pid(v string) *M2tsSettings {
|
|
s.Scte35Pid = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetSegmentationMarkers sets the SegmentationMarkers field's value.
|
|
func (s *M2tsSettings) SetSegmentationMarkers(v string) *M2tsSettings {
|
|
s.SegmentationMarkers = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetSegmentationStyle sets the SegmentationStyle field's value.
|
|
func (s *M2tsSettings) SetSegmentationStyle(v string) *M2tsSettings {
|
|
s.SegmentationStyle = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetSegmentationTime sets the SegmentationTime field's value.
|
|
func (s *M2tsSettings) SetSegmentationTime(v float64) *M2tsSettings {
|
|
s.SegmentationTime = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetTimedMetadataBehavior sets the TimedMetadataBehavior field's value.
|
|
func (s *M2tsSettings) SetTimedMetadataBehavior(v string) *M2tsSettings {
|
|
s.TimedMetadataBehavior = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetTimedMetadataPid sets the TimedMetadataPid field's value.
|
|
func (s *M2tsSettings) SetTimedMetadataPid(v string) *M2tsSettings {
|
|
s.TimedMetadataPid = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetTransportStreamId sets the TransportStreamId field's value.
|
|
func (s *M2tsSettings) SetTransportStreamId(v int64) *M2tsSettings {
|
|
s.TransportStreamId = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetVideoPid sets the VideoPid field's value.
|
|
func (s *M2tsSettings) SetVideoPid(v string) *M2tsSettings {
|
|
s.VideoPid = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Settings information for the .m3u8 container
|
|
type M3u8Settings struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// The number of audio frames to insert for each PES packet.
|
|
AudioFramesPerPes *int64 `locationName:"audioFramesPerPes" type:"integer"`
|
|
|
|
// Packet Identifier (PID) of the elementary audio stream(s) in the transport
|
|
// stream. Multiple values are accepted, and can be entered in ranges and/or
|
|
// by comma separation. Can be entered as decimal or hexadecimal values.
|
|
AudioPids *string `locationName:"audioPids" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// This parameter is unused and deprecated.
|
|
EcmPid *string `locationName:"ecmPid" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// The number of milliseconds between instances of this table in the output
|
|
// transport stream. A value of \"0\" writes out the PMT once per segment file.
|
|
PatInterval *int64 `locationName:"patInterval" type:"integer"`
|
|
|
|
// When set to pcrEveryPesPacket, a Program Clock Reference value is inserted
|
|
// for every Packetized Elementary Stream (PES) header. This parameter is effective
|
|
// only when the PCR PID is the same as the video or audio elementary stream.
|
|
PcrControl *string `locationName:"pcrControl" type:"string" enum:"M3u8PcrControl"`
|
|
|
|
// Maximum time in milliseconds between Program Clock References (PCRs) inserted
|
|
// into the transport stream.
|
|
PcrPeriod *int64 `locationName:"pcrPeriod" type:"integer"`
|
|
|
|
// Packet Identifier (PID) of the Program Clock Reference (PCR) in the transport
|
|
// stream. When no value is given, the encoder will assign the same value as
|
|
// the Video PID. Can be entered as a decimal or hexadecimal value.
|
|
PcrPid *string `locationName:"pcrPid" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// The number of milliseconds between instances of this table in the output
|
|
// transport stream. A value of \"0\" writes out the PMT once per segment file.
|
|
PmtInterval *int64 `locationName:"pmtInterval" type:"integer"`
|
|
|
|
// Packet Identifier (PID) for the Program Map Table (PMT) in the transport
|
|
// stream. Can be entered as a decimal or hexadecimal value.
|
|
PmtPid *string `locationName:"pmtPid" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// The value of the program number field in the Program Map Table.
|
|
ProgramNum *int64 `locationName:"programNum" type:"integer"`
|
|
|
|
// If set to passthrough, passes any SCTE-35 signals from the input source to
|
|
// this output.
|
|
Scte35Behavior *string `locationName:"scte35Behavior" type:"string" enum:"M3u8Scte35Behavior"`
|
|
|
|
// Packet Identifier (PID) of the SCTE-35 stream in the transport stream. Can
|
|
// be entered as a decimal or hexadecimal value.
|
|
Scte35Pid *string `locationName:"scte35Pid" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// When set to passthrough, timed metadata is passed through from input to output.
|
|
TimedMetadataBehavior *string `locationName:"timedMetadataBehavior" type:"string" enum:"M3u8TimedMetadataBehavior"`
|
|
|
|
// Packet Identifier (PID) of the timed metadata stream in the transport stream.
|
|
// Can be entered as a decimal or hexadecimal value. Valid values are 32 (or
|
|
// 0x20)..8182 (or 0x1ff6).
|
|
TimedMetadataPid *string `locationName:"timedMetadataPid" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// The value of the transport stream ID field in the Program Map Table.
|
|
TransportStreamId *int64 `locationName:"transportStreamId" type:"integer"`
|
|
|
|
// Packet Identifier (PID) of the elementary video stream in the transport stream.
|
|
// Can be entered as a decimal or hexadecimal value.
|
|
VideoPid *string `locationName:"videoPid" type:"string"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s M3u8Settings) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s M3u8Settings) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetAudioFramesPerPes sets the AudioFramesPerPes field's value.
|
|
func (s *M3u8Settings) SetAudioFramesPerPes(v int64) *M3u8Settings {
|
|
s.AudioFramesPerPes = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetAudioPids sets the AudioPids field's value.
|
|
func (s *M3u8Settings) SetAudioPids(v string) *M3u8Settings {
|
|
s.AudioPids = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetEcmPid sets the EcmPid field's value.
|
|
func (s *M3u8Settings) SetEcmPid(v string) *M3u8Settings {
|
|
s.EcmPid = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetPatInterval sets the PatInterval field's value.
|
|
func (s *M3u8Settings) SetPatInterval(v int64) *M3u8Settings {
|
|
s.PatInterval = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetPcrControl sets the PcrControl field's value.
|
|
func (s *M3u8Settings) SetPcrControl(v string) *M3u8Settings {
|
|
s.PcrControl = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetPcrPeriod sets the PcrPeriod field's value.
|
|
func (s *M3u8Settings) SetPcrPeriod(v int64) *M3u8Settings {
|
|
s.PcrPeriod = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetPcrPid sets the PcrPid field's value.
|
|
func (s *M3u8Settings) SetPcrPid(v string) *M3u8Settings {
|
|
s.PcrPid = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetPmtInterval sets the PmtInterval field's value.
|
|
func (s *M3u8Settings) SetPmtInterval(v int64) *M3u8Settings {
|
|
s.PmtInterval = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetPmtPid sets the PmtPid field's value.
|
|
func (s *M3u8Settings) SetPmtPid(v string) *M3u8Settings {
|
|
s.PmtPid = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetProgramNum sets the ProgramNum field's value.
|
|
func (s *M3u8Settings) SetProgramNum(v int64) *M3u8Settings {
|
|
s.ProgramNum = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetScte35Behavior sets the Scte35Behavior field's value.
|
|
func (s *M3u8Settings) SetScte35Behavior(v string) *M3u8Settings {
|
|
s.Scte35Behavior = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetScte35Pid sets the Scte35Pid field's value.
|
|
func (s *M3u8Settings) SetScte35Pid(v string) *M3u8Settings {
|
|
s.Scte35Pid = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetTimedMetadataBehavior sets the TimedMetadataBehavior field's value.
|
|
func (s *M3u8Settings) SetTimedMetadataBehavior(v string) *M3u8Settings {
|
|
s.TimedMetadataBehavior = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetTimedMetadataPid sets the TimedMetadataPid field's value.
|
|
func (s *M3u8Settings) SetTimedMetadataPid(v string) *M3u8Settings {
|
|
s.TimedMetadataPid = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetTransportStreamId sets the TransportStreamId field's value.
|
|
func (s *M3u8Settings) SetTransportStreamId(v int64) *M3u8Settings {
|
|
s.TransportStreamId = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetVideoPid sets the VideoPid field's value.
|
|
func (s *M3u8Settings) SetVideoPid(v string) *M3u8Settings {
|
|
s.VideoPid = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// The settings for a MediaConnect Flow.
|
|
type MediaConnectFlow struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// The unique ARN of the MediaConnect Flow being used as a source.
|
|
FlowArn *string `locationName:"flowArn" type:"string"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s MediaConnectFlow) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s MediaConnectFlow) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetFlowArn sets the FlowArn field's value.
|
|
func (s *MediaConnectFlow) SetFlowArn(v string) *MediaConnectFlow {
|
|
s.FlowArn = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// The settings for a MediaConnect Flow.
|
|
type MediaConnectFlowRequest struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// The ARN of the MediaConnect Flow that you want to use as a source.
|
|
FlowArn *string `locationName:"flowArn" type:"string"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s MediaConnectFlowRequest) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s MediaConnectFlowRequest) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetFlowArn sets the FlowArn field's value.
|
|
func (s *MediaConnectFlowRequest) SetFlowArn(v string) *MediaConnectFlowRequest {
|
|
s.FlowArn = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type Mp2Settings struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// Average bitrate in bits/second.
|
|
Bitrate *float64 `locationName:"bitrate" type:"double"`
|
|
|
|
// The MPEG2 Audio coding mode. Valid values are codingMode10 (for mono) or
|
|
// codingMode20 (for stereo).
|
|
CodingMode *string `locationName:"codingMode" type:"string" enum:"Mp2CodingMode"`
|
|
|
|
// Sample rate in Hz.
|
|
SampleRate *float64 `locationName:"sampleRate" type:"double"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s Mp2Settings) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s Mp2Settings) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetBitrate sets the Bitrate field's value.
|
|
func (s *Mp2Settings) SetBitrate(v float64) *Mp2Settings {
|
|
s.Bitrate = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetCodingMode sets the CodingMode field's value.
|
|
func (s *Mp2Settings) SetCodingMode(v string) *Mp2Settings {
|
|
s.CodingMode = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetSampleRate sets the SampleRate field's value.
|
|
func (s *Mp2Settings) SetSampleRate(v float64) *Mp2Settings {
|
|
s.SampleRate = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type MsSmoothGroupSettings struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// The value of the "Acquisition Point Identity" element used in each message
|
|
// placed in the sparse track. Only enabled if sparseTrackType is not "none".
|
|
AcquisitionPointId *string `locationName:"acquisitionPointId" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// If set to passthrough for an audio-only MS Smooth output, the fragment absolute
|
|
// time will be set to the current timecode. This option does not write timecodes
|
|
// to the audio elementary stream.
|
|
AudioOnlyTimecodeControl *string `locationName:"audioOnlyTimecodeControl" type:"string" enum:"SmoothGroupAudioOnlyTimecodeControl"`
|
|
|
|
// If set to verifyAuthenticity, verify the https certificate chain to a trusted
|
|
// Certificate Authority (CA). This will cause https outputs to self-signed
|
|
// certificates to fail.
|
|
CertificateMode *string `locationName:"certificateMode" type:"string" enum:"SmoothGroupCertificateMode"`
|
|
|
|
// Number of seconds to wait before retrying connection to the IIS server if
|
|
// the connection is lost. Content will be cached during this time and the cache
|
|
// will be be delivered to the IIS server once the connection is re-established.
|
|
ConnectionRetryInterval *int64 `locationName:"connectionRetryInterval" type:"integer"`
|
|
|
|
// Smooth Streaming publish point on an IIS server. Elemental Live acts as a
|
|
// "Push" encoder to IIS.
|
|
//
|
|
// Destination is a required field
|
|
Destination *OutputLocationRef `locationName:"destination" type:"structure" required:"true"`
|
|
|
|
// MS Smooth event ID to be sent to the IIS server.Should only be specified
|
|
// if eventIdMode is set to useConfigured.
|
|
EventId *string `locationName:"eventId" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// Specifies whether or not to send an event ID to the IIS server. If no event
|
|
// ID is sent and the same Live Event is used without changing the publishing
|
|
// point, clients might see cached video from the previous run.Options:- "useConfigured"
|
|
// - use the value provided in eventId- "useTimestamp" - generate and send an
|
|
// event ID based on the current timestamp- "noEventId" - do not send an event
|
|
// ID to the IIS server.
|
|
EventIdMode *string `locationName:"eventIdMode" type:"string" enum:"SmoothGroupEventIdMode"`
|
|
|
|
// When set to sendEos, send EOS signal to IIS server when stopping the event
|
|
EventStopBehavior *string `locationName:"eventStopBehavior" type:"string" enum:"SmoothGroupEventStopBehavior"`
|
|
|
|
// Size in seconds of file cache for streaming outputs.
|
|
FilecacheDuration *int64 `locationName:"filecacheDuration" type:"integer"`
|
|
|
|
// Length of mp4 fragments to generate (in seconds). Fragment length must be
|
|
// compatible with GOP size and framerate.
|
|
FragmentLength *int64 `locationName:"fragmentLength" min:"1" type:"integer"`
|
|
|
|
// Parameter that control output group behavior on input loss.
|
|
InputLossAction *string `locationName:"inputLossAction" type:"string" enum:"InputLossActionForMsSmoothOut"`
|
|
|
|
// Number of retry attempts.
|
|
NumRetries *int64 `locationName:"numRetries" type:"integer"`
|
|
|
|
// Number of seconds before initiating a restart due to output failure, due
|
|
// to exhausting the numRetries on one segment, or exceeding filecacheDuration.
|
|
RestartDelay *int64 `locationName:"restartDelay" type:"integer"`
|
|
|
|
// useInputSegmentation has been deprecated. The configured segment size is
|
|
// always used.
|
|
SegmentationMode *string `locationName:"segmentationMode" type:"string" enum:"SmoothGroupSegmentationMode"`
|
|
|
|
// Number of milliseconds to delay the output from the second pipeline.
|
|
SendDelayMs *int64 `locationName:"sendDelayMs" type:"integer"`
|
|
|
|
// If set to scte35, use incoming SCTE-35 messages to generate a sparse track
|
|
// in this group of MS-Smooth outputs.
|
|
SparseTrackType *string `locationName:"sparseTrackType" type:"string" enum:"SmoothGroupSparseTrackType"`
|
|
|
|
// When set to send, send stream manifest so publishing point doesn't start
|
|
// until all streams start.
|
|
StreamManifestBehavior *string `locationName:"streamManifestBehavior" type:"string" enum:"SmoothGroupStreamManifestBehavior"`
|
|
|
|
// Timestamp offset for the event. Only used if timestampOffsetMode is set to
|
|
// useConfiguredOffset.
|
|
TimestampOffset *string `locationName:"timestampOffset" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// Type of timestamp date offset to use.- useEventStartDate: Use the date the
|
|
// event was started as the offset- useConfiguredOffset: Use an explicitly configured
|
|
// date as the offset
|
|
TimestampOffsetMode *string `locationName:"timestampOffsetMode" type:"string" enum:"SmoothGroupTimestampOffsetMode"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s MsSmoothGroupSettings) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s MsSmoothGroupSettings) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *MsSmoothGroupSettings) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "MsSmoothGroupSettings"}
|
|
if s.Destination == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("Destination"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.FragmentLength != nil && *s.FragmentLength < 1 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinValue("FragmentLength", 1))
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetAcquisitionPointId sets the AcquisitionPointId field's value.
|
|
func (s *MsSmoothGroupSettings) SetAcquisitionPointId(v string) *MsSmoothGroupSettings {
|
|
s.AcquisitionPointId = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetAudioOnlyTimecodeControl sets the AudioOnlyTimecodeControl field's value.
|
|
func (s *MsSmoothGroupSettings) SetAudioOnlyTimecodeControl(v string) *MsSmoothGroupSettings {
|
|
s.AudioOnlyTimecodeControl = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetCertificateMode sets the CertificateMode field's value.
|
|
func (s *MsSmoothGroupSettings) SetCertificateMode(v string) *MsSmoothGroupSettings {
|
|
s.CertificateMode = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetConnectionRetryInterval sets the ConnectionRetryInterval field's value.
|
|
func (s *MsSmoothGroupSettings) SetConnectionRetryInterval(v int64) *MsSmoothGroupSettings {
|
|
s.ConnectionRetryInterval = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetDestination sets the Destination field's value.
|
|
func (s *MsSmoothGroupSettings) SetDestination(v *OutputLocationRef) *MsSmoothGroupSettings {
|
|
s.Destination = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetEventId sets the EventId field's value.
|
|
func (s *MsSmoothGroupSettings) SetEventId(v string) *MsSmoothGroupSettings {
|
|
s.EventId = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetEventIdMode sets the EventIdMode field's value.
|
|
func (s *MsSmoothGroupSettings) SetEventIdMode(v string) *MsSmoothGroupSettings {
|
|
s.EventIdMode = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetEventStopBehavior sets the EventStopBehavior field's value.
|
|
func (s *MsSmoothGroupSettings) SetEventStopBehavior(v string) *MsSmoothGroupSettings {
|
|
s.EventStopBehavior = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetFilecacheDuration sets the FilecacheDuration field's value.
|
|
func (s *MsSmoothGroupSettings) SetFilecacheDuration(v int64) *MsSmoothGroupSettings {
|
|
s.FilecacheDuration = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetFragmentLength sets the FragmentLength field's value.
|
|
func (s *MsSmoothGroupSettings) SetFragmentLength(v int64) *MsSmoothGroupSettings {
|
|
s.FragmentLength = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetInputLossAction sets the InputLossAction field's value.
|
|
func (s *MsSmoothGroupSettings) SetInputLossAction(v string) *MsSmoothGroupSettings {
|
|
s.InputLossAction = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetNumRetries sets the NumRetries field's value.
|
|
func (s *MsSmoothGroupSettings) SetNumRetries(v int64) *MsSmoothGroupSettings {
|
|
s.NumRetries = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetRestartDelay sets the RestartDelay field's value.
|
|
func (s *MsSmoothGroupSettings) SetRestartDelay(v int64) *MsSmoothGroupSettings {
|
|
s.RestartDelay = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetSegmentationMode sets the SegmentationMode field's value.
|
|
func (s *MsSmoothGroupSettings) SetSegmentationMode(v string) *MsSmoothGroupSettings {
|
|
s.SegmentationMode = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetSendDelayMs sets the SendDelayMs field's value.
|
|
func (s *MsSmoothGroupSettings) SetSendDelayMs(v int64) *MsSmoothGroupSettings {
|
|
s.SendDelayMs = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetSparseTrackType sets the SparseTrackType field's value.
|
|
func (s *MsSmoothGroupSettings) SetSparseTrackType(v string) *MsSmoothGroupSettings {
|
|
s.SparseTrackType = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetStreamManifestBehavior sets the StreamManifestBehavior field's value.
|
|
func (s *MsSmoothGroupSettings) SetStreamManifestBehavior(v string) *MsSmoothGroupSettings {
|
|
s.StreamManifestBehavior = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetTimestampOffset sets the TimestampOffset field's value.
|
|
func (s *MsSmoothGroupSettings) SetTimestampOffset(v string) *MsSmoothGroupSettings {
|
|
s.TimestampOffset = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetTimestampOffsetMode sets the TimestampOffsetMode field's value.
|
|
func (s *MsSmoothGroupSettings) SetTimestampOffsetMode(v string) *MsSmoothGroupSettings {
|
|
s.TimestampOffsetMode = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type MsSmoothOutputSettings struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// String concatenated to the end of the destination filename. Required for
|
|
// multiple outputs of the same type.
|
|
NameModifier *string `locationName:"nameModifier" type:"string"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s MsSmoothOutputSettings) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s MsSmoothOutputSettings) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetNameModifier sets the NameModifier field's value.
|
|
func (s *MsSmoothOutputSettings) SetNameModifier(v string) *MsSmoothOutputSettings {
|
|
s.NameModifier = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Network source to transcode. Must be accessible to the Elemental Live node
|
|
// that is running the live event through a network connection.
|
|
type NetworkInputSettings struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// Specifies HLS input settings when the uri is for a HLS manifest.
|
|
HlsInputSettings *HlsInputSettings `locationName:"hlsInputSettings" type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// Check HTTPS server certificates. When set to checkCryptographyOnly, cryptography
|
|
// in the certificate will be checked, but not the server's name. Certain subdomains
|
|
// (notably S3 buckets that use dots in the bucket name) do not strictly match
|
|
// the corresponding certificate's wildcard pattern and would otherwise cause
|
|
// the event to error. This setting is ignored for protocols that do not use
|
|
// https.
|
|
ServerValidation *string `locationName:"serverValidation" type:"string" enum:"NetworkInputServerValidation"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s NetworkInputSettings) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s NetworkInputSettings) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetHlsInputSettings sets the HlsInputSettings field's value.
|
|
func (s *NetworkInputSettings) SetHlsInputSettings(v *HlsInputSettings) *NetworkInputSettings {
|
|
s.HlsInputSettings = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetServerValidation sets the ServerValidation field's value.
|
|
func (s *NetworkInputSettings) SetServerValidation(v string) *NetworkInputSettings {
|
|
s.ServerValidation = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Reserved resources available for purchase
|
|
type Offering struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// Unique offering ARN, e.g. 'arn:aws:medialive:us-west-2:123456789012:offering:87654321'
|
|
Arn *string `locationName:"arn" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// Currency code for usagePrice and fixedPrice in ISO-4217 format, e.g. 'USD'
|
|
CurrencyCode *string `locationName:"currencyCode" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// Lease duration, e.g. '12'
|
|
Duration *int64 `locationName:"duration" type:"integer"`
|
|
|
|
// Units for duration, e.g. 'MONTHS'
|
|
DurationUnits *string `locationName:"durationUnits" type:"string" enum:"OfferingDurationUnits"`
|
|
|
|
// One-time charge for each reserved resource, e.g. '0.0' for a NO_UPFRONT offering
|
|
FixedPrice *float64 `locationName:"fixedPrice" type:"double"`
|
|
|
|
// Offering description, e.g. 'HD AVC output at 10-20 Mbps, 30 fps, and standard
|
|
// VQ in US West (Oregon)'
|
|
OfferingDescription *string `locationName:"offeringDescription" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// Unique offering ID, e.g. '87654321'
|
|
OfferingId *string `locationName:"offeringId" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// Offering type, e.g. 'NO_UPFRONT'
|
|
OfferingType *string `locationName:"offeringType" type:"string" enum:"OfferingType"`
|
|
|
|
// AWS region, e.g. 'us-west-2'
|
|
Region *string `locationName:"region" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// Resource configuration details
|
|
ResourceSpecification *ReservationResourceSpecification `locationName:"resourceSpecification" type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// Recurring usage charge for each reserved resource, e.g. '157.0'
|
|
UsagePrice *float64 `locationName:"usagePrice" type:"double"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s Offering) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s Offering) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetArn sets the Arn field's value.
|
|
func (s *Offering) SetArn(v string) *Offering {
|
|
s.Arn = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetCurrencyCode sets the CurrencyCode field's value.
|
|
func (s *Offering) SetCurrencyCode(v string) *Offering {
|
|
s.CurrencyCode = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetDuration sets the Duration field's value.
|
|
func (s *Offering) SetDuration(v int64) *Offering {
|
|
s.Duration = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetDurationUnits sets the DurationUnits field's value.
|
|
func (s *Offering) SetDurationUnits(v string) *Offering {
|
|
s.DurationUnits = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetFixedPrice sets the FixedPrice field's value.
|
|
func (s *Offering) SetFixedPrice(v float64) *Offering {
|
|
s.FixedPrice = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetOfferingDescription sets the OfferingDescription field's value.
|
|
func (s *Offering) SetOfferingDescription(v string) *Offering {
|
|
s.OfferingDescription = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetOfferingId sets the OfferingId field's value.
|
|
func (s *Offering) SetOfferingId(v string) *Offering {
|
|
s.OfferingId = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetOfferingType sets the OfferingType field's value.
|
|
func (s *Offering) SetOfferingType(v string) *Offering {
|
|
s.OfferingType = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetRegion sets the Region field's value.
|
|
func (s *Offering) SetRegion(v string) *Offering {
|
|
s.Region = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetResourceSpecification sets the ResourceSpecification field's value.
|
|
func (s *Offering) SetResourceSpecification(v *ReservationResourceSpecification) *Offering {
|
|
s.ResourceSpecification = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetUsagePrice sets the UsagePrice field's value.
|
|
func (s *Offering) SetUsagePrice(v float64) *Offering {
|
|
s.UsagePrice = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Output settings. There can be multiple outputs within a group.
|
|
type Output struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// The names of the AudioDescriptions used as audio sources for this output.
|
|
AudioDescriptionNames []*string `locationName:"audioDescriptionNames" type:"list"`
|
|
|
|
// The names of the CaptionDescriptions used as caption sources for this output.
|
|
CaptionDescriptionNames []*string `locationName:"captionDescriptionNames" type:"list"`
|
|
|
|
// The name used to identify an output.
|
|
OutputName *string `locationName:"outputName" min:"1" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// Output type-specific settings.
|
|
//
|
|
// OutputSettings is a required field
|
|
OutputSettings *OutputSettings `locationName:"outputSettings" type:"structure" required:"true"`
|
|
|
|
// The name of the VideoDescription used as the source for this output.
|
|
VideoDescriptionName *string `locationName:"videoDescriptionName" type:"string"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s Output) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s Output) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *Output) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "Output"}
|
|
if s.OutputName != nil && len(*s.OutputName) < 1 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("OutputName", 1))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.OutputSettings == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("OutputSettings"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.OutputSettings != nil {
|
|
if err := s.OutputSettings.Validate(); err != nil {
|
|
invalidParams.AddNested("OutputSettings", err.(request.ErrInvalidParams))
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetAudioDescriptionNames sets the AudioDescriptionNames field's value.
|
|
func (s *Output) SetAudioDescriptionNames(v []*string) *Output {
|
|
s.AudioDescriptionNames = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetCaptionDescriptionNames sets the CaptionDescriptionNames field's value.
|
|
func (s *Output) SetCaptionDescriptionNames(v []*string) *Output {
|
|
s.CaptionDescriptionNames = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetOutputName sets the OutputName field's value.
|
|
func (s *Output) SetOutputName(v string) *Output {
|
|
s.OutputName = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetOutputSettings sets the OutputSettings field's value.
|
|
func (s *Output) SetOutputSettings(v *OutputSettings) *Output {
|
|
s.OutputSettings = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetVideoDescriptionName sets the VideoDescriptionName field's value.
|
|
func (s *Output) SetVideoDescriptionName(v string) *Output {
|
|
s.VideoDescriptionName = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type OutputDestination struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// User-specified id. This is used in an output group or an output.
|
|
Id *string `locationName:"id" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// Destination settings for output; one for each redundant encoder.
|
|
Settings []*OutputDestinationSettings `locationName:"settings" type:"list"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s OutputDestination) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s OutputDestination) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetId sets the Id field's value.
|
|
func (s *OutputDestination) SetId(v string) *OutputDestination {
|
|
s.Id = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetSettings sets the Settings field's value.
|
|
func (s *OutputDestination) SetSettings(v []*OutputDestinationSettings) *OutputDestination {
|
|
s.Settings = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type OutputDestinationSettings struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// key used to extract the password from EC2 Parameter store
|
|
PasswordParam *string `locationName:"passwordParam" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// Stream name for RTMP destinations (URLs of type rtmp://)
|
|
StreamName *string `locationName:"streamName" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// A URL specifying a destination
|
|
Url *string `locationName:"url" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// username for destination
|
|
Username *string `locationName:"username" type:"string"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s OutputDestinationSettings) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s OutputDestinationSettings) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetPasswordParam sets the PasswordParam field's value.
|
|
func (s *OutputDestinationSettings) SetPasswordParam(v string) *OutputDestinationSettings {
|
|
s.PasswordParam = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetStreamName sets the StreamName field's value.
|
|
func (s *OutputDestinationSettings) SetStreamName(v string) *OutputDestinationSettings {
|
|
s.StreamName = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetUrl sets the Url field's value.
|
|
func (s *OutputDestinationSettings) SetUrl(v string) *OutputDestinationSettings {
|
|
s.Url = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetUsername sets the Username field's value.
|
|
func (s *OutputDestinationSettings) SetUsername(v string) *OutputDestinationSettings {
|
|
s.Username = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Output groups for this Live Event. Output groups contain information about
|
|
// where streams should be distributed.
|
|
type OutputGroup struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// Custom output group name optionally defined by the user. Only letters, numbers,
|
|
// and the underscore character allowed; only 32 characters allowed.
|
|
Name *string `locationName:"name" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// Settings associated with the output group.
|
|
//
|
|
// OutputGroupSettings is a required field
|
|
OutputGroupSettings *OutputGroupSettings `locationName:"outputGroupSettings" type:"structure" required:"true"`
|
|
|
|
// Outputs is a required field
|
|
Outputs []*Output `locationName:"outputs" type:"list" required:"true"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s OutputGroup) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s OutputGroup) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *OutputGroup) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "OutputGroup"}
|
|
if s.OutputGroupSettings == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("OutputGroupSettings"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.Outputs == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("Outputs"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.OutputGroupSettings != nil {
|
|
if err := s.OutputGroupSettings.Validate(); err != nil {
|
|
invalidParams.AddNested("OutputGroupSettings", err.(request.ErrInvalidParams))
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
if s.Outputs != nil {
|
|
for i, v := range s.Outputs {
|
|
if v == nil {
|
|
continue
|
|
}
|
|
if err := v.Validate(); err != nil {
|
|
invalidParams.AddNested(fmt.Sprintf("%s[%v]", "Outputs", i), err.(request.ErrInvalidParams))
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetName sets the Name field's value.
|
|
func (s *OutputGroup) SetName(v string) *OutputGroup {
|
|
s.Name = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetOutputGroupSettings sets the OutputGroupSettings field's value.
|
|
func (s *OutputGroup) SetOutputGroupSettings(v *OutputGroupSettings) *OutputGroup {
|
|
s.OutputGroupSettings = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetOutputs sets the Outputs field's value.
|
|
func (s *OutputGroup) SetOutputs(v []*Output) *OutputGroup {
|
|
s.Outputs = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type OutputGroupSettings struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
ArchiveGroupSettings *ArchiveGroupSettings `locationName:"archiveGroupSettings" type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
HlsGroupSettings *HlsGroupSettings `locationName:"hlsGroupSettings" type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
MsSmoothGroupSettings *MsSmoothGroupSettings `locationName:"msSmoothGroupSettings" type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
RtmpGroupSettings *RtmpGroupSettings `locationName:"rtmpGroupSettings" type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
UdpGroupSettings *UdpGroupSettings `locationName:"udpGroupSettings" type:"structure"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s OutputGroupSettings) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s OutputGroupSettings) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *OutputGroupSettings) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "OutputGroupSettings"}
|
|
if s.ArchiveGroupSettings != nil {
|
|
if err := s.ArchiveGroupSettings.Validate(); err != nil {
|
|
invalidParams.AddNested("ArchiveGroupSettings", err.(request.ErrInvalidParams))
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
if s.HlsGroupSettings != nil {
|
|
if err := s.HlsGroupSettings.Validate(); err != nil {
|
|
invalidParams.AddNested("HlsGroupSettings", err.(request.ErrInvalidParams))
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
if s.MsSmoothGroupSettings != nil {
|
|
if err := s.MsSmoothGroupSettings.Validate(); err != nil {
|
|
invalidParams.AddNested("MsSmoothGroupSettings", err.(request.ErrInvalidParams))
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
if s.RtmpGroupSettings != nil {
|
|
if err := s.RtmpGroupSettings.Validate(); err != nil {
|
|
invalidParams.AddNested("RtmpGroupSettings", err.(request.ErrInvalidParams))
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetArchiveGroupSettings sets the ArchiveGroupSettings field's value.
|
|
func (s *OutputGroupSettings) SetArchiveGroupSettings(v *ArchiveGroupSettings) *OutputGroupSettings {
|
|
s.ArchiveGroupSettings = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetHlsGroupSettings sets the HlsGroupSettings field's value.
|
|
func (s *OutputGroupSettings) SetHlsGroupSettings(v *HlsGroupSettings) *OutputGroupSettings {
|
|
s.HlsGroupSettings = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetMsSmoothGroupSettings sets the MsSmoothGroupSettings field's value.
|
|
func (s *OutputGroupSettings) SetMsSmoothGroupSettings(v *MsSmoothGroupSettings) *OutputGroupSettings {
|
|
s.MsSmoothGroupSettings = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetRtmpGroupSettings sets the RtmpGroupSettings field's value.
|
|
func (s *OutputGroupSettings) SetRtmpGroupSettings(v *RtmpGroupSettings) *OutputGroupSettings {
|
|
s.RtmpGroupSettings = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetUdpGroupSettings sets the UdpGroupSettings field's value.
|
|
func (s *OutputGroupSettings) SetUdpGroupSettings(v *UdpGroupSettings) *OutputGroupSettings {
|
|
s.UdpGroupSettings = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Reference to an OutputDestination ID defined in the channel
|
|
type OutputLocationRef struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
DestinationRefId *string `locationName:"destinationRefId" type:"string"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s OutputLocationRef) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s OutputLocationRef) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetDestinationRefId sets the DestinationRefId field's value.
|
|
func (s *OutputLocationRef) SetDestinationRefId(v string) *OutputLocationRef {
|
|
s.DestinationRefId = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type OutputSettings struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
ArchiveOutputSettings *ArchiveOutputSettings `locationName:"archiveOutputSettings" type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
HlsOutputSettings *HlsOutputSettings `locationName:"hlsOutputSettings" type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
MsSmoothOutputSettings *MsSmoothOutputSettings `locationName:"msSmoothOutputSettings" type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
RtmpOutputSettings *RtmpOutputSettings `locationName:"rtmpOutputSettings" type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
UdpOutputSettings *UdpOutputSettings `locationName:"udpOutputSettings" type:"structure"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s OutputSettings) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s OutputSettings) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *OutputSettings) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "OutputSettings"}
|
|
if s.ArchiveOutputSettings != nil {
|
|
if err := s.ArchiveOutputSettings.Validate(); err != nil {
|
|
invalidParams.AddNested("ArchiveOutputSettings", err.(request.ErrInvalidParams))
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
if s.HlsOutputSettings != nil {
|
|
if err := s.HlsOutputSettings.Validate(); err != nil {
|
|
invalidParams.AddNested("HlsOutputSettings", err.(request.ErrInvalidParams))
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
if s.RtmpOutputSettings != nil {
|
|
if err := s.RtmpOutputSettings.Validate(); err != nil {
|
|
invalidParams.AddNested("RtmpOutputSettings", err.(request.ErrInvalidParams))
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
if s.UdpOutputSettings != nil {
|
|
if err := s.UdpOutputSettings.Validate(); err != nil {
|
|
invalidParams.AddNested("UdpOutputSettings", err.(request.ErrInvalidParams))
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetArchiveOutputSettings sets the ArchiveOutputSettings field's value.
|
|
func (s *OutputSettings) SetArchiveOutputSettings(v *ArchiveOutputSettings) *OutputSettings {
|
|
s.ArchiveOutputSettings = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetHlsOutputSettings sets the HlsOutputSettings field's value.
|
|
func (s *OutputSettings) SetHlsOutputSettings(v *HlsOutputSettings) *OutputSettings {
|
|
s.HlsOutputSettings = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetMsSmoothOutputSettings sets the MsSmoothOutputSettings field's value.
|
|
func (s *OutputSettings) SetMsSmoothOutputSettings(v *MsSmoothOutputSettings) *OutputSettings {
|
|
s.MsSmoothOutputSettings = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetRtmpOutputSettings sets the RtmpOutputSettings field's value.
|
|
func (s *OutputSettings) SetRtmpOutputSettings(v *RtmpOutputSettings) *OutputSettings {
|
|
s.RtmpOutputSettings = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetUdpOutputSettings sets the UdpOutputSettings field's value.
|
|
func (s *OutputSettings) SetUdpOutputSettings(v *UdpOutputSettings) *OutputSettings {
|
|
s.UdpOutputSettings = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type PassThroughSettings struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s PassThroughSettings) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s PassThroughSettings) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type PurchaseOfferingInput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// Count is a required field
|
|
Count *int64 `locationName:"count" min:"1" type:"integer" required:"true"`
|
|
|
|
Name *string `locationName:"name" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// OfferingId is a required field
|
|
OfferingId *string `location:"uri" locationName:"offeringId" type:"string" required:"true"`
|
|
|
|
RequestId *string `locationName:"requestId" type:"string" idempotencyToken:"true"`
|
|
|
|
Start *string `locationName:"start" type:"string"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s PurchaseOfferingInput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s PurchaseOfferingInput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *PurchaseOfferingInput) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "PurchaseOfferingInput"}
|
|
if s.Count == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("Count"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.Count != nil && *s.Count < 1 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinValue("Count", 1))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.OfferingId == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("OfferingId"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.OfferingId != nil && len(*s.OfferingId) < 1 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("OfferingId", 1))
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetCount sets the Count field's value.
|
|
func (s *PurchaseOfferingInput) SetCount(v int64) *PurchaseOfferingInput {
|
|
s.Count = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetName sets the Name field's value.
|
|
func (s *PurchaseOfferingInput) SetName(v string) *PurchaseOfferingInput {
|
|
s.Name = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetOfferingId sets the OfferingId field's value.
|
|
func (s *PurchaseOfferingInput) SetOfferingId(v string) *PurchaseOfferingInput {
|
|
s.OfferingId = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetRequestId sets the RequestId field's value.
|
|
func (s *PurchaseOfferingInput) SetRequestId(v string) *PurchaseOfferingInput {
|
|
s.RequestId = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetStart sets the Start field's value.
|
|
func (s *PurchaseOfferingInput) SetStart(v string) *PurchaseOfferingInput {
|
|
s.Start = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type PurchaseOfferingOutput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// Reserved resources available to use
|
|
Reservation *Reservation `locationName:"reservation" type:"structure"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s PurchaseOfferingOutput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s PurchaseOfferingOutput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetReservation sets the Reservation field's value.
|
|
func (s *PurchaseOfferingOutput) SetReservation(v *Reservation) *PurchaseOfferingOutput {
|
|
s.Reservation = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type RemixSettings struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// Mapping of input channels to output channels, with appropriate gain adjustments.
|
|
//
|
|
// ChannelMappings is a required field
|
|
ChannelMappings []*AudioChannelMapping `locationName:"channelMappings" type:"list" required:"true"`
|
|
|
|
// Number of input channels to be used.
|
|
ChannelsIn *int64 `locationName:"channelsIn" min:"1" type:"integer"`
|
|
|
|
// Number of output channels to be produced.Valid values: 1, 2, 4, 6, 8
|
|
ChannelsOut *int64 `locationName:"channelsOut" min:"1" type:"integer"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s RemixSettings) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s RemixSettings) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *RemixSettings) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "RemixSettings"}
|
|
if s.ChannelMappings == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("ChannelMappings"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.ChannelsIn != nil && *s.ChannelsIn < 1 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinValue("ChannelsIn", 1))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.ChannelsOut != nil && *s.ChannelsOut < 1 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinValue("ChannelsOut", 1))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.ChannelMappings != nil {
|
|
for i, v := range s.ChannelMappings {
|
|
if v == nil {
|
|
continue
|
|
}
|
|
if err := v.Validate(); err != nil {
|
|
invalidParams.AddNested(fmt.Sprintf("%s[%v]", "ChannelMappings", i), err.(request.ErrInvalidParams))
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetChannelMappings sets the ChannelMappings field's value.
|
|
func (s *RemixSettings) SetChannelMappings(v []*AudioChannelMapping) *RemixSettings {
|
|
s.ChannelMappings = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetChannelsIn sets the ChannelsIn field's value.
|
|
func (s *RemixSettings) SetChannelsIn(v int64) *RemixSettings {
|
|
s.ChannelsIn = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetChannelsOut sets the ChannelsOut field's value.
|
|
func (s *RemixSettings) SetChannelsOut(v int64) *RemixSettings {
|
|
s.ChannelsOut = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Reserved resources available to use
|
|
type Reservation struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// Unique reservation ARN, e.g. 'arn:aws:medialive:us-west-2:123456789012:reservation:1234567'
|
|
Arn *string `locationName:"arn" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// Number of reserved resources
|
|
Count *int64 `locationName:"count" type:"integer"`
|
|
|
|
// Currency code for usagePrice and fixedPrice in ISO-4217 format, e.g. 'USD'
|
|
CurrencyCode *string `locationName:"currencyCode" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// Lease duration, e.g. '12'
|
|
Duration *int64 `locationName:"duration" type:"integer"`
|
|
|
|
// Units for duration, e.g. 'MONTHS'
|
|
DurationUnits *string `locationName:"durationUnits" type:"string" enum:"OfferingDurationUnits"`
|
|
|
|
// Reservation UTC end date and time in ISO-8601 format, e.g. '2019-03-01T00:00:00'
|
|
End *string `locationName:"end" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// One-time charge for each reserved resource, e.g. '0.0' for a NO_UPFRONT offering
|
|
FixedPrice *float64 `locationName:"fixedPrice" type:"double"`
|
|
|
|
// User specified reservation name
|
|
Name *string `locationName:"name" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// Offering description, e.g. 'HD AVC output at 10-20 Mbps, 30 fps, and standard
|
|
// VQ in US West (Oregon)'
|
|
OfferingDescription *string `locationName:"offeringDescription" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// Unique offering ID, e.g. '87654321'
|
|
OfferingId *string `locationName:"offeringId" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// Offering type, e.g. 'NO_UPFRONT'
|
|
OfferingType *string `locationName:"offeringType" type:"string" enum:"OfferingType"`
|
|
|
|
// AWS region, e.g. 'us-west-2'
|
|
Region *string `locationName:"region" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// Unique reservation ID, e.g. '1234567'
|
|
ReservationId *string `locationName:"reservationId" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// Resource configuration details
|
|
ResourceSpecification *ReservationResourceSpecification `locationName:"resourceSpecification" type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// Reservation UTC start date and time in ISO-8601 format, e.g. '2018-03-01T00:00:00'
|
|
Start *string `locationName:"start" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// Current state of reservation, e.g. 'ACTIVE'
|
|
State *string `locationName:"state" type:"string" enum:"ReservationState"`
|
|
|
|
// Recurring usage charge for each reserved resource, e.g. '157.0'
|
|
UsagePrice *float64 `locationName:"usagePrice" type:"double"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s Reservation) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s Reservation) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetArn sets the Arn field's value.
|
|
func (s *Reservation) SetArn(v string) *Reservation {
|
|
s.Arn = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetCount sets the Count field's value.
|
|
func (s *Reservation) SetCount(v int64) *Reservation {
|
|
s.Count = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetCurrencyCode sets the CurrencyCode field's value.
|
|
func (s *Reservation) SetCurrencyCode(v string) *Reservation {
|
|
s.CurrencyCode = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetDuration sets the Duration field's value.
|
|
func (s *Reservation) SetDuration(v int64) *Reservation {
|
|
s.Duration = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetDurationUnits sets the DurationUnits field's value.
|
|
func (s *Reservation) SetDurationUnits(v string) *Reservation {
|
|
s.DurationUnits = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetEnd sets the End field's value.
|
|
func (s *Reservation) SetEnd(v string) *Reservation {
|
|
s.End = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetFixedPrice sets the FixedPrice field's value.
|
|
func (s *Reservation) SetFixedPrice(v float64) *Reservation {
|
|
s.FixedPrice = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetName sets the Name field's value.
|
|
func (s *Reservation) SetName(v string) *Reservation {
|
|
s.Name = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetOfferingDescription sets the OfferingDescription field's value.
|
|
func (s *Reservation) SetOfferingDescription(v string) *Reservation {
|
|
s.OfferingDescription = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetOfferingId sets the OfferingId field's value.
|
|
func (s *Reservation) SetOfferingId(v string) *Reservation {
|
|
s.OfferingId = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetOfferingType sets the OfferingType field's value.
|
|
func (s *Reservation) SetOfferingType(v string) *Reservation {
|
|
s.OfferingType = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetRegion sets the Region field's value.
|
|
func (s *Reservation) SetRegion(v string) *Reservation {
|
|
s.Region = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetReservationId sets the ReservationId field's value.
|
|
func (s *Reservation) SetReservationId(v string) *Reservation {
|
|
s.ReservationId = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetResourceSpecification sets the ResourceSpecification field's value.
|
|
func (s *Reservation) SetResourceSpecification(v *ReservationResourceSpecification) *Reservation {
|
|
s.ResourceSpecification = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetStart sets the Start field's value.
|
|
func (s *Reservation) SetStart(v string) *Reservation {
|
|
s.Start = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetState sets the State field's value.
|
|
func (s *Reservation) SetState(v string) *Reservation {
|
|
s.State = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetUsagePrice sets the UsagePrice field's value.
|
|
func (s *Reservation) SetUsagePrice(v float64) *Reservation {
|
|
s.UsagePrice = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Resource configuration (codec, resolution, bitrate, ...)
|
|
type ReservationResourceSpecification struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// Codec, e.g. 'AVC'
|
|
Codec *string `locationName:"codec" type:"string" enum:"ReservationCodec"`
|
|
|
|
// Maximum bitrate, e.g. 'MAX_20_MBPS'
|
|
MaximumBitrate *string `locationName:"maximumBitrate" type:"string" enum:"ReservationMaximumBitrate"`
|
|
|
|
// Maximum framerate, e.g. 'MAX_30_FPS' (Outputs only)
|
|
MaximumFramerate *string `locationName:"maximumFramerate" type:"string" enum:"ReservationMaximumFramerate"`
|
|
|
|
// Resolution, e.g. 'HD'
|
|
Resolution *string `locationName:"resolution" type:"string" enum:"ReservationResolution"`
|
|
|
|
// Resource type, 'INPUT', 'OUTPUT', or 'CHANNEL'
|
|
ResourceType *string `locationName:"resourceType" type:"string" enum:"ReservationResourceType"`
|
|
|
|
// Special feature, e.g. 'AUDIO_NORMALIZATION' (Channels only)
|
|
SpecialFeature *string `locationName:"specialFeature" type:"string" enum:"ReservationSpecialFeature"`
|
|
|
|
// Video quality, e.g. 'STANDARD' (Outputs only)
|
|
VideoQuality *string `locationName:"videoQuality" type:"string" enum:"ReservationVideoQuality"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s ReservationResourceSpecification) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s ReservationResourceSpecification) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetCodec sets the Codec field's value.
|
|
func (s *ReservationResourceSpecification) SetCodec(v string) *ReservationResourceSpecification {
|
|
s.Codec = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetMaximumBitrate sets the MaximumBitrate field's value.
|
|
func (s *ReservationResourceSpecification) SetMaximumBitrate(v string) *ReservationResourceSpecification {
|
|
s.MaximumBitrate = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetMaximumFramerate sets the MaximumFramerate field's value.
|
|
func (s *ReservationResourceSpecification) SetMaximumFramerate(v string) *ReservationResourceSpecification {
|
|
s.MaximumFramerate = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetResolution sets the Resolution field's value.
|
|
func (s *ReservationResourceSpecification) SetResolution(v string) *ReservationResourceSpecification {
|
|
s.Resolution = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetResourceType sets the ResourceType field's value.
|
|
func (s *ReservationResourceSpecification) SetResourceType(v string) *ReservationResourceSpecification {
|
|
s.ResourceType = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetSpecialFeature sets the SpecialFeature field's value.
|
|
func (s *ReservationResourceSpecification) SetSpecialFeature(v string) *ReservationResourceSpecification {
|
|
s.SpecialFeature = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetVideoQuality sets the VideoQuality field's value.
|
|
func (s *ReservationResourceSpecification) SetVideoQuality(v string) *ReservationResourceSpecification {
|
|
s.VideoQuality = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type RtmpCaptionInfoDestinationSettings struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s RtmpCaptionInfoDestinationSettings) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s RtmpCaptionInfoDestinationSettings) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type RtmpGroupSettings struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// Authentication scheme to use when connecting with CDN
|
|
AuthenticationScheme *string `locationName:"authenticationScheme" type:"string" enum:"AuthenticationScheme"`
|
|
|
|
// Controls behavior when content cache fills up. If remote origin server stalls
|
|
// the RTMP connection and does not accept content fast enough the 'Media Cache'
|
|
// will fill up. When the cache reaches the duration specified by cacheLength
|
|
// the cache will stop accepting new content. If set to disconnectImmediately,
|
|
// the RTMP output will force a disconnect. Clear the media cache, and reconnect
|
|
// after restartDelay seconds. If set to waitForServer, the RTMP output will
|
|
// wait up to 5 minutes to allow the origin server to begin accepting data again.
|
|
CacheFullBehavior *string `locationName:"cacheFullBehavior" type:"string" enum:"RtmpCacheFullBehavior"`
|
|
|
|
// Cache length, in seconds, is used to calculate buffer size.
|
|
CacheLength *int64 `locationName:"cacheLength" min:"30" type:"integer"`
|
|
|
|
// Controls the types of data that passes to onCaptionInfo outputs. If set to
|
|
// 'all' then 608 and 708 carried DTVCC data will be passed. If set to 'field1AndField2608'
|
|
// then DTVCC data will be stripped out, but 608 data from both fields will
|
|
// be passed. If set to 'field1608' then only the data carried in 608 from field
|
|
// 1 video will be passed.
|
|
CaptionData *string `locationName:"captionData" type:"string" enum:"RtmpCaptionData"`
|
|
|
|
// Controls the behavior of this RTMP group if input becomes unavailable.- emitOutput:
|
|
// Emit a slate until input returns.- pauseOutput: Stop transmitting data until
|
|
// input returns. This does not close the underlying RTMP connection.
|
|
InputLossAction *string `locationName:"inputLossAction" type:"string" enum:"InputLossActionForRtmpOut"`
|
|
|
|
// If a streaming output fails, number of seconds to wait until a restart is
|
|
// initiated. A value of 0 means never restart.
|
|
RestartDelay *int64 `locationName:"restartDelay" type:"integer"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s RtmpGroupSettings) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s RtmpGroupSettings) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *RtmpGroupSettings) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "RtmpGroupSettings"}
|
|
if s.CacheLength != nil && *s.CacheLength < 30 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinValue("CacheLength", 30))
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetAuthenticationScheme sets the AuthenticationScheme field's value.
|
|
func (s *RtmpGroupSettings) SetAuthenticationScheme(v string) *RtmpGroupSettings {
|
|
s.AuthenticationScheme = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetCacheFullBehavior sets the CacheFullBehavior field's value.
|
|
func (s *RtmpGroupSettings) SetCacheFullBehavior(v string) *RtmpGroupSettings {
|
|
s.CacheFullBehavior = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetCacheLength sets the CacheLength field's value.
|
|
func (s *RtmpGroupSettings) SetCacheLength(v int64) *RtmpGroupSettings {
|
|
s.CacheLength = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetCaptionData sets the CaptionData field's value.
|
|
func (s *RtmpGroupSettings) SetCaptionData(v string) *RtmpGroupSettings {
|
|
s.CaptionData = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetInputLossAction sets the InputLossAction field's value.
|
|
func (s *RtmpGroupSettings) SetInputLossAction(v string) *RtmpGroupSettings {
|
|
s.InputLossAction = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetRestartDelay sets the RestartDelay field's value.
|
|
func (s *RtmpGroupSettings) SetRestartDelay(v int64) *RtmpGroupSettings {
|
|
s.RestartDelay = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type RtmpOutputSettings struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// If set to verifyAuthenticity, verify the tls certificate chain to a trusted
|
|
// Certificate Authority (CA). This will cause rtmps outputs with self-signed
|
|
// certificates to fail.
|
|
CertificateMode *string `locationName:"certificateMode" type:"string" enum:"RtmpOutputCertificateMode"`
|
|
|
|
// Number of seconds to wait before retrying a connection to the Flash Media
|
|
// server if the connection is lost.
|
|
ConnectionRetryInterval *int64 `locationName:"connectionRetryInterval" min:"1" type:"integer"`
|
|
|
|
// The RTMP endpoint excluding the stream name (eg. rtmp://host/appname). For
|
|
// connection to Akamai, a username and password must be supplied. URI fields
|
|
// accept format identifiers.
|
|
//
|
|
// Destination is a required field
|
|
Destination *OutputLocationRef `locationName:"destination" type:"structure" required:"true"`
|
|
|
|
// Number of retry attempts.
|
|
NumRetries *int64 `locationName:"numRetries" type:"integer"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s RtmpOutputSettings) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s RtmpOutputSettings) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *RtmpOutputSettings) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "RtmpOutputSettings"}
|
|
if s.ConnectionRetryInterval != nil && *s.ConnectionRetryInterval < 1 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinValue("ConnectionRetryInterval", 1))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.Destination == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("Destination"))
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetCertificateMode sets the CertificateMode field's value.
|
|
func (s *RtmpOutputSettings) SetCertificateMode(v string) *RtmpOutputSettings {
|
|
s.CertificateMode = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetConnectionRetryInterval sets the ConnectionRetryInterval field's value.
|
|
func (s *RtmpOutputSettings) SetConnectionRetryInterval(v int64) *RtmpOutputSettings {
|
|
s.ConnectionRetryInterval = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetDestination sets the Destination field's value.
|
|
func (s *RtmpOutputSettings) SetDestination(v *OutputLocationRef) *RtmpOutputSettings {
|
|
s.Destination = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetNumRetries sets the NumRetries field's value.
|
|
func (s *RtmpOutputSettings) SetNumRetries(v int64) *RtmpOutputSettings {
|
|
s.NumRetries = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Contains information on a single schedule action.
|
|
type ScheduleAction struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// The name of the action, must be unique within the schedule. This name provides
|
|
// the main reference to an action once it is added to the schedule. A name
|
|
// is unique if it is no longer in the schedule. The schedule is automatically
|
|
// cleaned up to remove actions with a start time of more than 1 hour ago (approximately)
|
|
// so at that point a name can be reused.
|
|
//
|
|
// ActionName is a required field
|
|
ActionName *string `locationName:"actionName" type:"string" required:"true"`
|
|
|
|
// Settings for this schedule action.
|
|
//
|
|
// ScheduleActionSettings is a required field
|
|
ScheduleActionSettings *ScheduleActionSettings `locationName:"scheduleActionSettings" type:"structure" required:"true"`
|
|
|
|
// The time for the action to start in the channel.
|
|
//
|
|
// ScheduleActionStartSettings is a required field
|
|
ScheduleActionStartSettings *ScheduleActionStartSettings `locationName:"scheduleActionStartSettings" type:"structure" required:"true"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s ScheduleAction) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s ScheduleAction) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *ScheduleAction) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "ScheduleAction"}
|
|
if s.ActionName == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("ActionName"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.ScheduleActionSettings == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("ScheduleActionSettings"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.ScheduleActionStartSettings == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("ScheduleActionStartSettings"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.ScheduleActionSettings != nil {
|
|
if err := s.ScheduleActionSettings.Validate(); err != nil {
|
|
invalidParams.AddNested("ScheduleActionSettings", err.(request.ErrInvalidParams))
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
if s.ScheduleActionStartSettings != nil {
|
|
if err := s.ScheduleActionStartSettings.Validate(); err != nil {
|
|
invalidParams.AddNested("ScheduleActionStartSettings", err.(request.ErrInvalidParams))
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetActionName sets the ActionName field's value.
|
|
func (s *ScheduleAction) SetActionName(v string) *ScheduleAction {
|
|
s.ActionName = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetScheduleActionSettings sets the ScheduleActionSettings field's value.
|
|
func (s *ScheduleAction) SetScheduleActionSettings(v *ScheduleActionSettings) *ScheduleAction {
|
|
s.ScheduleActionSettings = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetScheduleActionStartSettings sets the ScheduleActionStartSettings field's value.
|
|
func (s *ScheduleAction) SetScheduleActionStartSettings(v *ScheduleActionStartSettings) *ScheduleAction {
|
|
s.ScheduleActionStartSettings = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Holds the settings for a single schedule action.
|
|
type ScheduleActionSettings struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// Settings to emit HLS metadata
|
|
HlsTimedMetadataSettings *HlsTimedMetadataScheduleActionSettings `locationName:"hlsTimedMetadataSettings" type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// Settings to switch an input
|
|
InputSwitchSettings *InputSwitchScheduleActionSettings `locationName:"inputSwitchSettings" type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// Settings for SCTE-35 return_to_network message
|
|
Scte35ReturnToNetworkSettings *Scte35ReturnToNetworkScheduleActionSettings `locationName:"scte35ReturnToNetworkSettings" type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// Settings for SCTE-35 splice_insert message
|
|
Scte35SpliceInsertSettings *Scte35SpliceInsertScheduleActionSettings `locationName:"scte35SpliceInsertSettings" type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// Settings for SCTE-35 time_signal message
|
|
Scte35TimeSignalSettings *Scte35TimeSignalScheduleActionSettings `locationName:"scte35TimeSignalSettings" type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// Settings to activate a static image overlay
|
|
StaticImageActivateSettings *StaticImageActivateScheduleActionSettings `locationName:"staticImageActivateSettings" type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// Settings to deactivate a static image overlay
|
|
StaticImageDeactivateSettings *StaticImageDeactivateScheduleActionSettings `locationName:"staticImageDeactivateSettings" type:"structure"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s ScheduleActionSettings) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s ScheduleActionSettings) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *ScheduleActionSettings) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "ScheduleActionSettings"}
|
|
if s.HlsTimedMetadataSettings != nil {
|
|
if err := s.HlsTimedMetadataSettings.Validate(); err != nil {
|
|
invalidParams.AddNested("HlsTimedMetadataSettings", err.(request.ErrInvalidParams))
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
if s.InputSwitchSettings != nil {
|
|
if err := s.InputSwitchSettings.Validate(); err != nil {
|
|
invalidParams.AddNested("InputSwitchSettings", err.(request.ErrInvalidParams))
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
if s.Scte35ReturnToNetworkSettings != nil {
|
|
if err := s.Scte35ReturnToNetworkSettings.Validate(); err != nil {
|
|
invalidParams.AddNested("Scte35ReturnToNetworkSettings", err.(request.ErrInvalidParams))
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
if s.Scte35SpliceInsertSettings != nil {
|
|
if err := s.Scte35SpliceInsertSettings.Validate(); err != nil {
|
|
invalidParams.AddNested("Scte35SpliceInsertSettings", err.(request.ErrInvalidParams))
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
if s.Scte35TimeSignalSettings != nil {
|
|
if err := s.Scte35TimeSignalSettings.Validate(); err != nil {
|
|
invalidParams.AddNested("Scte35TimeSignalSettings", err.(request.ErrInvalidParams))
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
if s.StaticImageActivateSettings != nil {
|
|
if err := s.StaticImageActivateSettings.Validate(); err != nil {
|
|
invalidParams.AddNested("StaticImageActivateSettings", err.(request.ErrInvalidParams))
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetHlsTimedMetadataSettings sets the HlsTimedMetadataSettings field's value.
|
|
func (s *ScheduleActionSettings) SetHlsTimedMetadataSettings(v *HlsTimedMetadataScheduleActionSettings) *ScheduleActionSettings {
|
|
s.HlsTimedMetadataSettings = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetInputSwitchSettings sets the InputSwitchSettings field's value.
|
|
func (s *ScheduleActionSettings) SetInputSwitchSettings(v *InputSwitchScheduleActionSettings) *ScheduleActionSettings {
|
|
s.InputSwitchSettings = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetScte35ReturnToNetworkSettings sets the Scte35ReturnToNetworkSettings field's value.
|
|
func (s *ScheduleActionSettings) SetScte35ReturnToNetworkSettings(v *Scte35ReturnToNetworkScheduleActionSettings) *ScheduleActionSettings {
|
|
s.Scte35ReturnToNetworkSettings = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetScte35SpliceInsertSettings sets the Scte35SpliceInsertSettings field's value.
|
|
func (s *ScheduleActionSettings) SetScte35SpliceInsertSettings(v *Scte35SpliceInsertScheduleActionSettings) *ScheduleActionSettings {
|
|
s.Scte35SpliceInsertSettings = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetScte35TimeSignalSettings sets the Scte35TimeSignalSettings field's value.
|
|
func (s *ScheduleActionSettings) SetScte35TimeSignalSettings(v *Scte35TimeSignalScheduleActionSettings) *ScheduleActionSettings {
|
|
s.Scte35TimeSignalSettings = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetStaticImageActivateSettings sets the StaticImageActivateSettings field's value.
|
|
func (s *ScheduleActionSettings) SetStaticImageActivateSettings(v *StaticImageActivateScheduleActionSettings) *ScheduleActionSettings {
|
|
s.StaticImageActivateSettings = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetStaticImageDeactivateSettings sets the StaticImageDeactivateSettings field's value.
|
|
func (s *ScheduleActionSettings) SetStaticImageDeactivateSettings(v *StaticImageDeactivateScheduleActionSettings) *ScheduleActionSettings {
|
|
s.StaticImageDeactivateSettings = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Settings to specify the start time for an action.
|
|
type ScheduleActionStartSettings struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// Holds the start time for the action.
|
|
FixedModeScheduleActionStartSettings *FixedModeScheduleActionStartSettings `locationName:"fixedModeScheduleActionStartSettings" type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// Specifies an action to follow for scheduling this action.
|
|
FollowModeScheduleActionStartSettings *FollowModeScheduleActionStartSettings `locationName:"followModeScheduleActionStartSettings" type:"structure"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s ScheduleActionStartSettings) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s ScheduleActionStartSettings) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *ScheduleActionStartSettings) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "ScheduleActionStartSettings"}
|
|
if s.FixedModeScheduleActionStartSettings != nil {
|
|
if err := s.FixedModeScheduleActionStartSettings.Validate(); err != nil {
|
|
invalidParams.AddNested("FixedModeScheduleActionStartSettings", err.(request.ErrInvalidParams))
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
if s.FollowModeScheduleActionStartSettings != nil {
|
|
if err := s.FollowModeScheduleActionStartSettings.Validate(); err != nil {
|
|
invalidParams.AddNested("FollowModeScheduleActionStartSettings", err.(request.ErrInvalidParams))
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetFixedModeScheduleActionStartSettings sets the FixedModeScheduleActionStartSettings field's value.
|
|
func (s *ScheduleActionStartSettings) SetFixedModeScheduleActionStartSettings(v *FixedModeScheduleActionStartSettings) *ScheduleActionStartSettings {
|
|
s.FixedModeScheduleActionStartSettings = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetFollowModeScheduleActionStartSettings sets the FollowModeScheduleActionStartSettings field's value.
|
|
func (s *ScheduleActionStartSettings) SetFollowModeScheduleActionStartSettings(v *FollowModeScheduleActionStartSettings) *ScheduleActionStartSettings {
|
|
s.FollowModeScheduleActionStartSettings = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type Scte20PlusEmbeddedDestinationSettings struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s Scte20PlusEmbeddedDestinationSettings) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s Scte20PlusEmbeddedDestinationSettings) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type Scte20SourceSettings struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// If upconvert, 608 data is both passed through via the "608 compatibility
|
|
// bytes" fields of the 708 wrapper as well as translated into 708. 708 data
|
|
// present in the source content will be discarded.
|
|
Convert608To708 *string `locationName:"convert608To708" type:"string" enum:"Scte20Convert608To708"`
|
|
|
|
// Specifies the 608/708 channel number within the video track from which to
|
|
// extract captions. Unused for passthrough.
|
|
Source608ChannelNumber *int64 `locationName:"source608ChannelNumber" min:"1" type:"integer"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s Scte20SourceSettings) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s Scte20SourceSettings) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *Scte20SourceSettings) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "Scte20SourceSettings"}
|
|
if s.Source608ChannelNumber != nil && *s.Source608ChannelNumber < 1 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinValue("Source608ChannelNumber", 1))
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetConvert608To708 sets the Convert608To708 field's value.
|
|
func (s *Scte20SourceSettings) SetConvert608To708(v string) *Scte20SourceSettings {
|
|
s.Convert608To708 = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetSource608ChannelNumber sets the Source608ChannelNumber field's value.
|
|
func (s *Scte20SourceSettings) SetSource608ChannelNumber(v int64) *Scte20SourceSettings {
|
|
s.Source608ChannelNumber = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type Scte27DestinationSettings struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s Scte27DestinationSettings) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s Scte27DestinationSettings) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type Scte27SourceSettings struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// The pid field is used in conjunction with the caption selector languageCode
|
|
// field as follows: - Specify PID and Language: Extracts captions from that
|
|
// PID; the language is "informational". - Specify PID and omit Language: Extracts
|
|
// the specified PID. - Omit PID and specify Language: Extracts the specified
|
|
// language, whichever PID that happens to be. - Omit PID and omit Language:
|
|
// Valid only if source is DVB-Sub that is being passed through; all languages
|
|
// will be passed through.
|
|
Pid *int64 `locationName:"pid" min:"1" type:"integer"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s Scte27SourceSettings) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s Scte27SourceSettings) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *Scte27SourceSettings) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "Scte27SourceSettings"}
|
|
if s.Pid != nil && *s.Pid < 1 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinValue("Pid", 1))
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetPid sets the Pid field's value.
|
|
func (s *Scte27SourceSettings) SetPid(v int64) *Scte27SourceSettings {
|
|
s.Pid = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Corresponds to SCTE-35 delivery_not_restricted_flag parameter. To declare
|
|
// delivery restrictions, include this element and its four "restriction" flags.
|
|
// To declare that there are no restrictions, omit this element.
|
|
type Scte35DeliveryRestrictions struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// Corresponds to SCTE-35 archive_allowed_flag.
|
|
//
|
|
// ArchiveAllowedFlag is a required field
|
|
ArchiveAllowedFlag *string `locationName:"archiveAllowedFlag" type:"string" required:"true" enum:"Scte35ArchiveAllowedFlag"`
|
|
|
|
// Corresponds to SCTE-35 device_restrictions parameter.
|
|
//
|
|
// DeviceRestrictions is a required field
|
|
DeviceRestrictions *string `locationName:"deviceRestrictions" type:"string" required:"true" enum:"Scte35DeviceRestrictions"`
|
|
|
|
// Corresponds to SCTE-35 no_regional_blackout_flag parameter.
|
|
//
|
|
// NoRegionalBlackoutFlag is a required field
|
|
NoRegionalBlackoutFlag *string `locationName:"noRegionalBlackoutFlag" type:"string" required:"true" enum:"Scte35NoRegionalBlackoutFlag"`
|
|
|
|
// Corresponds to SCTE-35 web_delivery_allowed_flag parameter.
|
|
//
|
|
// WebDeliveryAllowedFlag is a required field
|
|
WebDeliveryAllowedFlag *string `locationName:"webDeliveryAllowedFlag" type:"string" required:"true" enum:"Scte35WebDeliveryAllowedFlag"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s Scte35DeliveryRestrictions) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s Scte35DeliveryRestrictions) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *Scte35DeliveryRestrictions) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "Scte35DeliveryRestrictions"}
|
|
if s.ArchiveAllowedFlag == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("ArchiveAllowedFlag"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.DeviceRestrictions == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("DeviceRestrictions"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.NoRegionalBlackoutFlag == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("NoRegionalBlackoutFlag"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.WebDeliveryAllowedFlag == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("WebDeliveryAllowedFlag"))
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetArchiveAllowedFlag sets the ArchiveAllowedFlag field's value.
|
|
func (s *Scte35DeliveryRestrictions) SetArchiveAllowedFlag(v string) *Scte35DeliveryRestrictions {
|
|
s.ArchiveAllowedFlag = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetDeviceRestrictions sets the DeviceRestrictions field's value.
|
|
func (s *Scte35DeliveryRestrictions) SetDeviceRestrictions(v string) *Scte35DeliveryRestrictions {
|
|
s.DeviceRestrictions = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetNoRegionalBlackoutFlag sets the NoRegionalBlackoutFlag field's value.
|
|
func (s *Scte35DeliveryRestrictions) SetNoRegionalBlackoutFlag(v string) *Scte35DeliveryRestrictions {
|
|
s.NoRegionalBlackoutFlag = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetWebDeliveryAllowedFlag sets the WebDeliveryAllowedFlag field's value.
|
|
func (s *Scte35DeliveryRestrictions) SetWebDeliveryAllowedFlag(v string) *Scte35DeliveryRestrictions {
|
|
s.WebDeliveryAllowedFlag = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Holds one set of SCTE-35 Descriptor Settings.
|
|
type Scte35Descriptor struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// SCTE-35 Descriptor Settings.
|
|
//
|
|
// Scte35DescriptorSettings is a required field
|
|
Scte35DescriptorSettings *Scte35DescriptorSettings `locationName:"scte35DescriptorSettings" type:"structure" required:"true"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s Scte35Descriptor) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s Scte35Descriptor) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *Scte35Descriptor) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "Scte35Descriptor"}
|
|
if s.Scte35DescriptorSettings == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("Scte35DescriptorSettings"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.Scte35DescriptorSettings != nil {
|
|
if err := s.Scte35DescriptorSettings.Validate(); err != nil {
|
|
invalidParams.AddNested("Scte35DescriptorSettings", err.(request.ErrInvalidParams))
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetScte35DescriptorSettings sets the Scte35DescriptorSettings field's value.
|
|
func (s *Scte35Descriptor) SetScte35DescriptorSettings(v *Scte35DescriptorSettings) *Scte35Descriptor {
|
|
s.Scte35DescriptorSettings = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SCTE-35 Descriptor settings.
|
|
type Scte35DescriptorSettings struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// SCTE-35 Segmentation Descriptor.
|
|
//
|
|
// SegmentationDescriptorScte35DescriptorSettings is a required field
|
|
SegmentationDescriptorScte35DescriptorSettings *Scte35SegmentationDescriptor `locationName:"segmentationDescriptorScte35DescriptorSettings" type:"structure" required:"true"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s Scte35DescriptorSettings) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s Scte35DescriptorSettings) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *Scte35DescriptorSettings) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "Scte35DescriptorSettings"}
|
|
if s.SegmentationDescriptorScte35DescriptorSettings == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("SegmentationDescriptorScte35DescriptorSettings"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.SegmentationDescriptorScte35DescriptorSettings != nil {
|
|
if err := s.SegmentationDescriptorScte35DescriptorSettings.Validate(); err != nil {
|
|
invalidParams.AddNested("SegmentationDescriptorScte35DescriptorSettings", err.(request.ErrInvalidParams))
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetSegmentationDescriptorScte35DescriptorSettings sets the SegmentationDescriptorScte35DescriptorSettings field's value.
|
|
func (s *Scte35DescriptorSettings) SetSegmentationDescriptorScte35DescriptorSettings(v *Scte35SegmentationDescriptor) *Scte35DescriptorSettings {
|
|
s.SegmentationDescriptorScte35DescriptorSettings = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Settings for a SCTE-35 return_to_network message.
|
|
type Scte35ReturnToNetworkScheduleActionSettings struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// The splice_event_id for the SCTE-35 splice_insert, as defined in SCTE-35.
|
|
//
|
|
// SpliceEventId is a required field
|
|
SpliceEventId *int64 `locationName:"spliceEventId" type:"long" required:"true"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s Scte35ReturnToNetworkScheduleActionSettings) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s Scte35ReturnToNetworkScheduleActionSettings) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *Scte35ReturnToNetworkScheduleActionSettings) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "Scte35ReturnToNetworkScheduleActionSettings"}
|
|
if s.SpliceEventId == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("SpliceEventId"))
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetSpliceEventId sets the SpliceEventId field's value.
|
|
func (s *Scte35ReturnToNetworkScheduleActionSettings) SetSpliceEventId(v int64) *Scte35ReturnToNetworkScheduleActionSettings {
|
|
s.SpliceEventId = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Corresponds to SCTE-35 segmentation_descriptor.
|
|
type Scte35SegmentationDescriptor struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// Holds the four SCTE-35 delivery restriction parameters.
|
|
DeliveryRestrictions *Scte35DeliveryRestrictions `locationName:"deliveryRestrictions" type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// Corresponds to SCTE-35 segment_num. A value that is valid for the specified
|
|
// segmentation_type_id.
|
|
SegmentNum *int64 `locationName:"segmentNum" type:"integer"`
|
|
|
|
// Corresponds to SCTE-35 segmentation_event_cancel_indicator.
|
|
//
|
|
// SegmentationCancelIndicator is a required field
|
|
SegmentationCancelIndicator *string `locationName:"segmentationCancelIndicator" type:"string" required:"true" enum:"Scte35SegmentationCancelIndicator"`
|
|
|
|
// Corresponds to SCTE-35 segmentation_duration. Optional. The duration for
|
|
// the time_signal, in 90 KHz ticks. To convert seconds to ticks, multiple the
|
|
// seconds by 90,000. Enter time in 90 KHz clock ticks. If you do not enter
|
|
// a duration, the time_signal will continue until you insert a cancellation
|
|
// message.
|
|
SegmentationDuration *int64 `locationName:"segmentationDuration" type:"long"`
|
|
|
|
// Corresponds to SCTE-35 segmentation_event_id.
|
|
//
|
|
// SegmentationEventId is a required field
|
|
SegmentationEventId *int64 `locationName:"segmentationEventId" type:"long" required:"true"`
|
|
|
|
// Corresponds to SCTE-35 segmentation_type_id. One of the segmentation_type_id
|
|
// values listed in the SCTE-35 specification. On the console, enter the ID
|
|
// in decimal (for example, "52"). In the CLI, API, or an SDK, enter the ID
|
|
// in hex (for example, "0x34") or decimal (for example, "52").
|
|
SegmentationTypeId *int64 `locationName:"segmentationTypeId" type:"integer"`
|
|
|
|
// Corresponds to SCTE-35 segmentation_upid. Enter a string containing the hexadecimal
|
|
// representation of the characters that make up the SCTE-35 segmentation_upid
|
|
// value. Must contain an even number of hex characters. Do not include spaces
|
|
// between each hex pair. For example, the ASCII "ADS Information" becomes hex
|
|
// "41445320496e666f726d6174696f6e.
|
|
SegmentationUpid *string `locationName:"segmentationUpid" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// Corresponds to SCTE-35 segmentation_upid_type. On the console, enter one
|
|
// of the types listed in the SCTE-35 specification, converted to a decimal.
|
|
// For example, "0x0C" hex from the specification is "12" in decimal. In the
|
|
// CLI, API, or an SDK, enter one of the types listed in the SCTE-35 specification,
|
|
// in either hex (for example, "0x0C" ) or in decimal (for example, "12").
|
|
SegmentationUpidType *int64 `locationName:"segmentationUpidType" type:"integer"`
|
|
|
|
// Corresponds to SCTE-35 segments_expected. A value that is valid for the specified
|
|
// segmentation_type_id.
|
|
SegmentsExpected *int64 `locationName:"segmentsExpected" type:"integer"`
|
|
|
|
// Corresponds to SCTE-35 sub_segment_num. A value that is valid for the specified
|
|
// segmentation_type_id.
|
|
SubSegmentNum *int64 `locationName:"subSegmentNum" type:"integer"`
|
|
|
|
// Corresponds to SCTE-35 sub_segments_expected. A value that is valid for the
|
|
// specified segmentation_type_id.
|
|
SubSegmentsExpected *int64 `locationName:"subSegmentsExpected" type:"integer"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s Scte35SegmentationDescriptor) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s Scte35SegmentationDescriptor) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *Scte35SegmentationDescriptor) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "Scte35SegmentationDescriptor"}
|
|
if s.SegmentationCancelIndicator == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("SegmentationCancelIndicator"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.SegmentationEventId == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("SegmentationEventId"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.DeliveryRestrictions != nil {
|
|
if err := s.DeliveryRestrictions.Validate(); err != nil {
|
|
invalidParams.AddNested("DeliveryRestrictions", err.(request.ErrInvalidParams))
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetDeliveryRestrictions sets the DeliveryRestrictions field's value.
|
|
func (s *Scte35SegmentationDescriptor) SetDeliveryRestrictions(v *Scte35DeliveryRestrictions) *Scte35SegmentationDescriptor {
|
|
s.DeliveryRestrictions = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetSegmentNum sets the SegmentNum field's value.
|
|
func (s *Scte35SegmentationDescriptor) SetSegmentNum(v int64) *Scte35SegmentationDescriptor {
|
|
s.SegmentNum = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetSegmentationCancelIndicator sets the SegmentationCancelIndicator field's value.
|
|
func (s *Scte35SegmentationDescriptor) SetSegmentationCancelIndicator(v string) *Scte35SegmentationDescriptor {
|
|
s.SegmentationCancelIndicator = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetSegmentationDuration sets the SegmentationDuration field's value.
|
|
func (s *Scte35SegmentationDescriptor) SetSegmentationDuration(v int64) *Scte35SegmentationDescriptor {
|
|
s.SegmentationDuration = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetSegmentationEventId sets the SegmentationEventId field's value.
|
|
func (s *Scte35SegmentationDescriptor) SetSegmentationEventId(v int64) *Scte35SegmentationDescriptor {
|
|
s.SegmentationEventId = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetSegmentationTypeId sets the SegmentationTypeId field's value.
|
|
func (s *Scte35SegmentationDescriptor) SetSegmentationTypeId(v int64) *Scte35SegmentationDescriptor {
|
|
s.SegmentationTypeId = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetSegmentationUpid sets the SegmentationUpid field's value.
|
|
func (s *Scte35SegmentationDescriptor) SetSegmentationUpid(v string) *Scte35SegmentationDescriptor {
|
|
s.SegmentationUpid = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetSegmentationUpidType sets the SegmentationUpidType field's value.
|
|
func (s *Scte35SegmentationDescriptor) SetSegmentationUpidType(v int64) *Scte35SegmentationDescriptor {
|
|
s.SegmentationUpidType = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetSegmentsExpected sets the SegmentsExpected field's value.
|
|
func (s *Scte35SegmentationDescriptor) SetSegmentsExpected(v int64) *Scte35SegmentationDescriptor {
|
|
s.SegmentsExpected = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetSubSegmentNum sets the SubSegmentNum field's value.
|
|
func (s *Scte35SegmentationDescriptor) SetSubSegmentNum(v int64) *Scte35SegmentationDescriptor {
|
|
s.SubSegmentNum = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetSubSegmentsExpected sets the SubSegmentsExpected field's value.
|
|
func (s *Scte35SegmentationDescriptor) SetSubSegmentsExpected(v int64) *Scte35SegmentationDescriptor {
|
|
s.SubSegmentsExpected = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type Scte35SpliceInsert struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// When specified, this offset (in milliseconds) is added to the input Ad Avail
|
|
// PTS time. This only applies to embedded SCTE 104/35 messages and does not
|
|
// apply to OOB messages.
|
|
AdAvailOffset *int64 `locationName:"adAvailOffset" type:"integer"`
|
|
|
|
// When set to ignore, Segment Descriptors with noRegionalBlackoutFlag set to
|
|
// 0 will no longer trigger blackouts or Ad Avail slates
|
|
NoRegionalBlackoutFlag *string `locationName:"noRegionalBlackoutFlag" type:"string" enum:"Scte35SpliceInsertNoRegionalBlackoutBehavior"`
|
|
|
|
// When set to ignore, Segment Descriptors with webDeliveryAllowedFlag set to
|
|
// 0 will no longer trigger blackouts or Ad Avail slates
|
|
WebDeliveryAllowedFlag *string `locationName:"webDeliveryAllowedFlag" type:"string" enum:"Scte35SpliceInsertWebDeliveryAllowedBehavior"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s Scte35SpliceInsert) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s Scte35SpliceInsert) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *Scte35SpliceInsert) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "Scte35SpliceInsert"}
|
|
if s.AdAvailOffset != nil && *s.AdAvailOffset < -1000 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinValue("AdAvailOffset", -1000))
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetAdAvailOffset sets the AdAvailOffset field's value.
|
|
func (s *Scte35SpliceInsert) SetAdAvailOffset(v int64) *Scte35SpliceInsert {
|
|
s.AdAvailOffset = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetNoRegionalBlackoutFlag sets the NoRegionalBlackoutFlag field's value.
|
|
func (s *Scte35SpliceInsert) SetNoRegionalBlackoutFlag(v string) *Scte35SpliceInsert {
|
|
s.NoRegionalBlackoutFlag = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetWebDeliveryAllowedFlag sets the WebDeliveryAllowedFlag field's value.
|
|
func (s *Scte35SpliceInsert) SetWebDeliveryAllowedFlag(v string) *Scte35SpliceInsert {
|
|
s.WebDeliveryAllowedFlag = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Settings for a SCTE-35 splice_insert message.
|
|
type Scte35SpliceInsertScheduleActionSettings struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// Optional, the duration for the splice_insert, in 90 KHz ticks. To convert
|
|
// seconds to ticks, multiple the seconds by 90,000. If you enter a duration,
|
|
// there is an expectation that the downstream system can read the duration
|
|
// and cue in at that time. If you do not enter a duration, the splice_insert
|
|
// will continue indefinitely and there is an expectation that you will enter
|
|
// a return_to_network to end the splice_insert at the appropriate time.
|
|
Duration *int64 `locationName:"duration" type:"long"`
|
|
|
|
// The splice_event_id for the SCTE-35 splice_insert, as defined in SCTE-35.
|
|
//
|
|
// SpliceEventId is a required field
|
|
SpliceEventId *int64 `locationName:"spliceEventId" type:"long" required:"true"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s Scte35SpliceInsertScheduleActionSettings) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s Scte35SpliceInsertScheduleActionSettings) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *Scte35SpliceInsertScheduleActionSettings) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "Scte35SpliceInsertScheduleActionSettings"}
|
|
if s.SpliceEventId == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("SpliceEventId"))
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetDuration sets the Duration field's value.
|
|
func (s *Scte35SpliceInsertScheduleActionSettings) SetDuration(v int64) *Scte35SpliceInsertScheduleActionSettings {
|
|
s.Duration = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetSpliceEventId sets the SpliceEventId field's value.
|
|
func (s *Scte35SpliceInsertScheduleActionSettings) SetSpliceEventId(v int64) *Scte35SpliceInsertScheduleActionSettings {
|
|
s.SpliceEventId = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type Scte35TimeSignalApos struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// When specified, this offset (in milliseconds) is added to the input Ad Avail
|
|
// PTS time. This only applies to embedded SCTE 104/35 messages and does not
|
|
// apply to OOB messages.
|
|
AdAvailOffset *int64 `locationName:"adAvailOffset" type:"integer"`
|
|
|
|
// When set to ignore, Segment Descriptors with noRegionalBlackoutFlag set to
|
|
// 0 will no longer trigger blackouts or Ad Avail slates
|
|
NoRegionalBlackoutFlag *string `locationName:"noRegionalBlackoutFlag" type:"string" enum:"Scte35AposNoRegionalBlackoutBehavior"`
|
|
|
|
// When set to ignore, Segment Descriptors with webDeliveryAllowedFlag set to
|
|
// 0 will no longer trigger blackouts or Ad Avail slates
|
|
WebDeliveryAllowedFlag *string `locationName:"webDeliveryAllowedFlag" type:"string" enum:"Scte35AposWebDeliveryAllowedBehavior"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s Scte35TimeSignalApos) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s Scte35TimeSignalApos) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *Scte35TimeSignalApos) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "Scte35TimeSignalApos"}
|
|
if s.AdAvailOffset != nil && *s.AdAvailOffset < -1000 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinValue("AdAvailOffset", -1000))
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetAdAvailOffset sets the AdAvailOffset field's value.
|
|
func (s *Scte35TimeSignalApos) SetAdAvailOffset(v int64) *Scte35TimeSignalApos {
|
|
s.AdAvailOffset = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetNoRegionalBlackoutFlag sets the NoRegionalBlackoutFlag field's value.
|
|
func (s *Scte35TimeSignalApos) SetNoRegionalBlackoutFlag(v string) *Scte35TimeSignalApos {
|
|
s.NoRegionalBlackoutFlag = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetWebDeliveryAllowedFlag sets the WebDeliveryAllowedFlag field's value.
|
|
func (s *Scte35TimeSignalApos) SetWebDeliveryAllowedFlag(v string) *Scte35TimeSignalApos {
|
|
s.WebDeliveryAllowedFlag = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Settings for a SCTE-35 time_signal.
|
|
type Scte35TimeSignalScheduleActionSettings struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// The list of SCTE-35 descriptors accompanying the SCTE-35 time_signal.
|
|
//
|
|
// Scte35Descriptors is a required field
|
|
Scte35Descriptors []*Scte35Descriptor `locationName:"scte35Descriptors" type:"list" required:"true"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s Scte35TimeSignalScheduleActionSettings) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s Scte35TimeSignalScheduleActionSettings) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *Scte35TimeSignalScheduleActionSettings) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "Scte35TimeSignalScheduleActionSettings"}
|
|
if s.Scte35Descriptors == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("Scte35Descriptors"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.Scte35Descriptors != nil {
|
|
for i, v := range s.Scte35Descriptors {
|
|
if v == nil {
|
|
continue
|
|
}
|
|
if err := v.Validate(); err != nil {
|
|
invalidParams.AddNested(fmt.Sprintf("%s[%v]", "Scte35Descriptors", i), err.(request.ErrInvalidParams))
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetScte35Descriptors sets the Scte35Descriptors field's value.
|
|
func (s *Scte35TimeSignalScheduleActionSettings) SetScte35Descriptors(v []*Scte35Descriptor) *Scte35TimeSignalScheduleActionSettings {
|
|
s.Scte35Descriptors = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type SmpteTtDestinationSettings struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s SmpteTtDestinationSettings) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s SmpteTtDestinationSettings) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type StandardHlsSettings struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// List all the audio groups that are used with the video output stream. Input
|
|
// all the audio GROUP-IDs that are associated to the video, separate by ','.
|
|
AudioRenditionSets *string `locationName:"audioRenditionSets" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
// Settings information for the .m3u8 container
|
|
//
|
|
// M3u8Settings is a required field
|
|
M3u8Settings *M3u8Settings `locationName:"m3u8Settings" type:"structure" required:"true"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s StandardHlsSettings) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s StandardHlsSettings) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *StandardHlsSettings) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "StandardHlsSettings"}
|
|
if s.M3u8Settings == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("M3u8Settings"))
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetAudioRenditionSets sets the AudioRenditionSets field's value.
|
|
func (s *StandardHlsSettings) SetAudioRenditionSets(v string) *StandardHlsSettings {
|
|
s.AudioRenditionSets = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetM3u8Settings sets the M3u8Settings field's value.
|
|
func (s *StandardHlsSettings) SetM3u8Settings(v *M3u8Settings) *StandardHlsSettings {
|
|
s.M3u8Settings = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type StartChannelInput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// ChannelId is a required field
|
|
ChannelId *string `location:"uri" locationName:"channelId" type:"string" required:"true"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s StartChannelInput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s StartChannelInput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *StartChannelInput) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "StartChannelInput"}
|
|
if s.ChannelId == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("ChannelId"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.ChannelId != nil && len(*s.ChannelId) < 1 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("ChannelId", 1))
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetChannelId sets the ChannelId field's value.
|
|
func (s *StartChannelInput) SetChannelId(v string) *StartChannelInput {
|
|
s.ChannelId = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type StartChannelOutput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
Arn *string `locationName:"arn" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
Destinations []*OutputDestination `locationName:"destinations" type:"list"`
|
|
|
|
EgressEndpoints []*ChannelEgressEndpoint `locationName:"egressEndpoints" type:"list"`
|
|
|
|
EncoderSettings *EncoderSettings `locationName:"encoderSettings" type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
Id *string `locationName:"id" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
InputAttachments []*InputAttachment `locationName:"inputAttachments" type:"list"`
|
|
|
|
InputSpecification *InputSpecification `locationName:"inputSpecification" type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// The log level the user wants for their channel.
|
|
LogLevel *string `locationName:"logLevel" type:"string" enum:"LogLevel"`
|
|
|
|
Name *string `locationName:"name" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
PipelinesRunningCount *int64 `locationName:"pipelinesRunningCount" type:"integer"`
|
|
|
|
RoleArn *string `locationName:"roleArn" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
State *string `locationName:"state" type:"string" enum:"ChannelState"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s StartChannelOutput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s StartChannelOutput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetArn sets the Arn field's value.
|
|
func (s *StartChannelOutput) SetArn(v string) *StartChannelOutput {
|
|
s.Arn = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetDestinations sets the Destinations field's value.
|
|
func (s *StartChannelOutput) SetDestinations(v []*OutputDestination) *StartChannelOutput {
|
|
s.Destinations = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetEgressEndpoints sets the EgressEndpoints field's value.
|
|
func (s *StartChannelOutput) SetEgressEndpoints(v []*ChannelEgressEndpoint) *StartChannelOutput {
|
|
s.EgressEndpoints = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetEncoderSettings sets the EncoderSettings field's value.
|
|
func (s *StartChannelOutput) SetEncoderSettings(v *EncoderSettings) *StartChannelOutput {
|
|
s.EncoderSettings = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetId sets the Id field's value.
|
|
func (s *StartChannelOutput) SetId(v string) *StartChannelOutput {
|
|
s.Id = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetInputAttachments sets the InputAttachments field's value.
|
|
func (s *StartChannelOutput) SetInputAttachments(v []*InputAttachment) *StartChannelOutput {
|
|
s.InputAttachments = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetInputSpecification sets the InputSpecification field's value.
|
|
func (s *StartChannelOutput) SetInputSpecification(v *InputSpecification) *StartChannelOutput {
|
|
s.InputSpecification = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetLogLevel sets the LogLevel field's value.
|
|
func (s *StartChannelOutput) SetLogLevel(v string) *StartChannelOutput {
|
|
s.LogLevel = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetName sets the Name field's value.
|
|
func (s *StartChannelOutput) SetName(v string) *StartChannelOutput {
|
|
s.Name = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetPipelinesRunningCount sets the PipelinesRunningCount field's value.
|
|
func (s *StartChannelOutput) SetPipelinesRunningCount(v int64) *StartChannelOutput {
|
|
s.PipelinesRunningCount = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetRoleArn sets the RoleArn field's value.
|
|
func (s *StartChannelOutput) SetRoleArn(v string) *StartChannelOutput {
|
|
s.RoleArn = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetState sets the State field's value.
|
|
func (s *StartChannelOutput) SetState(v string) *StartChannelOutput {
|
|
s.State = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Settings for the action to activate a static image.
|
|
type StaticImageActivateScheduleActionSettings struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// The duration in milliseconds for the image to remain on the video. If omitted
|
|
// or set to 0 the duration is unlimited and the image will remain until it
|
|
// is explicitly deactivated.
|
|
Duration *int64 `locationName:"duration" type:"integer"`
|
|
|
|
// The time in milliseconds for the image to fade in. The fade-in starts at
|
|
// the start time of the overlay. Default is 0 (no fade-in).
|
|
FadeIn *int64 `locationName:"fadeIn" type:"integer"`
|
|
|
|
// Applies only if a duration is specified. The time in milliseconds for the
|
|
// image to fade out. The fade-out starts when the duration time is hit, so
|
|
// it effectively extends the duration. Default is 0 (no fade-out).
|
|
FadeOut *int64 `locationName:"fadeOut" type:"integer"`
|
|
|
|
// The height of the image when inserted into the video, in pixels. The overlay
|
|
// will be scaled up or down to the specified height. Leave blank to use the
|
|
// native height of the overlay.
|
|
Height *int64 `locationName:"height" min:"1" type:"integer"`
|
|
|
|
// The location and filename of the image file to overlay on the video. The
|
|
// file must be a 32-bit BMP, PNG, or TGA file, and must not be larger (in pixels)
|
|
// than the input video.
|
|
//
|
|
// Image is a required field
|
|
Image *InputLocation `locationName:"image" type:"structure" required:"true"`
|
|
|
|
// Placement of the left edge of the overlay relative to the left edge of the
|
|
// video frame, in pixels. 0 (the default) is the left edge of the frame. If
|
|
// the placement causes the overlay to extend beyond the right edge of the underlying
|
|
// video, then the overlay is cropped on the right.
|
|
ImageX *int64 `locationName:"imageX" type:"integer"`
|
|
|
|
// Placement of the top edge of the overlay relative to the top edge of the
|
|
// video frame, in pixels. 0 (the default) is the top edge of the frame. If
|
|
// the placement causes the overlay to extend beyond the bottom edge of the
|
|
// underlying video, then the overlay is cropped on the bottom.
|
|
ImageY *int64 `locationName:"imageY" type:"integer"`
|
|
|
|
// The number of the layer, 0 to 7. There are 8 layers that can be overlaid
|
|
// on the video, each layer with a different image. The layers are in Z order,
|
|
// which means that overlays with higher values of layer are inserted on top
|
|
// of overlays with lower values of layer. Default is 0.
|
|
Layer *int64 `locationName:"layer" type:"integer"`
|
|
|
|
// Opacity of image where 0 is transparent and 100 is fully opaque. Default
|
|
// is 100.
|
|
Opacity *int64 `locationName:"opacity" type:"integer"`
|
|
|
|
// The width of the image when inserted into the video, in pixels. The overlay
|
|
// will be scaled up or down to the specified width. Leave blank to use the
|
|
// native width of the overlay.
|
|
Width *int64 `locationName:"width" min:"1" type:"integer"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s StaticImageActivateScheduleActionSettings) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s StaticImageActivateScheduleActionSettings) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *StaticImageActivateScheduleActionSettings) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "StaticImageActivateScheduleActionSettings"}
|
|
if s.Height != nil && *s.Height < 1 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinValue("Height", 1))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.Image == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("Image"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.Width != nil && *s.Width < 1 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinValue("Width", 1))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.Image != nil {
|
|
if err := s.Image.Validate(); err != nil {
|
|
invalidParams.AddNested("Image", err.(request.ErrInvalidParams))
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetDuration sets the Duration field's value.
|
|
func (s *StaticImageActivateScheduleActionSettings) SetDuration(v int64) *StaticImageActivateScheduleActionSettings {
|
|
s.Duration = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetFadeIn sets the FadeIn field's value.
|
|
func (s *StaticImageActivateScheduleActionSettings) SetFadeIn(v int64) *StaticImageActivateScheduleActionSettings {
|
|
s.FadeIn = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetFadeOut sets the FadeOut field's value.
|
|
func (s *StaticImageActivateScheduleActionSettings) SetFadeOut(v int64) *StaticImageActivateScheduleActionSettings {
|
|
s.FadeOut = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetHeight sets the Height field's value.
|
|
func (s *StaticImageActivateScheduleActionSettings) SetHeight(v int64) *StaticImageActivateScheduleActionSettings {
|
|
s.Height = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetImage sets the Image field's value.
|
|
func (s *StaticImageActivateScheduleActionSettings) SetImage(v *InputLocation) *StaticImageActivateScheduleActionSettings {
|
|
s.Image = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetImageX sets the ImageX field's value.
|
|
func (s *StaticImageActivateScheduleActionSettings) SetImageX(v int64) *StaticImageActivateScheduleActionSettings {
|
|
s.ImageX = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetImageY sets the ImageY field's value.
|
|
func (s *StaticImageActivateScheduleActionSettings) SetImageY(v int64) *StaticImageActivateScheduleActionSettings {
|
|
s.ImageY = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetLayer sets the Layer field's value.
|
|
func (s *StaticImageActivateScheduleActionSettings) SetLayer(v int64) *StaticImageActivateScheduleActionSettings {
|
|
s.Layer = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetOpacity sets the Opacity field's value.
|
|
func (s *StaticImageActivateScheduleActionSettings) SetOpacity(v int64) *StaticImageActivateScheduleActionSettings {
|
|
s.Opacity = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetWidth sets the Width field's value.
|
|
func (s *StaticImageActivateScheduleActionSettings) SetWidth(v int64) *StaticImageActivateScheduleActionSettings {
|
|
s.Width = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Settings for the action to deactivate the image in a specific layer.
|
|
type StaticImageDeactivateScheduleActionSettings struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// The time in milliseconds for the image to fade out. Default is 0 (no fade-out).
|
|
FadeOut *int64 `locationName:"fadeOut" type:"integer"`
|
|
|
|
// The image overlay layer to deactivate, 0 to 7. Default is 0.
|
|
Layer *int64 `locationName:"layer" type:"integer"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s StaticImageDeactivateScheduleActionSettings) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s StaticImageDeactivateScheduleActionSettings) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetFadeOut sets the FadeOut field's value.
|
|
func (s *StaticImageDeactivateScheduleActionSettings) SetFadeOut(v int64) *StaticImageDeactivateScheduleActionSettings {
|
|
s.FadeOut = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetLayer sets the Layer field's value.
|
|
func (s *StaticImageDeactivateScheduleActionSettings) SetLayer(v int64) *StaticImageDeactivateScheduleActionSettings {
|
|
s.Layer = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type StaticKeySettings struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// The URL of the license server used for protecting content.
|
|
KeyProviderServer *InputLocation `locationName:"keyProviderServer" type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// Static key value as a 32 character hexadecimal string.
|
|
//
|
|
// StaticKeyValue is a required field
|
|
StaticKeyValue *string `locationName:"staticKeyValue" min:"32" type:"string" required:"true"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s StaticKeySettings) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s StaticKeySettings) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *StaticKeySettings) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "StaticKeySettings"}
|
|
if s.StaticKeyValue == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("StaticKeyValue"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.StaticKeyValue != nil && len(*s.StaticKeyValue) < 32 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("StaticKeyValue", 32))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.KeyProviderServer != nil {
|
|
if err := s.KeyProviderServer.Validate(); err != nil {
|
|
invalidParams.AddNested("KeyProviderServer", err.(request.ErrInvalidParams))
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetKeyProviderServer sets the KeyProviderServer field's value.
|
|
func (s *StaticKeySettings) SetKeyProviderServer(v *InputLocation) *StaticKeySettings {
|
|
s.KeyProviderServer = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetStaticKeyValue sets the StaticKeyValue field's value.
|
|
func (s *StaticKeySettings) SetStaticKeyValue(v string) *StaticKeySettings {
|
|
s.StaticKeyValue = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type StopChannelInput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// ChannelId is a required field
|
|
ChannelId *string `location:"uri" locationName:"channelId" type:"string" required:"true"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s StopChannelInput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s StopChannelInput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *StopChannelInput) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "StopChannelInput"}
|
|
if s.ChannelId == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("ChannelId"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.ChannelId != nil && len(*s.ChannelId) < 1 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("ChannelId", 1))
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetChannelId sets the ChannelId field's value.
|
|
func (s *StopChannelInput) SetChannelId(v string) *StopChannelInput {
|
|
s.ChannelId = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type StopChannelOutput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
Arn *string `locationName:"arn" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
Destinations []*OutputDestination `locationName:"destinations" type:"list"`
|
|
|
|
EgressEndpoints []*ChannelEgressEndpoint `locationName:"egressEndpoints" type:"list"`
|
|
|
|
EncoderSettings *EncoderSettings `locationName:"encoderSettings" type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
Id *string `locationName:"id" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
InputAttachments []*InputAttachment `locationName:"inputAttachments" type:"list"`
|
|
|
|
InputSpecification *InputSpecification `locationName:"inputSpecification" type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// The log level the user wants for their channel.
|
|
LogLevel *string `locationName:"logLevel" type:"string" enum:"LogLevel"`
|
|
|
|
Name *string `locationName:"name" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
PipelinesRunningCount *int64 `locationName:"pipelinesRunningCount" type:"integer"`
|
|
|
|
RoleArn *string `locationName:"roleArn" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
State *string `locationName:"state" type:"string" enum:"ChannelState"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s StopChannelOutput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s StopChannelOutput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetArn sets the Arn field's value.
|
|
func (s *StopChannelOutput) SetArn(v string) *StopChannelOutput {
|
|
s.Arn = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetDestinations sets the Destinations field's value.
|
|
func (s *StopChannelOutput) SetDestinations(v []*OutputDestination) *StopChannelOutput {
|
|
s.Destinations = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetEgressEndpoints sets the EgressEndpoints field's value.
|
|
func (s *StopChannelOutput) SetEgressEndpoints(v []*ChannelEgressEndpoint) *StopChannelOutput {
|
|
s.EgressEndpoints = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetEncoderSettings sets the EncoderSettings field's value.
|
|
func (s *StopChannelOutput) SetEncoderSettings(v *EncoderSettings) *StopChannelOutput {
|
|
s.EncoderSettings = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetId sets the Id field's value.
|
|
func (s *StopChannelOutput) SetId(v string) *StopChannelOutput {
|
|
s.Id = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetInputAttachments sets the InputAttachments field's value.
|
|
func (s *StopChannelOutput) SetInputAttachments(v []*InputAttachment) *StopChannelOutput {
|
|
s.InputAttachments = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetInputSpecification sets the InputSpecification field's value.
|
|
func (s *StopChannelOutput) SetInputSpecification(v *InputSpecification) *StopChannelOutput {
|
|
s.InputSpecification = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetLogLevel sets the LogLevel field's value.
|
|
func (s *StopChannelOutput) SetLogLevel(v string) *StopChannelOutput {
|
|
s.LogLevel = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetName sets the Name field's value.
|
|
func (s *StopChannelOutput) SetName(v string) *StopChannelOutput {
|
|
s.Name = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetPipelinesRunningCount sets the PipelinesRunningCount field's value.
|
|
func (s *StopChannelOutput) SetPipelinesRunningCount(v int64) *StopChannelOutput {
|
|
s.PipelinesRunningCount = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetRoleArn sets the RoleArn field's value.
|
|
func (s *StopChannelOutput) SetRoleArn(v string) *StopChannelOutput {
|
|
s.RoleArn = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetState sets the State field's value.
|
|
func (s *StopChannelOutput) SetState(v string) *StopChannelOutput {
|
|
s.State = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type TeletextDestinationSettings struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s TeletextDestinationSettings) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s TeletextDestinationSettings) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type TeletextSourceSettings struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// Specifies the teletext page number within the data stream from which to extract
|
|
// captions. Range of 0x100 (256) to 0x8FF (2303). Unused for passthrough. Should
|
|
// be specified as a hexadecimal string with no "0x" prefix.
|
|
PageNumber *string `locationName:"pageNumber" type:"string"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s TeletextSourceSettings) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s TeletextSourceSettings) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetPageNumber sets the PageNumber field's value.
|
|
func (s *TeletextSourceSettings) SetPageNumber(v string) *TeletextSourceSettings {
|
|
s.PageNumber = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type TimecodeConfig struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// Identifies the source for the timecode that will be associated with the events
|
|
// outputs.-Embedded (embedded): Initialize the output timecode with timecode
|
|
// from the the source. If no embedded timecode is detected in the source, the
|
|
// system falls back to using "Start at 0" (zerobased).-System Clock (systemclock):
|
|
// Use the UTC time.-Start at 0 (zerobased): The time of the first frame of
|
|
// the event will be 00:00:00:00.
|
|
//
|
|
// Source is a required field
|
|
Source *string `locationName:"source" type:"string" required:"true" enum:"TimecodeConfigSource"`
|
|
|
|
// Threshold in frames beyond which output timecode is resynchronized to the
|
|
// input timecode. Discrepancies below this threshold are permitted to avoid
|
|
// unnecessary discontinuities in the output timecode. No timecode sync when
|
|
// this is not specified.
|
|
SyncThreshold *int64 `locationName:"syncThreshold" min:"1" type:"integer"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s TimecodeConfig) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s TimecodeConfig) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *TimecodeConfig) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "TimecodeConfig"}
|
|
if s.Source == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("Source"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.SyncThreshold != nil && *s.SyncThreshold < 1 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinValue("SyncThreshold", 1))
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetSource sets the Source field's value.
|
|
func (s *TimecodeConfig) SetSource(v string) *TimecodeConfig {
|
|
s.Source = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetSyncThreshold sets the SyncThreshold field's value.
|
|
func (s *TimecodeConfig) SetSyncThreshold(v int64) *TimecodeConfig {
|
|
s.SyncThreshold = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type TtmlDestinationSettings struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// When set to passthrough, passes through style and position information from
|
|
// a TTML-like input source (TTML, SMPTE-TT, CFF-TT) to the CFF-TT output or
|
|
// TTML output.
|
|
StyleControl *string `locationName:"styleControl" type:"string" enum:"TtmlDestinationStyleControl"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s TtmlDestinationSettings) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s TtmlDestinationSettings) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetStyleControl sets the StyleControl field's value.
|
|
func (s *TtmlDestinationSettings) SetStyleControl(v string) *TtmlDestinationSettings {
|
|
s.StyleControl = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type UdpContainerSettings struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
M2tsSettings *M2tsSettings `locationName:"m2tsSettings" type:"structure"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s UdpContainerSettings) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s UdpContainerSettings) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *UdpContainerSettings) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "UdpContainerSettings"}
|
|
if s.M2tsSettings != nil {
|
|
if err := s.M2tsSettings.Validate(); err != nil {
|
|
invalidParams.AddNested("M2tsSettings", err.(request.ErrInvalidParams))
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetM2tsSettings sets the M2tsSettings field's value.
|
|
func (s *UdpContainerSettings) SetM2tsSettings(v *M2tsSettings) *UdpContainerSettings {
|
|
s.M2tsSettings = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type UdpGroupSettings struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// Specifies behavior of last resort when input video is lost, and no more backup
|
|
// inputs are available. When dropTs is selected the entire transport stream
|
|
// will stop being emitted. When dropProgram is selected the program can be
|
|
// dropped from the transport stream (and replaced with null packets to meet
|
|
// the TS bitrate requirement). Or, when emitProgram is chosen the transport
|
|
// stream will continue to be produced normally with repeat frames, black frames,
|
|
// or slate frames substituted for the absent input video.
|
|
InputLossAction *string `locationName:"inputLossAction" type:"string" enum:"InputLossActionForUdpOut"`
|
|
|
|
// Indicates ID3 frame that has the timecode.
|
|
TimedMetadataId3Frame *string `locationName:"timedMetadataId3Frame" type:"string" enum:"UdpTimedMetadataId3Frame"`
|
|
|
|
// Timed Metadata interval in seconds.
|
|
TimedMetadataId3Period *int64 `locationName:"timedMetadataId3Period" type:"integer"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s UdpGroupSettings) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s UdpGroupSettings) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetInputLossAction sets the InputLossAction field's value.
|
|
func (s *UdpGroupSettings) SetInputLossAction(v string) *UdpGroupSettings {
|
|
s.InputLossAction = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetTimedMetadataId3Frame sets the TimedMetadataId3Frame field's value.
|
|
func (s *UdpGroupSettings) SetTimedMetadataId3Frame(v string) *UdpGroupSettings {
|
|
s.TimedMetadataId3Frame = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetTimedMetadataId3Period sets the TimedMetadataId3Period field's value.
|
|
func (s *UdpGroupSettings) SetTimedMetadataId3Period(v int64) *UdpGroupSettings {
|
|
s.TimedMetadataId3Period = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type UdpOutputSettings struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// UDP output buffering in milliseconds. Larger values increase latency through
|
|
// the transcoder but simultaneously assist the transcoder in maintaining a
|
|
// constant, low-jitter UDP/RTP output while accommodating clock recovery, input
|
|
// switching, input disruptions, picture reordering, etc.
|
|
BufferMsec *int64 `locationName:"bufferMsec" type:"integer"`
|
|
|
|
// ContainerSettings is a required field
|
|
ContainerSettings *UdpContainerSettings `locationName:"containerSettings" type:"structure" required:"true"`
|
|
|
|
// Destination address and port number for RTP or UDP packets. Can be unicast
|
|
// or multicast RTP or UDP (eg. rtp://239.10.10.10:5001 or udp://10.100.100.100:5002).
|
|
//
|
|
// Destination is a required field
|
|
Destination *OutputLocationRef `locationName:"destination" type:"structure" required:"true"`
|
|
|
|
// Settings for enabling and adjusting Forward Error Correction on UDP outputs.
|
|
FecOutputSettings *FecOutputSettings `locationName:"fecOutputSettings" type:"structure"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s UdpOutputSettings) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s UdpOutputSettings) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *UdpOutputSettings) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "UdpOutputSettings"}
|
|
if s.ContainerSettings == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("ContainerSettings"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.Destination == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("Destination"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.ContainerSettings != nil {
|
|
if err := s.ContainerSettings.Validate(); err != nil {
|
|
invalidParams.AddNested("ContainerSettings", err.(request.ErrInvalidParams))
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
if s.FecOutputSettings != nil {
|
|
if err := s.FecOutputSettings.Validate(); err != nil {
|
|
invalidParams.AddNested("FecOutputSettings", err.(request.ErrInvalidParams))
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetBufferMsec sets the BufferMsec field's value.
|
|
func (s *UdpOutputSettings) SetBufferMsec(v int64) *UdpOutputSettings {
|
|
s.BufferMsec = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetContainerSettings sets the ContainerSettings field's value.
|
|
func (s *UdpOutputSettings) SetContainerSettings(v *UdpContainerSettings) *UdpOutputSettings {
|
|
s.ContainerSettings = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetDestination sets the Destination field's value.
|
|
func (s *UdpOutputSettings) SetDestination(v *OutputLocationRef) *UdpOutputSettings {
|
|
s.Destination = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetFecOutputSettings sets the FecOutputSettings field's value.
|
|
func (s *UdpOutputSettings) SetFecOutputSettings(v *FecOutputSettings) *UdpOutputSettings {
|
|
s.FecOutputSettings = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type UpdateChannelInput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// ChannelId is a required field
|
|
ChannelId *string `location:"uri" locationName:"channelId" type:"string" required:"true"`
|
|
|
|
Destinations []*OutputDestination `locationName:"destinations" type:"list"`
|
|
|
|
EncoderSettings *EncoderSettings `locationName:"encoderSettings" type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
InputAttachments []*InputAttachment `locationName:"inputAttachments" type:"list"`
|
|
|
|
InputSpecification *InputSpecification `locationName:"inputSpecification" type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// The log level the user wants for their channel.
|
|
LogLevel *string `locationName:"logLevel" type:"string" enum:"LogLevel"`
|
|
|
|
Name *string `locationName:"name" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
RoleArn *string `locationName:"roleArn" type:"string"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s UpdateChannelInput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s UpdateChannelInput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *UpdateChannelInput) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "UpdateChannelInput"}
|
|
if s.ChannelId == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("ChannelId"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.ChannelId != nil && len(*s.ChannelId) < 1 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("ChannelId", 1))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.EncoderSettings != nil {
|
|
if err := s.EncoderSettings.Validate(); err != nil {
|
|
invalidParams.AddNested("EncoderSettings", err.(request.ErrInvalidParams))
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
if s.InputAttachments != nil {
|
|
for i, v := range s.InputAttachments {
|
|
if v == nil {
|
|
continue
|
|
}
|
|
if err := v.Validate(); err != nil {
|
|
invalidParams.AddNested(fmt.Sprintf("%s[%v]", "InputAttachments", i), err.(request.ErrInvalidParams))
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetChannelId sets the ChannelId field's value.
|
|
func (s *UpdateChannelInput) SetChannelId(v string) *UpdateChannelInput {
|
|
s.ChannelId = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetDestinations sets the Destinations field's value.
|
|
func (s *UpdateChannelInput) SetDestinations(v []*OutputDestination) *UpdateChannelInput {
|
|
s.Destinations = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetEncoderSettings sets the EncoderSettings field's value.
|
|
func (s *UpdateChannelInput) SetEncoderSettings(v *EncoderSettings) *UpdateChannelInput {
|
|
s.EncoderSettings = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetInputAttachments sets the InputAttachments field's value.
|
|
func (s *UpdateChannelInput) SetInputAttachments(v []*InputAttachment) *UpdateChannelInput {
|
|
s.InputAttachments = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetInputSpecification sets the InputSpecification field's value.
|
|
func (s *UpdateChannelInput) SetInputSpecification(v *InputSpecification) *UpdateChannelInput {
|
|
s.InputSpecification = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetLogLevel sets the LogLevel field's value.
|
|
func (s *UpdateChannelInput) SetLogLevel(v string) *UpdateChannelInput {
|
|
s.LogLevel = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetName sets the Name field's value.
|
|
func (s *UpdateChannelInput) SetName(v string) *UpdateChannelInput {
|
|
s.Name = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetRoleArn sets the RoleArn field's value.
|
|
func (s *UpdateChannelInput) SetRoleArn(v string) *UpdateChannelInput {
|
|
s.RoleArn = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type UpdateChannelOutput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
Channel *Channel `locationName:"channel" type:"structure"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s UpdateChannelOutput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s UpdateChannelOutput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetChannel sets the Channel field's value.
|
|
func (s *UpdateChannelOutput) SetChannel(v *Channel) *UpdateChannelOutput {
|
|
s.Channel = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type UpdateInputInput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
Destinations []*InputDestinationRequest `locationName:"destinations" type:"list"`
|
|
|
|
// InputId is a required field
|
|
InputId *string `location:"uri" locationName:"inputId" type:"string" required:"true"`
|
|
|
|
InputSecurityGroups []*string `locationName:"inputSecurityGroups" type:"list"`
|
|
|
|
MediaConnectFlows []*MediaConnectFlowRequest `locationName:"mediaConnectFlows" type:"list"`
|
|
|
|
Name *string `locationName:"name" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
RoleArn *string `locationName:"roleArn" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
Sources []*InputSourceRequest `locationName:"sources" type:"list"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s UpdateInputInput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s UpdateInputInput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *UpdateInputInput) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "UpdateInputInput"}
|
|
if s.InputId == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("InputId"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.InputId != nil && len(*s.InputId) < 1 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("InputId", 1))
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetDestinations sets the Destinations field's value.
|
|
func (s *UpdateInputInput) SetDestinations(v []*InputDestinationRequest) *UpdateInputInput {
|
|
s.Destinations = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetInputId sets the InputId field's value.
|
|
func (s *UpdateInputInput) SetInputId(v string) *UpdateInputInput {
|
|
s.InputId = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetInputSecurityGroups sets the InputSecurityGroups field's value.
|
|
func (s *UpdateInputInput) SetInputSecurityGroups(v []*string) *UpdateInputInput {
|
|
s.InputSecurityGroups = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetMediaConnectFlows sets the MediaConnectFlows field's value.
|
|
func (s *UpdateInputInput) SetMediaConnectFlows(v []*MediaConnectFlowRequest) *UpdateInputInput {
|
|
s.MediaConnectFlows = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetName sets the Name field's value.
|
|
func (s *UpdateInputInput) SetName(v string) *UpdateInputInput {
|
|
s.Name = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetRoleArn sets the RoleArn field's value.
|
|
func (s *UpdateInputInput) SetRoleArn(v string) *UpdateInputInput {
|
|
s.RoleArn = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetSources sets the Sources field's value.
|
|
func (s *UpdateInputInput) SetSources(v []*InputSourceRequest) *UpdateInputInput {
|
|
s.Sources = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type UpdateInputOutput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
Input *Input `locationName:"input" type:"structure"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s UpdateInputOutput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s UpdateInputOutput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetInput sets the Input field's value.
|
|
func (s *UpdateInputOutput) SetInput(v *Input) *UpdateInputOutput {
|
|
s.Input = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type UpdateInputSecurityGroupInput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// InputSecurityGroupId is a required field
|
|
InputSecurityGroupId *string `location:"uri" locationName:"inputSecurityGroupId" type:"string" required:"true"`
|
|
|
|
WhitelistRules []*InputWhitelistRuleCidr `locationName:"whitelistRules" type:"list"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s UpdateInputSecurityGroupInput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s UpdateInputSecurityGroupInput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *UpdateInputSecurityGroupInput) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "UpdateInputSecurityGroupInput"}
|
|
if s.InputSecurityGroupId == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("InputSecurityGroupId"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.InputSecurityGroupId != nil && len(*s.InputSecurityGroupId) < 1 {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamMinLen("InputSecurityGroupId", 1))
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetInputSecurityGroupId sets the InputSecurityGroupId field's value.
|
|
func (s *UpdateInputSecurityGroupInput) SetInputSecurityGroupId(v string) *UpdateInputSecurityGroupInput {
|
|
s.InputSecurityGroupId = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetWhitelistRules sets the WhitelistRules field's value.
|
|
func (s *UpdateInputSecurityGroupInput) SetWhitelistRules(v []*InputWhitelistRuleCidr) *UpdateInputSecurityGroupInput {
|
|
s.WhitelistRules = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type UpdateInputSecurityGroupOutput struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// An Input Security Group
|
|
SecurityGroup *InputSecurityGroup `locationName:"securityGroup" type:"structure"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s UpdateInputSecurityGroupOutput) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s UpdateInputSecurityGroupOutput) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetSecurityGroup sets the SecurityGroup field's value.
|
|
func (s *UpdateInputSecurityGroupOutput) SetSecurityGroup(v *InputSecurityGroup) *UpdateInputSecurityGroupOutput {
|
|
s.SecurityGroup = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type ValidationError struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
ElementPath *string `locationName:"elementPath" type:"string"`
|
|
|
|
ErrorMessage *string `locationName:"errorMessage" type:"string"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s ValidationError) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s ValidationError) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetElementPath sets the ElementPath field's value.
|
|
func (s *ValidationError) SetElementPath(v string) *ValidationError {
|
|
s.ElementPath = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetErrorMessage sets the ErrorMessage field's value.
|
|
func (s *ValidationError) SetErrorMessage(v string) *ValidationError {
|
|
s.ErrorMessage = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type VideoCodecSettings struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
H264Settings *H264Settings `locationName:"h264Settings" type:"structure"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s VideoCodecSettings) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s VideoCodecSettings) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *VideoCodecSettings) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "VideoCodecSettings"}
|
|
if s.H264Settings != nil {
|
|
if err := s.H264Settings.Validate(); err != nil {
|
|
invalidParams.AddNested("H264Settings", err.(request.ErrInvalidParams))
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetH264Settings sets the H264Settings field's value.
|
|
func (s *VideoCodecSettings) SetH264Settings(v *H264Settings) *VideoCodecSettings {
|
|
s.H264Settings = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Video settings for this stream.
|
|
type VideoDescription struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// Video codec settings.
|
|
CodecSettings *VideoCodecSettings `locationName:"codecSettings" type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// Output video height (in pixels). Leave blank to use source video height.
|
|
// If left blank, width must also be unspecified.
|
|
Height *int64 `locationName:"height" type:"integer"`
|
|
|
|
// The name of this VideoDescription. Outputs will use this name to uniquely
|
|
// identify this Description. Description names should be unique within this
|
|
// Live Event.
|
|
//
|
|
// Name is a required field
|
|
Name *string `locationName:"name" type:"string" required:"true"`
|
|
|
|
// Indicates how to respond to the AFD values in the input stream. Setting to
|
|
// "respond" causes input video to be clipped, depending on AFD value, input
|
|
// display aspect ratio and output display aspect ratio.
|
|
RespondToAfd *string `locationName:"respondToAfd" type:"string" enum:"VideoDescriptionRespondToAfd"`
|
|
|
|
// When set to "stretchToOutput", automatically configures the output position
|
|
// to stretch the video to the specified output resolution. This option will
|
|
// override any position value.
|
|
ScalingBehavior *string `locationName:"scalingBehavior" type:"string" enum:"VideoDescriptionScalingBehavior"`
|
|
|
|
// Changes the width of the anti-alias filter kernel used for scaling. Only
|
|
// applies if scaling is being performed and antiAlias is set to true. 0 is
|
|
// the softest setting, 100 the sharpest, and 50 recommended for most content.
|
|
Sharpness *int64 `locationName:"sharpness" type:"integer"`
|
|
|
|
// Output video width (in pixels). Leave out to use source video width. If left
|
|
// out, height must also be left out. Display aspect ratio is always preserved
|
|
// by letterboxing or pillarboxing when necessary.
|
|
Width *int64 `locationName:"width" type:"integer"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s VideoDescription) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s VideoDescription) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Validate inspects the fields of the type to determine if they are valid.
|
|
func (s *VideoDescription) Validate() error {
|
|
invalidParams := request.ErrInvalidParams{Context: "VideoDescription"}
|
|
if s.Name == nil {
|
|
invalidParams.Add(request.NewErrParamRequired("Name"))
|
|
}
|
|
if s.CodecSettings != nil {
|
|
if err := s.CodecSettings.Validate(); err != nil {
|
|
invalidParams.AddNested("CodecSettings", err.(request.ErrInvalidParams))
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if invalidParams.Len() > 0 {
|
|
return invalidParams
|
|
}
|
|
return nil
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetCodecSettings sets the CodecSettings field's value.
|
|
func (s *VideoDescription) SetCodecSettings(v *VideoCodecSettings) *VideoDescription {
|
|
s.CodecSettings = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetHeight sets the Height field's value.
|
|
func (s *VideoDescription) SetHeight(v int64) *VideoDescription {
|
|
s.Height = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetName sets the Name field's value.
|
|
func (s *VideoDescription) SetName(v string) *VideoDescription {
|
|
s.Name = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetRespondToAfd sets the RespondToAfd field's value.
|
|
func (s *VideoDescription) SetRespondToAfd(v string) *VideoDescription {
|
|
s.RespondToAfd = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetScalingBehavior sets the ScalingBehavior field's value.
|
|
func (s *VideoDescription) SetScalingBehavior(v string) *VideoDescription {
|
|
s.ScalingBehavior = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetSharpness sets the Sharpness field's value.
|
|
func (s *VideoDescription) SetSharpness(v int64) *VideoDescription {
|
|
s.Sharpness = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetWidth sets the Width field's value.
|
|
func (s *VideoDescription) SetWidth(v int64) *VideoDescription {
|
|
s.Width = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Specifies a particular video stream within an input source. An input may
|
|
// have only a single video selector.
|
|
type VideoSelector struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// Specifies the colorspace of an input. This setting works in tandem with colorSpaceConversion
|
|
// to determine if any conversion will be performed.
|
|
ColorSpace *string `locationName:"colorSpace" type:"string" enum:"VideoSelectorColorSpace"`
|
|
|
|
// Applies only if colorSpace is a value other than follow. This field controls
|
|
// how the value in the colorSpace field will be used. fallback means that when
|
|
// the input does include color space data, that data will be used, but when
|
|
// the input has no color space data, the value in colorSpace will be used.
|
|
// Choose fallback if your input is sometimes missing color space data, but
|
|
// when it does have color space data, that data is correct. force means to
|
|
// always use the value in colorSpace. Choose force if your input usually has
|
|
// no color space data or might have unreliable color space data.
|
|
ColorSpaceUsage *string `locationName:"colorSpaceUsage" type:"string" enum:"VideoSelectorColorSpaceUsage"`
|
|
|
|
// The video selector settings.
|
|
SelectorSettings *VideoSelectorSettings `locationName:"selectorSettings" type:"structure"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s VideoSelector) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s VideoSelector) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetColorSpace sets the ColorSpace field's value.
|
|
func (s *VideoSelector) SetColorSpace(v string) *VideoSelector {
|
|
s.ColorSpace = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetColorSpaceUsage sets the ColorSpaceUsage field's value.
|
|
func (s *VideoSelector) SetColorSpaceUsage(v string) *VideoSelector {
|
|
s.ColorSpaceUsage = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetSelectorSettings sets the SelectorSettings field's value.
|
|
func (s *VideoSelector) SetSelectorSettings(v *VideoSelectorSettings) *VideoSelector {
|
|
s.SelectorSettings = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type VideoSelectorPid struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// Selects a specific PID from within a video source.
|
|
Pid *int64 `locationName:"pid" type:"integer"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s VideoSelectorPid) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s VideoSelectorPid) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetPid sets the Pid field's value.
|
|
func (s *VideoSelectorPid) SetPid(v int64) *VideoSelectorPid {
|
|
s.Pid = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type VideoSelectorProgramId struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
// Selects a specific program from within a multi-program transport stream.
|
|
// If the program doesn't exist, the first program within the transport stream
|
|
// will be selected by default.
|
|
ProgramId *int64 `locationName:"programId" type:"integer"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s VideoSelectorProgramId) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s VideoSelectorProgramId) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetProgramId sets the ProgramId field's value.
|
|
func (s *VideoSelectorProgramId) SetProgramId(v int64) *VideoSelectorProgramId {
|
|
s.ProgramId = &v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type VideoSelectorSettings struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
VideoSelectorPid *VideoSelectorPid `locationName:"videoSelectorPid" type:"structure"`
|
|
|
|
VideoSelectorProgramId *VideoSelectorProgramId `locationName:"videoSelectorProgramId" type:"structure"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s VideoSelectorSettings) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s VideoSelectorSettings) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetVideoSelectorPid sets the VideoSelectorPid field's value.
|
|
func (s *VideoSelectorSettings) SetVideoSelectorPid(v *VideoSelectorPid) *VideoSelectorSettings {
|
|
s.VideoSelectorPid = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SetVideoSelectorProgramId sets the VideoSelectorProgramId field's value.
|
|
func (s *VideoSelectorSettings) SetVideoSelectorProgramId(v *VideoSelectorProgramId) *VideoSelectorSettings {
|
|
s.VideoSelectorProgramId = v
|
|
return s
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
type WebvttDestinationSettings struct {
|
|
_ struct{} `type:"structure"`
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// String returns the string representation
|
|
func (s WebvttDestinationSettings) String() string {
|
|
return awsutil.Prettify(s)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// GoString returns the string representation
|
|
func (s WebvttDestinationSettings) GoString() string {
|
|
return s.String()
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
const (
|
|
// AacCodingModeAdReceiverMix is a AacCodingMode enum value
|
|
AacCodingModeAdReceiverMix = "AD_RECEIVER_MIX"
|
|
|
|
// AacCodingModeCodingMode10 is a AacCodingMode enum value
|
|
AacCodingModeCodingMode10 = "CODING_MODE_1_0"
|
|
|
|
// AacCodingModeCodingMode11 is a AacCodingMode enum value
|
|
AacCodingModeCodingMode11 = "CODING_MODE_1_1"
|
|
|
|
// AacCodingModeCodingMode20 is a AacCodingMode enum value
|
|
AacCodingModeCodingMode20 = "CODING_MODE_2_0"
|
|
|
|
// AacCodingModeCodingMode51 is a AacCodingMode enum value
|
|
AacCodingModeCodingMode51 = "CODING_MODE_5_1"
|
|
)
|
|
|
|
const (
|
|
// AacInputTypeBroadcasterMixedAd is a AacInputType enum value
|
|
AacInputTypeBroadcasterMixedAd = "BROADCASTER_MIXED_AD"
|
|
|
|
// AacInputTypeNormal is a AacInputType enum value
|
|
AacInputTypeNormal = "NORMAL"
|
|
)
|
|
|
|
const (
|
|
// AacProfileHev1 is a AacProfile enum value
|
|
AacProfileHev1 = "HEV1"
|
|
|
|
// AacProfileHev2 is a AacProfile enum value
|
|
AacProfileHev2 = "HEV2"
|
|
|
|
// AacProfileLc is a AacProfile enum value
|
|
AacProfileLc = "LC"
|
|
)
|
|
|
|
const (
|
|
// AacRateControlModeCbr is a AacRateControlMode enum value
|
|
AacRateControlModeCbr = "CBR"
|
|
|
|
// AacRateControlModeVbr is a AacRateControlMode enum value
|
|
AacRateControlModeVbr = "VBR"
|
|
)
|
|
|
|
const (
|
|
// AacRawFormatLatmLoas is a AacRawFormat enum value
|
|
AacRawFormatLatmLoas = "LATM_LOAS"
|
|
|
|
// AacRawFormatNone is a AacRawFormat enum value
|
|
AacRawFormatNone = "NONE"
|
|
)
|
|
|
|
const (
|
|
// AacSpecMpeg2 is a AacSpec enum value
|
|
AacSpecMpeg2 = "MPEG2"
|
|
|
|
// AacSpecMpeg4 is a AacSpec enum value
|
|
AacSpecMpeg4 = "MPEG4"
|
|
)
|
|
|
|
const (
|
|
// AacVbrQualityHigh is a AacVbrQuality enum value
|
|
AacVbrQualityHigh = "HIGH"
|
|
|
|
// AacVbrQualityLow is a AacVbrQuality enum value
|
|
AacVbrQualityLow = "LOW"
|
|
|
|
// AacVbrQualityMediumHigh is a AacVbrQuality enum value
|
|
AacVbrQualityMediumHigh = "MEDIUM_HIGH"
|
|
|
|
// AacVbrQualityMediumLow is a AacVbrQuality enum value
|
|
AacVbrQualityMediumLow = "MEDIUM_LOW"
|
|
)
|
|
|
|
const (
|
|
// Ac3BitstreamModeCommentary is a Ac3BitstreamMode enum value
|
|
Ac3BitstreamModeCommentary = "COMMENTARY"
|
|
|
|
// Ac3BitstreamModeCompleteMain is a Ac3BitstreamMode enum value
|
|
Ac3BitstreamModeCompleteMain = "COMPLETE_MAIN"
|
|
|
|
// Ac3BitstreamModeDialogue is a Ac3BitstreamMode enum value
|
|
Ac3BitstreamModeDialogue = "DIALOGUE"
|
|
|
|
// Ac3BitstreamModeEmergency is a Ac3BitstreamMode enum value
|
|
Ac3BitstreamModeEmergency = "EMERGENCY"
|
|
|
|
// Ac3BitstreamModeHearingImpaired is a Ac3BitstreamMode enum value
|
|
Ac3BitstreamModeHearingImpaired = "HEARING_IMPAIRED"
|
|
|
|
// Ac3BitstreamModeMusicAndEffects is a Ac3BitstreamMode enum value
|
|
Ac3BitstreamModeMusicAndEffects = "MUSIC_AND_EFFECTS"
|
|
|
|
// Ac3BitstreamModeVisuallyImpaired is a Ac3BitstreamMode enum value
|
|
Ac3BitstreamModeVisuallyImpaired = "VISUALLY_IMPAIRED"
|
|
|
|
// Ac3BitstreamModeVoiceOver is a Ac3BitstreamMode enum value
|
|
Ac3BitstreamModeVoiceOver = "VOICE_OVER"
|
|
)
|
|
|
|
const (
|
|
// Ac3CodingModeCodingMode10 is a Ac3CodingMode enum value
|
|
Ac3CodingModeCodingMode10 = "CODING_MODE_1_0"
|
|
|
|
// Ac3CodingModeCodingMode11 is a Ac3CodingMode enum value
|
|
Ac3CodingModeCodingMode11 = "CODING_MODE_1_1"
|
|
|
|
// Ac3CodingModeCodingMode20 is a Ac3CodingMode enum value
|
|
Ac3CodingModeCodingMode20 = "CODING_MODE_2_0"
|
|
|
|
// Ac3CodingModeCodingMode32Lfe is a Ac3CodingMode enum value
|
|
Ac3CodingModeCodingMode32Lfe = "CODING_MODE_3_2_LFE"
|
|
)
|
|
|
|
const (
|
|
// Ac3DrcProfileFilmStandard is a Ac3DrcProfile enum value
|
|
Ac3DrcProfileFilmStandard = "FILM_STANDARD"
|
|
|
|
// Ac3DrcProfileNone is a Ac3DrcProfile enum value
|
|
Ac3DrcProfileNone = "NONE"
|
|
)
|
|
|
|
const (
|
|
// Ac3LfeFilterDisabled is a Ac3LfeFilter enum value
|
|
Ac3LfeFilterDisabled = "DISABLED"
|
|
|
|
// Ac3LfeFilterEnabled is a Ac3LfeFilter enum value
|
|
Ac3LfeFilterEnabled = "ENABLED"
|
|
)
|
|
|
|
const (
|
|
// Ac3MetadataControlFollowInput is a Ac3MetadataControl enum value
|
|
Ac3MetadataControlFollowInput = "FOLLOW_INPUT"
|
|
|
|
// Ac3MetadataControlUseConfigured is a Ac3MetadataControl enum value
|
|
Ac3MetadataControlUseConfigured = "USE_CONFIGURED"
|
|
)
|
|
|
|
const (
|
|
// AfdSignalingAuto is a AfdSignaling enum value
|
|
AfdSignalingAuto = "AUTO"
|
|
|
|
// AfdSignalingFixed is a AfdSignaling enum value
|
|
AfdSignalingFixed = "FIXED"
|
|
|
|
// AfdSignalingNone is a AfdSignaling enum value
|
|
AfdSignalingNone = "NONE"
|
|
)
|
|
|
|
const (
|
|
// AudioDescriptionAudioTypeControlFollowInput is a AudioDescriptionAudioTypeControl enum value
|
|
AudioDescriptionAudioTypeControlFollowInput = "FOLLOW_INPUT"
|
|
|
|
// AudioDescriptionAudioTypeControlUseConfigured is a AudioDescriptionAudioTypeControl enum value
|
|
AudioDescriptionAudioTypeControlUseConfigured = "USE_CONFIGURED"
|
|
)
|
|
|
|
const (
|
|
// AudioDescriptionLanguageCodeControlFollowInput is a AudioDescriptionLanguageCodeControl enum value
|
|
AudioDescriptionLanguageCodeControlFollowInput = "FOLLOW_INPUT"
|
|
|
|
// AudioDescriptionLanguageCodeControlUseConfigured is a AudioDescriptionLanguageCodeControl enum value
|
|
AudioDescriptionLanguageCodeControlUseConfigured = "USE_CONFIGURED"
|
|
)
|
|
|
|
const (
|
|
// AudioLanguageSelectionPolicyLoose is a AudioLanguageSelectionPolicy enum value
|
|
AudioLanguageSelectionPolicyLoose = "LOOSE"
|
|
|
|
// AudioLanguageSelectionPolicyStrict is a AudioLanguageSelectionPolicy enum value
|
|
AudioLanguageSelectionPolicyStrict = "STRICT"
|
|
)
|
|
|
|
const (
|
|
// AudioNormalizationAlgorithmItu17701 is a AudioNormalizationAlgorithm enum value
|
|
AudioNormalizationAlgorithmItu17701 = "ITU_1770_1"
|
|
|
|
// AudioNormalizationAlgorithmItu17702 is a AudioNormalizationAlgorithm enum value
|
|
AudioNormalizationAlgorithmItu17702 = "ITU_1770_2"
|
|
)
|
|
|
|
const (
|
|
// AudioNormalizationAlgorithmControlCorrectAudio is a AudioNormalizationAlgorithmControl enum value
|
|
AudioNormalizationAlgorithmControlCorrectAudio = "CORRECT_AUDIO"
|
|
)
|
|
|
|
const (
|
|
// AudioOnlyHlsTrackTypeAlternateAudioAutoSelect is a AudioOnlyHlsTrackType enum value
|
|
AudioOnlyHlsTrackTypeAlternateAudioAutoSelect = "ALTERNATE_AUDIO_AUTO_SELECT"
|
|
|
|
// AudioOnlyHlsTrackTypeAlternateAudioAutoSelectDefault is a AudioOnlyHlsTrackType enum value
|
|
AudioOnlyHlsTrackTypeAlternateAudioAutoSelectDefault = "ALTERNATE_AUDIO_AUTO_SELECT_DEFAULT"
|
|
|
|
// AudioOnlyHlsTrackTypeAlternateAudioNotAutoSelect is a AudioOnlyHlsTrackType enum value
|
|
AudioOnlyHlsTrackTypeAlternateAudioNotAutoSelect = "ALTERNATE_AUDIO_NOT_AUTO_SELECT"
|
|
|
|
// AudioOnlyHlsTrackTypeAudioOnlyVariantStream is a AudioOnlyHlsTrackType enum value
|
|
AudioOnlyHlsTrackTypeAudioOnlyVariantStream = "AUDIO_ONLY_VARIANT_STREAM"
|
|
)
|
|
|
|
const (
|
|
// AudioTypeCleanEffects is a AudioType enum value
|
|
AudioTypeCleanEffects = "CLEAN_EFFECTS"
|
|
|
|
// AudioTypeHearingImpaired is a AudioType enum value
|
|
AudioTypeHearingImpaired = "HEARING_IMPAIRED"
|
|
|
|
// AudioTypeUndefined is a AudioType enum value
|
|
AudioTypeUndefined = "UNDEFINED"
|
|
|
|
// AudioTypeVisualImpairedCommentary is a AudioType enum value
|
|
AudioTypeVisualImpairedCommentary = "VISUAL_IMPAIRED_COMMENTARY"
|
|
)
|
|
|
|
const (
|
|
// AuthenticationSchemeAkamai is a AuthenticationScheme enum value
|
|
AuthenticationSchemeAkamai = "AKAMAI"
|
|
|
|
// AuthenticationSchemeCommon is a AuthenticationScheme enum value
|
|
AuthenticationSchemeCommon = "COMMON"
|
|
)
|
|
|
|
const (
|
|
// AvailBlankingStateDisabled is a AvailBlankingState enum value
|
|
AvailBlankingStateDisabled = "DISABLED"
|
|
|
|
// AvailBlankingStateEnabled is a AvailBlankingState enum value
|
|
AvailBlankingStateEnabled = "ENABLED"
|
|
)
|
|
|
|
const (
|
|
// BlackoutSlateNetworkEndBlackoutDisabled is a BlackoutSlateNetworkEndBlackout enum value
|
|
BlackoutSlateNetworkEndBlackoutDisabled = "DISABLED"
|
|
|
|
// BlackoutSlateNetworkEndBlackoutEnabled is a BlackoutSlateNetworkEndBlackout enum value
|
|
BlackoutSlateNetworkEndBlackoutEnabled = "ENABLED"
|
|
)
|
|
|
|
const (
|
|
// BlackoutSlateStateDisabled is a BlackoutSlateState enum value
|
|
BlackoutSlateStateDisabled = "DISABLED"
|
|
|
|
// BlackoutSlateStateEnabled is a BlackoutSlateState enum value
|
|
BlackoutSlateStateEnabled = "ENABLED"
|
|
)
|
|
|
|
const (
|
|
// BurnInAlignmentCentered is a BurnInAlignment enum value
|
|
BurnInAlignmentCentered = "CENTERED"
|
|
|
|
// BurnInAlignmentLeft is a BurnInAlignment enum value
|
|
BurnInAlignmentLeft = "LEFT"
|
|
|
|
// BurnInAlignmentSmart is a BurnInAlignment enum value
|
|
BurnInAlignmentSmart = "SMART"
|
|
)
|
|
|
|
const (
|
|
// BurnInBackgroundColorBlack is a BurnInBackgroundColor enum value
|
|
BurnInBackgroundColorBlack = "BLACK"
|
|
|
|
// BurnInBackgroundColorNone is a BurnInBackgroundColor enum value
|
|
BurnInBackgroundColorNone = "NONE"
|
|
|
|
// BurnInBackgroundColorWhite is a BurnInBackgroundColor enum value
|
|
BurnInBackgroundColorWhite = "WHITE"
|
|
)
|
|
|
|
const (
|
|
// BurnInFontColorBlack is a BurnInFontColor enum value
|
|
BurnInFontColorBlack = "BLACK"
|
|
|
|
// BurnInFontColorBlue is a BurnInFontColor enum value
|
|
BurnInFontColorBlue = "BLUE"
|
|
|
|
// BurnInFontColorGreen is a BurnInFontColor enum value
|
|
BurnInFontColorGreen = "GREEN"
|
|
|
|
// BurnInFontColorRed is a BurnInFontColor enum value
|
|
BurnInFontColorRed = "RED"
|
|
|
|
// BurnInFontColorWhite is a BurnInFontColor enum value
|
|
BurnInFontColorWhite = "WHITE"
|
|
|
|
// BurnInFontColorYellow is a BurnInFontColor enum value
|
|
BurnInFontColorYellow = "YELLOW"
|
|
)
|
|
|
|
const (
|
|
// BurnInOutlineColorBlack is a BurnInOutlineColor enum value
|
|
BurnInOutlineColorBlack = "BLACK"
|
|
|
|
// BurnInOutlineColorBlue is a BurnInOutlineColor enum value
|
|
BurnInOutlineColorBlue = "BLUE"
|
|
|
|
// BurnInOutlineColorGreen is a BurnInOutlineColor enum value
|
|
BurnInOutlineColorGreen = "GREEN"
|
|
|
|
// BurnInOutlineColorRed is a BurnInOutlineColor enum value
|
|
BurnInOutlineColorRed = "RED"
|
|
|
|
// BurnInOutlineColorWhite is a BurnInOutlineColor enum value
|
|
BurnInOutlineColorWhite = "WHITE"
|
|
|
|
// BurnInOutlineColorYellow is a BurnInOutlineColor enum value
|
|
BurnInOutlineColorYellow = "YELLOW"
|
|
)
|
|
|
|
const (
|
|
// BurnInShadowColorBlack is a BurnInShadowColor enum value
|
|
BurnInShadowColorBlack = "BLACK"
|
|
|
|
// BurnInShadowColorNone is a BurnInShadowColor enum value
|
|
BurnInShadowColorNone = "NONE"
|
|
|
|
// BurnInShadowColorWhite is a BurnInShadowColor enum value
|
|
BurnInShadowColorWhite = "WHITE"
|
|
)
|
|
|
|
const (
|
|
// BurnInTeletextGridControlFixed is a BurnInTeletextGridControl enum value
|
|
BurnInTeletextGridControlFixed = "FIXED"
|
|
|
|
// BurnInTeletextGridControlScaled is a BurnInTeletextGridControl enum value
|
|
BurnInTeletextGridControlScaled = "SCALED"
|
|
)
|
|
|
|
const (
|
|
// ChannelStateCreating is a ChannelState enum value
|
|
ChannelStateCreating = "CREATING"
|
|
|
|
// ChannelStateCreateFailed is a ChannelState enum value
|
|
ChannelStateCreateFailed = "CREATE_FAILED"
|
|
|
|
// ChannelStateIdle is a ChannelState enum value
|
|
ChannelStateIdle = "IDLE"
|
|
|
|
// ChannelStateStarting is a ChannelState enum value
|
|
ChannelStateStarting = "STARTING"
|
|
|
|
// ChannelStateRunning is a ChannelState enum value
|
|
ChannelStateRunning = "RUNNING"
|
|
|
|
// ChannelStateRecovering is a ChannelState enum value
|
|
ChannelStateRecovering = "RECOVERING"
|
|
|
|
// ChannelStateStopping is a ChannelState enum value
|
|
ChannelStateStopping = "STOPPING"
|
|
|
|
// ChannelStateDeleting is a ChannelState enum value
|
|
ChannelStateDeleting = "DELETING"
|
|
|
|
// ChannelStateDeleted is a ChannelState enum value
|
|
ChannelStateDeleted = "DELETED"
|
|
)
|
|
|
|
const (
|
|
// DvbSdtOutputSdtSdtFollow is a DvbSdtOutputSdt enum value
|
|
DvbSdtOutputSdtSdtFollow = "SDT_FOLLOW"
|
|
|
|
// DvbSdtOutputSdtSdtFollowIfPresent is a DvbSdtOutputSdt enum value
|
|
DvbSdtOutputSdtSdtFollowIfPresent = "SDT_FOLLOW_IF_PRESENT"
|
|
|
|
// DvbSdtOutputSdtSdtManual is a DvbSdtOutputSdt enum value
|
|
DvbSdtOutputSdtSdtManual = "SDT_MANUAL"
|
|
|
|
// DvbSdtOutputSdtSdtNone is a DvbSdtOutputSdt enum value
|
|
DvbSdtOutputSdtSdtNone = "SDT_NONE"
|
|
)
|
|
|
|
const (
|
|
// DvbSubDestinationAlignmentCentered is a DvbSubDestinationAlignment enum value
|
|
DvbSubDestinationAlignmentCentered = "CENTERED"
|
|
|
|
// DvbSubDestinationAlignmentLeft is a DvbSubDestinationAlignment enum value
|
|
DvbSubDestinationAlignmentLeft = "LEFT"
|
|
|
|
// DvbSubDestinationAlignmentSmart is a DvbSubDestinationAlignment enum value
|
|
DvbSubDestinationAlignmentSmart = "SMART"
|
|
)
|
|
|
|
const (
|
|
// DvbSubDestinationBackgroundColorBlack is a DvbSubDestinationBackgroundColor enum value
|
|
DvbSubDestinationBackgroundColorBlack = "BLACK"
|
|
|
|
// DvbSubDestinationBackgroundColorNone is a DvbSubDestinationBackgroundColor enum value
|
|
DvbSubDestinationBackgroundColorNone = "NONE"
|
|
|
|
// DvbSubDestinationBackgroundColorWhite is a DvbSubDestinationBackgroundColor enum value
|
|
DvbSubDestinationBackgroundColorWhite = "WHITE"
|
|
)
|
|
|
|
const (
|
|
// DvbSubDestinationFontColorBlack is a DvbSubDestinationFontColor enum value
|
|
DvbSubDestinationFontColorBlack = "BLACK"
|
|
|
|
// DvbSubDestinationFontColorBlue is a DvbSubDestinationFontColor enum value
|
|
DvbSubDestinationFontColorBlue = "BLUE"
|
|
|
|
// DvbSubDestinationFontColorGreen is a DvbSubDestinationFontColor enum value
|
|
DvbSubDestinationFontColorGreen = "GREEN"
|
|
|
|
// DvbSubDestinationFontColorRed is a DvbSubDestinationFontColor enum value
|
|
DvbSubDestinationFontColorRed = "RED"
|
|
|
|
// DvbSubDestinationFontColorWhite is a DvbSubDestinationFontColor enum value
|
|
DvbSubDestinationFontColorWhite = "WHITE"
|
|
|
|
// DvbSubDestinationFontColorYellow is a DvbSubDestinationFontColor enum value
|
|
DvbSubDestinationFontColorYellow = "YELLOW"
|
|
)
|
|
|
|
const (
|
|
// DvbSubDestinationOutlineColorBlack is a DvbSubDestinationOutlineColor enum value
|
|
DvbSubDestinationOutlineColorBlack = "BLACK"
|
|
|
|
// DvbSubDestinationOutlineColorBlue is a DvbSubDestinationOutlineColor enum value
|
|
DvbSubDestinationOutlineColorBlue = "BLUE"
|
|
|
|
// DvbSubDestinationOutlineColorGreen is a DvbSubDestinationOutlineColor enum value
|
|
DvbSubDestinationOutlineColorGreen = "GREEN"
|
|
|
|
// DvbSubDestinationOutlineColorRed is a DvbSubDestinationOutlineColor enum value
|
|
DvbSubDestinationOutlineColorRed = "RED"
|
|
|
|
// DvbSubDestinationOutlineColorWhite is a DvbSubDestinationOutlineColor enum value
|
|
DvbSubDestinationOutlineColorWhite = "WHITE"
|
|
|
|
// DvbSubDestinationOutlineColorYellow is a DvbSubDestinationOutlineColor enum value
|
|
DvbSubDestinationOutlineColorYellow = "YELLOW"
|
|
)
|
|
|
|
const (
|
|
// DvbSubDestinationShadowColorBlack is a DvbSubDestinationShadowColor enum value
|
|
DvbSubDestinationShadowColorBlack = "BLACK"
|
|
|
|
// DvbSubDestinationShadowColorNone is a DvbSubDestinationShadowColor enum value
|
|
DvbSubDestinationShadowColorNone = "NONE"
|
|
|
|
// DvbSubDestinationShadowColorWhite is a DvbSubDestinationShadowColor enum value
|
|
DvbSubDestinationShadowColorWhite = "WHITE"
|
|
)
|
|
|
|
const (
|
|
// DvbSubDestinationTeletextGridControlFixed is a DvbSubDestinationTeletextGridControl enum value
|
|
DvbSubDestinationTeletextGridControlFixed = "FIXED"
|
|
|
|
// DvbSubDestinationTeletextGridControlScaled is a DvbSubDestinationTeletextGridControl enum value
|
|
DvbSubDestinationTeletextGridControlScaled = "SCALED"
|
|
)
|
|
|
|
const (
|
|
// Eac3AttenuationControlAttenuate3Db is a Eac3AttenuationControl enum value
|
|
Eac3AttenuationControlAttenuate3Db = "ATTENUATE_3_DB"
|
|
|
|
// Eac3AttenuationControlNone is a Eac3AttenuationControl enum value
|
|
Eac3AttenuationControlNone = "NONE"
|
|
)
|
|
|
|
const (
|
|
// Eac3BitstreamModeCommentary is a Eac3BitstreamMode enum value
|
|
Eac3BitstreamModeCommentary = "COMMENTARY"
|
|
|
|
// Eac3BitstreamModeCompleteMain is a Eac3BitstreamMode enum value
|
|
Eac3BitstreamModeCompleteMain = "COMPLETE_MAIN"
|
|
|
|
// Eac3BitstreamModeEmergency is a Eac3BitstreamMode enum value
|
|
Eac3BitstreamModeEmergency = "EMERGENCY"
|
|
|
|
// Eac3BitstreamModeHearingImpaired is a Eac3BitstreamMode enum value
|
|
Eac3BitstreamModeHearingImpaired = "HEARING_IMPAIRED"
|
|
|
|
// Eac3BitstreamModeVisuallyImpaired is a Eac3BitstreamMode enum value
|
|
Eac3BitstreamModeVisuallyImpaired = "VISUALLY_IMPAIRED"
|
|
)
|
|
|
|
const (
|
|
// Eac3CodingModeCodingMode10 is a Eac3CodingMode enum value
|
|
Eac3CodingModeCodingMode10 = "CODING_MODE_1_0"
|
|
|
|
// Eac3CodingModeCodingMode20 is a Eac3CodingMode enum value
|
|
Eac3CodingModeCodingMode20 = "CODING_MODE_2_0"
|
|
|
|
// Eac3CodingModeCodingMode32 is a Eac3CodingMode enum value
|
|
Eac3CodingModeCodingMode32 = "CODING_MODE_3_2"
|
|
)
|
|
|
|
const (
|
|
// Eac3DcFilterDisabled is a Eac3DcFilter enum value
|
|
Eac3DcFilterDisabled = "DISABLED"
|
|
|
|
// Eac3DcFilterEnabled is a Eac3DcFilter enum value
|
|
Eac3DcFilterEnabled = "ENABLED"
|
|
)
|
|
|
|
const (
|
|
// Eac3DrcLineFilmLight is a Eac3DrcLine enum value
|
|
Eac3DrcLineFilmLight = "FILM_LIGHT"
|
|
|
|
// Eac3DrcLineFilmStandard is a Eac3DrcLine enum value
|
|
Eac3DrcLineFilmStandard = "FILM_STANDARD"
|
|
|
|
// Eac3DrcLineMusicLight is a Eac3DrcLine enum value
|
|
Eac3DrcLineMusicLight = "MUSIC_LIGHT"
|
|
|
|
// Eac3DrcLineMusicStandard is a Eac3DrcLine enum value
|
|
Eac3DrcLineMusicStandard = "MUSIC_STANDARD"
|
|
|
|
// Eac3DrcLineNone is a Eac3DrcLine enum value
|
|
Eac3DrcLineNone = "NONE"
|
|
|
|
// Eac3DrcLineSpeech is a Eac3DrcLine enum value
|
|
Eac3DrcLineSpeech = "SPEECH"
|
|
)
|
|
|
|
const (
|
|
// Eac3DrcRfFilmLight is a Eac3DrcRf enum value
|
|
Eac3DrcRfFilmLight = "FILM_LIGHT"
|
|
|
|
// Eac3DrcRfFilmStandard is a Eac3DrcRf enum value
|
|
Eac3DrcRfFilmStandard = "FILM_STANDARD"
|
|
|
|
// Eac3DrcRfMusicLight is a Eac3DrcRf enum value
|
|
Eac3DrcRfMusicLight = "MUSIC_LIGHT"
|
|
|
|
// Eac3DrcRfMusicStandard is a Eac3DrcRf enum value
|
|
Eac3DrcRfMusicStandard = "MUSIC_STANDARD"
|
|
|
|
// Eac3DrcRfNone is a Eac3DrcRf enum value
|
|
Eac3DrcRfNone = "NONE"
|
|
|
|
// Eac3DrcRfSpeech is a Eac3DrcRf enum value
|
|
Eac3DrcRfSpeech = "SPEECH"
|
|
)
|
|
|
|
const (
|
|
// Eac3LfeControlLfe is a Eac3LfeControl enum value
|
|
Eac3LfeControlLfe = "LFE"
|
|
|
|
// Eac3LfeControlNoLfe is a Eac3LfeControl enum value
|
|
Eac3LfeControlNoLfe = "NO_LFE"
|
|
)
|
|
|
|
const (
|
|
// Eac3LfeFilterDisabled is a Eac3LfeFilter enum value
|
|
Eac3LfeFilterDisabled = "DISABLED"
|
|
|
|
// Eac3LfeFilterEnabled is a Eac3LfeFilter enum value
|
|
Eac3LfeFilterEnabled = "ENABLED"
|
|
)
|
|
|
|
const (
|
|
// Eac3MetadataControlFollowInput is a Eac3MetadataControl enum value
|
|
Eac3MetadataControlFollowInput = "FOLLOW_INPUT"
|
|
|
|
// Eac3MetadataControlUseConfigured is a Eac3MetadataControl enum value
|
|
Eac3MetadataControlUseConfigured = "USE_CONFIGURED"
|
|
)
|
|
|
|
const (
|
|
// Eac3PassthroughControlNoPassthrough is a Eac3PassthroughControl enum value
|
|
Eac3PassthroughControlNoPassthrough = "NO_PASSTHROUGH"
|
|
|
|
// Eac3PassthroughControlWhenPossible is a Eac3PassthroughControl enum value
|
|
Eac3PassthroughControlWhenPossible = "WHEN_POSSIBLE"
|
|
)
|
|
|
|
const (
|
|
// Eac3PhaseControlNoShift is a Eac3PhaseControl enum value
|
|
Eac3PhaseControlNoShift = "NO_SHIFT"
|
|
|
|
// Eac3PhaseControlShift90Degrees is a Eac3PhaseControl enum value
|
|
Eac3PhaseControlShift90Degrees = "SHIFT_90_DEGREES"
|
|
)
|
|
|
|
const (
|
|
// Eac3StereoDownmixDpl2 is a Eac3StereoDownmix enum value
|
|
Eac3StereoDownmixDpl2 = "DPL2"
|
|
|
|
// Eac3StereoDownmixLoRo is a Eac3StereoDownmix enum value
|
|
Eac3StereoDownmixLoRo = "LO_RO"
|
|
|
|
// Eac3StereoDownmixLtRt is a Eac3StereoDownmix enum value
|
|
Eac3StereoDownmixLtRt = "LT_RT"
|
|
|
|
// Eac3StereoDownmixNotIndicated is a Eac3StereoDownmix enum value
|
|
Eac3StereoDownmixNotIndicated = "NOT_INDICATED"
|
|
)
|
|
|
|
const (
|
|
// Eac3SurroundExModeDisabled is a Eac3SurroundExMode enum value
|
|
Eac3SurroundExModeDisabled = "DISABLED"
|
|
|
|
// Eac3SurroundExModeEnabled is a Eac3SurroundExMode enum value
|
|
Eac3SurroundExModeEnabled = "ENABLED"
|
|
|
|
// Eac3SurroundExModeNotIndicated is a Eac3SurroundExMode enum value
|
|
Eac3SurroundExModeNotIndicated = "NOT_INDICATED"
|
|
)
|
|
|
|
const (
|
|
// Eac3SurroundModeDisabled is a Eac3SurroundMode enum value
|
|
Eac3SurroundModeDisabled = "DISABLED"
|
|
|
|
// Eac3SurroundModeEnabled is a Eac3SurroundMode enum value
|
|
Eac3SurroundModeEnabled = "ENABLED"
|
|
|
|
// Eac3SurroundModeNotIndicated is a Eac3SurroundMode enum value
|
|
Eac3SurroundModeNotIndicated = "NOT_INDICATED"
|
|
)
|
|
|
|
const (
|
|
// EmbeddedConvert608To708Disabled is a EmbeddedConvert608To708 enum value
|
|
EmbeddedConvert608To708Disabled = "DISABLED"
|
|
|
|
// EmbeddedConvert608To708Upconvert is a EmbeddedConvert608To708 enum value
|
|
EmbeddedConvert608To708Upconvert = "UPCONVERT"
|
|
)
|
|
|
|
const (
|
|
// EmbeddedScte20DetectionAuto is a EmbeddedScte20Detection enum value
|
|
EmbeddedScte20DetectionAuto = "AUTO"
|
|
|
|
// EmbeddedScte20DetectionOff is a EmbeddedScte20Detection enum value
|
|
EmbeddedScte20DetectionOff = "OFF"
|
|
)
|
|
|
|
const (
|
|
// FecOutputIncludeFecColumn is a FecOutputIncludeFec enum value
|
|
FecOutputIncludeFecColumn = "COLUMN"
|
|
|
|
// FecOutputIncludeFecColumnAndRow is a FecOutputIncludeFec enum value
|
|
FecOutputIncludeFecColumnAndRow = "COLUMN_AND_ROW"
|
|
)
|
|
|
|
const (
|
|
// FixedAfdAfd0000 is a FixedAfd enum value
|
|
FixedAfdAfd0000 = "AFD_0000"
|
|
|
|
// FixedAfdAfd0010 is a FixedAfd enum value
|
|
FixedAfdAfd0010 = "AFD_0010"
|
|
|
|
// FixedAfdAfd0011 is a FixedAfd enum value
|
|
FixedAfdAfd0011 = "AFD_0011"
|
|
|
|
// FixedAfdAfd0100 is a FixedAfd enum value
|
|
FixedAfdAfd0100 = "AFD_0100"
|
|
|
|
// FixedAfdAfd1000 is a FixedAfd enum value
|
|
FixedAfdAfd1000 = "AFD_1000"
|
|
|
|
// FixedAfdAfd1001 is a FixedAfd enum value
|
|
FixedAfdAfd1001 = "AFD_1001"
|
|
|
|
// FixedAfdAfd1010 is a FixedAfd enum value
|
|
FixedAfdAfd1010 = "AFD_1010"
|
|
|
|
// FixedAfdAfd1011 is a FixedAfd enum value
|
|
FixedAfdAfd1011 = "AFD_1011"
|
|
|
|
// FixedAfdAfd1101 is a FixedAfd enum value
|
|
FixedAfdAfd1101 = "AFD_1101"
|
|
|
|
// FixedAfdAfd1110 is a FixedAfd enum value
|
|
FixedAfdAfd1110 = "AFD_1110"
|
|
|
|
// FixedAfdAfd1111 is a FixedAfd enum value
|
|
FixedAfdAfd1111 = "AFD_1111"
|
|
)
|
|
|
|
// Follow reference point.
|
|
const (
|
|
// FollowPointEnd is a FollowPoint enum value
|
|
FollowPointEnd = "END"
|
|
|
|
// FollowPointStart is a FollowPoint enum value
|
|
FollowPointStart = "START"
|
|
)
|
|
|
|
const (
|
|
// GlobalConfigurationInputEndActionNone is a GlobalConfigurationInputEndAction enum value
|
|
GlobalConfigurationInputEndActionNone = "NONE"
|
|
|
|
// GlobalConfigurationInputEndActionSwitchAndLoopInputs is a GlobalConfigurationInputEndAction enum value
|
|
GlobalConfigurationInputEndActionSwitchAndLoopInputs = "SWITCH_AND_LOOP_INPUTS"
|
|
)
|
|
|
|
const (
|
|
// GlobalConfigurationLowFramerateInputsDisabled is a GlobalConfigurationLowFramerateInputs enum value
|
|
GlobalConfigurationLowFramerateInputsDisabled = "DISABLED"
|
|
|
|
// GlobalConfigurationLowFramerateInputsEnabled is a GlobalConfigurationLowFramerateInputs enum value
|
|
GlobalConfigurationLowFramerateInputsEnabled = "ENABLED"
|
|
)
|
|
|
|
const (
|
|
// GlobalConfigurationOutputTimingSourceInputClock is a GlobalConfigurationOutputTimingSource enum value
|
|
GlobalConfigurationOutputTimingSourceInputClock = "INPUT_CLOCK"
|
|
|
|
// GlobalConfigurationOutputTimingSourceSystemClock is a GlobalConfigurationOutputTimingSource enum value
|
|
GlobalConfigurationOutputTimingSourceSystemClock = "SYSTEM_CLOCK"
|
|
)
|
|
|
|
const (
|
|
// H264AdaptiveQuantizationHigh is a H264AdaptiveQuantization enum value
|
|
H264AdaptiveQuantizationHigh = "HIGH"
|
|
|
|
// H264AdaptiveQuantizationHigher is a H264AdaptiveQuantization enum value
|
|
H264AdaptiveQuantizationHigher = "HIGHER"
|
|
|
|
// H264AdaptiveQuantizationLow is a H264AdaptiveQuantization enum value
|
|
H264AdaptiveQuantizationLow = "LOW"
|
|
|
|
// H264AdaptiveQuantizationMax is a H264AdaptiveQuantization enum value
|
|
H264AdaptiveQuantizationMax = "MAX"
|
|
|
|
// H264AdaptiveQuantizationMedium is a H264AdaptiveQuantization enum value
|
|
H264AdaptiveQuantizationMedium = "MEDIUM"
|
|
|
|
// H264AdaptiveQuantizationOff is a H264AdaptiveQuantization enum value
|
|
H264AdaptiveQuantizationOff = "OFF"
|
|
)
|
|
|
|
const (
|
|
// H264ColorMetadataIgnore is a H264ColorMetadata enum value
|
|
H264ColorMetadataIgnore = "IGNORE"
|
|
|
|
// H264ColorMetadataInsert is a H264ColorMetadata enum value
|
|
H264ColorMetadataInsert = "INSERT"
|
|
)
|
|
|
|
const (
|
|
// H264EntropyEncodingCabac is a H264EntropyEncoding enum value
|
|
H264EntropyEncodingCabac = "CABAC"
|
|
|
|
// H264EntropyEncodingCavlc is a H264EntropyEncoding enum value
|
|
H264EntropyEncodingCavlc = "CAVLC"
|
|
)
|
|
|
|
const (
|
|
// H264FlickerAqDisabled is a H264FlickerAq enum value
|
|
H264FlickerAqDisabled = "DISABLED"
|
|
|
|
// H264FlickerAqEnabled is a H264FlickerAq enum value
|
|
H264FlickerAqEnabled = "ENABLED"
|
|
)
|
|
|
|
const (
|
|
// H264FramerateControlInitializeFromSource is a H264FramerateControl enum value
|
|
H264FramerateControlInitializeFromSource = "INITIALIZE_FROM_SOURCE"
|
|
|
|
// H264FramerateControlSpecified is a H264FramerateControl enum value
|
|
H264FramerateControlSpecified = "SPECIFIED"
|
|
)
|
|
|
|
const (
|
|
// H264GopBReferenceDisabled is a H264GopBReference enum value
|
|
H264GopBReferenceDisabled = "DISABLED"
|
|
|
|
// H264GopBReferenceEnabled is a H264GopBReference enum value
|
|
H264GopBReferenceEnabled = "ENABLED"
|
|
)
|
|
|
|
const (
|
|
// H264GopSizeUnitsFrames is a H264GopSizeUnits enum value
|
|
H264GopSizeUnitsFrames = "FRAMES"
|
|
|
|
// H264GopSizeUnitsSeconds is a H264GopSizeUnits enum value
|
|
H264GopSizeUnitsSeconds = "SECONDS"
|
|
)
|
|
|
|
const (
|
|
// H264LevelH264Level1 is a H264Level enum value
|
|
H264LevelH264Level1 = "H264_LEVEL_1"
|
|
|
|
// H264LevelH264Level11 is a H264Level enum value
|
|
H264LevelH264Level11 = "H264_LEVEL_1_1"
|
|
|
|
// H264LevelH264Level12 is a H264Level enum value
|
|
H264LevelH264Level12 = "H264_LEVEL_1_2"
|
|
|
|
// H264LevelH264Level13 is a H264Level enum value
|
|
H264LevelH264Level13 = "H264_LEVEL_1_3"
|
|
|
|
// H264LevelH264Level2 is a H264Level enum value
|
|
H264LevelH264Level2 = "H264_LEVEL_2"
|
|
|
|
// H264LevelH264Level21 is a H264Level enum value
|
|
H264LevelH264Level21 = "H264_LEVEL_2_1"
|
|
|
|
// H264LevelH264Level22 is a H264Level enum value
|
|
H264LevelH264Level22 = "H264_LEVEL_2_2"
|
|
|
|
// H264LevelH264Level3 is a H264Level enum value
|
|
H264LevelH264Level3 = "H264_LEVEL_3"
|
|
|
|
// H264LevelH264Level31 is a H264Level enum value
|
|
H264LevelH264Level31 = "H264_LEVEL_3_1"
|
|
|
|
// H264LevelH264Level32 is a H264Level enum value
|
|
H264LevelH264Level32 = "H264_LEVEL_3_2"
|
|
|
|
// H264LevelH264Level4 is a H264Level enum value
|
|
H264LevelH264Level4 = "H264_LEVEL_4"
|
|
|
|
// H264LevelH264Level41 is a H264Level enum value
|
|
H264LevelH264Level41 = "H264_LEVEL_4_1"
|
|
|
|
// H264LevelH264Level42 is a H264Level enum value
|
|
H264LevelH264Level42 = "H264_LEVEL_4_2"
|
|
|
|
// H264LevelH264Level5 is a H264Level enum value
|
|
H264LevelH264Level5 = "H264_LEVEL_5"
|
|
|
|
// H264LevelH264Level51 is a H264Level enum value
|
|
H264LevelH264Level51 = "H264_LEVEL_5_1"
|
|
|
|
// H264LevelH264Level52 is a H264Level enum value
|
|
H264LevelH264Level52 = "H264_LEVEL_5_2"
|
|
|
|
// H264LevelH264LevelAuto is a H264Level enum value
|
|
H264LevelH264LevelAuto = "H264_LEVEL_AUTO"
|
|
)
|
|
|
|
const (
|
|
// H264LookAheadRateControlHigh is a H264LookAheadRateControl enum value
|
|
H264LookAheadRateControlHigh = "HIGH"
|
|
|
|
// H264LookAheadRateControlLow is a H264LookAheadRateControl enum value
|
|
H264LookAheadRateControlLow = "LOW"
|
|
|
|
// H264LookAheadRateControlMedium is a H264LookAheadRateControl enum value
|
|
H264LookAheadRateControlMedium = "MEDIUM"
|
|
)
|
|
|
|
const (
|
|
// H264ParControlInitializeFromSource is a H264ParControl enum value
|
|
H264ParControlInitializeFromSource = "INITIALIZE_FROM_SOURCE"
|
|
|
|
// H264ParControlSpecified is a H264ParControl enum value
|
|
H264ParControlSpecified = "SPECIFIED"
|
|
)
|
|
|
|
const (
|
|
// H264ProfileBaseline is a H264Profile enum value
|
|
H264ProfileBaseline = "BASELINE"
|
|
|
|
// H264ProfileHigh is a H264Profile enum value
|
|
H264ProfileHigh = "HIGH"
|
|
|
|
// H264ProfileHigh10bit is a H264Profile enum value
|
|
H264ProfileHigh10bit = "HIGH_10BIT"
|
|
|
|
// H264ProfileHigh422 is a H264Profile enum value
|
|
H264ProfileHigh422 = "HIGH_422"
|
|
|
|
// H264ProfileHigh42210bit is a H264Profile enum value
|
|
H264ProfileHigh42210bit = "HIGH_422_10BIT"
|
|
|
|
// H264ProfileMain is a H264Profile enum value
|
|
H264ProfileMain = "MAIN"
|
|
)
|
|
|
|
const (
|
|
// H264RateControlModeCbr is a H264RateControlMode enum value
|
|
H264RateControlModeCbr = "CBR"
|
|
|
|
// H264RateControlModeQvbr is a H264RateControlMode enum value
|
|
H264RateControlModeQvbr = "QVBR"
|
|
|
|
// H264RateControlModeVbr is a H264RateControlMode enum value
|
|
H264RateControlModeVbr = "VBR"
|
|
)
|
|
|
|
const (
|
|
// H264ScanTypeInterlaced is a H264ScanType enum value
|
|
H264ScanTypeInterlaced = "INTERLACED"
|
|
|
|
// H264ScanTypeProgressive is a H264ScanType enum value
|
|
H264ScanTypeProgressive = "PROGRESSIVE"
|
|
)
|
|
|
|
const (
|
|
// H264SceneChangeDetectDisabled is a H264SceneChangeDetect enum value
|
|
H264SceneChangeDetectDisabled = "DISABLED"
|
|
|
|
// H264SceneChangeDetectEnabled is a H264SceneChangeDetect enum value
|
|
H264SceneChangeDetectEnabled = "ENABLED"
|
|
)
|
|
|
|
const (
|
|
// H264SpatialAqDisabled is a H264SpatialAq enum value
|
|
H264SpatialAqDisabled = "DISABLED"
|
|
|
|
// H264SpatialAqEnabled is a H264SpatialAq enum value
|
|
H264SpatialAqEnabled = "ENABLED"
|
|
)
|
|
|
|
const (
|
|
// H264SubGopLengthDynamic is a H264SubGopLength enum value
|
|
H264SubGopLengthDynamic = "DYNAMIC"
|
|
|
|
// H264SubGopLengthFixed is a H264SubGopLength enum value
|
|
H264SubGopLengthFixed = "FIXED"
|
|
)
|
|
|
|
const (
|
|
// H264SyntaxDefault is a H264Syntax enum value
|
|
H264SyntaxDefault = "DEFAULT"
|
|
|
|
// H264SyntaxRp2027 is a H264Syntax enum value
|
|
H264SyntaxRp2027 = "RP2027"
|
|
)
|
|
|
|
const (
|
|
// H264TemporalAqDisabled is a H264TemporalAq enum value
|
|
H264TemporalAqDisabled = "DISABLED"
|
|
|
|
// H264TemporalAqEnabled is a H264TemporalAq enum value
|
|
H264TemporalAqEnabled = "ENABLED"
|
|
)
|
|
|
|
const (
|
|
// H264TimecodeInsertionBehaviorDisabled is a H264TimecodeInsertionBehavior enum value
|
|
H264TimecodeInsertionBehaviorDisabled = "DISABLED"
|
|
|
|
// H264TimecodeInsertionBehaviorPicTimingSei is a H264TimecodeInsertionBehavior enum value
|
|
H264TimecodeInsertionBehaviorPicTimingSei = "PIC_TIMING_SEI"
|
|
)
|
|
|
|
const (
|
|
// HlsAdMarkersAdobe is a HlsAdMarkers enum value
|
|
HlsAdMarkersAdobe = "ADOBE"
|
|
|
|
// HlsAdMarkersElemental is a HlsAdMarkers enum value
|
|
HlsAdMarkersElemental = "ELEMENTAL"
|
|
|
|
// HlsAdMarkersElementalScte35 is a HlsAdMarkers enum value
|
|
HlsAdMarkersElementalScte35 = "ELEMENTAL_SCTE35"
|
|
)
|
|
|
|
const (
|
|
// HlsAkamaiHttpTransferModeChunked is a HlsAkamaiHttpTransferMode enum value
|
|
HlsAkamaiHttpTransferModeChunked = "CHUNKED"
|
|
|
|
// HlsAkamaiHttpTransferModeNonChunked is a HlsAkamaiHttpTransferMode enum value
|
|
HlsAkamaiHttpTransferModeNonChunked = "NON_CHUNKED"
|
|
)
|
|
|
|
const (
|
|
// HlsCaptionLanguageSettingInsert is a HlsCaptionLanguageSetting enum value
|
|
HlsCaptionLanguageSettingInsert = "INSERT"
|
|
|
|
// HlsCaptionLanguageSettingNone is a HlsCaptionLanguageSetting enum value
|
|
HlsCaptionLanguageSettingNone = "NONE"
|
|
|
|
// HlsCaptionLanguageSettingOmit is a HlsCaptionLanguageSetting enum value
|
|
HlsCaptionLanguageSettingOmit = "OMIT"
|
|
)
|
|
|
|
const (
|
|
// HlsClientCacheDisabled is a HlsClientCache enum value
|
|
HlsClientCacheDisabled = "DISABLED"
|
|
|
|
// HlsClientCacheEnabled is a HlsClientCache enum value
|
|
HlsClientCacheEnabled = "ENABLED"
|
|
)
|
|
|
|
const (
|
|
// HlsCodecSpecificationRfc4281 is a HlsCodecSpecification enum value
|
|
HlsCodecSpecificationRfc4281 = "RFC_4281"
|
|
|
|
// HlsCodecSpecificationRfc6381 is a HlsCodecSpecification enum value
|
|
HlsCodecSpecificationRfc6381 = "RFC_6381"
|
|
)
|
|
|
|
const (
|
|
// HlsDirectoryStructureSingleDirectory is a HlsDirectoryStructure enum value
|
|
HlsDirectoryStructureSingleDirectory = "SINGLE_DIRECTORY"
|
|
|
|
// HlsDirectoryStructureSubdirectoryPerStream is a HlsDirectoryStructure enum value
|
|
HlsDirectoryStructureSubdirectoryPerStream = "SUBDIRECTORY_PER_STREAM"
|
|
)
|
|
|
|
const (
|
|
// HlsEncryptionTypeAes128 is a HlsEncryptionType enum value
|
|
HlsEncryptionTypeAes128 = "AES128"
|
|
|
|
// HlsEncryptionTypeSampleAes is a HlsEncryptionType enum value
|
|
HlsEncryptionTypeSampleAes = "SAMPLE_AES"
|
|
)
|
|
|
|
const (
|
|
// HlsIvInManifestExclude is a HlsIvInManifest enum value
|
|
HlsIvInManifestExclude = "EXCLUDE"
|
|
|
|
// HlsIvInManifestInclude is a HlsIvInManifest enum value
|
|
HlsIvInManifestInclude = "INCLUDE"
|
|
)
|
|
|
|
const (
|
|
// HlsIvSourceExplicit is a HlsIvSource enum value
|
|
HlsIvSourceExplicit = "EXPLICIT"
|
|
|
|
// HlsIvSourceFollowsSegmentNumber is a HlsIvSource enum value
|
|
HlsIvSourceFollowsSegmentNumber = "FOLLOWS_SEGMENT_NUMBER"
|
|
)
|
|
|
|
const (
|
|
// HlsManifestCompressionGzip is a HlsManifestCompression enum value
|
|
HlsManifestCompressionGzip = "GZIP"
|
|
|
|
// HlsManifestCompressionNone is a HlsManifestCompression enum value
|
|
HlsManifestCompressionNone = "NONE"
|
|
)
|
|
|
|
const (
|
|
// HlsManifestDurationFormatFloatingPoint is a HlsManifestDurationFormat enum value
|
|
HlsManifestDurationFormatFloatingPoint = "FLOATING_POINT"
|
|
|
|
// HlsManifestDurationFormatInteger is a HlsManifestDurationFormat enum value
|
|
HlsManifestDurationFormatInteger = "INTEGER"
|
|
)
|
|
|
|
const (
|
|
// HlsMediaStoreStorageClassTemporal is a HlsMediaStoreStorageClass enum value
|
|
HlsMediaStoreStorageClassTemporal = "TEMPORAL"
|
|
)
|
|
|
|
const (
|
|
// HlsModeLive is a HlsMode enum value
|
|
HlsModeLive = "LIVE"
|
|
|
|
// HlsModeVod is a HlsMode enum value
|
|
HlsModeVod = "VOD"
|
|
)
|
|
|
|
const (
|
|
// HlsOutputSelectionManifestsAndSegments is a HlsOutputSelection enum value
|
|
HlsOutputSelectionManifestsAndSegments = "MANIFESTS_AND_SEGMENTS"
|
|
|
|
// HlsOutputSelectionSegmentsOnly is a HlsOutputSelection enum value
|
|
HlsOutputSelectionSegmentsOnly = "SEGMENTS_ONLY"
|
|
)
|
|
|
|
const (
|
|
// HlsProgramDateTimeExclude is a HlsProgramDateTime enum value
|
|
HlsProgramDateTimeExclude = "EXCLUDE"
|
|
|
|
// HlsProgramDateTimeInclude is a HlsProgramDateTime enum value
|
|
HlsProgramDateTimeInclude = "INCLUDE"
|
|
)
|
|
|
|
const (
|
|
// HlsRedundantManifestDisabled is a HlsRedundantManifest enum value
|
|
HlsRedundantManifestDisabled = "DISABLED"
|
|
|
|
// HlsRedundantManifestEnabled is a HlsRedundantManifest enum value
|
|
HlsRedundantManifestEnabled = "ENABLED"
|
|
)
|
|
|
|
const (
|
|
// HlsSegmentationModeUseInputSegmentation is a HlsSegmentationMode enum value
|
|
HlsSegmentationModeUseInputSegmentation = "USE_INPUT_SEGMENTATION"
|
|
|
|
// HlsSegmentationModeUseSegmentDuration is a HlsSegmentationMode enum value
|
|
HlsSegmentationModeUseSegmentDuration = "USE_SEGMENT_DURATION"
|
|
)
|
|
|
|
const (
|
|
// HlsStreamInfResolutionExclude is a HlsStreamInfResolution enum value
|
|
HlsStreamInfResolutionExclude = "EXCLUDE"
|
|
|
|
// HlsStreamInfResolutionInclude is a HlsStreamInfResolution enum value
|
|
HlsStreamInfResolutionInclude = "INCLUDE"
|
|
)
|
|
|
|
const (
|
|
// HlsTimedMetadataId3FrameNone is a HlsTimedMetadataId3Frame enum value
|
|
HlsTimedMetadataId3FrameNone = "NONE"
|
|
|
|
// HlsTimedMetadataId3FramePriv is a HlsTimedMetadataId3Frame enum value
|
|
HlsTimedMetadataId3FramePriv = "PRIV"
|
|
|
|
// HlsTimedMetadataId3FrameTdrl is a HlsTimedMetadataId3Frame enum value
|
|
HlsTimedMetadataId3FrameTdrl = "TDRL"
|
|
)
|
|
|
|
const (
|
|
// HlsTsFileModeSegmentedFiles is a HlsTsFileMode enum value
|
|
HlsTsFileModeSegmentedFiles = "SEGMENTED_FILES"
|
|
|
|
// HlsTsFileModeSingleFile is a HlsTsFileMode enum value
|
|
HlsTsFileModeSingleFile = "SINGLE_FILE"
|
|
)
|
|
|
|
const (
|
|
// HlsWebdavHttpTransferModeChunked is a HlsWebdavHttpTransferMode enum value
|
|
HlsWebdavHttpTransferModeChunked = "CHUNKED"
|
|
|
|
// HlsWebdavHttpTransferModeNonChunked is a HlsWebdavHttpTransferMode enum value
|
|
HlsWebdavHttpTransferModeNonChunked = "NON_CHUNKED"
|
|
)
|
|
|
|
// codec in increasing order of complexity
|
|
const (
|
|
// InputCodecMpeg2 is a InputCodec enum value
|
|
InputCodecMpeg2 = "MPEG2"
|
|
|
|
// InputCodecAvc is a InputCodec enum value
|
|
InputCodecAvc = "AVC"
|
|
|
|
// InputCodecHevc is a InputCodec enum value
|
|
InputCodecHevc = "HEVC"
|
|
)
|
|
|
|
const (
|
|
// InputDeblockFilterDisabled is a InputDeblockFilter enum value
|
|
InputDeblockFilterDisabled = "DISABLED"
|
|
|
|
// InputDeblockFilterEnabled is a InputDeblockFilter enum value
|
|
InputDeblockFilterEnabled = "ENABLED"
|
|
)
|
|
|
|
const (
|
|
// InputDenoiseFilterDisabled is a InputDenoiseFilter enum value
|
|
InputDenoiseFilterDisabled = "DISABLED"
|
|
|
|
// InputDenoiseFilterEnabled is a InputDenoiseFilter enum value
|
|
InputDenoiseFilterEnabled = "ENABLED"
|
|
)
|
|
|
|
const (
|
|
// InputFilterAuto is a InputFilter enum value
|
|
InputFilterAuto = "AUTO"
|
|
|
|
// InputFilterDisabled is a InputFilter enum value
|
|
InputFilterDisabled = "DISABLED"
|
|
|
|
// InputFilterForced is a InputFilter enum value
|
|
InputFilterForced = "FORCED"
|
|
)
|
|
|
|
const (
|
|
// InputLossActionForHlsOutEmitOutput is a InputLossActionForHlsOut enum value
|
|
InputLossActionForHlsOutEmitOutput = "EMIT_OUTPUT"
|
|
|
|
// InputLossActionForHlsOutPauseOutput is a InputLossActionForHlsOut enum value
|
|
InputLossActionForHlsOutPauseOutput = "PAUSE_OUTPUT"
|
|
)
|
|
|
|
const (
|
|
// InputLossActionForMsSmoothOutEmitOutput is a InputLossActionForMsSmoothOut enum value
|
|
InputLossActionForMsSmoothOutEmitOutput = "EMIT_OUTPUT"
|
|
|
|
// InputLossActionForMsSmoothOutPauseOutput is a InputLossActionForMsSmoothOut enum value
|
|
InputLossActionForMsSmoothOutPauseOutput = "PAUSE_OUTPUT"
|
|
)
|
|
|
|
const (
|
|
// InputLossActionForRtmpOutEmitOutput is a InputLossActionForRtmpOut enum value
|
|
InputLossActionForRtmpOutEmitOutput = "EMIT_OUTPUT"
|
|
|
|
// InputLossActionForRtmpOutPauseOutput is a InputLossActionForRtmpOut enum value
|
|
InputLossActionForRtmpOutPauseOutput = "PAUSE_OUTPUT"
|
|
)
|
|
|
|
const (
|
|
// InputLossActionForUdpOutDropProgram is a InputLossActionForUdpOut enum value
|
|
InputLossActionForUdpOutDropProgram = "DROP_PROGRAM"
|
|
|
|
// InputLossActionForUdpOutDropTs is a InputLossActionForUdpOut enum value
|
|
InputLossActionForUdpOutDropTs = "DROP_TS"
|
|
|
|
// InputLossActionForUdpOutEmitProgram is a InputLossActionForUdpOut enum value
|
|
InputLossActionForUdpOutEmitProgram = "EMIT_PROGRAM"
|
|
)
|
|
|
|
const (
|
|
// InputLossImageTypeColor is a InputLossImageType enum value
|
|
InputLossImageTypeColor = "COLOR"
|
|
|
|
// InputLossImageTypeSlate is a InputLossImageType enum value
|
|
InputLossImageTypeSlate = "SLATE"
|
|
)
|
|
|
|
// Maximum input bitrate in megabits per second. Bitrates up to 50 Mbps are
|
|
// supported currently.
|
|
const (
|
|
// InputMaximumBitrateMax10Mbps is a InputMaximumBitrate enum value
|
|
InputMaximumBitrateMax10Mbps = "MAX_10_MBPS"
|
|
|
|
// InputMaximumBitrateMax20Mbps is a InputMaximumBitrate enum value
|
|
InputMaximumBitrateMax20Mbps = "MAX_20_MBPS"
|
|
|
|
// InputMaximumBitrateMax50Mbps is a InputMaximumBitrate enum value
|
|
InputMaximumBitrateMax50Mbps = "MAX_50_MBPS"
|
|
)
|
|
|
|
// Input resolution based on lines of vertical resolution in the input; SD is
|
|
// less than 720 lines, HD is 720 to 1080 lines, UHD is greater than 1080 lines
|
|
const (
|
|
// InputResolutionSd is a InputResolution enum value
|
|
InputResolutionSd = "SD"
|
|
|
|
// InputResolutionHd is a InputResolution enum value
|
|
InputResolutionHd = "HD"
|
|
|
|
// InputResolutionUhd is a InputResolution enum value
|
|
InputResolutionUhd = "UHD"
|
|
)
|
|
|
|
const (
|
|
// InputSecurityGroupStateIdle is a InputSecurityGroupState enum value
|
|
InputSecurityGroupStateIdle = "IDLE"
|
|
|
|
// InputSecurityGroupStateInUse is a InputSecurityGroupState enum value
|
|
InputSecurityGroupStateInUse = "IN_USE"
|
|
|
|
// InputSecurityGroupStateUpdating is a InputSecurityGroupState enum value
|
|
InputSecurityGroupStateUpdating = "UPDATING"
|
|
|
|
// InputSecurityGroupStateDeleted is a InputSecurityGroupState enum value
|
|
InputSecurityGroupStateDeleted = "DELETED"
|
|
)
|
|
|
|
const (
|
|
// InputSourceEndBehaviorContinue is a InputSourceEndBehavior enum value
|
|
InputSourceEndBehaviorContinue = "CONTINUE"
|
|
|
|
// InputSourceEndBehaviorLoop is a InputSourceEndBehavior enum value
|
|
InputSourceEndBehaviorLoop = "LOOP"
|
|
)
|
|
|
|
const (
|
|
// InputStateCreating is a InputState enum value
|
|
InputStateCreating = "CREATING"
|
|
|
|
// InputStateDetached is a InputState enum value
|
|
InputStateDetached = "DETACHED"
|
|
|
|
// InputStateAttached is a InputState enum value
|
|
InputStateAttached = "ATTACHED"
|
|
|
|
// InputStateDeleting is a InputState enum value
|
|
InputStateDeleting = "DELETING"
|
|
|
|
// InputStateDeleted is a InputState enum value
|
|
InputStateDeleted = "DELETED"
|
|
)
|
|
|
|
const (
|
|
// InputTypeUdpPush is a InputType enum value
|
|
InputTypeUdpPush = "UDP_PUSH"
|
|
|
|
// InputTypeRtpPush is a InputType enum value
|
|
InputTypeRtpPush = "RTP_PUSH"
|
|
|
|
// InputTypeRtmpPush is a InputType enum value
|
|
InputTypeRtmpPush = "RTMP_PUSH"
|
|
|
|
// InputTypeRtmpPull is a InputType enum value
|
|
InputTypeRtmpPull = "RTMP_PULL"
|
|
|
|
// InputTypeUrlPull is a InputType enum value
|
|
InputTypeUrlPull = "URL_PULL"
|
|
|
|
// InputTypeMp4File is a InputType enum value
|
|
InputTypeMp4File = "MP4_FILE"
|
|
|
|
// InputTypeMediaconnect is a InputType enum value
|
|
InputTypeMediaconnect = "MEDIACONNECT"
|
|
)
|
|
|
|
// The log level the user wants for their channel.
|
|
const (
|
|
// LogLevelError is a LogLevel enum value
|
|
LogLevelError = "ERROR"
|
|
|
|
// LogLevelWarning is a LogLevel enum value
|
|
LogLevelWarning = "WARNING"
|
|
|
|
// LogLevelInfo is a LogLevel enum value
|
|
LogLevelInfo = "INFO"
|
|
|
|
// LogLevelDebug is a LogLevel enum value
|
|
LogLevelDebug = "DEBUG"
|
|
|
|
// LogLevelDisabled is a LogLevel enum value
|
|
LogLevelDisabled = "DISABLED"
|
|
)
|
|
|
|
const (
|
|
// M2tsAbsentInputAudioBehaviorDrop is a M2tsAbsentInputAudioBehavior enum value
|
|
M2tsAbsentInputAudioBehaviorDrop = "DROP"
|
|
|
|
// M2tsAbsentInputAudioBehaviorEncodeSilence is a M2tsAbsentInputAudioBehavior enum value
|
|
M2tsAbsentInputAudioBehaviorEncodeSilence = "ENCODE_SILENCE"
|
|
)
|
|
|
|
const (
|
|
// M2tsAribDisabled is a M2tsArib enum value
|
|
M2tsAribDisabled = "DISABLED"
|
|
|
|
// M2tsAribEnabled is a M2tsArib enum value
|
|
M2tsAribEnabled = "ENABLED"
|
|
)
|
|
|
|
const (
|
|
// M2tsAribCaptionsPidControlAuto is a M2tsAribCaptionsPidControl enum value
|
|
M2tsAribCaptionsPidControlAuto = "AUTO"
|
|
|
|
// M2tsAribCaptionsPidControlUseConfigured is a M2tsAribCaptionsPidControl enum value
|
|
M2tsAribCaptionsPidControlUseConfigured = "USE_CONFIGURED"
|
|
)
|
|
|
|
const (
|
|
// M2tsAudioBufferModelAtsc is a M2tsAudioBufferModel enum value
|
|
M2tsAudioBufferModelAtsc = "ATSC"
|
|
|
|
// M2tsAudioBufferModelDvb is a M2tsAudioBufferModel enum value
|
|
M2tsAudioBufferModelDvb = "DVB"
|
|
)
|
|
|
|
const (
|
|
// M2tsAudioIntervalVideoAndFixedIntervals is a M2tsAudioInterval enum value
|
|
M2tsAudioIntervalVideoAndFixedIntervals = "VIDEO_AND_FIXED_INTERVALS"
|
|
|
|
// M2tsAudioIntervalVideoInterval is a M2tsAudioInterval enum value
|
|
M2tsAudioIntervalVideoInterval = "VIDEO_INTERVAL"
|
|
)
|
|
|
|
const (
|
|
// M2tsAudioStreamTypeAtsc is a M2tsAudioStreamType enum value
|
|
M2tsAudioStreamTypeAtsc = "ATSC"
|
|
|
|
// M2tsAudioStreamTypeDvb is a M2tsAudioStreamType enum value
|
|
M2tsAudioStreamTypeDvb = "DVB"
|
|
)
|
|
|
|
const (
|
|
// M2tsBufferModelMultiplex is a M2tsBufferModel enum value
|
|
M2tsBufferModelMultiplex = "MULTIPLEX"
|
|
|
|
// M2tsBufferModelNone is a M2tsBufferModel enum value
|
|
M2tsBufferModelNone = "NONE"
|
|
)
|
|
|
|
const (
|
|
// M2tsCcDescriptorDisabled is a M2tsCcDescriptor enum value
|
|
M2tsCcDescriptorDisabled = "DISABLED"
|
|
|
|
// M2tsCcDescriptorEnabled is a M2tsCcDescriptor enum value
|
|
M2tsCcDescriptorEnabled = "ENABLED"
|
|
)
|
|
|
|
const (
|
|
// M2tsEbifControlNone is a M2tsEbifControl enum value
|
|
M2tsEbifControlNone = "NONE"
|
|
|
|
// M2tsEbifControlPassthrough is a M2tsEbifControl enum value
|
|
M2tsEbifControlPassthrough = "PASSTHROUGH"
|
|
)
|
|
|
|
const (
|
|
// M2tsEbpPlacementVideoAndAudioPids is a M2tsEbpPlacement enum value
|
|
M2tsEbpPlacementVideoAndAudioPids = "VIDEO_AND_AUDIO_PIDS"
|
|
|
|
// M2tsEbpPlacementVideoPid is a M2tsEbpPlacement enum value
|
|
M2tsEbpPlacementVideoPid = "VIDEO_PID"
|
|
)
|
|
|
|
const (
|
|
// M2tsEsRateInPesExclude is a M2tsEsRateInPes enum value
|
|
M2tsEsRateInPesExclude = "EXCLUDE"
|
|
|
|
// M2tsEsRateInPesInclude is a M2tsEsRateInPes enum value
|
|
M2tsEsRateInPesInclude = "INCLUDE"
|
|
)
|
|
|
|
const (
|
|
// M2tsKlvNone is a M2tsKlv enum value
|
|
M2tsKlvNone = "NONE"
|
|
|
|
// M2tsKlvPassthrough is a M2tsKlv enum value
|
|
M2tsKlvPassthrough = "PASSTHROUGH"
|
|
)
|
|
|
|
const (
|
|
// M2tsPcrControlConfiguredPcrPeriod is a M2tsPcrControl enum value
|
|
M2tsPcrControlConfiguredPcrPeriod = "CONFIGURED_PCR_PERIOD"
|
|
|
|
// M2tsPcrControlPcrEveryPesPacket is a M2tsPcrControl enum value
|
|
M2tsPcrControlPcrEveryPesPacket = "PCR_EVERY_PES_PACKET"
|
|
)
|
|
|
|
const (
|
|
// M2tsRateModeCbr is a M2tsRateMode enum value
|
|
M2tsRateModeCbr = "CBR"
|
|
|
|
// M2tsRateModeVbr is a M2tsRateMode enum value
|
|
M2tsRateModeVbr = "VBR"
|
|
)
|
|
|
|
const (
|
|
// M2tsScte35ControlNone is a M2tsScte35Control enum value
|
|
M2tsScte35ControlNone = "NONE"
|
|
|
|
// M2tsScte35ControlPassthrough is a M2tsScte35Control enum value
|
|
M2tsScte35ControlPassthrough = "PASSTHROUGH"
|
|
)
|
|
|
|
const (
|
|
// M2tsSegmentationMarkersEbp is a M2tsSegmentationMarkers enum value
|
|
M2tsSegmentationMarkersEbp = "EBP"
|
|
|
|
// M2tsSegmentationMarkersEbpLegacy is a M2tsSegmentationMarkers enum value
|
|
M2tsSegmentationMarkersEbpLegacy = "EBP_LEGACY"
|
|
|
|
// M2tsSegmentationMarkersNone is a M2tsSegmentationMarkers enum value
|
|
M2tsSegmentationMarkersNone = "NONE"
|
|
|
|
// M2tsSegmentationMarkersPsiSegstart is a M2tsSegmentationMarkers enum value
|
|
M2tsSegmentationMarkersPsiSegstart = "PSI_SEGSTART"
|
|
|
|
// M2tsSegmentationMarkersRaiAdapt is a M2tsSegmentationMarkers enum value
|
|
M2tsSegmentationMarkersRaiAdapt = "RAI_ADAPT"
|
|
|
|
// M2tsSegmentationMarkersRaiSegstart is a M2tsSegmentationMarkers enum value
|
|
M2tsSegmentationMarkersRaiSegstart = "RAI_SEGSTART"
|
|
)
|
|
|
|
const (
|
|
// M2tsSegmentationStyleMaintainCadence is a M2tsSegmentationStyle enum value
|
|
M2tsSegmentationStyleMaintainCadence = "MAINTAIN_CADENCE"
|
|
|
|
// M2tsSegmentationStyleResetCadence is a M2tsSegmentationStyle enum value
|
|
M2tsSegmentationStyleResetCadence = "RESET_CADENCE"
|
|
)
|
|
|
|
const (
|
|
// M2tsTimedMetadataBehaviorNoPassthrough is a M2tsTimedMetadataBehavior enum value
|
|
M2tsTimedMetadataBehaviorNoPassthrough = "NO_PASSTHROUGH"
|
|
|
|
// M2tsTimedMetadataBehaviorPassthrough is a M2tsTimedMetadataBehavior enum value
|
|
M2tsTimedMetadataBehaviorPassthrough = "PASSTHROUGH"
|
|
)
|
|
|
|
const (
|
|
// M3u8PcrControlConfiguredPcrPeriod is a M3u8PcrControl enum value
|
|
M3u8PcrControlConfiguredPcrPeriod = "CONFIGURED_PCR_PERIOD"
|
|
|
|
// M3u8PcrControlPcrEveryPesPacket is a M3u8PcrControl enum value
|
|
M3u8PcrControlPcrEveryPesPacket = "PCR_EVERY_PES_PACKET"
|
|
)
|
|
|
|
const (
|
|
// M3u8Scte35BehaviorNoPassthrough is a M3u8Scte35Behavior enum value
|
|
M3u8Scte35BehaviorNoPassthrough = "NO_PASSTHROUGH"
|
|
|
|
// M3u8Scte35BehaviorPassthrough is a M3u8Scte35Behavior enum value
|
|
M3u8Scte35BehaviorPassthrough = "PASSTHROUGH"
|
|
)
|
|
|
|
const (
|
|
// M3u8TimedMetadataBehaviorNoPassthrough is a M3u8TimedMetadataBehavior enum value
|
|
M3u8TimedMetadataBehaviorNoPassthrough = "NO_PASSTHROUGH"
|
|
|
|
// M3u8TimedMetadataBehaviorPassthrough is a M3u8TimedMetadataBehavior enum value
|
|
M3u8TimedMetadataBehaviorPassthrough = "PASSTHROUGH"
|
|
)
|
|
|
|
const (
|
|
// Mp2CodingModeCodingMode10 is a Mp2CodingMode enum value
|
|
Mp2CodingModeCodingMode10 = "CODING_MODE_1_0"
|
|
|
|
// Mp2CodingModeCodingMode20 is a Mp2CodingMode enum value
|
|
Mp2CodingModeCodingMode20 = "CODING_MODE_2_0"
|
|
)
|
|
|
|
const (
|
|
// NetworkInputServerValidationCheckCryptographyAndValidateName is a NetworkInputServerValidation enum value
|
|
NetworkInputServerValidationCheckCryptographyAndValidateName = "CHECK_CRYPTOGRAPHY_AND_VALIDATE_NAME"
|
|
|
|
// NetworkInputServerValidationCheckCryptographyOnly is a NetworkInputServerValidation enum value
|
|
NetworkInputServerValidationCheckCryptographyOnly = "CHECK_CRYPTOGRAPHY_ONLY"
|
|
)
|
|
|
|
// Units for duration, e.g. 'MONTHS'
|
|
const (
|
|
// OfferingDurationUnitsMonths is a OfferingDurationUnits enum value
|
|
OfferingDurationUnitsMonths = "MONTHS"
|
|
)
|
|
|
|
// Offering type, e.g. 'NO_UPFRONT'
|
|
const (
|
|
// OfferingTypeNoUpfront is a OfferingType enum value
|
|
OfferingTypeNoUpfront = "NO_UPFRONT"
|
|
)
|
|
|
|
// Codec, 'MPEG2', 'AVC', 'HEVC', or 'AUDIO'
|
|
const (
|
|
// ReservationCodecMpeg2 is a ReservationCodec enum value
|
|
ReservationCodecMpeg2 = "MPEG2"
|
|
|
|
// ReservationCodecAvc is a ReservationCodec enum value
|
|
ReservationCodecAvc = "AVC"
|
|
|
|
// ReservationCodecHevc is a ReservationCodec enum value
|
|
ReservationCodecHevc = "HEVC"
|
|
|
|
// ReservationCodecAudio is a ReservationCodec enum value
|
|
ReservationCodecAudio = "AUDIO"
|
|
)
|
|
|
|
// Maximum bitrate in megabits per second
|
|
const (
|
|
// ReservationMaximumBitrateMax10Mbps is a ReservationMaximumBitrate enum value
|
|
ReservationMaximumBitrateMax10Mbps = "MAX_10_MBPS"
|
|
|
|
// ReservationMaximumBitrateMax20Mbps is a ReservationMaximumBitrate enum value
|
|
ReservationMaximumBitrateMax20Mbps = "MAX_20_MBPS"
|
|
|
|
// ReservationMaximumBitrateMax50Mbps is a ReservationMaximumBitrate enum value
|
|
ReservationMaximumBitrateMax50Mbps = "MAX_50_MBPS"
|
|
)
|
|
|
|
// Maximum framerate in frames per second (Outputs only)
|
|
const (
|
|
// ReservationMaximumFramerateMax30Fps is a ReservationMaximumFramerate enum value
|
|
ReservationMaximumFramerateMax30Fps = "MAX_30_FPS"
|
|
|
|
// ReservationMaximumFramerateMax60Fps is a ReservationMaximumFramerate enum value
|
|
ReservationMaximumFramerateMax60Fps = "MAX_60_FPS"
|
|
)
|
|
|
|
// Resolution based on lines of vertical resolution; SD is less than 720 lines,
|
|
// HD is 720 to 1080 lines, UHD is greater than 1080 lines
|
|
const (
|
|
// ReservationResolutionSd is a ReservationResolution enum value
|
|
ReservationResolutionSd = "SD"
|
|
|
|
// ReservationResolutionHd is a ReservationResolution enum value
|
|
ReservationResolutionHd = "HD"
|
|
|
|
// ReservationResolutionUhd is a ReservationResolution enum value
|
|
ReservationResolutionUhd = "UHD"
|
|
)
|
|
|
|
// Resource type, 'INPUT', 'OUTPUT', or 'CHANNEL'
|
|
const (
|
|
// ReservationResourceTypeInput is a ReservationResourceType enum value
|
|
ReservationResourceTypeInput = "INPUT"
|
|
|
|
// ReservationResourceTypeOutput is a ReservationResourceType enum value
|
|
ReservationResourceTypeOutput = "OUTPUT"
|
|
|
|
// ReservationResourceTypeChannel is a ReservationResourceType enum value
|
|
ReservationResourceTypeChannel = "CHANNEL"
|
|
)
|
|
|
|
// Special features, 'ADVANCED_AUDIO' or 'AUDIO_NORMALIZATION'
|
|
const (
|
|
// ReservationSpecialFeatureAdvancedAudio is a ReservationSpecialFeature enum value
|
|
ReservationSpecialFeatureAdvancedAudio = "ADVANCED_AUDIO"
|
|
|
|
// ReservationSpecialFeatureAudioNormalization is a ReservationSpecialFeature enum value
|
|
ReservationSpecialFeatureAudioNormalization = "AUDIO_NORMALIZATION"
|
|
)
|
|
|
|
// Current reservation state
|
|
const (
|
|
// ReservationStateActive is a ReservationState enum value
|
|
ReservationStateActive = "ACTIVE"
|
|
|
|
// ReservationStateExpired is a ReservationState enum value
|
|
ReservationStateExpired = "EXPIRED"
|
|
|
|
// ReservationStateCanceled is a ReservationState enum value
|
|
ReservationStateCanceled = "CANCELED"
|
|
|
|
// ReservationStateDeleted is a ReservationState enum value
|
|
ReservationStateDeleted = "DELETED"
|
|
)
|
|
|
|
// Video quality, e.g. 'STANDARD' (Outputs only)
|
|
const (
|
|
// ReservationVideoQualityStandard is a ReservationVideoQuality enum value
|
|
ReservationVideoQualityStandard = "STANDARD"
|
|
|
|
// ReservationVideoQualityEnhanced is a ReservationVideoQuality enum value
|
|
ReservationVideoQualityEnhanced = "ENHANCED"
|
|
|
|
// ReservationVideoQualityPremium is a ReservationVideoQuality enum value
|
|
ReservationVideoQualityPremium = "PREMIUM"
|
|
)
|
|
|
|
const (
|
|
// RtmpCacheFullBehaviorDisconnectImmediately is a RtmpCacheFullBehavior enum value
|
|
RtmpCacheFullBehaviorDisconnectImmediately = "DISCONNECT_IMMEDIATELY"
|
|
|
|
// RtmpCacheFullBehaviorWaitForServer is a RtmpCacheFullBehavior enum value
|
|
RtmpCacheFullBehaviorWaitForServer = "WAIT_FOR_SERVER"
|
|
)
|
|
|
|
const (
|
|
// RtmpCaptionDataAll is a RtmpCaptionData enum value
|
|
RtmpCaptionDataAll = "ALL"
|
|
|
|
// RtmpCaptionDataField1608 is a RtmpCaptionData enum value
|
|
RtmpCaptionDataField1608 = "FIELD1_608"
|
|
|
|
// RtmpCaptionDataField1AndField2608 is a RtmpCaptionData enum value
|
|
RtmpCaptionDataField1AndField2608 = "FIELD1_AND_FIELD2_608"
|
|
)
|
|
|
|
const (
|
|
// RtmpOutputCertificateModeSelfSigned is a RtmpOutputCertificateMode enum value
|
|
RtmpOutputCertificateModeSelfSigned = "SELF_SIGNED"
|
|
|
|
// RtmpOutputCertificateModeVerifyAuthenticity is a RtmpOutputCertificateMode enum value
|
|
RtmpOutputCertificateModeVerifyAuthenticity = "VERIFY_AUTHENTICITY"
|
|
)
|
|
|
|
const (
|
|
// Scte20Convert608To708Disabled is a Scte20Convert608To708 enum value
|
|
Scte20Convert608To708Disabled = "DISABLED"
|
|
|
|
// Scte20Convert608To708Upconvert is a Scte20Convert608To708 enum value
|
|
Scte20Convert608To708Upconvert = "UPCONVERT"
|
|
)
|
|
|
|
const (
|
|
// Scte35AposNoRegionalBlackoutBehaviorFollow is a Scte35AposNoRegionalBlackoutBehavior enum value
|
|
Scte35AposNoRegionalBlackoutBehaviorFollow = "FOLLOW"
|
|
|
|
// Scte35AposNoRegionalBlackoutBehaviorIgnore is a Scte35AposNoRegionalBlackoutBehavior enum value
|
|
Scte35AposNoRegionalBlackoutBehaviorIgnore = "IGNORE"
|
|
)
|
|
|
|
const (
|
|
// Scte35AposWebDeliveryAllowedBehaviorFollow is a Scte35AposWebDeliveryAllowedBehavior enum value
|
|
Scte35AposWebDeliveryAllowedBehaviorFollow = "FOLLOW"
|
|
|
|
// Scte35AposWebDeliveryAllowedBehaviorIgnore is a Scte35AposWebDeliveryAllowedBehavior enum value
|
|
Scte35AposWebDeliveryAllowedBehaviorIgnore = "IGNORE"
|
|
)
|
|
|
|
// Corresponds to the archive_allowed parameter. A value of ARCHIVE_NOT_ALLOWED
|
|
// corresponds to 0 (false) in the SCTE-35 specification. If you include one
|
|
// of the "restriction" flags then you must include all four of them.
|
|
const (
|
|
// Scte35ArchiveAllowedFlagArchiveNotAllowed is a Scte35ArchiveAllowedFlag enum value
|
|
Scte35ArchiveAllowedFlagArchiveNotAllowed = "ARCHIVE_NOT_ALLOWED"
|
|
|
|
// Scte35ArchiveAllowedFlagArchiveAllowed is a Scte35ArchiveAllowedFlag enum value
|
|
Scte35ArchiveAllowedFlagArchiveAllowed = "ARCHIVE_ALLOWED"
|
|
)
|
|
|
|
// Corresponds to the device_restrictions parameter in a segmentation_descriptor.
|
|
// If you include one of the "restriction" flags then you must include all four
|
|
// of them.
|
|
const (
|
|
// Scte35DeviceRestrictionsNone is a Scte35DeviceRestrictions enum value
|
|
Scte35DeviceRestrictionsNone = "NONE"
|
|
|
|
// Scte35DeviceRestrictionsRestrictGroup0 is a Scte35DeviceRestrictions enum value
|
|
Scte35DeviceRestrictionsRestrictGroup0 = "RESTRICT_GROUP0"
|
|
|
|
// Scte35DeviceRestrictionsRestrictGroup1 is a Scte35DeviceRestrictions enum value
|
|
Scte35DeviceRestrictionsRestrictGroup1 = "RESTRICT_GROUP1"
|
|
|
|
// Scte35DeviceRestrictionsRestrictGroup2 is a Scte35DeviceRestrictions enum value
|
|
Scte35DeviceRestrictionsRestrictGroup2 = "RESTRICT_GROUP2"
|
|
)
|
|
|
|
// Corresponds to the no_regional_blackout_flag parameter. A value of REGIONAL_BLACKOUT
|
|
// corresponds to 0 (false) in the SCTE-35 specification. If you include one
|
|
// of the "restriction" flags then you must include all four of them.
|
|
const (
|
|
// Scte35NoRegionalBlackoutFlagRegionalBlackout is a Scte35NoRegionalBlackoutFlag enum value
|
|
Scte35NoRegionalBlackoutFlagRegionalBlackout = "REGIONAL_BLACKOUT"
|
|
|
|
// Scte35NoRegionalBlackoutFlagNoRegionalBlackout is a Scte35NoRegionalBlackoutFlag enum value
|
|
Scte35NoRegionalBlackoutFlagNoRegionalBlackout = "NO_REGIONAL_BLACKOUT"
|
|
)
|
|
|
|
// Corresponds to SCTE-35 segmentation_event_cancel_indicator. SEGMENTATION_EVENT_NOT_CANCELED
|
|
// corresponds to 0 in the SCTE-35 specification and indicates that this is
|
|
// an insertion request. SEGMENTATION_EVENT_CANCELED corresponds to 1 in the
|
|
// SCTE-35 specification and indicates that this is a cancelation request, in
|
|
// which case complete this field and the existing event ID to cancel.
|
|
const (
|
|
// Scte35SegmentationCancelIndicatorSegmentationEventNotCanceled is a Scte35SegmentationCancelIndicator enum value
|
|
Scte35SegmentationCancelIndicatorSegmentationEventNotCanceled = "SEGMENTATION_EVENT_NOT_CANCELED"
|
|
|
|
// Scte35SegmentationCancelIndicatorSegmentationEventCanceled is a Scte35SegmentationCancelIndicator enum value
|
|
Scte35SegmentationCancelIndicatorSegmentationEventCanceled = "SEGMENTATION_EVENT_CANCELED"
|
|
)
|
|
|
|
const (
|
|
// Scte35SpliceInsertNoRegionalBlackoutBehaviorFollow is a Scte35SpliceInsertNoRegionalBlackoutBehavior enum value
|
|
Scte35SpliceInsertNoRegionalBlackoutBehaviorFollow = "FOLLOW"
|
|
|
|
// Scte35SpliceInsertNoRegionalBlackoutBehaviorIgnore is a Scte35SpliceInsertNoRegionalBlackoutBehavior enum value
|
|
Scte35SpliceInsertNoRegionalBlackoutBehaviorIgnore = "IGNORE"
|
|
)
|
|
|
|
const (
|
|
// Scte35SpliceInsertWebDeliveryAllowedBehaviorFollow is a Scte35SpliceInsertWebDeliveryAllowedBehavior enum value
|
|
Scte35SpliceInsertWebDeliveryAllowedBehaviorFollow = "FOLLOW"
|
|
|
|
// Scte35SpliceInsertWebDeliveryAllowedBehaviorIgnore is a Scte35SpliceInsertWebDeliveryAllowedBehavior enum value
|
|
Scte35SpliceInsertWebDeliveryAllowedBehaviorIgnore = "IGNORE"
|
|
)
|
|
|
|
// Corresponds to the web_delivery_allowed_flag parameter. A value of WEB_DELIVERY_NOT_ALLOWED
|
|
// corresponds to 0 (false) in the SCTE-35 specification. If you include one
|
|
// of the "restriction" flags then you must include all four of them.
|
|
const (
|
|
// Scte35WebDeliveryAllowedFlagWebDeliveryNotAllowed is a Scte35WebDeliveryAllowedFlag enum value
|
|
Scte35WebDeliveryAllowedFlagWebDeliveryNotAllowed = "WEB_DELIVERY_NOT_ALLOWED"
|
|
|
|
// Scte35WebDeliveryAllowedFlagWebDeliveryAllowed is a Scte35WebDeliveryAllowedFlag enum value
|
|
Scte35WebDeliveryAllowedFlagWebDeliveryAllowed = "WEB_DELIVERY_ALLOWED"
|
|
)
|
|
|
|
const (
|
|
// SmoothGroupAudioOnlyTimecodeControlPassthrough is a SmoothGroupAudioOnlyTimecodeControl enum value
|
|
SmoothGroupAudioOnlyTimecodeControlPassthrough = "PASSTHROUGH"
|
|
|
|
// SmoothGroupAudioOnlyTimecodeControlUseConfiguredClock is a SmoothGroupAudioOnlyTimecodeControl enum value
|
|
SmoothGroupAudioOnlyTimecodeControlUseConfiguredClock = "USE_CONFIGURED_CLOCK"
|
|
)
|
|
|
|
const (
|
|
// SmoothGroupCertificateModeSelfSigned is a SmoothGroupCertificateMode enum value
|
|
SmoothGroupCertificateModeSelfSigned = "SELF_SIGNED"
|
|
|
|
// SmoothGroupCertificateModeVerifyAuthenticity is a SmoothGroupCertificateMode enum value
|
|
SmoothGroupCertificateModeVerifyAuthenticity = "VERIFY_AUTHENTICITY"
|
|
)
|
|
|
|
const (
|
|
// SmoothGroupEventIdModeNoEventId is a SmoothGroupEventIdMode enum value
|
|
SmoothGroupEventIdModeNoEventId = "NO_EVENT_ID"
|
|
|
|
// SmoothGroupEventIdModeUseConfigured is a SmoothGroupEventIdMode enum value
|
|
SmoothGroupEventIdModeUseConfigured = "USE_CONFIGURED"
|
|
|
|
// SmoothGroupEventIdModeUseTimestamp is a SmoothGroupEventIdMode enum value
|
|
SmoothGroupEventIdModeUseTimestamp = "USE_TIMESTAMP"
|
|
)
|
|
|
|
const (
|
|
// SmoothGroupEventStopBehaviorNone is a SmoothGroupEventStopBehavior enum value
|
|
SmoothGroupEventStopBehaviorNone = "NONE"
|
|
|
|
// SmoothGroupEventStopBehaviorSendEos is a SmoothGroupEventStopBehavior enum value
|
|
SmoothGroupEventStopBehaviorSendEos = "SEND_EOS"
|
|
)
|
|
|
|
const (
|
|
// SmoothGroupSegmentationModeUseInputSegmentation is a SmoothGroupSegmentationMode enum value
|
|
SmoothGroupSegmentationModeUseInputSegmentation = "USE_INPUT_SEGMENTATION"
|
|
|
|
// SmoothGroupSegmentationModeUseSegmentDuration is a SmoothGroupSegmentationMode enum value
|
|
SmoothGroupSegmentationModeUseSegmentDuration = "USE_SEGMENT_DURATION"
|
|
)
|
|
|
|
const (
|
|
// SmoothGroupSparseTrackTypeNone is a SmoothGroupSparseTrackType enum value
|
|
SmoothGroupSparseTrackTypeNone = "NONE"
|
|
|
|
// SmoothGroupSparseTrackTypeScte35 is a SmoothGroupSparseTrackType enum value
|
|
SmoothGroupSparseTrackTypeScte35 = "SCTE_35"
|
|
)
|
|
|
|
const (
|
|
// SmoothGroupStreamManifestBehaviorDoNotSend is a SmoothGroupStreamManifestBehavior enum value
|
|
SmoothGroupStreamManifestBehaviorDoNotSend = "DO_NOT_SEND"
|
|
|
|
// SmoothGroupStreamManifestBehaviorSend is a SmoothGroupStreamManifestBehavior enum value
|
|
SmoothGroupStreamManifestBehaviorSend = "SEND"
|
|
)
|
|
|
|
const (
|
|
// SmoothGroupTimestampOffsetModeUseConfiguredOffset is a SmoothGroupTimestampOffsetMode enum value
|
|
SmoothGroupTimestampOffsetModeUseConfiguredOffset = "USE_CONFIGURED_OFFSET"
|
|
|
|
// SmoothGroupTimestampOffsetModeUseEventStartDate is a SmoothGroupTimestampOffsetMode enum value
|
|
SmoothGroupTimestampOffsetModeUseEventStartDate = "USE_EVENT_START_DATE"
|
|
)
|
|
|
|
const (
|
|
// TimecodeConfigSourceEmbedded is a TimecodeConfigSource enum value
|
|
TimecodeConfigSourceEmbedded = "EMBEDDED"
|
|
|
|
// TimecodeConfigSourceSystemclock is a TimecodeConfigSource enum value
|
|
TimecodeConfigSourceSystemclock = "SYSTEMCLOCK"
|
|
|
|
// TimecodeConfigSourceZerobased is a TimecodeConfigSource enum value
|
|
TimecodeConfigSourceZerobased = "ZEROBASED"
|
|
)
|
|
|
|
const (
|
|
// TtmlDestinationStyleControlPassthrough is a TtmlDestinationStyleControl enum value
|
|
TtmlDestinationStyleControlPassthrough = "PASSTHROUGH"
|
|
|
|
// TtmlDestinationStyleControlUseConfigured is a TtmlDestinationStyleControl enum value
|
|
TtmlDestinationStyleControlUseConfigured = "USE_CONFIGURED"
|
|
)
|
|
|
|
const (
|
|
// UdpTimedMetadataId3FrameNone is a UdpTimedMetadataId3Frame enum value
|
|
UdpTimedMetadataId3FrameNone = "NONE"
|
|
|
|
// UdpTimedMetadataId3FramePriv is a UdpTimedMetadataId3Frame enum value
|
|
UdpTimedMetadataId3FramePriv = "PRIV"
|
|
|
|
// UdpTimedMetadataId3FrameTdrl is a UdpTimedMetadataId3Frame enum value
|
|
UdpTimedMetadataId3FrameTdrl = "TDRL"
|
|
)
|
|
|
|
const (
|
|
// VideoDescriptionRespondToAfdNone is a VideoDescriptionRespondToAfd enum value
|
|
VideoDescriptionRespondToAfdNone = "NONE"
|
|
|
|
// VideoDescriptionRespondToAfdPassthrough is a VideoDescriptionRespondToAfd enum value
|
|
VideoDescriptionRespondToAfdPassthrough = "PASSTHROUGH"
|
|
|
|
// VideoDescriptionRespondToAfdRespond is a VideoDescriptionRespondToAfd enum value
|
|
VideoDescriptionRespondToAfdRespond = "RESPOND"
|
|
)
|
|
|
|
const (
|
|
// VideoDescriptionScalingBehaviorDefault is a VideoDescriptionScalingBehavior enum value
|
|
VideoDescriptionScalingBehaviorDefault = "DEFAULT"
|
|
|
|
// VideoDescriptionScalingBehaviorStretchToOutput is a VideoDescriptionScalingBehavior enum value
|
|
VideoDescriptionScalingBehaviorStretchToOutput = "STRETCH_TO_OUTPUT"
|
|
)
|
|
|
|
const (
|
|
// VideoSelectorColorSpaceFollow is a VideoSelectorColorSpace enum value
|
|
VideoSelectorColorSpaceFollow = "FOLLOW"
|
|
|
|
// VideoSelectorColorSpaceRec601 is a VideoSelectorColorSpace enum value
|
|
VideoSelectorColorSpaceRec601 = "REC_601"
|
|
|
|
// VideoSelectorColorSpaceRec709 is a VideoSelectorColorSpace enum value
|
|
VideoSelectorColorSpaceRec709 = "REC_709"
|
|
)
|
|
|
|
const (
|
|
// VideoSelectorColorSpaceUsageFallback is a VideoSelectorColorSpaceUsage enum value
|
|
VideoSelectorColorSpaceUsageFallback = "FALLBACK"
|
|
|
|
// VideoSelectorColorSpaceUsageForce is a VideoSelectorColorSpaceUsage enum value
|
|
VideoSelectorColorSpaceUsageForce = "FORCE"
|
|
)
|